STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
February 28, 2024 (as revised _________, 2024)
NATIONWIDE MUTUAL FUNDS
Nationwide Amundi
Strategic Income Fund
Class A (NWXEX)
Class R6 (NWXGX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWXHX)
Nationwide Bailard
Cognitive Value Fund
Class A (NWHDX)
Class M (NWHFX)
Class R6 (NWHGX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWHHX)
Nationwide Bailard
International Equities
Fund
Class A (NWHJX)
Class M (NWHLX)
Class R6 (NWHMX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWHNX)
Nationwide Bailard
Technology & Science
Fund
Class A (NWHOX)
Class M (NWHQX)
Class R6 (NWHTX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWHUX)
Nationwide BNY
Mellon Core Plus
Bond ESG Fund
Class A (NWCPX)
Class R6 (NWCIX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWCSX)
Nationwide BNY
Mellon Dynamic
U.S. Core Fund Class A
(NMFAX)
Class R (GGFRX)
Class R6 (MUIGX)
Institutional Service
Class (NGISX)
Eagle Class (NWAEX)
Nationwide BNY
Mellon Dynamic
U.S. Equity Income
Fund (formerly,
Nationwide BNY Mellon
Disciplined Value Fund)
Class A (NWALX)
Class K (NWAMX)
Class R6 (NWANX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWAOX)
Eagle Class (NWAPX)
Nationwide Bond
Fund
Class A (NBDAX)
Class R6 (NWIBX)
Institutional Service
Class (MUIBX)
Nationwide Bond
Index Fund
Class A (GBIAX)
Class R (n/a)
Class R6 (GBXIX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWXOX)
Nationwide Fund
Class A (NWFAX)
Class R (GNWRX)
Class R6 (NWABX)
Institutional Service
Class (MUIFX)
Nationwide Geneva
Mid Cap Growth Fund
Class A (NWHVX)
Class R6 (NWKAX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWHYX)
Nationwide Geneva
Small Cap Growth
Fund
Class A (NWHZX)
Class R6 (NWKCX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWKDX)
Nationwide Global
Sustainable Equity
Fund
Class A (GGEAX)
Class R6 (GGEIX)
Institutional Service
Class (GGESX)
Nationwide
Government Money
Market Fund
Investor Shares
(MIFXX)
Class R6 (GMIXX)
Service
Class (NWSXX)
Nationwide GQG US
Quality Equity Fund
Class A (NWAUX)
Class R6 (NWAVX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWAWX)
Eagle Class (NWAYX)
Nationwide Inflation-
Protected Securities
Fund
Class A (NIFAX)
Class R6 (NIFIX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWXNX)
Nationwide
International Index
Fund
Class A (GIIAX)
Class R (GIIRX)
Class R6 (GIXIX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWXPX)
Nationwide
International Small
Cap Fund
Class A (NWXSX)
Class R6 (NWXUX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWXVX)
Nationwide Janus
Henderson Overseas
Fund
Class A (NWAGX)
Class R6 (NWAHX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWAKX)
Eagle Class (NWAJX)
Nationwide Loomis All
Cap Growth Fund
Class A (NWZLX)
Class R6 (NWZMX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWZNX)
Eagle Class (NWADX)
Nationwide Loomis
Core Bond Fund
Class A (NWJGX)
Class R6 (NWJIX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWJJX)
Eagle Class [( )]
Nationwide Loomis
Short Term Bond
Fund
Class A (NWJSX)
Class R6 (NWJUX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWJVX)
Nationwide Mid Cap
Market Index Fund
Class A (GMXAX)
Class R (GMXRX)
Class R6 (GMXIX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWXQX)
Nationwide NYSE
Arca Tech 100 Index
Fund
Class A (NWJCX)
Class R6 (NWJEX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWJFX)
Nationwide S&P 500
Index Fund
Class A (GRMAX)
Class R (GRMRX)
Class R6 (GRMIX)
Service
Class (GRMSX)
Institutional Service
Class (GRISX)

Nationwide Small Cap
Index Fund
Class A (GMRAX)
Class R (GMSRX)
Class R6 (GMRIX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWXRX)
Nationwide Small
Company Growth
Fund
Class A (NWSAX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWSIX)
Nationwide WCM
Focused Small Cap
Fund
Class A (NWGPX)
Class R6 (NWKEX)
Institutional Service
Class (NWGSX)
 
 

Nationwide Mutual Funds (the “Trust”), a Delaware statutory trust, is a registered open-end investment company currently consisting of 47 series as of the date hereof. This Statement of Additional Information (“SAI”) relates to the 28 series of the Trust which are listed above (each, a “Fund” and collectively, the “Funds”).
This SAI is not a prospectus but is incorporated by reference into the following Prospectuses. It contains information in addition to and more detailed than that set forth in the Prospectuses for the Funds and should be read in conjunction with the following Prospectuses:
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund, Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund, Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund, Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund (formerly, Nationwide BNY Mellon Disciplined Value Fund), Nationwide Fund, Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund, Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund, Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund, Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund, Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund and Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund dated February 28, 2024;
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund, Nationwide Bond Fund, Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund and Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund dated February 28, 2024 (as revised ________, 2024);
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund, dated February 28, 2024 (as revised ________, 2024);
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund, Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund, Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund, Nationwide International Small Cap Fund and Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund, dated February 28, 2024; and
Nationwide Bond Index Fund, Nationwide International Index Fund, Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund, Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund, Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund and Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund and dated February 28, 2024.
Terms not defined in this SAI have the meanings assigned to them in the Prospectuses. The Prospectuses are posted on the Funds' website, nationwide.com/mutualfundprospectuses, or may be obtained from Nationwide Mutual Funds, P.O. Box 701, Milwaukee, Wisconsin 53201-0701 or by calling toll free 800-848-0920.
The Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm and Financial Statements of the Trust for the fiscal year ended October 31, 2023, included in the Trust’s Annual Report are incorporated herein by reference. Copies of the Annual Report and Semi-Annual Report are available without charge upon request by writing the Trust or by calling toll free 800-848-0920.
THE TRUST’S INVESTMENT COMPANY ACT FILE NO.: 811-08495
iii

TABLE OF CONTENTS
Page
1
2
54
55
57
58
67
84
95
100
102
103
105
105
107
122
A-1
B-1
C-1
D-1
iv

General Information and History
Nationwide Mutual Funds (the “Trust”) is an open-end management investment company organized under the laws of the state of Delaware on October 1, 2004, pursuant to a Second Amended and Restated Agreement and Declaration of Trust dated June 17, 2009 (the “Second Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust”). The Trust currently consists of 47 separate series, each with its own investment objective.
Except for the Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund, each of the Funds featured herein is a diversified fund as defined in the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the “1940 Act”). The Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund is a non-diversified fund, as defined in the 1940 Act.
The Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund commenced operations on November 19, 2012 as a result of a reorganization in which the Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund acquired all of the assets, subject to stated liabilities, of the UBS Global Equity Fund, a former series of The UBS Funds. The Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund has adopted the historical performance of the UBS Global Equity Fund and had substantially similar investment goals and strategies as the UBS Global Equity Fund at the time of the reorganization.
The Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund commenced operations on April 22, 2013, as a result of a reorganization in which the Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund acquired all of the assets, subject to stated liabilities, of the TS&W Fixed Income Portfolio, a former series of The Advisors’ Inner Circle Fund (the “AIC Predecessor Fund”). The Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund has adopted the historical performance of the AIC Predecessor Fund and had substantially similar investment goals and strategies as the AIC Predecessor Fund at the time of the reorganization.
Each of the Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund, Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund, Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund, Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund, Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund, Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund, Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund, Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund and Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund, commenced operations on September 16, 2013, as a result of a reorganization in which the Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund, Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund, Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund, Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund, Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund, Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund, Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund, Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund and Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund, acquired all of the assets, subject to stated liabilities, of the HighMark Cognitive Value Fund, HighMark Enhanced Growth Fund, HighMark Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund, HighMark Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund, HighMark International Opportunities Fund, HighMark NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund, HighMark Small Cap Core Fund, HighMark Bond Fund and HighMark Short Term Bond Fund, respectively, each a former series of HighMark Funds (each a “Predecessor Fund,” and collectively the “Predecessor Funds”). Each of these Funds have adopted the historical performance of its corresponding Predecessor Fund. Each such Fund and its corresponding Predecessor Fund had substantially similar investment goals and strategies at the time of the reorganization.
The Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund commenced operations on June 3, 2019, as a result of a reorganization in which the Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund acquired all of the assets, subject to stated liabilities, of the AllianzGI International Growth Fund, a former series of Allianz Funds Multi-Strategy Trust (the “Predecessor Fund”). The Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund has adopted the historical performance of the Predecessor Fund. At the time of the reorganization, the Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund and the Predecessor Fund had substantially similar investment goals and strategies.
The Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund (formerly, Nationwide BNY Mellon Disciplined Value Fund) commenced operations on December 16, 2019, as a result of a reorganization in which the Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund acquired all of the assets, subject to stated liabilities, of the BNY Mellon Disciplined Stock Fund, a former series of BNY Mellon Investment Funds IV, Inc. (the “Predecessor Fund”). The Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund has adopted the historical performance of the Predecessor Fund. At the time of the reorganization, the Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund and the Predecessor Fund had similar investment goals, although the Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund and the Predecessor Fund had different investment objectives. Further, while the Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund and the Predecessor Fund shared some investment strategies and policies, certain of the Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund’s investment strategies and policies were different from those of the Predecessor Fund.
1

Additional Information on Portfolio Instruments, Strategies
and Investment Policies
The Funds invest in a variety of securities and employ a number of investment techniques, which involve certain risks. The Prospectuses discuss each Fund’s principal investment strategies, investment techniques and risks. Therefore, you should carefully review a Fund’s Prospectus. This SAI contains information about non-principal investment strategies the Funds may use, as well as further information about certain principal strategies that are discussed in the Prospectuses. The discussion of investments in this SAI is qualified by Rule 2a-7 limitations with respect to the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund.
For purposes of this SAI, each of the following Funds (either singly or collectively) is referred to as the “Equity Funds”:
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund
Nationwide Fund
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund
Nationwide International Index Fund
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
For purposes of this SAI, each of the following Funds (either singly or collectively) is referred to as the “Fixed-Income Funds”:
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
Nationwide Bond Fund
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
For purposes of this SAI, each of the following Funds (either singly or collectively) is referred to as the “Index Funds”:
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
Nationwide International Index Fund
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
Bank and Corporate Loans
With the exception of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, each of the Fixed-Income Funds may invest in bank or corporate loans. Bank or corporate loans are generally non-investment grade floating rate instruments. Usually, they are freely callable at the issuer’s option. A Fund may invest in fixed and floating rate loans (“Loans”) arranged through private negotiations between a corporate borrower or a foreign sovereign entity and one or more financial institutions (“Lenders”). A Fund may invest in such Loans in the form of participations in Loans (“Participations”) and assignments of all or a portion of Loans from third parties (“Assignments”). A Fund considers these investments to be investments in debt securities for purposes of its investment policies. Participations typically will result in a Fund having a contractual relationship only with the Lender, not with the borrower. A Fund will have the right to receive payments of principal, interest and any fees to which it is entitled only from the Lender selling the Participation and only upon receipt by the Lender of the payments from the borrower. In connection with purchasing Participations, a Fund generally will have no right to enforce compliance by the borrower with the terms of the loan agreement relating to the Loans, nor any rights of set-off against the borrower, and a Fund may not benefit directly from any collateral supporting the Loan in which it has purchased the Participation. As a result, a Fund will assume the credit risk of both the borrower and the Lender that is selling the Participation. In the event of the insolvency of the Lender selling the Participation, a Fund may be treated as a general creditor of the Lender and may not benefit from any set-off between the Lender and the borrower. When a Fund purchases Assignments from Lenders, a Fund will acquire direct rights against the borrower on the Loan, and will not have exposure to a counterparty’s credit risk. A Fund may enter into Participations and Assignments on a forward commitment or “when
2

issued” basis, whereby a Fund would agree to purchase a Participation or Assignment at set terms in the future. For more information on forward commitments and when issued securities, see “When Issued Securities and Delayed-Delivery Transactions” below.
A Fund may have difficulty disposing of Assignments and Participations. In certain cases, the market for such instruments is not highly liquid, and therefore a Fund anticipates that in such cases such instruments could be sold only to a limited number of institutional investors. The lack of a highly liquid secondary market may have an adverse impact on the value of such instruments and on a Fund’s ability to dispose of particular Assignments or Participations in response to a specific economic event, such as deterioration in the creditworthiness of the borrower. Assignments and Participations will not be considered illiquid so long as it is determined by a Fund’s subadviser that an adequate trading market exists for these securities. To the extent that liquid Assignments and Participations that a Fund holds become illiquid, due to the lack of sufficient buyers or market or other conditions, the percentage of a Fund’s assets invested in illiquid assets would increase.
Leading financial institutions often act as agent for a broader group of lenders, generally referred to as a syndicate. The syndicate’s agent arranges the loans, holds collateral and accepts payments of principal and interest. If the agent develops financial problems, a Fund may not recover its investment or recovery may be delayed.
The Loans in which a Fund may invest are subject to the risk of loss of principal and income. Although borrowers frequently provide collateral to secure repayment of these obligations they do not always do so. If they do provide collateral, the value of the collateral may not completely cover the borrower’s obligations at the time of a default. If a borrower files for protection from its creditors under the U.S. bankruptcy laws, these laws may limit a Fund’s rights to its collateral. In addition, the value of collateral may erode during a bankruptcy case. In the event of a bankruptcy, the holder of a Loan may not recover its principal, may experience a long delay in recovering its investment and may not receive interest during the delay.
In certain circumstances, Loans may not be deemed to be securities under certain federal securities laws. Therefore, in the event of fraud or misrepresentation by a borrower or an arranger, Lenders and purchasers of interests in Loans, such as a Fund, may not have the protection of the anti-fraud provisions of the federal securities laws as would otherwise be available for bonds or stocks. Instead, in such cases, parties generally would rely on the contractual provisions in the Loan agreement itself and common-law fraud protections under applicable state law.
Borrowing
Each Fund may borrow money from banks, limited by each Fund’s fundamental investment restriction (generally, 33 13% of its total assets (including the amount borrowed)), including borrowings for temporary or emergency purposes. In addition to borrowings that are subject to 300% asset coverage and are considered by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) to be permitted “senior securities,” each Fund is also permitted under the 1940 Act to borrow for temporary purposes in an amount not exceeding 5% of the value of its total assets at the time when the loan is made. A loan will be presumed to be for temporary purposes if it is repaid within 60 days and is not extended or renewed.
Leverage. The use of leverage by a Fund creates an opportunity for greater total return, but, at the same time, creates special risks. For example, leveraging may exaggerate changes in the net asset value of Fund shares and in the return on a Fund’s portfolio. Although the principal of such borrowings will be fixed, a Fund’s assets may change in value during the time the borrowings are outstanding. Borrowings will create interest expenses for the Fund which can exceed the income from the assets purchased with the borrowings. To the extent the income or capital appreciation derived from securities purchased with borrowed funds exceeds the interest a Fund will have to pay on the borrowings, the Fund’s return will be greater than if leverage had not been used. Conversely, if the income or capital appreciation from the securities purchased with such borrowed funds is not sufficient to cover the cost of borrowing, the return to a Fund will be less than if leverage had not been used, and therefore the amount available for distribution to shareholders as dividends and other distributions will be reduced. In the latter case, a Fund’s portfolio management in its best judgment nevertheless may determine to maintain the Fund’s leveraged position if it expects that the benefits to the Fund’s shareholders of maintaining the leveraged position will outweigh the current reduced return.
Certain types of borrowings by a Fund may result in the Fund being subject to covenants in credit agreements relating to asset coverage, portfolio composition requirements and other matters. It is not anticipated that observance of such covenants would impede the Fund’s portfolio management from managing a Fund’s portfolio in accordance with the Fund’s investment
3

objectives and policies. However, a breach of any such covenants not cured within the specified cure period may result in acceleration of outstanding indebtedness and require the Fund to dispose of portfolio investments at a time when it may be disadvantageous to do so.
Brady Bonds
Except for the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, each of the Fixed-Income Funds may invest in Brady Bonds. Brady Bonds are debt securities, generally denominated in U.S. dollars, issued under the framework of the Brady Plan. The Brady Plan is an initiative announced by former U.S. Treasury Secretary Nicholas F. Brady in 1989 as a mechanism for debtor nations to restructure their outstanding external commercial bank indebtedness. In restructuring its external debt under the Brady Plan framework, a debtor nation negotiates with its existing bank lenders as well as multilateral institutions such as the International Bank for Reconstruction and Development (the “World Bank”) and the International Monetary Fund (the “IMF”). The Brady Plan framework, as it has developed, contemplates the exchange of external commercial bank debt for newly issued bonds known as “Brady Bonds.” Brady Bonds may also be issued in respect of new money being advanced by existing lenders in connection with the debt restructuring. The World Bank and/or the IMF support the restructuring by providing funds pursuant to loan agreements or other arrangements that enable the debtor nation to collateralize the new Brady Bonds or to repurchase outstanding bank debt at a discount. Under these arrangements with the World Bank and/or the IMF, debtor nations have been required to agree to the implementation of certain domestic monetary and fiscal reforms. Such reforms have included the liberalization of trade and foreign investment, the privatization of state-owned enterprises and the setting of targets for public spending and borrowing. These policies and programs seek to promote the debtor country’s economic growth and development. Investors should also recognize that the Brady Plan only sets forth general guiding principles for economic reform and debt reduction, emphasizing that solutions must be negotiated on a case-by-case basis between debtor nations and their creditors. A Fund's portfolio management may believe that economic reforms undertaken by countries in connection with the issuance of Brady Bonds may make the debt of countries which have issued or have announced plans to issue Brady Bonds an attractive opportunity for investment. However, there can be no assurance that the portfolio management’s expectations with respect to Brady Bonds will be realized.
Agreements implemented under the Brady Plan to date are designed to achieve debt and debt-service reduction through specific options negotiated by a debtor nation with its creditors. As a result, the financial packages offered by each country differ. The types of options have included the exchange of outstanding commercial bank debt for bonds issued at 100% of face value of such debt which carry a below-market stated rate of interest (generally known as par bonds), bonds issued at a discount from the face value of such debt (generally known as discount bonds), bonds bearing an interest rate which increases over time and bonds issued in exchange for the advancement of new money by existing lenders. Regardless of the stated face amount and stated interest rate of the various types of Brady Bonds, a Fund will purchase Brady Bonds in secondary markets, as described below, in which the price and yield to the investor reflect market conditions at the time of purchase. Certain sovereign bonds are entitled to “value recovery payments” in certain circumstances, which in effect constitute supplemental interest payments but generally are not collateralized. Certain Brady Bonds have been collateralized as to principal due date at maturity (typically 30 years from the date of issuance) by U.S. Treasury zero coupon bonds with a maturity equal to the final maturity of such Brady Bonds. The U.S. Treasury bonds purchased as collateral for such Brady Bonds are financed by the IMF, the World Bank and the debtor nations’ reserves. In addition, interest payments on certain types of Brady Bonds may be collateralized by cash or high-grade securities in amounts that typically represent between 12 and 18 months of interest accruals on these instruments with the balance of the interest accruals being uncollateralized. In the event of a default with respect to collateralized Brady Bonds as a result of which the payment obligations of the issuer are accelerated, the U.S. Treasury zero coupon obligations held as collateral for the payment of principal will not be distributed to investors, nor will such obligations be sold and the proceeds distributed. The collateral will be held by the collateral agent to the scheduled maturity of the defaulted Brady Bonds, which will continue to be outstanding, at which time the face amount of the collateral will equal the principal payments that would have then been due on the Brady Bonds in the normal course. However, in light of the residual risk of the Brady Bonds and, among other factors, the history of default with respect to commercial bank loans by public and private entities of countries issuing Brady Bonds, investments in Brady Bonds are considered speculative. Each Fund may purchase Brady Bonds with no or limited collateralization, and, for payment of interest and (except in the case of principal collateralized Brady Bonds) principal, will be relying primarily on the willingness and ability of the foreign government to make payment in accordance with the terms of the Brady Bonds.
4

Collateralized Debt Obligations
Except for the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, each of the Fixed-Income Funds may invest in collateralized debt obligations. Collateralized debt obligations (“CDOs”) are a type of asset-backed security and include, among other things, collateralized bond obligations (“CBOs”), collateralized loan obligations (“CLOs”) and other similarly structured securities. A CBO is a trust which is backed by a diversified pool of high risk, below investment grade fixed-income securities. A CLO is a trust typically collateralized by a pool of loans, which may include, among others, domestic and foreign senior secured loans, senior unsecured loans and subordinate corporate loans, including loans that may be rated below investment grade or equivalent unrated loans.
The cash flows from the CDO trust are split generally into two or more portions, called tranches, varying in risk and yield. Senior tranches are paid from the cash flows from the underlying assets before the junior tranches and equity or “first loss” tranches. Losses are first borne by the equity tranches, next by the junior tranches, and finally by the senior tranches. Senior tranches pay the lowest interest rates but generally are safer investments than more junior tranches because, should there be any default, senior tranches typically are paid first. The most junior tranches, such as equity tranches, would attract the highest interest rates but suffer the highest risk should the holder of an underlying loan default. If some loans default and the cash collected by the CDO is insufficient to pay all of its investors, those in the lowest, most junior tranches suffer losses first. Since it is partially protected from defaults, a senior tranche from a CDO trust typically has higher ratings and lower yields than the underlying securities, and can be rated investment grade. Despite the protection from the equity tranche, more senior CDO tranches can experience substantial losses due to actual defaults, increased sensitivity to defaults due to collateral default and disappearance of protecting tranches, market anticipation of defaults and aversion to CDO securities as a class.
The risks of an investment in a CDO depend largely on the quality and type of the collateral and the tranche of the CDO in which a Fund invests. Normally, CBOs, CLOs and other CDOs are privately offered and sold, and thus are not registered under the securities laws. As a result, investments in CDOs may be characterized by a Fund as illiquid securities; however, an active dealer market, or other relevant measures of liquidity, may exist for CDOs allowing a CDO potentially to be deemed liquid by the subadviser under liquidity policies approved by the Board of Trustees. In addition to the risks associated with debt instruments (e.g., interest rate risk and credit risk), CDOs carry additional risks including, but not limited to: (i) the possibility that distributions from collateral securities will not be adequate to make interest or other payments; (ii) the quality of the collateral may decline in value or default; (iii) the possibility that a Fund may invest in CDOs that are subordinate to other classes; and (iv) the complex structure of the security may not be fully understood at the time of investment and may produce disputes with the issuer or unexpected investment results.
Collateralized Loan Obligations (“CLOs”). Except for the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, each of the Fixed-Income Funds may invest in collateralized loan obligations. A CLO is a financing company (generally called a Special Purpose Vehicle or “SPV”), created to reapportion the risk and return characteristics of a pool of assets. While the assets underlying CLOs are typically senior loans, the assets also may include: (i) unsecured loans, (ii) other debt securities that are rated below investment grade, (iii) debt tranches of other CLOs and (iv) equity securities incidental to investments in senior loans. When investing in CLOs, a Fund will not invest in equity tranches, which are the lowest tranche. However, a Fund may invest in lower debt tranches of CLOs, which typically experience a lower recovery, greater risk of loss or deferral or non-payment of interest than more senior debt tranches of the CLO. In addition, a Fund may invest in CLOs consisting primarily of individual senior loans of borrowers and not repackaged CLO obligations from other high risk pools. The underlying senior loans purchased by CLOs generally are performing at the time of purchase but may become non-performing, distressed or defaulted. CLOs with underlying assets of non-performing, distressed or defaulted loans are not contemplated to comprise a significant portion of a Fund’s investments in CLOs. The key feature of the CLO structure is the prioritization of the cash flows from a pool of debt securities among the several classes of the CLO. The SPV is a company founded solely for the purpose of securitizing payment claims arising out of this diversified asset pool. On this basis, marketable securities are issued by the SPV which, due to the diversification of the underlying risk, generally represent a lower level of risk than the original assets. The redemption of the securities issued by the SPV typically takes place at maturity out of the cash flow generated by the collected claims. Holders of CLOs bear risks of the underlying investments, index or reference obligation and are subject to counterparty risk.
A Fund may have the right to receive payments only from the CLOs, and generally does not have direct rights against the issuer or the entity that sold the assets to be securitized. While certain CLOs enable the investor to acquire interests in a pool of securities without the brokerage and other expenses associated with directly holding the same securities, investors in
5

CLOs generally pay their share of the CLO’s administrative and other expenses. Although it is difficult to predict whether the prices of indices and securities underlying a CLO will rise or fall, these prices (and, therefore, the prices of CLOs) will be influenced by the same types of political and economic events that affect issuers of securities and capital markets generally. If the issuer of a CLO uses shorter term financing to purchase longer term securities, the issuer may be forced to sell its securities at below market prices if it experiences difficulty in obtaining short-term financing, which may adversely affect the value of the CLOs owned by a Fund.
Certain CLOs may be thinly traded or have a limited trading market. CLOs typically are offered and sold privately. As a result, investments in CLOs may be characterized by a Fund as illiquid securities. In addition to the general risks associated with debt securities discussed below, CLOs carry additional risks, including, but not limited to: (i) the possibility that distributions from collateral securities will not be adequate to make interest or other payments; (ii) the quality of the collateral may decline in value or default; (iii) the possibility that the investments in CLOs are subordinate to other classes or tranches thereof; and (iv) the complex structure of the security may not be fully understood at the time of investment and may produce disputes with the issuer or unexpected investment results.
Debt Obligations
Debt obligations are subject to the risk of an issuer’s inability to meet principal and interest payments on its obligations when due (“credit risk”) and are subject to price volatility due to such factors as interest rate sensitivity, market perception of the creditworthiness of the issuer, and general market liquidity. Lower-rated securities are more likely to react to developments affecting these risks than are more highly rated securities, which react primarily to movements in the general level of interest rates. Although the fluctuation in the price of debt securities is normally less than that of common stocks, in the past there have been extended periods of cyclical increases in interest rates that have caused significant declines in the price of debt securities in general and have caused the effective maturity of securities with prepayment features to be extended, thus effectively converting short or intermediate securities (which tend to be less volatile in price) into long-term securities (which tend to be more volatile in price). In addition, a corporate event such as a restructuring, merger, leveraged buyout, takeover, or similar action may cause a decline in market value of its securities or credit quality of the company’s bonds due to factors including an unfavorable market response or a resulting increase in the company’s debt. Added debt may significantly reduce the credit quality and market value of a company’s bonds, and may thereby affect the value of its equity securities as well.
Recent market data indicates that primary dealer inventories of corporate bonds appear to be at an all-time low, relative to the market size. A significant reduction in dealer market-making capacity has the potential to decrease liquidity and increase volatility in the fixed-income markets.
Changes to monetary policy by the Federal Reserve or other regulatory actions could expose fixed income and related markets to heightened volatility, interest rate sensitivity and reduced liquidity, which may impact a Fund’s operations and return potential.
Duration. Duration is a measure of the average life of a fixed-income security that was developed as a more precise alternative to the concepts of “term-to-maturity” or “average dollar weighted maturity” as measures of “volatility” or “risk” associated with changes in interest rates. Duration incorporates a security’s yield, coupon interest payments, final maturity and call features into one measure.
Most debt obligations provide interest (“coupon”) payments in addition to final (“par”) payment at maturity. Some obligations also have call provisions. Depending on the relative magnitude of these payments and the nature of the call provisions, the market values of debt obligations may respond differently to changes in interest rates.
Traditionally, a debt security’s “term-to-maturity” has been used as a measure of the sensitivity of the security’s price to changes in interest rates (which is the “interest rate risk” or “volatility” of the security). However, “term-to-maturity” measures only the time until a debt security provides its final payment, taking no account of the pattern of the security’s payments prior to maturity. Average dollar weighted maturity is calculated by averaging the terms of maturity of each debt security held with each maturity “weighted” according to the percentage of assets that it represents. Duration is a measure of the expected life of a debt security on a present value basis and reflects both principal and interest payments. Duration takes the length of the time intervals between the present time and the time that the interest and principal payments are scheduled or, in the case of a callable security, expected to be received, and weights them by the present values of the cash to be received
6

at each future point in time. For any debt security with interest payments occurring prior to the payment of principal, duration is ordinarily less than maturity. In general, all other factors being the same, the lower the stated or coupon rate of interest of a debt security, the longer the duration of the security; conversely, the higher the stated or coupon rate of interest of a debt security, the shorter the duration of the security.
There are some situations where the standard duration calculation does not properly reflect the interest rate exposure of a security. For example, floating- and variable-rate securities often have final maturities of ten or more years; however, their interest rate exposure corresponds to the frequency of the coupon reset. Another example where the interest rate exposure is not properly captured by duration is the case of mortgage pass-through securities. The stated final maturity of such securities is generally 30 years, but current prepayment rates are more critical in determining the securities’ interest rate exposure. In these and other similar situations, a Fund’s portfolio management will use more sophisticated analytical techniques to project the economic life of a security and estimate its interest rate exposure. Since the computation of duration is based on predictions of future events rather than known factors, there can be no assurance that a Fund will at all times achieve its targeted portfolio duration.
The change in market value of U.S. government fixed-income securities is largely a function of changes in the prevailing level of interest rates. When interest rates are falling, a portfolio with a shorter duration generally will not generate as high a level of total return as a portfolio with a longer duration. When interest rates are stable, shorter duration portfolios generally will not generate as high a level of total return as longer duration portfolios (assuming that long-term interest rates are higher than short-term rates, which is commonly the case). When interest rates are rising, a portfolio with a shorter duration will generally outperform longer duration portfolios. With respect to the composition of a fixed-income portfolio, the longer the duration of the portfolio, generally, the greater the anticipated potential for total return, with, however, greater attendant interest rate risk and price volatility than for a portfolio with a shorter duration.
Low or Negative Interest Rates. In a low or negative interest rate environment, debt securities may trade at, or be issued with, negative yields, which means the purchaser of the security may receive at maturity less than the total amount invested. In addition, in a negative interest rate environment, if a bank charges negative interest, instead of receiving interest on deposits, a depositor must pay the bank fees to keep money with the bank. To the extent a Fund holds a negatively-yielding debt security or has a bank deposit with a negative interest rate, the Fund would generate a negative return on that investment. Cash positions may also subject a Fund to increased counterparty risk to the Fund's bank.
If low or negative interest rates become more prevalent in the market and/or if low or negative interest rates persist for a sustained period of time, some investors may seek to reallocate assets to other income-producing assets. This may cause the price of such higher yielding instruments to rise, could further reduce the value of instruments with a negative yield, and may limit a Fund's ability to locate fixed income instruments containing the desired risk/return profile. Changing interest rates including, rates that fall below zero, could have unpredictable effects on the markets and may expose fixed income markets to heightened volatility, increased redemptions, and potential illiquidity.
A low or negative interest rate environment could, and a prolonged low or negative interest rate environment will, impact the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund's ability to provide a positive yield to its shareholders, pay expenses out of current income, and/or achieve its investment objective, including maintaining a stable NAV of $1 per share. In a prolonged environment of low to negative interest rates, the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund's board of trustees may consider taking various actions, including discontinuing use of the amortized cost method of valuation to maintain a stable NAV of $1 per share and establishing a fluctuating NAV rounded to four decimal places by using available market quotations or equivalents. In December 2021, the SEC proposed amendments to Rule 2a-7 that, if adopted, would impact the manner in which all types of money market funds operate. The amendments would, among other items, prohibit certain mechanisms for maintaining a stable NAV per share in negative interest rate environments, such as by reducing the number of fund shares outstanding (including through reverse distribution mechanisms).
Ratings as Investment Criteria. High-quality, medium-quality and non-investment grade debt obligations are characterized as such based on their ratings by nationally recognized statistical rating organizations (“NRSROs”), such as Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services (“Standard & Poor’s”) or Moody’s Investors Service (“Moody’s”). In general, the ratings of NRSROs represent the opinions of these agencies as to the quality of securities that they rate. Such ratings, however, are relative and subjective, are not absolute standards of quality and do not evaluate the market value risk of the securities. Further, credit ratings do not provide assurance against default or other loss of money. These ratings are considered in the selection of a Fund’s portfolio securities, but the Fund also relies upon the independent advice of its portfolio management to
7

evaluate potential investments. This is particularly important for lower-quality securities. Among the factors that will be considered is the long-term ability of the issuer to pay principal and interest and general economic trends, as well as an issuer’s capital structure, existing debt and earnings history. Appendix A to this SAI contains further information about the rating categories of NRSROs and their significance. If a security has not received a credit rating, the Fund must rely entirely on the credit assessment of the portfolio management.
Subsequent to the purchase of securities by a Fund, the issuer of the securities may cease to be rated or its rating may be reduced below the minimum required for purchase by such Fund. In addition, it is possible that an NRSRO might not change its rating of a particular issuer to reflect subsequent events. None of these events generally will require sale of such securities, but a Fund’s portfolio management will consider such events in its determination of whether the Fund should continue to hold the securities.
In addition, to the extent that the ratings change as a result of changes in an NRSRO or its rating systems, or due to a corporate reorganization, a Fund will attempt to use comparable ratings as standards for its investments in accordance with its investment objective and policies.
Eligible Securities (Nationwide Government Money Market Fund). All investments made by the Fund must be Eligible Securities at the time of acquisition as defined in Rule 2a-7 under the 1940 Act. Eligible Securities include: U.S. government securities; securities with a remaining maturity of 397 calendar days or less that the Fund’s subadviser, subject to oversight by the Fund’s Board of Trustees, determines present minimal credit risks to the Fund; and securities issued by other money market funds. As a government money market fund, the Fund invests at least 99.5% of its total assets in (1) U.S. government securities, (2) repurchase agreements that are collateralized fully by U.S. government securities or cash, (3) cash, and/or (4) other money market funds that operate as government money market funds.
Under Rule 2a-7, the determination of whether a security presents minimal credit risks to the Fund must include an analysis of the capacity of the security’s issuer or guarantor (including for the provider of a conditional demand feature, when applicable) to meet its financial obligations, and such analysis must include, to the extent appropriate, consideration of the following factors with respect to the security’s issuer or guarantor: (i) financial condition; (ii) sources of liquidity; (iii) ability to react to future market-wide and issuer- or guarantor-specific events, including ability to repay debt in a highly adverse situation; and (iv) strength of the issuer or guarantor’s industry within the economy and relative to economic trends, and issuer or guarantor’s competitive position within its industry.
In determining whether a security presents minimal credit risks, the subadviser may take into account credit quality determinations prepared by outside sources, including NRSROs that the subadviser considers reliable in assessing credit risk.
Derivative Instruments
Each Fund, except the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, may use instruments referred to as derivative instruments (“derivatives”). A derivative is a financial instrument the value of which is derived from a security, a commodity (such as gold or oil), a currency or an index (a measure of value or rates, such as the S&P 500 Index or the prime lending rate). Derivatives allow a Fund to increase or decrease the level of risk to which the Fund is exposed more quickly and efficiently than transactions in other types of instruments. Each Fund may use derivatives as a substitute for taking a position in a security, a group of securities or a securities index as well as for hedging purposes. Certain Funds, as noted in their respective Prospectuses, also may use derivatives for speculative purposes to seek to enhance returns. The use of a derivative is speculative if a Fund is primarily seeking to achieve gains, rather than offset the risk of other positions. When a Fund invests in a derivative for speculative purposes, the Fund will be fully exposed to the risks of loss of that derivative, which may sometimes be greater than the derivative’s cost. No Fund may use any derivative to gain exposure to an asset or class of assets that it would be prohibited by its investment restrictions from purchasing directly.
Derivatives generally have investment characteristics that are based upon either forward contracts (under which one party is obligated to buy and the other party is obligated to sell an underlying asset at a specific price on a specified date) or option contracts (under which the holder of the option has the right but not the obligation to buy or sell an underlying asset at a specified price on or before a specified date). Consequently, the change in value of a forward-based derivative generally is roughly proportional to the change in value of the underlying asset. In contrast, the buyer of an option-based derivative generally will benefit from favorable movements in the price of the underlying asset but is not exposed to the corresponding losses that result from adverse movements in the value of the underlying asset. The seller (writer) of an option-based
8

derivative generally will receive fees or premiums but generally is exposed to losses resulting from changes in the value of the underlying asset. Depending on the change in the value of the underlying asset, the potential for loss may be limitless. Derivative transactions may include elements of leverage and, accordingly, the fluctuation of the value of the derivative transaction in relation to the underlying asset may be magnified.
The use of these derivatives is subject to applicable regulations of the SEC, the several options and futures exchanges upon which they may be traded, and the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (“CFTC”). Nationwide Fund Advisors (“NFA” or the “Adviser”), although registered as a commodity pool operator, has claimed exclusion from the definition of the term “commodity pool operator” under the Commodity Exchange Act (“CEA”) with respect to the Funds and, therefore, is not subject to regulation as a commodity pool operator under the CEA with respect to the Funds.
In October 2020, the SEC adopted Rule 18f-4 under the 1940 Act (“Rule 18f-4”), which imposed new requirements and restrictions on the Funds' use of derivatives and eliminated the asset segregation framework previously used by funds, including the Funds, to comply with Section 18 of the 1940 Act. Rule 18f-4 imposes limits on the amount of leverage risk to which a Fund may be exposed through certain derivative instruments that may oblige the Fund to make payments or incur additional obligations in the future. Under Rule 18f-4, the Funds' investment in such derivatives is limited through a value-at-risk or “VaR” test. Funds whose use of such derivatives is more than a limited specified exposure amount are required to establish and maintain a derivatives risk management program, subject to oversight by the Board of Trustees of the Trust (“Board of Trustees”), and appoint a derivatives risk manager to implement such program. To the extent a Fund’s compliance with Rule 18f-4 changes how the Fund uses derivatives, Rule 18f-4 may adversely affect the Fund’s performance and/or increase costs related to the Fund’s use of derivatives.
Special Risks of Derivative Instruments. The use of derivatives involves special considerations and risks as described below. Risks pertaining to particular instruments are described in the sections that follow.
(1)
Successful use of most derivatives depends upon a Fund’s portfolio management’s ability to predict movements of the overall securities and currency markets, which requires different skills than predicting changes in the prices of individual securities. There can be no assurance that any particular strategy adopted will succeed.
(2)
There might be imperfect correlation, or even no correlation, between price movements of a derivative and price movements of the investments being hedged. For example, if the value of a derivative used in a short hedge (such as writing a call option, buying a put option, or selling a futures contract) increased by less than the decline in value of the hedged investment, the hedge would not be fully successful. Such a lack of correlation might occur due to factors unrelated to the value of the investments being hedged, such as speculative or other pressures on the markets in which these instruments are traded. The effectiveness of hedges using derivatives on indices will depend on the degree of correlation between price movements in the index and price movements in the investments being hedged, as well as how similar the index is to the portion of the Fund’s assets being hedged in terms of securities composition.
(3)
Hedging strategies, if successful, can reduce the risk of loss by wholly or partially offsetting the negative effect of unfavorable price movements in the investments being hedged. However, hedging strategies also can reduce opportunity for gain by offsetting the positive effect of favorable price movements in the hedged investments. For example, if a Fund entered into a short hedge because a Fund’s portfolio management projected a decline in the price of a security in the Fund’s portfolio, and the price of that security increased instead, the gain from that increase might be wholly or partially offset by a decline in the price of the derivative. Moreover, if the price of the derivative declines by more than the increase in the price of the security, a Fund could suffer a loss.
(4)
As described below, a Fund might be required to make margin payments when it takes positions in derivatives involving obligations to third parties (i.e., instruments other than purchased options). If the Fund were unable to close out its positions in such derivatives, it might be required to continue to make such payments until the position expired or matured. The requirements might impair the Fund’s ability to sell a portfolio security or make an investment at a time when it would otherwise be favorable to do so, or require that the Fund sell a portfolio security at a disadvantageous time. The Fund’s ability to close out a position in a derivative prior to expiration or maturity depends on the existence of a liquid secondary market or, in the absence of such a market, the ability and willingness of the other party to the transaction (“counterparty”) to enter into a transaction closing out the position. Therefore, there is no assurance that any hedging position can be closed out at a time and price that is favorable to the Fund.
For a discussion of the federal income tax treatment of a Fund’s derivative instruments, see “Additional General Tax Information for All Funds” in this SAI.
9

Options. A Fund may purchase or write put and call options on securities and indices, and may purchase options on foreign currencies, and enter into closing transactions with respect to such options to terminate an existing position. The purchase of call options can serve as a long hedge (i.e., taking a long position in the underlying security), and the purchase of put options can serve as a short hedge (i.e., taking a short position in the underlying security). Writing put or call options can enable a Fund to enhance income by reason of the premiums paid by the purchaser of such options. Writing call options serves as a limited short hedge because declines in the value of the hedged investment would be offset to the extent of the premium received for writing the option. However, if the security appreciates to a price higher than the exercise price of the call option, it can be expected that the option will be exercised, and a Fund will be obligated to sell the security at less than its market value or will be obligated to purchase the security at a price greater than that at which the security must be sold under the option. All or a portion of any assets used as cover for over-the-counter (“OTC”) options written by a Fund would be considered illiquid to the extent described under “Restricted, Non-Publicly Traded and Illiquid Securities” below. Writing put options serves as a limited long hedge because increases in the value of the hedged investment would be offset to the extent of the premium received for writing the option. However, if the security depreciates to a price lower than the exercise price of the put option, it can be expected that the put option will be exercised, and the Fund will be obligated to purchase the security at more than its market value.
The value of an option position will reflect, among other things, the historical price volatility of the underlying investment, the current market value of the underlying investment, the time remaining until expiration of the option, the relationship of the exercise price to the market price of the underlying investment, and general market conditions. Options that expire unexercised have no value. Options used by a Fund may include European-style options, which can be exercised only at expiration. This is in contrast to American-style options which can be exercised at any time prior to the expiration date of the option.
A Fund may effectively terminate its right or obligation under an option by entering into a closing transaction. For example, a Fund may terminate its obligation under a call or put option that it had written by purchasing an identical call or put option; this is known as a closing purchase transaction. Conversely, a Fund may terminate a position in a put or call option it had purchased by writing an identical put or call option; this is known as a closing sale transaction. Closing transactions permit the Fund to realize the profit or limit the loss on an option position prior to its exercise or expiration.
A Fund may purchase or write both OTC options and options traded on foreign and U.S. exchanges. Exchange-traded options are issued by a clearing organization affiliated with the exchange on which the option is listed that, in effect, guarantees completion of every exchange-traded option transaction. OTC options are contracts between the Fund and the counterparty (usually a securities dealer or a bank) with no clearing organization guarantee. Thus, when the Fund purchases or writes an OTC option, it relies on the counterparty to make or take delivery of the underlying investment upon exercise of the option. Failure by the counterparty to do so would result in the loss of any premium paid by the Fund as well as the loss of any expected benefit of the transaction.
A Fund’s ability to establish and close out positions in exchange-listed options depends on the existence of a liquid market. A Fund generally intends to purchase or write only those exchange-traded options for which there appears to be a liquid secondary market. However, there can be no assurance that such a market will exist at any particular time. Closing transactions can be made for OTC options only by negotiating directly with the counterparty, or by a transaction in the secondary market if any such market exists. Although a Fund will enter into OTC options only with counterparties that are expected to be capable of entering into closing transactions with a Fund, there is no assurance that such Fund will in fact be able to close out an OTC option at a favorable price prior to expiration. In the event of insolvency of the counterparty, a Fund might be unable to close out an OTC option position at any time prior to its expiration.
If a Fund is unable to effect a closing transaction for an option it had purchased, it would have to exercise the option to realize any profit. The inability to enter into a closing purchase transaction for a covered call option written by a Fund could cause material losses because the Fund would be unable to sell the investment used as a cover for the written option until the option expires or is exercised.
A Fund may engage in options transactions on indices in much the same manner as the options on securities discussed above, except that index options may serve as a hedge against overall fluctuations in the securities markets in general.
10

The writing and purchasing of options is a highly specialized activity that involves investment techniques and risks different from those associated with ordinary portfolio securities transactions. Imperfect correlation between the options and securities markets may detract from the effectiveness of attempted hedging.
An interest rate option is an agreement with a counterparty giving the buyer the right but not the obligation to buy or sell an interest rate hedging vehicle (such as a Treasury future or interest rate swap) at a future date at a predetermined price. The option buyer would pay a premium at the inception of the agreement. An interest rate option can be used to actively manage a Fund’s interest rate risk with respect to either an individual bond or an overlay of the entire portfolio.
Spread Transactions. A Fund may purchase covered spread options from securities dealers. Such covered spread options are not presently exchange-listed or exchange-traded. The purchase of a spread option gives a Fund the right to put, or sell, a security that it owns at a fixed dollar spread or fixed yield spread in relationship to another security that the Fund does not own, but which is used as a benchmark. The risk to a Fund in purchasing covered spread options is the cost of the premium paid for the spread option and any transaction costs. In addition, there is no assurance that closing transactions will be available. The purchase of spread options will be used to protect a Fund against adverse changes in prevailing credit quality spreads, i.e., the yield spread between high-quality and lower-quality securities. Such protection is only provided during the life of the spread option.
Futures Contracts. A Fund may enter into futures contracts, including interest rate, index, and currency futures and purchase and write (sell) related options. The purchase of futures or call options thereon can serve as a long hedge, and the sale of futures or the purchase of put options thereon can serve as a short hedge. Writing covered call options on futures contracts can serve as a limited short hedge, and writing covered put options on futures contracts can serve as a limited long hedge, using a strategy similar to that used for writing covered options in securities. A Fund’s hedging may include purchases of futures as an offset against the effect of expected increases in securities prices or currency exchange rates and sales of futures as an offset against the effect of expected declines in securities prices or currency exchange rates. A Fund may write put options on futures contracts while at the same time purchasing call options on the same futures contracts in order to create synthetically a long futures contract position. Such options would have the same strike prices and expiration dates. A Fund will engage in this strategy only when a Fund’s portfolio management believes it is more advantageous to a Fund than purchasing the futures contract.
To the extent required by regulatory authorities, a Fund will only enter into futures contracts that are traded on U.S. or foreign exchanges or boards of trade approved by the CFTC and are standardized as to maturity date and underlying financial instrument. These transactions may be entered into for “bona fide hedging” purposes as defined in CFTC regulations and other permissible purposes including increasing return, substituting a position in a security, group of securities or an index, and hedging against changes in the value of portfolio securities due to anticipated changes in interest rates, currency values and/or market conditions. There is no overall limit on the percentage of a Fund’s assets that may be at risk with respect to futures activities. Although techniques other than sales and purchases of futures contracts could be used to obtain or reduce a Fund’s exposure to market, currency, or interest rate fluctuations, such Fund may be able to obtain or hedge its exposure more effectively and perhaps at a lower cost through using futures contracts.
A futures contract provides for the future sale by one party and purchase by another party of a specified amount of a specific financial instrument (e.g., debt security), asset, commodity or currency for a specified price at a designated date, time, and place. An index futures contract is an agreement pursuant to which the parties agree to take or make delivery of an amount of cash equal to a specified multiplier times the difference between the value of the index at the close of the last trading day of the contract and the price at which the index futures contract was originally written. Transaction costs are incurred when a futures contract is bought or sold and margin deposits must be maintained. A futures contract may be satisfied by delivery or purchase, as the case may be, of the instrument, the currency, or by payment of the change in the cash value of the index. More commonly, futures contracts are closed out prior to delivery by entering into an offsetting transaction in a matching futures contract. Although the value of an index might be a function of the value of certain specified securities, no physical delivery of those securities is made. If the offsetting purchase price is less than the original sale price, a Fund realizes a gain; if it is more, a Fund realizes a loss. Conversely, if the offsetting sale price is more than the original purchase price, a Fund realizes a gain; if it is less, a Fund realizes a loss. The transaction costs must also be included in these calculations. There can be no assurance, however, that a Fund will be able to enter into an offsetting transaction with respect to a particular futures contract at a particular time. If a Fund is not able to enter into an offsetting transaction, the Fund will continue to be required to maintain the margin deposits on the futures contract.
11

No price is paid by a Fund upon entering into a futures contract. Instead, at the inception of a futures contract, the Fund is required to deposit with the futures broker or in a segregated account with its custodian, in the name of the futures broker through whom the transaction was effected, “initial margin” consisting of cash, U.S. government securities or other liquid obligations, in an amount generally equal to 10% or less of the contract value. Margin must also be deposited when writing a call or put option on a futures contract, in accordance with applicable exchange rules. Unlike margin in securities transactions, initial margin on futures contracts does not represent a borrowing, but rather is in the nature of a performance bond or good-faith deposit that is returned to a Fund at the termination of the transaction if all contractual obligations have been satisfied. Under certain circumstances, such as periods of high volatility, a Fund may be required by an exchange to increase the level of its initial margin payment, and initial margin requirements might be increased generally in the future by regulatory action.
Subsequent “variation margin” payments are made to and from the futures broker daily as the value of the futures position varies, a process known as “marking to market.” Variation margin does not involve borrowing, but rather represents a daily settlement of a Fund’s obligations to or from a futures broker. When a Fund purchases an option on a future, the premium paid plus transaction costs is all that is at risk. In contrast, when a Fund purchases or sells a futures contract or writes a call or put option thereon, it is subject to daily variation margin calls that could be substantial in the event of adverse price movements. If a Fund has insufficient cash to meet daily variation margin requirements, it might need to sell securities at a time when such sales are disadvantageous. Purchasers and sellers of futures positions and options on futures can enter into offsetting closing transactions by selling or purchasing, respectively, an instrument identical to the instrument held or written. Positions in futures and options on futures may be closed only on an exchange or board of trade on which they were entered into (or through a linked exchange). Although the Funds generally intend to enter into futures transactions only on exchanges or boards of trade where there appears to be an active market, there can be no assurance that such a market will exist for a particular contract at a particular time.
Under certain circumstances, futures exchanges may establish daily limits on the amount that the price of a future or option on a futures contract can vary from the previous day’s settlement price; once that limit is reached, no trades may be made that day at a price beyond the limit. Daily price limits do not limit potential losses because prices could move to the daily limit for several consecutive days with little or no trading, thereby preventing liquidation of unfavorable positions.
If a Fund were unable to liquidate a futures contract or option on a futures contract position due to the absence of a liquid secondary market or the imposition of price limits, it could incur substantial losses, because it would continue to be subject to market risk with respect to the position. In addition, except in the case of purchased options, the Fund would continue to be required to make daily variation margin payments and might be required to maintain the position being hedged by the future or option or to maintain cash or securities in a segregated account.
Certain characteristics of the futures market might increase the risk that movements in the prices of futures contracts or options on futures contracts might not correlate perfectly with movements in the prices of the investments being hedged. For example, all participants in the futures and options on futures contracts markets are subject to daily variation margin calls and might be compelled to liquidate futures or options on futures contracts positions whose prices are moving unfavorably to avoid being subject to further calls. These liquidations could increase price volatility of the instruments and distort the normal price relationship between the futures or options and the investments being hedged. Also, because initial margin deposit requirements in the futures markets are less onerous than margin requirements in the securities markets, there might be increased participation by speculators in the future markets. This participation also might cause temporary price distortions. In addition, activities of large traders in both the futures and securities markets involving arbitrage, “program trading” and other investment strategies might result in temporary price distortions.
A Fund that enters into a futures contract is subject to the risk of loss of the initial and variation margin in the event of bankruptcy of the futures commission merchant (“FCM”) with which the Fund has an open futures position. A Fund’s assets may not be fully protected in the event of the bankruptcy of the FCM or central counterparty because the Fund might be limited to recovering only a pro rata share of all available funds and margin segregated on behalf of the FCM’s customers. If the FCM fails to provide accurate reporting, a Fund is also subject to the risk that the FCM could use the Fund’s assets, which are held in an omnibus account with assets belonging to the FCM’s other customers, to satisfy its own obligations or the payment obligations of another customer to the central counterparty.
12

Indexed and Inverse Securities. A Fund may invest in securities the potential return of which is based on an index or interest rate. As an illustration, a Fund may invest in a debt security that pays interest based on the current value of an interest rate index, such as the prime rate. A Fund also may invest in a debt security that returns principal at maturity based on the level of a securities index or a basket of securities, or based on the relative changes of two indices. In addition, certain Funds may invest in securities the potential return of which is based inversely on the change in an index or interest rate (that is, a security the value of which will move in the opposite direction of changes to an index or interest rate). For example, a Fund may invest in securities that pay a higher rate of interest when a particular index decreases and pay a lower rate of interest (or do not fully return principal) when the value of the index increases. If a Fund invests in such securities, it may be subject to reduced or eliminated interest payments or loss of principal in the event of an adverse movement in the relevant interest rate, index or indices. Indexed and inverse securities involve credit risk, and certain indexed and inverse securities may involve leverage risk, liquidity risk and currency risk. When used for hedging purposes, indexed and inverse securities involve correlation risk. (Furthermore, where such a security includes a contingent liability, in the event of an adverse movement in the underlying index or interest rate, a Fund may be required to pay substantial additional margin to maintain the position.)
Structured Notes. A Fund may use structured notes to pursue its objective. Structured notes generally are individually negotiated agreements and may be traded over-the-counter. They are organized and operated to restructure the investment characteristics of the underlying security or asset. This restructuring involves the deposit with or purchase by an entity, such as a corporation or trust, of specified instruments (such as commercial bank loans) and the issuance by that entity of one or more classes of securities (“structured securities”) backed by, or representing interests in, the underlying instruments. The cash flow on the underlying instruments may be apportioned among the newly issued structured securities to create securities with different investment characteristics, such as varying maturities, payment priorities and interest rate provisions, and the extent of such payments made with respect to structured securities is dependent on the extent of the cash flow on the underlying instruments.
With respect to structured notes, because structured securities typically involve no credit enhancement, their credit risk generally will be equivalent to that of the underlying instruments. Investments in structured securities are generally of a class that is either subordinated or unsubordinated to the right of payment of another class. Subordinated structured securities typically have higher yields and present greater risks than unsubordinated structured securities. Structured securities are typically sold in private placement transactions, and there is currently no active trading market for these securities. See also “Additional Information on Portfolio Instruments, Strategies and Investment Policies Restricted, Non-Publicly Traded and Illiquid Securities.”
Credit Linked Notes. (Fixed-Income Funds only) A credit linked note (“CLN”) is a type of hybrid instrument in which a special purpose entity issues a structured note (the “Note Issuer”) that is intended to replicate a corporate bond or a portfolio of corporate bonds. The purchaser of the CLN (the “Note Purchaser”) invests a par amount and receives a payment during the term of the CLN that equals a fixed or floating rate of interest equivalent to a highly rated funded asset (such as a bank certificate of deposit) plus an additional premium that relates to taking on the credit risk of an identified bond (the “Reference Bond”). Upon maturity of the CLN, the Note Purchaser will receive a payment equal to: (i) the original par amount paid to the Note issuer, if there is neither a designated event of default (an “Event of Default”) with respect to the Reference Bond nor a restructuring of the issuer of the Reference Bond (a “Restructuring Event”); or (ii) the value of the Reference Bond if an Event of Default or a Restructuring Event has occurred. Depending upon the terms of the CLN, it is also possible that the Note Purchaser may be required to take physical delivery of the Reference Bond in the event of an Event of Default or a Restructuring Event.
Swap Agreements. The Funds (except the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund) may enter into securities index, interest rate, total return, currency exchange rate or single/multiple security swap agreements for any lawful purpose consistent with the Fund’s investment objective, such as (but not limited to) for the purpose of attempting to obtain or preserve a particular desired return or spread at a lower cost to the Fund than if the Fund had invested directly in an instrument that yielded that desired return or spread. The Fund also may enter into swaps in order to protect against an increase in the price of, or the currency exchange rate applicable to, securities that the Fund anticipates purchasing at a later date. Swap agreements are two-party contracts entered into primarily by institutional investors for periods ranging from one or more days to several years. In a standard “swap” transaction, two parties agree to exchange the returns (or differentials in rates of return) realized on particular predetermined investments or instruments. The gross returns to be exchanged or “swapped” between the parties are calculated with respect to a “notional amount,” i.e., the return on or increase or decrease in value of a particular dollar amount invested at a particular interest rate, in a particular foreign currency, or in a “basket” of securities, such as a selection of particular securities or those representing a particular index. Swap agreements may be
13

negotiated bilaterally and traded OTC between the two parties (for an uncleared swap) or, with respect to swaps that have been designated by the CFTC for mandatory clearing (cleared swaps), through an FCM and cleared through a clearinghouse that serves as a central counterparty. See “Uncleared Swaps” and “Cleared Swaps” below for additional explanation of cleared and uncleared swaps. Swap agreements may include interest rate caps, under which, in return for a premium, one party agrees to make payments to the other to the extent that interest rates exceed a specified rate, or “cap”; interest rate floors under which, in return for a premium, one party agrees to make payments to the other to the extent that interest rates fall below a specified level, or “floor”; and interest rate collars, under which a party sells a cap and purchases a floor, or vice versa, in an attempt to protect itself against interest rate movements exceeding given minimum or maximum levels. “Total return swaps” are contracts in which one party agrees to make payments of the total return from the underlying asset during the specified period, in return for payments equal to a fixed or floating rate of interest or the total return from another underlying asset. See “Swaps regulation” below.
The “notional amount” of the swap agreement is the agreed upon basis for calculating the obligations that the parties to a swap agreement have agreed to exchange. Under most swap agreements entered into by the Fund, the obligations of the parties would be exchanged on a “net basis.” Consequently, the Fund’s obligation (or rights) under a swap agreement generally will be equal only to the net amount to be paid or received under the agreement based on the relative values of the positions held by each party to the agreement (the “net amount”). The Fund’s obligation under a swap agreement will be accrued daily (offset against amounts owed to the Fund). Moreover, the Fund bears the risk of loss of the amount expected to be received under a swap agreement in the event of the default or bankruptcy of a swap agreement counterparty. The swaps market is largely unregulated.
Whether the Fund’s use of swap agreements will be successful in furthering its investment objective will depend, in part, on the Fund’s portfolio management’s ability to predict correctly whether certain types of investments are likely to produce greater returns than other investments, replicate a particular benchmark index, or otherwise achieve the intended results. Swap agreements, especially OTC uncleared swap agreements, may be considered to be illiquid.
Swaps regulation. The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) and related regulatory developments have imposed comprehensive regulatory requirements on swaps and swap market participants. The regulatory framework includes: (1) registration and regulation of swap dealers and major swap participants; (2) central clearing and execution of standardized swaps; (3) margin requirements in swap transactions; (4) position limits and large trader reporting requirements; and (5) recordkeeping and centralized and public reporting requirements, on an anonymous basis, for most swaps. The CFTC is responsible for the regulation of most swaps, and has adopted rules implementing most of the swap regulations dictated by the Dodd-Frank Act. The SEC has jurisdiction over a small segment of the market referred to as “security-based swaps,” which includes swaps on single securities or credits, or narrow-based indices of securities or credits.
Uncleared swaps. In an uncleared swap, the swap counterparty is typically a brokerage firm, bank or other financial institution. The Fund customarily enters into uncleared swaps based on the standard terms and conditions of an International Swaps and Derivatives Association (ISDA) Master Agreement. ISDA is a voluntary industry association of participants in the OTC derivatives markets that has developed standardized contracts used by such participants that have agreed to be bound by such standardized contracts.
In the event that one party to a swap transaction defaults and the transaction is terminated prior to its scheduled termination date, one of the parties may be required to make an early termination payment to the other. An early termination payment may be payable by either the defaulting or non-defaulting party, depending upon which of them is “in-the-money” with respect to the swap at the time of its termination. Early termination payments may be calculated in various ways, but are intended to approximate the amount the “in-the-money” party would have to pay to replace the swap as of the date of its termination.
A Fund will enter uncleared swap agreements only with counterparties that the Fund’s portfolio management reasonably believes are capable of performing under the swap agreements. If there is a default by the other party to such a transaction, the Fund will have to rely on its contractual remedies (which may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency or similar laws) pursuant to the agreements related to the transaction.
14

Cleared swaps. Certain swaps have been designated by the CFTC for mandatory central clearing. The Dodd-Frank Act and implementing rules will ultimately require the clearing and exchange-trading of many swaps. Mandatory exchange-trading and clearing will occur on a phased-in basis based on the type of market participant and CFTC approval of contracts for central clearing. To date, the CFTC has designated only certain of the most common types of credit default index swaps and interest rate swaps for mandatory clearing, but it is expected that the CFTC will designate additional categories of swaps for mandatory clearing. Central clearing is intended to reduce counterparty credit risk and increase liquidity, but central clearing does not necessarily eliminate these risks and may involve additional risks not involved with uncleared swaps.
In a cleared swap, a Fund’s ultimate counterparty is a central clearinghouse rather than a brokerage firm, bank or other financial institution. The Fund initially will enter into cleared swaps through an executing broker. Such transactions will then be submitted for clearing and, if cleared, will be held at regulated FCMs that are members of the clearinghouse that serves as the central counterparty.
When a Fund enters into a cleared swap, it must deliver to the central counterparty (via the FCM) an amount referred to as “initial margin.” Initial margin requirements are determined by the central counterparty, but an FCM may require additional initial margin above the amount required by the central counterparty. During the term of the swap agreement, a “variation margin” amount also may be required to be paid by the Fund or may be received by the Fund in accordance with margin controls set for such accounts, depending upon changes in the price of the underlying reference instrument subject to the swap agreement. At the conclusion of the term of the swap agreement, if the Fund has a loss equal to or greater than the margin amount, the margin amount is paid to the FCM along with any loss in excess of the margin amount. If the Fund has a loss of less than the margin amount, the excess margin is returned to the Fund. If the Fund has a gain, the full margin amount and the amount of the gain is paid to the Fund.
CFTC rules require the trading and execution of certain cleared swaps on Swap Execution Facilities (“SEFs”), which are trading systems on platforms in which multiple participants have the ability to execute or trade swaps by accepting bids and offers made by multiple participants on the facility or system, through any means of interstate commerce. Moving trading to an exchange-type system may increase market transparency and liquidity but may require a Fund to incur increased expenses to access the same types of swaps that it has used in the past.
Rules adopted under the Dodd-Frank Act require centralized reporting of detailed information about many swaps, whether cleared or uncleared. This information is available to regulators and also, to a more limited extent and on an anonymous basis, to the public. Reporting of swaps data is intended to result in greater market transparency. This may be beneficial to funds that use swaps in their trading strategies. However, public reporting imposes additional recordkeeping burdens on these funds, and the safeguards established to protect anonymity are not yet tested and may not provide protection of trader identities as intended.
Certain Internal Revenue Service positions may limit a Fund’s ability to use swap agreements in a desired tax strategy. It is possible that developments in the swap markets and/or the laws relating to swap agreements, including potential government regulation, could adversely affect the Fund’s ability to benefit from using swap agreements, or could have adverse tax consequences.
Risks of cleared swaps. As noted above, certain types of swaps are, and others eventually are expected to be, required to be cleared through a central counterparty, which may affect counterparty risk and other risks faced by a Fund. Central clearing is designed to reduce counterparty credit risk and increase liquidity compared to bilateral swaps because central clearing interposes the central clearinghouse as the counterparty to each participant’s swap, but it does not eliminate those risks completely. There is also a risk of loss by a Fund of the initial and variation margin deposits in the event of bankruptcy of the FCM with which the Fund has an open position in a swap contract. The assets of the Fund may not be fully protected in the event of the bankruptcy of the FCM or central counterparty because the Fund might be limited to recovering only a pro rata share of all available funds and margin segregated on behalf of an FCM’s customers. If the FCM does not provide accurate reporting, the Fund is also subject to the risk that the FCM could use the Fund’s assets, which are held in an omnibus account with assets belonging to the FCM’s other customers, to satisfy its own financial obligations or the payment obligations of another customer to the central counterparty.
With cleared swaps, a Fund may not be able to obtain as favorable terms as it would be able to negotiate for a bilateral, uncleared swap. In addition, an FCM may unilaterally amend the terms of its agreement with the Fund, which may include the imposition of position limits or additional margin requirements with respect to the Fund’s investment in certain types of
15

swaps. Central counterparties and FCMs generally can require termination of existing cleared swap transactions at any time, and can also require increases in margin above the margin that is required at the initiation of the swap agreement. Additionally, depending on a number of factors, the margin required under the rules of the clearinghouse and FCM may be in excess of the collateral required to be posted by a Fund to support its obligations under a similar uncleared swap. However, regulators are expected to adopt rules imposing certain margin requirements, including minimums, on uncleared swaps in the near future, which could change this comparison.
Finally, the Fund is subject to the risk that, after entering into a cleared swap with an executing broker, no FCM or central counterparty is willing or able to clear the transaction. In such an event, a Fund may be required to break the trade and make an early termination payment to the executing broker.
Credit Default Swaps. Except for the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, each Fixed-Income Fund may enter into credit default swap contracts for any lawful purpose consistent with such Fund's investment objective, such as for the purpose of attempting to obtain or preserve a particular desired return or spread at a lower cost to the Fund than if the Fund had invested directly in an instrument that yielded that desired return or spread (e.g., to create direct or synthetic short or long exposure to domestic or foreign corporate or sovereign debt securities). The Funds also may enter into credit default swaps in order to protect against an increase in the price of, or the currency exchange rate applicable to, securities that Funds anticipate purchasing at a later date, or for other hedging purposes.
As the seller in a credit default swap contract, a Fund would be required to pay the par (or other agreed-upon) value of a referenced debt obligation to the counterparty in the event of a default (or similar event) by a third party, such as a U.S. or foreign issuer, on the debt obligation. In return, the Fund would receive from the counterparty a periodic stream of payments over the term of the contract, provided that no event of default (or similar event) occurs. If no event of default (or similar event) occurs, the Fund would keep the stream of payments and would have no payment of obligations. As the seller in a credit default swap contract, the Fund effectively would add economic leverage to its portfolio because, in addition to its total net assets, the Fund would be subject to investment exposure on the notional amount of the swap.
As the purchaser in a credit default swap contract, a Fund would function as the counterparty referenced in the preceding paragraph. This would involve the risk that the investment might expire worthless. It also would involve credit risk–that the seller may fail to satisfy its payment obligations to a Fund in the event of a default (or similar event). As the purchaser in a credit default swap contract, a Fund’s investment would generate income only in the event of an actual default (or similar event) by the issuer of the underlying obligation.
Equity Swaps. The Equity Funds may enter into equity swap contracts to invest in a market without owning or taking physical custody of securities in various circumstances, including (but not limited to) circumstances where direct investment in the securities is restricted for legal reasons or is otherwise impracticable. Equity swaps may also be used for hedging purposes or to seek to increase total return. Until equity swaps are designated for central clearing, the counterparty to an equity swap contract will typically be a bank, investment banking firm or broker/dealer. Equity swap contracts may be structured in different ways. For example, a counterparty may agree to pay the Fund the amount, if any, by which the notional amount of the equity swap contract would have increased in value had it been invested in the particular stocks (or an index of stocks), plus the dividends that would have been received on those stocks. In these cases, the Fund may agree to pay to the counterparty a floating rate of interest on the notional amount of the equity swap contract plus the amount, if any, by which that notional amount would have decreased in value had it been invested in such stocks. Therefore, the return to the Fund on the equity swap contract should be the gain or loss on the notional amount plus dividends on the stocks less the interest paid by the Fund on the notional amount. In other cases, the counterparty and the Fund may each agree to pay the other the difference between the relative investment performances that would have been achieved if the notional amount of the equity swap contract had been invested in different stocks (or indices of stocks).
A Fund will generally enter into equity swaps on a net basis, which means that the two payment streams are netted out, with the Fund receiving or paying, as the case may be, only the net amount of the two payments. Payments may be made at the conclusion of an equity swap contract or periodically during its term. Equity swaps normally do not involve the delivery of securities or other underlying assets. Accordingly, the risk of loss with respect to equity swaps is normally limited to the net amount of payments that the Fund is contractually obligated to make. If the other party to an equity swap defaults, the Funds' risk of loss consists of the net amount of payments that the Fund is contractually entitled to receive, if any.
16

Total Return Swaps. The Funds (except the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund) may enter into total return swaps. A total return swap (also sometimes referred to as a synthetic equity swap or “contract for difference”) is an agreement between two parties under which the parties agree to make payments to each other so as to replicate the economic consequences that would apply had a purchase or short sale of the underlying reference instrument taken place. For example, one party agrees to pay the other party the total return earned or realized on the notional amount of an underlying equity security and any dividends declared with respect to that equity security. In return the other party makes payments, typically at a floating rate, calculated based on the notional amount. Total return swaps are subject to illiquidity risk because the liquidity for total return swaps is based on the liquidity of the underlying instrument. Total return swaps also are subject to the risk that the counterparty to the swap transaction may be unable or unwilling to make payments or to otherwise honor its financial obligations under the terms of the swap contract. As is the case with owning any financial instrument, there is the risk of loss associated with entering into a total return swap transaction. For example, if a Fund buys a long total return swap and the underlying security is worth less at the end of the contract, the Fund would be required to make a payment to the counterparty and would suffer a loss. If a Fund sells a short total return swap and the underlying security is worth more at the end of the contract, the Fund would be similarly required to make a payment to the counterparty and would suffer a loss.
Interest Rate Swaps. The Fixed-Income Funds (except for the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund) may enter into interest rate swaps. In an interest rate swap, the parties exchange their rights to receive interest payments on a security or other reference rate. For example, they might swap the right to receive floating rate payments for the right to receive fixed rate payments. Interest rate swaps entail both interest rate risk and credit risk. There is a risk that based on movements of interest rates, the payments made under a swap agreement will be greater than the payments received, as well as the risk that the counterparty will fail to meet its obligations.
Hybrid Instruments. Hybrid instruments combine elements of derivative contracts with those of another security (typically a fixed-income security). All or a portion of the interest or principal payable on a hybrid security is determined by reference to changes in the price of an underlying asset or by reference to another benchmark (such as interest rates, currency exchange rates or indices). Hybrid instruments also include convertible securities with conversion terms related to an underlying asset or benchmark.
The risks of investing in hybrid instruments reflect a combination of the risks of investing in securities, options, futures and currencies, and depend upon the terms of the instrument. Thus, an investment in a hybrid instrument may entail significant risks in addition to those associated with traditional fixed-income or convertible securities. Hybrid instruments are also potentially more volatile and carry greater interest rate risks than traditional instruments. Moreover, depending on the structure of the particular hybrid, it may expose a Fund to leverage risks or carry liquidity risks.
Foreign Currency-Related Derivative Strategies Special Considerations. A Fund may use futures and options on futures on foreign currencies and forward currency contracts to increase returns, to manage the Fund’s average portfolio duration, or to hedge against movements in the values of the foreign currencies in which a Fund’s securities are denominated. Currency contracts also may be purchased such that net exposure to an individual currency exceeds the value of the Fund’s securities that are denominated in that particular currency. A Fund may engage in currency exchange transactions to protect against uncertainty in the level of future exchange rates and also may engage in currency transactions to increase income and total return. Such currency hedges can protect against price movements in a security the Fund owns or intends to acquire that are attributable to changes in the value of the currency in which it is denominated. Such hedges do not, however, protect against price movements in the securities that are attributable to other causes.
A Fund might seek to hedge against changes in the value of a particular currency when no hedging instruments on that currency are available or such hedging instruments are more expensive than certain other hedging instruments. In such cases, a Fund may hedge against price movements in that currency by entering into transactions using hedging instruments on another foreign currency or a basket of currencies, the values of which a Fund’s portfolio management believes will have a high degree of positive correlation to the value of the currency being hedged. The risk that movements in the price of the hedging instrument will not correlate perfectly with movements in the price of the currency being hedged is magnified when this strategy is used.
17

The value of derivative instruments on foreign currencies depends on the value of the underlying currency relative to the U.S. dollar. Because foreign currency transactions occurring in the interbank market might involve substantially larger amounts than those involved in the use of such hedging instruments, a Fund could be disadvantaged by having to deal in the odd-lot market (generally consisting of transactions of less than $1 million) for the underlying foreign currencies at prices that are less favorable than for round lots.
There is no systematic reporting of last sale information for foreign currencies or any regulatory requirement that quotations available through dealers or other market sources be firm or revised on a timely basis. Quotation information generally is representative of very large transactions in the interbank market and thus might not reflect odd-lot transactions where rates might be less favorable. The interbank market in foreign currencies is a global, round-the-clock market. To the extent the U.S. options or futures markets are closed while the markets for the underlying currencies remain open, significant price and rate movements might take place in the underlying markets that cannot be reflected in the markets for the derivative instruments until they reopen.
Settlement of derivative transactions involving foreign currencies might be required to take place within the country issuing the underlying currency. Thus, a Fund might be required to accept or make delivery of the underlying foreign currency in accordance with any U.S. or foreign regulations regarding the maintenance of foreign banking arrangements by U.S. residents and might be required to pay any fees, taxes and charges associated with such delivery assessed in the issuing country.
Permissible foreign currency options will include options traded primarily in the OTC market. Although options on foreign currencies are traded primarily in the OTC market, a Fund will normally purchase OTC options on foreign currency only when a Fund’s portfolio management believes a liquid secondary market will exist for a particular option at any specific time.
Forward Currency Contracts. A forward currency contract involves an obligation to purchase or sell a specific currency at a future date, which may be any fixed number of days from the date of the contract agreed upon by the parties, at a price set at the time of the contract. These contracts are entered into in the interbank market conducted directly between currency traders (usually large commercial banks) and their customers.
At or before the maturity of a forward currency contract, a Fund may either sell a portfolio security and make delivery of the currency, or retain the security and fully or partially offset its contractual obligation to deliver the currency by purchasing a second contract. If a Fund retains the portfolio security and engages in an offsetting transaction, the Fund, at the time of execution of the offsetting transaction, will incur a gain or a loss to the extent that movement has occurred in forward currency contract prices.
The precise matching of forward currency contract amounts and the value of the securities involved generally will not be possible because the value of such securities, measured in the foreign currency, will change after the foreign currency contract has been established. Thus, a Fund might need to purchase or sell foreign currencies in the spot (cash) market to the extent such foreign currencies are not covered by forward currency contracts. The projection of short-term currency market movements is extremely difficult, and the successful execution of a short-term hedging strategy is highly uncertain.
Markets for trading foreign forward currency contracts offer less protection against defaults than is available when trading in currency instruments on an exchange. Forward currency contracts are subject to the risk that the counterparty to such contract will default on its obligations. Since a forward foreign currency exchange contract is not guaranteed by an exchange or clearinghouse, a default on the contract would deprive a Fund of unrealized profits or the benefits of a currency hedge, impose transaction costs or force the Fund to cover its purchase or sale commitments, if any, at the current market price. In addition, the institutions that deal in forward currency contracts are not required to continue to make markets in the currencies in which they trade and these markets can experience periods of illiquidity. To the extent that a substantial portion of a Fund’s total assets, adjusted to reflect the Fund’s net position after giving effect to currency transactions, is denominated or quoted in currencies of foreign countries, the Fund will be more susceptible to the risk of adverse economic and political developments within those countries.
Currency Hedging. While the values of forward currency contracts, currency options, currency futures and options on futures may be expected to correlate with exchange rates, they will not reflect other factors that may affect the value of a Fund’s investments. A currency hedge, for example, should protect a Yen-denominated bond against a decline in the Yen, but
18

will not protect a Fund against price decline if the issuer’s creditworthiness deteriorates. Because the value of a Fund’s investments denominated in a foreign currency will change in response to many factors other than exchange rates, a currency hedge may not be entirely successful in mitigating changes in the value of a Fund’s investments denominated in that currency over time.
A decline in the dollar value of a foreign currency in which a Fund’s securities are denominated will reduce the dollar value of the securities, even if their value in the foreign currency remains constant. The use of currency hedges does not eliminate fluctuations in the underlying prices of the securities, but it does establish a rate of exchange that can be achieved in the future. In order to protect against such diminutions in the value of securities it holds, a Fund may purchase put options on the foreign currency. If the value of the currency does decline, the Fund will have the right to sell the currency for a fixed amount in dollars and will thereby offset, in whole or in part, the adverse effect on its securities that otherwise would have resulted. Conversely, if a rise in the dollar value of a currency in which securities to be acquired are denominated is projected, thereby potentially increasing the cost of the securities, a Fund may purchase call options on the particular currency. The purchase of these options could offset, at least partially, the effects of the adverse movements in exchange rates. Although currency hedges limit the risk of loss due to a decline in the value of a hedged currency, at the same time, they also limit any potential gain that might result should the value of the currency increase.
A Fund may enter into foreign currency exchange transactions to hedge its currency exposure in specific transactions or portfolio positions. Currency contracts also may be purchased such that net exposure to an individual currency exceeds the value of the Fund’s securities that are denominated in that particular currency. Transaction hedging is the purchase or sale of forward currency with respect to specific receivables or payables of a Fund generally accruing in connection with the purchase or sale of its portfolio securities. Position hedging is the sale of forward currency with respect to portfolio security positions. A Fund may not position hedge to an extent greater than the aggregate market value (at the time of making such sale) of the hedged securities.
Non-Deliverable Forwards. A Fund may, from time to time, engage in non-deliverable forward transactions to manage currency risk or to gain exposure to a currency without purchasing securities denominated in that currency. A non-deliverable forward is a transaction that represents an agreement between a Fund and a counterparty (usually a commercial bank) to buy or sell a specified (notional) amount of a particular currency at an agreed upon foreign exchange rate on an agreed upon future date. Unlike other currency transactions, there is no physical delivery of the currency on the settlement of a non-deliverable forward transaction. Rather, the Fund and the counterparty agree to net the settlement by making a payment in U.S. dollars or another fully convertible currency that represents any differential between the foreign exchange rate agreed upon at the inception of the non-deliverable forward agreement and the actual exchange rate on the agreed upon future date. Thus, the actual gain or loss of a given non-deliverable forward transaction is calculated by multiplying the transaction’s notional amount by the difference between the agreed upon forward exchange rate and the actual exchange rate when the transaction is completed.
Since a Fund generally may only close out a non-deliverable forward with the particular counterparty, there is a risk that the counterparty will default on its obligation under the agreement. If the counterparty defaults, the Fund will have contractual remedies pursuant to the agreement related to the transaction, but there is no assurance that contract counterparties will be able to meet their obligations pursuant to such agreements or that, in the event of a default, the Fund will succeed in pursuing contractual remedies. A Fund thus assumes the risk that it may be delayed or prevented from obtaining payments owed to it pursuant to non-deliverable forward transactions.
In addition, where the currency exchange rates that are the subject of a given non-deliverable forward transaction do not move in the direction or to the extent anticipated, the Fund could sustain losses on the non-deliverable forward transaction. A Fund’s investment in a particular non-deliverable forward transaction will be affected favorably or unfavorably by factors that affect the subject currencies, including economic, political and legal developments that impact the applicable countries, as well as exchange control regulations of the applicable countries. These risks are heightened when a non-deliverable forward transaction involves currencies of emerging market countries because such currencies can be volatile and there is a greater risk that such currencies will be devalued against the U.S. dollar or other currencies.
The SEC and CFTC consider non-deliverable forwards as swaps, and they are therefore included in the definition of “commodity interests.” Non-deliverable forwards have historically been traded in the OTC market. However, as swaps, non-deliverable forwards may become subject to central clearing and trading on public facilities. Currency and cross currency forwards that qualify as deliverable forwards are not regulated as swaps for most purposes, and thus are not deemed to be
19

commodity interests. However, such forwards are subject to some requirements applicable to swaps, including reporting to swap data repositories, documentation requirements, and business conduct rules applicable to swap dealers. CFTC regulation of currency and cross currency forwards, especially non-deliverable forwards, may restrict the Fund’s ability to use these instruments in the manner described above or subject NFA to CFTC registration and regulation as a commodity pool operator.
Foreign Commercial Paper. A Fund may invest in commercial paper which is indexed to certain specific foreign currency exchange rates. The terms of such commercial paper provide that its principal amount is adjusted upward or downward (but not below zero) at maturity to reflect changes in the exchange rate between two currencies while the obligation is outstanding. A Fund will purchase such commercial paper with the currency in which it is denominated and, at maturity, will receive interest and principal payments thereon in that currency, but the amount or principal payable by the issuer at maturity will change in proportion to the change (if any) in the exchange rate between two specified currencies between the date the instrument is issued and the date the instrument matures. While such commercial paper entails the risk of loss of principal, the potential for realizing gains as a result of changes in the foreign currency exchange rate enables a Fund to hedge or cross-hedge against a decline in the U.S. dollar value of investments denominated in foreign currencies while providing an attractive money market rate of return. A Fund will purchase such commercial paper either for hedging purposes or in order to seek investment gain.
Dividend-Paying Stocks
Dividend-paying stocks may fall out of favor with investors and underperform the market. Companies that issue dividend-paying stocks are not required to continue to pay dividends on such stocks. There is no guarantee that the issuers of the stocks held by a Fund will declare dividends in the future or that, if dividends are declared, they will remain at their current levels or increase over time. A Fund’s emphasis on dividend-paying stocks could cause the Fund to underperform similar funds that invest without consideration of a company’s track record of paying dividends or ability to pay dividends in the future. Dividend-paying stocks may not participate in a broad market advance to the same degree as other stocks, and a sharp rise in interest rates or economic downturn could cause a company to unexpectedly reduce or eliminate its dividend. Depending upon market conditions, dividend-paying stocks that meet a Fund’s investment criteria may not be widely available and/or may be highly concentrated in only a few market sectors. High-dividend stocks may not experience high earnings growth or capital appreciation.
Environmental, Social and Governance (“ESG”) Securities
Certain Funds may invest in securities of issuers that meet certain ESG criteria. The application of a subadviser’s ESG analysis when selecting investments may affect the Funds' exposure to certain companies, sectors, regions, and countries and may affect the Funds' performance depending on whether such investments are in or out of favor. Adhering to the ESG criteria and applying a subadviser’s ESG analysis may also affect the Funds' performance relative to similar funds that do not adhere to such criteria or apply such analysis. Additionally, a  Fund’s adherence to the ESG criteria and the application of the ESG analysis in connection with identifying and selecting equity investments in non-U.S. issuers, including emerging country issuers, often require subjective analysis and may be relatively more difficult than applying the ESG criteria or the ESG analysis to equity investments of U.S. issuers because data availability may be more limited or unreliable. Applying ESG criteria as an exclusionary approach to investing may result in a  Fund forgoing opportunities to buy certain securities when it might otherwise be advantageous to do so, or selling securities for ESG reasons when it might be otherwise disadvantageous for it to do so. The Funds may invest in companies that do not reflect the beliefs and values of any particular investor.
Equity Participation Notes or Equity Linked Notes
The Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund may invest up to 10% of its total assets in equity participation notes or equity linked notes (collectively, “EPNs”). An EPN is a debt instrument whose return is determined by the performance of a single equity security, a basket of securities, or an equity index (collectively, “underlying security”). When purchasing an EPN, the Fund pays the counterparty the current value of the underlying security plus a commission. During the time that the EPN is owned, the price of the EPN will fluctuate in accordance with the price fluctuation of the underlying security, with a currency adjustment to reflect the fact that EPNs are generally priced in U.S. dollars whereas the underlying security is generally denominated in a foreign currency. At maturity or sale, the EPN owner’s profit or loss is the sum of the
20

appreciation/depreciation of the underlying security, plus the appreciation/depreciation of the underlying security’s currency relative to the U.S. dollar, less any commissions paid. The Fund only invests in EPNs for which the underlying security is a permissible investment pursuant to the Fund’s investment policies and restrictions.
The Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund invests in EPNs only to gain exposure to equities in foreign markets where direct investments in equity securities are not easily accessible or otherwise obtainable. The Fund only may invest in EPNs that are unleveraged and that do not have a “cap” or a “floor” on the maximum principal amount to be repaid to the Fund at maturity. In addition, the Fund only may invest in EPNs that are based on the performance of a single underlying equity security; that have no premium or discount in relation to the underlying asset; and that provide for the retention of dividend rights. Investments in EPNs will only be made if the counterparty is a financial institution rated at least A1 by S&P or P1 by Moody’s. EPNs are not considered equity securities for purposes of the Fund’s policy to invest 80% of its net assets in equity securities.
EPNs possess the risks associated with the underlying security, such as market risk, and, with respect to EPNs based on foreign securities, foreign securities and currency risks. EPNs, however, involve greater risks than if the Fund had invested in the underlying security directly, since, in addition to general market and foreign securities risks, EPNs are subject to counterparty, credit and illiquidity risks. Counterparty risk is the risk that the issuer of the EPN may fail to pay the full amount due at maturity or redemption. In addition, an investment in an EPN creates exposure to the credit risk of the issuing financial institution. Also, the secondary market for EPNs may be limited, and the lack of liquidity in the secondary market may make EPNs difficult to dispose of and to value. In choosing EPNs appropriate for the Fund, the subadviser will select only those EPNs that have demonstrated patterns of brokers willing to provide liquidity on demand to ensure that the EPNs maintain their liquidity.
Floating- and Variable-Rate Securities
Each of the Fixed-Income Funds may invest in floating- or variable-rate securities. Floating- or variable-rate obligations bear interest at rates that are not fixed, but vary with changes in specified market rates or indices, such as the prime rate, or at specified intervals. The interest rate on floating-rate securities varies with changes in the underlying index (such as the Treasury bill rate), while the interest rate on variable- or adjustable-rate securities changes at preset times based upon an underlying index. Certain of the floating- or variable-rate obligations that may be purchased by the Funds may carry a demand feature that would permit the holder to tender them back to the issuer of the instrument or to a third party at par value prior to maturity.
Some of the demand instruments purchased by a Fund may not be traded in a secondary market and derive their liquidity solely from the ability of the holder to demand repayment from the issuer or third party providing credit support. If a demand instrument is not traded in a secondary market, a Fund will nonetheless treat the instrument as “readily marketable” for the purposes of its investment restriction limiting investments in illiquid securities unless the demand feature has a notice period of more than seven days in which case the instrument will be characterized as “not readily marketable” and therefore illiquid.
Such obligations include variable-rate master demand notes, which are unsecured instruments issued pursuant to an agreement between the issuer and the holder that permit the indebtedness thereunder to vary and to provide for periodic adjustments in the interest rate. Each Fund will limit its purchases of floating- and variable-rate obligations to those of the same quality as the debt securities it is otherwise allowed to purchase according to its principal investment strategies as disclosed in each Fund’s Prospectus. A Fund’s portfolio management will monitor on an ongoing basis the ability of an issuer of a demand instrument to pay principal and interest on demand.
A Fund’s right to obtain payment at par on a demand instrument could be affected by events occurring between the date the Fund elects to demand payment and the date payment is due that may affect the ability of the issuer of the instrument or third party providing credit support to make payment when due, except when such demand instruments permit same day settlement. To facilitate settlement, these same day demand instruments may be held in book entry form at a bank other than a Fund’s custodian subject to a sub-custodian agreement approved by the Fund between that bank and the Fund’s custodian.
21

Foreign Securities
Each Fund, except the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, may invest in the securities of issuers located outside the United States. Funds that invest in foreign securities offer the potential for more diversification than funds that invest only in the United States because securities traded on foreign markets have often (though not always) performed differently from securities traded in the United States. However, such investments often involve risks not present in U.S. investments that can increase the chances that a Fund will lose money. In particular, a Fund is subject to the risk that, because there are generally fewer investors on foreign exchanges and a smaller number of shares traded each day, it may be difficult for the Fund to buy and sell securities on those exchanges. In addition, prices of foreign securities may fluctuate more than prices of securities traded in the United States. Investments in foreign markets may also be adversely affected by governmental actions such as the imposition of punitive taxes. In addition, the governments of certain countries may prohibit or impose substantial restrictions on foreign investing in their capital markets or in certain industries. Any of these actions could severely affect security prices, impair a Fund’s ability to purchase or sell foreign securities or transfer the Fund’s assets or income back into the United States, or otherwise adversely affect a Fund’s operations. Other potential foreign market risks include changes in foreign currency exchange rates, exchange controls, difficulties in pricing securities, defaults on foreign government securities, difficulties in enforcing favorable legal judgments in foreign courts, and political and social instability. Legal remedies available to investors in certain foreign countries may be less extensive than those available to investors in the United States or other foreign countries. Dividends or interest on, or proceeds from the sale of, foreign securities may be subject to foreign withholding taxes.
Regional Risk. Adverse conditions in a certain region can adversely affect securities of issuers in other countries whose economies appear to be unrelated. To the extent that a Fund invests a significant portion of its assets in a specific geographic region, the Fund generally will have more exposure to regional economic risks. In the event of economic or political turmoil or a deterioration of diplomatic relations in a region or country where a substantial portion of the Fund’s assets are invested, the Fund may experience substantial illiquidity or losses.
Eurozone-Related Risk. A number of countries in the European Union (the “EU”) have experienced, and may continue to experience, severe economic and financial difficulties. Additional EU member countries may also fall subject to such difficulties. These events could negatively affect the value and liquidity of a Fund’s investments in euro-denominated securities and derivatives contracts, as well as securities of issuers located in the EU or with significant exposure to EU issuers or countries. If the euro is dissolved entirely, the legal and contractual consequences for holders of euro-denominated obligations and derivative contracts would be determined by laws in effect at such time. Such investments may continue to be held, or purchased, to the extent consistent with the Fund’s investment objective and permitted under applicable law. These potential developments, or market perceptions concerning these and related issues, could adversely affect the value of the Fund’s shares.
Certain countries in the EU have had to accept assistance from supra-governmental agencies such as the International Monetary Fund, the European Stability Mechanism, or other supra-governmental agencies. The European Central Bank has also been intervening to purchase Eurozone debt in an attempt to stabilize markets and reduce borrowing costs. There can be no assurance that these agencies will continue to intervene or provide further assistance, and markets may react adversely to any expected reduction in the financial support provided by these agencies. Responses to the financial problems by European governments, central banks, and others, including austerity measures and reforms, may not work, may result in social unrest, and may limit future growth and economic recovery or have other unintended consequences.
In June 2016, the United Kingdom (the “UK”) approved a referendum to leave the EU, commonly referred to as “Brexit,” which sparked depreciation in the value of the British pound, short-term declines in global stock markets, and heightened risk of continued worldwide economic volatility. The UK officially left the EU on January 31, 2020, with a transitional period that ended on December 31, 2020. On December 30, 2020, the UK and the EU signed an agreement on the terms governing certain aspects of the EU’s and the UK’s relationship following the end of the transition period, the EU-UK Trade and Cooperation Agreement (the “TCA”). Notwithstanding the TCA, there is likely to be considerable uncertainty as to the UK’s post-transition framework, and in particular as to the arrangements which will apply to the UK’s relationships with the EU and with other countries, which is likely to continue to develop and could result in increased volatility and illiquidity and potentially lower economic growth. Brexit created and may continue to create an uncertain political and economic environment in the UK and other EU countries. This long-term uncertainty may affect other countries in the EU and elsewhere. Further, the UK’s departure from the EU may cause volatility within the EU, triggering prolonged economic downturns in certain European countries or sparking additional member states to contemplate departing the EU. In addition,
22

the UK’s departure from the EU may create actual or perceived additional economic stresses for the UK, including potential for decreased trade, capital outflows, devaluation of the British pound, wider corporate bond spreads due to uncertainty, and possible declines in business and consumer spending, as well as foreign direct investment.
Foreign Economy Risk. The economies of certain foreign markets often do not compare favorably with that of the United States with respect to such issues as growth of gross national product, reinvestment of capital, resources, and balance of payments position. Certain such economies may rely heavily on particular industries or foreign capital and are more vulnerable to diplomatic developments, the imposition of economic sanctions against a particular country or countries, changes in international trading patterns, trade barriers, and other protectionist or retaliatory measures.
Currency Risk and Exchange Risk. Unless a Fund's Prospectus states a policy to invest only in securities denominated in U.S. dollars, a Fund may invest in securities denominated or quoted in currencies other than the U.S. dollar. In such case, changes in foreign currency exchange rates will affect the value of a Fund’s portfolio. Generally, when the U.S. dollar rises in value against a foreign currency, a security denominated in that currency loses value because the currency is worth fewer U.S. dollars. Conversely, when the U.S. dollar decreases in value against a foreign currency, a security denominated in that currency gains value because the currency is worth more U.S. dollars. This risk, generally known as “currency risk,” means that a stronger U.S. dollar will reduce returns for U.S. investors while a weak U.S. dollar will increase those returns.
Governmental Supervision and Regulation/Accounting Standards. Many foreign governments supervise and regulate stock exchanges, brokers and the sale of securities less than does the United States. Some countries may not have laws to protect investors comparable to the U.S. securities laws. For example, some foreign countries may have no laws or rules against insider trading. Insider trading occurs when a person buys or sells a company’s securities based on nonpublic information about that company. Accounting standards in other countries are not necessarily the same as in the United States. If the accounting standards in another country do not require as much detail as U.S. accounting standards, it may be harder for Fund management to completely and accurately determine a company’s financial condition. In addition, the U.S. government has from time to time in the past imposed restrictions, through penalties and otherwise, on foreign investments by U.S. investors such as a Fund. If such restrictions should be reinstituted, it might become necessary for the Fund to invest all or substantially all of its assets in U.S. securities.
Certain Risks of Holding Fund Assets Outside the United States. A Fund generally holds its foreign securities and cash in foreign banks and securities depositories. Some foreign banks and securities depositories may be recently organized or new to the foreign custody business. In addition, there may be limited or no regulatory oversight over their operations. Also, the laws of certain countries may put limits on a Fund’s ability to recover its assets if a foreign bank or depository or issuer of a security or any of their agents goes bankrupt. In addition, it is often more expensive for a Fund to buy, sell and hold securities in certain foreign markets than in the United States. The increased expense of investing in foreign markets reduces the amount a Fund can earn on its investments and typically results in a higher operating expense ratio for the Fund as compared to investment companies that invest only in the United States.
Settlement Risk. Settlement and clearance procedures in certain foreign markets differ significantly from those in the United States. Foreign settlement procedures and trade regulations also may involve certain risks (such as delays in payment for or delivery of securities) not typically generated by the settlement of U.S. investments. Communications between the United States and emerging market countries may be unreliable, increasing the risk of delayed settlements or losses of security certificates in markets that still rely on physical settlement. Settlements in certain foreign countries at times have not kept pace with the number of securities transactions; these problems may make it difficult for a Fund to carry out transactions. If a Fund cannot settle or is delayed in settling a purchase of securities, it may miss attractive investment opportunities and certain of its assets may be uninvested with no return earned thereon for some period. If a Fund cannot settle or is delayed in settling a sale of securities, it may lose money if the value of the security then declines or, if it has contracted to sell the security to another party, the Fund could be liable to that party for any losses incurred.
Investment in Emerging Markets. Each Fund, except the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, may invest in securities of issuers domiciled in various countries with emerging capital markets. Emerging market countries typically are developing and low- or middle-income countries. Emerging market countries may be found in regions such as Asia, Latin America, Eastern Europe, the Middle East and Africa.
23

Investments in the securities of issuers domiciled in countries with emerging capital markets involve certain additional risks that do not generally apply to investments in securities of issuers in more developed capital markets, such as (i) low or non-existent trading volume, resulting in a lack of liquidity and increased volatility in prices for such securities, as compared to securities of comparable issuers in more developed capital markets; (ii) uncertain national policies and social, political and economic instability, increasing the potential for expropriation of assets, confiscatory taxation, high rates of inflation or unfavorable diplomatic developments; (iii) possible fluctuations in exchange rates, differing legal systems and the existence or possible imposition of exchange controls, custodial restrictions or other foreign or U.S. governmental laws or restrictions applicable to such investments; (iv) national policies that may limit a Fund’s investment opportunities, such as restrictions on investment in issuers or industries deemed sensitive to national interests; and (v) the lack or relatively early development of legal structures governing private and foreign investments and private property. In addition to withholding taxes on investment income, some countries with emerging markets may impose differential capital gains taxes on foreign investors.
Emerging capital markets are developing in a dynamic political and economic environment brought about by events over recent years that have reshaped political boundaries and traditional ideologies. In such a dynamic environment, there can be no assurance that any or all of these capital markets will continue to present viable investment opportunities for a Fund. In the past, governments of such nations have expropriated substantial amounts of private property, and most claims of the property owners have never been fully settled. There is no assurance that such expropriations will not reoccur. In such an event, it is possible that a Fund could lose the entire value of its investments in the affected market.
Also, there may be less publicly available information about issuers in emerging markets than would be available about issuers in more developed capital markets, and such issuers may not be subject to accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards and requirements comparable to those to which U.S. companies are subject. In certain countries with emerging capital markets, reporting standards vary widely. As a result, traditional investment measurements used in the United States, such as price/earnings ratios, may not be applicable. Emerging market securities may be substantially less liquid and more volatile than those of mature markets, and company shares may be held by a limited number of persons. This may adversely affect the timing and pricing of the Fund’s acquisition or disposal of securities.
Practices in relation to settlement of securities transactions in emerging markets involve higher risks than those in developed markets, in part because a Fund will need to use brokers and counterparties that are less well capitalized, and custody and registration of assets in some countries may be unreliable compared to developed countries. The possibility of fraud, negligence, undue influence being exerted by the issuer, or refusal to recognize ownership exists in some emerging markets, and, along with other factors, could result in ownership registration being completely lost. A Fund would absorb any loss resulting from such registration problems and may have no successful claim for compensation.
Investment in Frontier Markets. Frontier market countries generally have smaller economies and less developed capital markets than traditional emerging markets, and, as a result, the risks of investing in emerging market countries are magnified in frontier market countries. The economies of frontier market countries are less correlated to global economic cycles than those of their more developed counterparts and their markets have low trading volumes and the potential for extreme price volatility and illiquidity. This volatility may be further heightened by the actions of a few major investors. For example, a substantial increase or decrease in cash flows of mutual funds investing in these markets could significantly affect local stock prices and, therefore, the price of Fund shares. These factors make investing in frontier market countries significantly riskier than in other countries and any one of them could cause the price of a Fund’s shares to decline.
Governments of many frontier market countries in which a Fund may invest may exercise substantial influence over many aspects of the private sector. In some cases, the governments of such frontier market countries may own or control certain companies. Accordingly, government actions could have a significant effect on economic conditions in a frontier market country and on market conditions, prices and yields of securities in a Fund’s portfolio. Moreover, the economies of frontier market countries may be heavily dependent upon international trade and, accordingly, have been and may continue to be, adversely affected by trade barriers, exchange controls, managed adjustments in relative currency values and other protectionist measures imposed or negotiated by the countries with which they trade. These economies also have been and may continue to be adversely affected by economic conditions in the countries with which they trade.
Investment in equity securities of issuers operating in certain frontier market countries may be restricted or controlled to varying degrees. These restrictions or controls may at times limit or preclude foreign investment in equity securities of issuers operating in certain frontier market countries and increase the costs and expenses of a Fund. Certain frontier market countries require governmental approval prior to investments by foreign persons, limit the amount of investment by foreign
24

persons in a particular issuer, limit the investment by foreign persons only to a specific class of securities of an issuer that may have less advantageous rights than the classes available for purchase by domiciliaries of the countries and/or impose additional taxes on foreign investors. Certain frontier market countries may also restrict investment opportunities in issuers in industries deemed important to national interests.
Frontier market countries may require governmental approval for the repatriation of investment income, capital or the proceeds of sales of securities by foreign investors, such as a Fund. In addition, if deterioration occurs in a frontier market country’s balance of payments, the country could impose temporary restrictions on foreign capital remittances. A Fund could be adversely affected by delays in, or a refusal to grant, any required governmental approval for repatriation of capital, as well as by the application to the Fund of any restrictions on investments. Investing in local markets in frontier market countries may require a Fund to adopt special procedures, seek local government approvals or take other actions, each of which may involve additional costs to the Fund.
In addition, investing in frontier markets includes the risk of share blocking. Share blocking refers to a practice, in certain foreign markets, where voting rights related to an issuer’s securities are predicated on these securities being blocked from trading at the custodian or sub-custodian level, for a period of time around a shareholder meeting. These restrictions have the effect of prohibiting securities to potentially be voted (or having been voted), from trading within a specified number of days before, and in certain instances, after the shareholder meeting. Share blocking may prevent a Fund from buying or selling securities for a period of time. During the time that shares are blocked, trades in such securities will not settle. The specific practices may vary by market and the blocking period can last from a day to several weeks, typically terminating on a date established at the discretion of the issuer. Once blocked, the only manner in which to remove the block would be to withdraw a previously cast vote, or to abstain from voting altogether. The process for having a blocking restriction lifted can be very difficult with the particular requirements varying widely by country. In certain countries, the block cannot be removed.
There may be no centralized securities exchange on which securities are traded in frontier market countries. Also, securities laws in many frontier market countries are relatively new and unsettled. Therefore, laws regarding foreign investment in frontier market securities, securities regulation, title to securities, and shareholder rights may change quickly and unpredictably.
The frontier market countries in which a Fund invests may become subject to sanctions or embargoes imposed by the U.S. government and the United Nations. The value of the securities issued by companies that operate in, or have dealings with, these countries may be negatively impacted by any such sanction or embargo and may reduce a Fund’s returns. Banks in frontier market countries used to hold a Fund’s securities and other assets in that country may lack the same operating experience as banks in developed markets. In addition, in certain countries there may be legal restrictions or limitations on the ability of a Fund to recover assets held by a foreign bank in the event of the bankruptcy of the bank. Settlement systems in frontier markets may be less well organized than in the developed markets. As a result, there is greater risk than in developed countries that settlement will take longer and that cash or securities of a Fund may be in jeopardy because of failures of or defects in the settlement systems.
Restrictions on Certain Investments. A number of publicly traded closed-end investment companies have been organized to facilitate indirect foreign investment in developing countries, and certain of such countries, such as Thailand, South Korea, Chile and Brazil, have specifically authorized such funds. There also are investment opportunities in certain of such countries in pooled vehicles that resemble open-end investment companies. In accordance with the 1940 Act, a Fund may invest up to 10% of its total assets in securities of other investment companies, not more than 5% of which may be invested in any one such company. In addition, under the 1940 Act, a Fund may not own more than 3% of the total outstanding voting stock of any investment company. These restrictions on investments in securities of investment companies may limit opportunities for a Fund to invest indirectly in certain developing countries. Shares of certain investment companies may at times be acquired only at market prices representing premiums to their net asset values. If a Fund acquires shares of other investment companies, shareholders would bear both their proportionate share of expenses of the Fund (including management and advisory fees) and, indirectly, the expenses of such other investment companies.
Depositary Receipts. A Fund may invest in foreign securities by purchasing depositary receipts, including American Depositary Receipts (“ADRs”), European Depositary Receipts (“EDRs”), Global Depositary Receipts (“GDRs”) and non-voting depositary receipts (“NVDRs”) or other securities convertible into securities of issuers based in foreign countries. These securities may not necessarily be denominated in the same currency as the securities into which they may be
25

converted. Generally, ADRs, in registered form, are denominated in U.S. dollars and are designed for use in the U.S. securities markets, GDRs, in bearer form, are issued and designed for use outside the United States and EDRs (also referred to as Continental Depositary Receipts (“CDRs”)), in bearer form, may be denominated in other currencies and are designed for use in European securities markets. ADRs are receipts typically issued by a U.S. bank or trust company evidencing ownership of the underlying securities. EDRs are European receipts evidencing a similar arrangement. GDRs are receipts typically issued by non-U.S. banks and trust companies that evidence ownership of either foreign or domestic securities. For purposes of a Fund’s investment policies, ADRs, EDRs, GDRs and NVDRs are deemed to have the same classification as the underlying securities they represent. Thus, an ADR, EDR, GDR or NVDR representing ownership of common stock will be treated as common stock.
A Fund may invest in depositary receipts through “sponsored” or “unsponsored” facilities. While ADRs issued under these two types of facilities are in some respects similar, there are distinctions between them relating to the rights and obligations of ADR holders and the practices of market participants.
A depositary may establish an unsponsored facility without participation by (or even necessarily the acquiescence of) the issuer of the deposited securities, although typically the depositary requests a letter of non-objection from such issuer prior to the establishment of the facility. Holders of unsponsored ADRs generally bear all the costs of such facilities. The depositary usually charges fees upon the deposit and withdrawal of the deposited securities, the conversion of dividends into U.S. dollars, the disposition of non-cash distributions, and the performance of other services. The depositary of an unsponsored facility frequently is under no obligation to pass through voting rights to ADR holders in respect of the deposited securities. In addition, an unsponsored facility is generally not obligated to distribute communications received from the issuer of the deposited securities or to disclose material information about such issuer in the U.S. and thus there may not be a correlation between such information and the market value of the depositary receipts. Unsponsored ADRs tend to be less liquid than sponsored ADRs.
Sponsored ADR facilities are created in generally the same manner as unsponsored facilities, except that the issuer of the deposited securities enters into a deposit agreement with the depositary. The deposit agreement sets out the rights and responsibilities of the issuer, the depositary, and the ADR holders. With sponsored facilities, the issuer of the deposited securities generally will bear some of the costs relating to the facility (such as dividend payment fees of the depositary), although ADR holders continue to bear certain other costs (such as deposit and withdrawal fees). Under the terms of most sponsored arrangements, depositaries agree to distribute notices of shareholder meetings and voting instructions, and to provide shareholder communications and other information to the ADR holders at the request of the issuer of the deposited securities.
Foreign Sovereign Debt. The Fixed-Income Funds may invest in sovereign debt obligations issued by foreign governments. To the extent that a Fund invests in obligations issued by governments of developing or emerging market countries, these investments involve additional risks. Sovereign obligors in developing and emerging market countries are among the world’s largest debtors to commercial banks, other governments, international financial organizations and other financial institutions. These obligors have in the past experienced substantial difficulties in servicing their external debt obligations, which led to defaults on certain obligations and the restructuring of certain indebtedness. Restructuring arrangements have included, among other things, reducing and rescheduling interest and principal payments by negotiating new or amended credit agreements or converting outstanding principal and unpaid interest to Brady Bonds, and obtaining new credit for finance interest payments. Holders of certain foreign sovereign debt securities may be requested to participate in the restructuring of such obligations and to extend further loans to their issuers. There can be no assurance that the foreign sovereign debt securities in which a Fund may invest will not be subject to similar restructuring arrangements or to requests for new credit which may adversely affect the Fund’s holdings. Furthermore, certain participants in the secondary market for such debt may be directly involved in negotiating the terms of these arrangements and may therefore have access to information not available to other market participants.
China Investment Risk. Investing in China involves a high degree of risk and special considerations not typically associated with investing in other economies or more established securities markets. Such risks include: (a) the risk of nationalization or expropriation of assets or confiscatory taxation; (b) greater social, economic and political uncertainty (including the risk of war); (c) dependency on exports and the corresponding importance of international trade; (d) the increasing competition from Asia’s other low-cost emerging economies; (e) greater price volatility and significantly smaller market capitalization of securities markets; (f) substantially less liquidity, particularly of certain share classes of Chinese securities; (g) currency exchange rate fluctuations and the lack of available currency hedging instruments; (h) higher rates of
26

inflation; (i) controls on foreign investment and limitations on repatriation of invested capital and on the Fund’s ability to exchange local currencies for U.S. dollars; (j) greater governmental involvement in and control over the economy; (k) the risk that the Chinese government may decide not to continue to support the economic reform programs implemented since 1978 and could return to the prior, completely centrally planned, economy; (l) the fact that Chinese companies may be smaller, less seasoned and newly-organized companies; (m) the difference in, or lack of, auditing and financial reporting standards which may result in unavailability of material information about issuers; (n) the fact that statistical information regarding the economy of China may be inaccurate or not comparable to statistical information regarding the U.S. or other economies; (o) the less extensive, and still developing, regulation of the securities markets, business entities and commercial transactions; (p) the fact that the settlement period of securities transactions in foreign markets may be longer; (q) the willingness and ability of the Chinese government to support the Chinese economy and market is uncertain; (r) the risk that it may be more difficult, or impossible, to obtain and/or enforce a judgment than in other countries; and (s) the rapidity and erratic nature of growth resulting in inefficiencies and dislocations.
Investment in China is subject to certain political risks. Following the establishment of the People’s Republic of China by the Communist Party in 1949, the Chinese government renounced various debt obligations incurred by China’s predecessor governments, which obligations remain in default, and expropriated assets without compensation. There can be no assurance that the Chinese government will not take similar action in the future.
Chinese Variable Interest Entities. In China, equity ownership of companies by foreign individuals and entities is restricted or prohibited in certain sectors, such as internet, media, education and telecommunications. To circumvent these limits, starting in the early 2000s many Chinese companies, including most of the well-known Chinese Internet companies, have used a special structure known as a variable interest entity (“VIE”) to raise capital from foreign investors. In a typical VIE structure, a shell company is set up in an offshore jurisdiction, such as the Cayman Islands. The shell company, through a wholly foreign-owned enterprise (“WFOE”) based in China, enters into service and other contracts with another Chinese company known as the VIE. The VIE must be owned by Chinese nationals (and/or other Chinese companies), which often are the VIE’s founders, in order to obtain the licenses and/or assets required to operate in the restricted or prohibited industry in China. The contractual arrangements entered into between the WFOE and VIE (which often include powers of attorney, loan and equity pledge agreements, call option agreements and exclusive services or business cooperation agreements) are designed to allow the shell company to exert a degree of control over, and obtain economic benefits arising from, the VIE without formal legal ownership.
The contractual arrangements are structured to require the shell company to consolidate the VIE into its financial statements, pursuant to U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, despite the absence of equity ownership. Such consolidation provides the shell company with the ability to issue shares on a foreign exchange, such as the New York Stock Exchange or NASDAQ, often with the same name as the VIE. Accordingly, foreign investors, such as the Fund, will only own stock in the shell company rather than directly in the VIE. Further, the ability of the WFOE to easily extract profits from the VIE structure through service agreements will partially depend on the proportion of the business that can legally be conducted by the WFOE versus the VIE, which varies based on the industry.
Guidance prohibiting these structures by the Chinese government, generally or with respect to specific industries, would likely cause impacted VIE-structured holding(s) to suffer significant, detrimental, and possibly permanent losses, and in turn, adversely affect the Fund’s returns and net asset value. While VIEs are a longstanding industry practice that is well known to Chinese officials and regulators, they have not been formally recognized under Chinese law. It is uncertain whether Chinese officials or regulators will withdraw their implicit acceptance of the VIE structure or limit a VIE’s ability to pass through economic and governance rights to foreign individuals and entities. In 2021, the Chinese government issued new guidelines that unexpectedly included a specific prohibition on the use of VIE structures by Chinese educational companies.
Further, if a Chinese court or arbitration body chose not to enforce the contracts, the value of the shell company would significantly decline, since it derives its value from the ability to consolidate the VIE into its financials pursuant to such contracts, and in turn, adversely affect the Fund’s returns and net asset value. The contractual arrangements with the VIE may not be as effective in providing operational control as direct equity ownership. The Chinese equity owner(s) of the VIE could decide to breach the contractual arrangement and may have conflicting interests and fiduciary duties as compared to investors in the shell company. Accordingly, VIEs depend heavily on executives who are Chinese nationals and own the underlying business licenses and/or assets required to operate in China. In addition to creating “key person” succession risk, the structure can restrict the ability of outside shareholders to challenge executives for poor decision-making, weak management, or equity-eroding actions. Any breach or dispute under these contracts will likely fall under Chinese
27

jurisdiction and law.
Investing through Stock Connect. A Fund may invest in China A-shares of certain Chinese companies listed and traded on the Shanghai Stock Exchange and on the Shenzhen Stock Exchange (together, the “Exchanges”) through the Shanghai-Hong Kong Stock Connect Program and the Shenzhen-Hong Kong Stock Connect Program, respectively (together, “Stock Connect”). Stock Connect is a securities trading and clearing program developed by the Exchange of Hong Kong, the Exchanges and the China Securities Depository and Clearing Corporation Limited. Stock Connect facilitates foreign investment in the People’s Republic of China (“PRC”) via brokers in Hong Kong. Persons investing through Stock Connect are subject to PRC regulations and Exchange listing rules, among others. These could include limitations on or suspension of trading. These regulations are relatively new and subject to changes which could adversely impact a Fund’s rights with respect to the securities. There are no assurances that the necessary systems to run the program will function properly. Stock Connect is subject to aggregate and daily quota limitations on purchases and a Fund may experience delays in transacting via Stock Connect. The stocks of Chinese companies that are owned by a Fund are held in an omnibus account and registered in nominee name. Please also see the sections on risks relating to investing outside the U.S. and investing in emerging markets. See, “Foreign Securities” above regarding investing outside the U.S.
Risks Related to Russian Invasion of Ukraine. In late February 2022, Russian military forces invaded Ukraine, significantly amplifying already existing geopolitical tensions among Russia, Ukraine, Europe, NATO, and the West. Russia’s invasion, the responses of countries and political bodies to Russia’s actions, and the potential for wider conflict may increase financial market volatility and could have severe adverse effects on regional and global economic markets, including the markets for certain securities and commodities such as oil and natural gas. Following Russia’s actions, various countries, including the U.S., Canada, the United Kingdom, Germany, and France, as well as the European Union, issued broad-ranging economic sanctions against Russia. The sanctions consist of the prohibition of trading in certain Russian securities and engaging in certain private transactions, the prohibition of doing business with certain Russian corporate entities, large financial institutions, officials and oligarchs, and the freezing of Russian assets. The sanctions include a commitment by certain countries and the European Union to remove selected Russian banks from the Society for Worldwide Interbank Financial Telecommunications, commonly called “SWIFT,” the electronic network that connects banks globally, and imposed restrictive measures to prevent the Russian Central Bank from undermining the impact of the sanctions. A number of large corporations and U.S. states have also announced plans to divest interests or otherwise curtail business dealings with certain Russian businesses.
The imposition of these current sanctions (and potential further sanctions in response to continued Russian military activity) and other actions undertaken by countries and businesses may adversely impact various sectors of the Russian economy, including but not limited to, the financials, energy, metals and mining, engineering, and defense and defense-related materials sectors. Such actions also may result in the decline of the value and liquidity of Russian securities, a weakening of the ruble, and could impair the ability of a Fund to buy, sell, receive, or deliver those securities. Moreover, the measures could adversely affect global financial and energy markets and thereby negatively affect the value of a Fund's investments beyond any direct exposure to Russian issuers or those of adjoining geographic regions. In response to sanctions, the Russian Central Bank raised its interest rates and banned sales of local securities by foreigners. Russia may take additional counter measures or retaliatory actions, which may further impair the value and liquidity of Russian securities and Fund investments. Such actions could, for example, include restricting gas exports to other countries, seizure of U.S. and European residents' assets, or undertaking or provoking other military conflict elsewhere in Europe, any of which could exacerbate negative consequences on global financial markets and the economy. The actions discussed above could have a negative effect on the performance of funds that have exposure to Russia. While diplomatic efforts have been ongoing, the conflict between Russia and Ukraine is currently unpredictable and has the potential to result in broadened military actions. The duration of ongoing hostilities and corresponding sanctions and related events cannot be predicted and may result in a negative impact on performance and the value of Fund investments, particularly as it relates to Russia exposure.
Due to difficulties transacting in impacted securities, a Fund may experience challenges liquidating the applicable positions to continue to seek a Fund’s investment objective. Additionally, due to current and potential future sanctions or potential market closure impacting the ability to trade Russian securities, a Fund may experience higher transaction costs.
Risks Related to Israel-Hamas War. In October 2023, armed conflict broke out between Israel and the militant group Hamas after Hamas infiltrated Israel’s southern border from the Gaza Strip. In response, Israel declared war on Hamas and Israeli Defense Forces invaded the Gaza Strip. Events in Israel, Gaza, and the greater Middle East region are rapidly evolving, and the extent and duration of the Israel-Hamas war are impossible to predict.
28

Both actual hostilities, including the Israel-Hamas war described above, and the threat of future hostilities may have a significant adverse effect on Israel’s economy, including increased volatility in the share price of companies based in or with operations in Israel, local securities trading suspensions, local securities market closures (including for extended periods), a lack of transparency concerning Israeli issuers or other local market information, and increased restrictions on foreign investment or repatriation of capital. Such hostilities or an attack also may escalate into a more wide-scale conflict with the potential for greater and far-reaching adverse effects in the region and globally. While it is not possible to predict the extent and duration of any such conflict, the resulting market disruptions could be significant, including in certain industries or sectors, such as the oil and natural gas markets, and may negatively affect global supply chains, inflation and global growth. These and any related events could significantly impact a Fund’s performance and the value of an investment in the Fund, even if the Fund does not have direct exposure to Israeli issuers or issuers in other countries affected by the war.
Initial Public Offerings
Each of the Equity Funds may participate in initial public offerings (“IPOs”). Securities issued in initial public offerings have no trading history, and information about the companies may be available for very limited periods. The volume of IPOs and the levels at which the newly issued stocks trade in the secondary market are affected by the performance of the stock market overall. If IPOs are brought to the market, availability may be limited and a Fund may not be able to buy any shares at the offering price, or if it is able to buy shares, it may not be able to buy as many shares at the offering price as it would like. In addition, the prices of securities involved in IPOs are often subject to greater and more unpredictable price changes than more established stocks.
Interfund Borrowing and Lending Program
Pursuant to an exemptive order issued by the SEC dated June 13, 2016, the Funds may lend money to, and borrow money for temporary purposes from, other funds advised by the Funds' investment adviser, NFA. Generally, a Fund will borrow money through the program only when the costs are equal to or lower than the cost of bank loans. Interfund borrowings can have a maximum duration of seven days. Loans may be called on one day’s notice. There is no assurance that a Fund will be able to borrow or lend under the program at any time, and a Fund may have to borrow from a bank at a higher interest rate if an interfund loan is unavailable, called, or not renewed.
Lending Portfolio Securities
Each Fund may lend its portfolio securities to brokers, dealers and other financial institutions, provided it receives collateral, with respect to each loan of U.S. securities, equal to at least 102% of the value of the portfolio securities loaned, and, with respect to each loan of non-U.S. securities, collateral of at least 105% of the value of the portfolio securities loaned, and at all times thereafter shall require the borrower to mark-to-market such collateral on a daily basis so that the market value of such collateral does not fall below 100% of the market value of the portfolio securities so loaned. By lending its portfolio securities, a Fund can increase its income through the investment of the collateral. For the purposes of this policy, a Fund considers collateral consisting of cash, U.S. government securities or letters of credit issued by banks whose securities meet the standards for investment by the Fund to be the equivalent of cash. From time to time, a Fund may return to the borrower or a third party which is unaffiliated with it, and which is acting as a “placing broker,” a part of the interest earned from the investment of collateral received for securities loaned.
The SEC currently requires that the following conditions must be met whenever portfolio securities are loaned: (1) a Fund must receive from the borrower collateral equal to at least 100% of the value of the portfolio securities loaned; (2) the borrower must increase such collateral whenever the market value of the securities loaned rises above the level of such collateral; (3) a Fund must be able to terminate the loan at any time; (4) a Fund must receive a reasonable rate of return on the loan, as well as any dividends, interest or other distributions payable on the loaned securities, and any increase in market value; (5) a Fund may pay only reasonable custodian fees in connection with the loan; and (6) while any voting rights on the loaned securities may pass to the borrower, the Board of Trustees must be able to terminate the loan and regain the right to vote the securities if a material event adversely affecting the investment occurs. In addition, a Fund may not have on loan securities representing more than one-third of its total assets at any given time. The collateral that a Fund receives may be included in calculating the Fund’s total assets. A Fund generally will not seek to vote proxies relating to the securities on loan, unless it is in the best interests of the applicable Fund to do so. These conditions may be subject to future modification. Loan agreements involve certain risks in the event of default or insolvency of the other party including possible delays or restrictions upon the Fund’s ability to recover the loaned securities or dispose of the collateral for the loan.
29

Investment of Securities Lending Collateral. The cash collateral received from a borrower as a result of a Fund’s securities lending activities will be used to purchase both fixed-income securities and other securities with debt-like characteristics that are rated A1 or P1 on a fixed-rate or floating-rate basis, including: bank obligations; commercial paper; investment agreements, funding agreements, or guaranteed investment contracts entered into with, or guaranteed by, an insurance company; loan participations; master notes; medium-term notes; repurchase agreements; and U.S. government securities. Except for the investment agreements, funding agreements or guaranteed investment contracts guaranteed by an insurance company, master notes, and medium-term notes (which are described below), these types of investments are described elsewhere in the SAI. Collateral may also be invested in a money market mutual fund or short-term collective investment trust.
Investment agreements, funding agreements, or guaranteed investment contracts entered into with, or guaranteed by, an insurance company are agreements in which an insurance company either provides for the investment of the Fund’s assets or provides for a minimum guaranteed rate of return to the investor.
Master notes are promissory notes issued usually with large, creditworthy broker-dealers on either a fixed-rate or floating-rate basis. Master notes may or may not be collateralized by underlying securities. If the master note is issued by an unrated subsidiary of a broker-dealer, then an unconditional guarantee is provided by the issuer’s parent.
Medium-term notes are unsecured, continuously offered corporate debt obligations. Although medium-term notes may be offered with a maturity from one to ten years, in the context of securities lending collateral, the maturity of the medium-term note generally will not exceed two years.
LIBOR Risk
The Funds may be exposed to financial instruments that are tied to the London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”) to determine payment obligations, financing terms, hedging strategies or investment value. The Funds' investments may pay interest at floating rates based on LIBOR or may be subject to interest caps or floors based on LIBOR. The Funds may also obtain financing at floating rates based on LIBOR. Derivative instruments utilized by the Funds may also reference LIBOR.
The United Kingdom’s Financial Conduct Authority (“FCA”), which regulates LIBOR, has ceased publishing all LIBOR settings. In April 2023, however, the FCA announced that some USD LIBOR settings will continue to be published under a synthetic methodology until September 30, 2024 for certain legacy contracts. Actions by regulators have resulted in the establishment of alternative reference rates in most major currencies. The U.S. Federal Reserve, based on the recommendations of Alternative Reference Rates Committee, has begun publishing the Secured Overnight Financing Rate (“SOFR”) that is intended to replace U.S. dollar LIBOR. Proposals for alternative reference rates for other currencies have also been announced or have already begun publication. Markets are slowly developing in response to these new reference rates.
Neither the effect of the LIBOR transition process nor its ultimate success can yet be known. The transition process might lead to increased volatility and illiquidity in markets for, and reduce the effectiveness of new hedges placed against, instruments whose terms currently include LIBOR. While some existing LIBOR-based instruments may contemplate a scenario where LIBOR is no longer available by providing for an alternative rate-setting methodology, there may be significant uncertainty regarding the effectiveness of any such alternative methodologies to replicate LIBOR. Not all existing LIBOR-based instruments may have alternative rate-setting provisions and there remains uncertainty regarding the willingness and ability of issuers to add alternative rate-setting provisions in certain existing instruments. In addition, a liquid market for newly-issued instruments that use a reference rate other than LIBOR still may be developing. There may also be challenges for the Funds to enter into hedging transactions against such newly-issued instruments until a market for such hedging transactions develops. All of the aforementioned may adversely affect the Funds' performance or net asset value.
Medium-Quality, Lower-Quality and High-Yield Securities
Except for the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, each of the Fixed-Income Funds may invest in medium-quality securities and also in lower-quality and high-yield securities (commonly known as “junk bonds”) (hereinafter referred to as “lower-quality securities”).
30

Medium-Quality Securities. Medium-quality securities are obligations rated in the fourth highest rating category by any NRSRO. Medium-quality securities, although considered investment grade, may have some speculative characteristics and may be subject to greater fluctuations in value than higher-rated securities. In addition, the issuers of medium-quality securities may be more vulnerable to adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances than issuers of higher-rated securities.
Lower-Quality/High-Yield Securities. Non-investment grade debt or lower-quality/rated securities include: (i) bonds rated as low as C by Moody’s, Standard & Poor’s, or Fitch, Inc. (“Fitch”); (ii) commercial paper rated as low as C by Standard & Poor’s, Not Prime by Moody’s or Fitch 4 by Fitch; and (iii) unrated debt securities of comparable quality. Lower-quality securities, while generally offering higher yields than investment grade securities with similar maturities, involve greater risks, including the possibility of default or bankruptcy. There is more risk associated with these investments because of reduced creditworthiness and increased risk of default. Under NRSRO guidelines, lower-quality securities and comparable unrated securities will likely have some quality and protective characteristics that are outweighed by large uncertainties or major risk exposures to adverse conditions. Lower-quality securities are considered to have extremely poor prospects of ever attaining any real investment standing, to have a current identifiable vulnerability to default or to be in default, to be unlikely to have the capacity to make required interest payments and repay principal when due in the event of adverse business, financial or economic conditions, or to be in default or not current in the payment of interest or principal. They are regarded as predominantly speculative with respect to the issuer’s capacity to pay interest and repay principal. The special risk considerations in connection with investments in these securities are discussed below.
Effect of Interest Rates and Economic Changes. Interest-bearing securities typically experience appreciation when interest rates decline and depreciation when interest rates rise. The market values of lower-quality and comparable unrated securities tend to reflect individual corporate developments to a greater extent than do higher-rated securities, which react primarily to fluctuations in the general level of interest rates. Lower-quality and comparable unrated securities also tend to be more sensitive to economic conditions than are higher-rated securities. As a result, they generally involve more credit risks than securities in the higher-rated categories. During an economic downturn or a sustained period of rising interest rates, highly leveraged issuers of lower-quality and comparable unrated securities may experience financial stress and may not have sufficient revenues to meet their payment obligations. The issuer’s ability to service its debt obligations may also be adversely affected by specific corporate developments, the issuer’s inability to meet specific projected business forecasts or the unavailability of additional financing. The risk of loss due to default by an issuer of these securities is significantly greater than that of issuers of higher-rated securities also because such securities are generally unsecured and are often subordinated to other creditors. Further, if the issuer of a lower-quality or comparable unrated security defaulted, a Fund might incur additional expenses to seek recovery. Periods of economic uncertainty and changes would also generally result in increased volatility in the market prices of these securities and thus in a Fund’s net asset value.
As previously stated, the value of a lower-quality or comparable unrated security will generally decrease in a rising interest rate market, and accordingly so will a Fund's net asset value. If a Fund experiences unexpected net redemptions in such a market, it may be forced to liquidate a portion of its portfolio securities without regard to their investment merits. Due to the limited liquidity of lower-quality and comparable unrated securities (discussed below), a Fund may be forced to liquidate these securities at a substantial discount which would result in a lower rate of return to the Fund.
Payment Expectations. Lower-quality and comparable unrated securities typically contain redemption, call or prepayment provisions which permit the issuer of such securities containing such provisions to, at its discretion, redeem the securities. During periods of falling interest rates, issuers of these securities are likely to redeem or prepay the securities and refinance them with debt securities at a lower interest rate. To the extent an issuer is able to refinance the securities, or otherwise redeem them, a Fund may have to replace the securities with a lower yielding security, which would result in a lower return for the Fund.
Liquidity and Valuation. A Fund may have difficulty disposing of certain lower-quality and comparable unrated securities because there may be a thin trading market for such securities. Because not all dealers maintain markets in all lower-quality and comparable unrated securities, there may be no established retail secondary market for many of these securities. The Funds anticipate that such securities could be sold only to a limited number of dealers or institutional investors. To the extent a secondary trading market does exist, it is generally not as liquid as the secondary market for higher-rated securities. The lack of a liquid secondary market may have an adverse impact on the market price of the security. As a result, a Fund’s net asset value and ability to dispose of particular securities, when necessary to meet the Fund’s liquidity needs or in response to a specific economic event, may be impacted. The lack of a liquid secondary market for certain
31

securities may also make it more difficult for a Fund to obtain accurate market quotations for purposes of valuing that Fund’s portfolio. Market quotations are generally available on many lower-quality and comparable unrated issues only from a limited number of dealers and may not necessarily represent firm bids of such dealers or prices for actual sales. During periods of thin trading, the spread between bid and asked prices is likely to increase significantly. In addition, adverse publicity and investor perceptions, whether or not based on fundamental analysis, may decrease the values and liquidity of lower-quality and comparable unrated securities, especially in a thinly traded market.
Mortgage- and Asset-Backed Securities
Each of the Fixed-Income Funds, except the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, may invest in mortgage- and asset-backed securities. Mortgage-backed securities represent direct or indirect participation in, or are secured by and payable from, mortgage loans secured by real property. Mortgage-backed securities come in different forms. The simplest form of mortgage-backed securities is pass-through certificates. Such securities may be issued or guaranteed by U.S. government agencies or instrumentalities or may be issued by private issuers, generally originators in mortgage loans, including savings and loan associations, mortgage bankers, commercial banks, investment bankers, and special purpose entities (collectively, “private lenders”). The purchase of mortgage-backed securities from private lenders may entail greater risk than mortgage-backed securities that are issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities. Mortgage-backed securities issued by private lenders may be supported by pools of mortgage loans or other mortgage-backed securities that are guaranteed, directly or indirectly, by the U.S. government or one of its agencies or instrumentalities, or they may be issued without any governmental guarantee of the underlying mortgage assets but with some form of non-governmental credit enhancement. These credit enhancements may include letters of credit, reserve funds, over-collateralization, or guarantees by third parties. There is no guarantee that these credit enhancements, if any, will be sufficient to prevent losses in the event of defaults on the underlying mortgage loans. Additionally, mortgage-backed securities purchased from private lenders are not traded on an exchange and there may be a limited market for the securities, especially when there is a perceived weakness in the mortgage and real estate market sectors. Without an active trading market, mortgage-backed securities held in a Fund’s portfolio may be particularly difficult to value because of the complexities involved in assessing the value of the underlying mortgage loan.
Through its investments in mortgage-backed securities, including those issued by private lenders, a Fund may have some exposure to subprime loans, as well as to the mortgage and credit markets generally. Subprime loans refer to loans made to borrowers with weakened credit histories or with a lower capacity to make timely payments on their loans. For these reasons, the loans underlying these securities have had, in many cases, higher default rates than those loans that meet government underwriting requirements. The risk of non-payment is greater for mortgage-backed securities issued by private lenders that contain subprime loans, but a level of risk exists for all loans.
Since privately-issued mortgage certificates are not guaranteed by an entity having the credit status of the Government National Mortgage Association (“GNMA”) or the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (“FHLMC”), such securities generally are structured with one or more types of credit enhancement. Such credit enhancement falls into two categories: (i) liquidity protection; and (ii) protection against losses resulting from ultimate default by an obligor on the underlying assets. Liquidity protection refers to the provisions of advances, generally by the entity administering the pool of assets, to ensure that the pass-through of payments due on the underlying pool occurs in a timely fashion. Protection against losses resulting from ultimate default enhances the likelihood of ultimate payment of the obligations on at least a portion of the assets in the pool. Such protection may be provided through guarantees, insurance policies or letters of credit obtained by the issuer or sponsor from third parties, through various means of structuring the transaction or through a combination of such approaches.
The ratings of mortgage-backed securities for which third-party credit enhancement provides liquidity protection or protection against losses from default are generally dependent upon the continued creditworthiness of the provider of the credit enhancement. The ratings of such securities could be subject to reduction in the event of deterioration in the creditworthiness of the credit enhancement provider even in cases where the delinquency loss experienced on the underlying pool of assets is better than expected. There can be no assurance that the private issuers or credit enhancers of mortgage-backed securities will meet their obligations under the relevant policies or other forms of credit enhancement.
Examples of credit support arising out of the structure of the transaction include “senior-subordinated securities” (multiclass securities with one or more classes subordinate to other classes as to the payment of principal thereof and interest thereon, with the result that defaults on the underlying assets are borne first by the holders of the subordinated class),
32

creation of “reserve funds” (where cash or investments sometimes funded from a portion of the payments on the underlying assets are held in reserve against future losses) and “over-collateralization” (where the scheduled payments on, or the principal amount of, the underlying assets exceed those required to make payment of the securities and pay any servicing or other fees). The degree of credit support provided for each issue is generally based on historical information with respect to the level of credit risk associated with the underlying assets. Delinquency or loss in excess of that which is anticipated could adversely affect the return on an investment in such security.
Private lenders or government-related entities may also create mortgage loan pools offering pass-through investments where the mortgages underlying these securities may be alternative mortgage instruments, that is, mortgage instruments whose principal or interest payments may vary or whose terms to maturity may be shorter than was previously customary. As new types of mortgage-related securities are developed and offered to investors, a Fund, consistent with its investment objective and policies, may consider making investments in such new types of securities.
The yield characteristics of mortgage-backed securities differ from those of traditional debt obligations. Among the principal differences are that interest and principal payments are made more frequently on mortgage-backed securities, usually monthly, and that principal may be prepaid at any time because the underlying mortgage loans or other assets generally may be prepaid at any time. As a result, if a Fund purchases these securities at a premium, a prepayment rate that is faster than expected will reduce yield to maturity, while a prepayment rate that is slower than expected will have the opposite effect of increasing the yield to maturity. Conversely, if a Fund purchases these securities at a discount, a prepayment rate that is faster than expected will increase yield to maturity, while a prepayment rate that is slower than expected will reduce yield to maturity. Accelerated prepayments on securities purchased by the Fund at a premium also impose a risk of loss of principal because the premium may not have been fully amortized at the time the principal is prepaid in full.
Unlike fixed rate mortgage-backed securities, adjustable rate mortgage-backed securities are collateralized by or represent interest in mortgage loans with variable rates of interest. These variable rates of interest reset periodically to align themselves with market rates. A Fund will not benefit from increases in interest rates to the extent that interest rates rise to the point where they cause the current coupon of the underlying adjustable rate mortgages to exceed any maximum allowable annual or lifetime reset limits (or “cap rates”) for a particular mortgage. In this event, the value of the adjustable rate mortgage-backed securities in a Fund would likely decrease. Also, a Fund’s net asset value could vary to the extent that current yields on adjustable rate mortgage-backed securities are different than market yields during interim periods between coupon reset dates or if the timing of changes to the index upon which the rate for the underlying mortgage is based lags behind changes in market rates. During periods of declining interest rates, income to a Fund derived from adjustable rate mortgage-backed securities which remain in a mortgage pool will decrease in contrast to the income on fixed rate mortgage-backed securities, which will remain constant. Adjustable rate mortgages also have less potential for appreciation in value as interest rates decline than do fixed rate investments.
There are a number of important differences among the agencies and instrumentalities of the U.S. government that issue mortgage-backed securities and among the securities that they issue. Mortgage-backed securities issued by GNMA include GNMA Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates (also known as “Ginnie Maes”), which are guaranteed as to the timely payment of principal and interest by GNMA, and such guarantee is backed by the full faith and credit of the United States. GNMA certificates also are supported by the authority of GNMA to borrow funds from the U.S. Treasury to make payments under its guarantee. Mortgage-backed securities issued by the Federal National Mortgage Association (“FNMA”) include FNMA Guaranteed Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates (also known as “Fannie Maes”), which are solely the obligations of FNMA, and are not backed by or entitled to the full faith and credit of the United States. Fannie Maes are guaranteed as to timely payment of the principal and interest by FNMA. Mortgage-backed securities issued by FHLMC include FHLMC Mortgage Participation Certificates (also known as “Freddie Macs” or “PCs”). FHLMC is a corporate instrumentality of the United States, created pursuant to an Act of Congress, which is owned entirely by Federal Home Loan Banks. Securities issued by FHLMC do not constitute a debt or obligation of the United States or by any Federal Home Loan Bank. Freddie Macs entitle the holder to timely payment of interest, which is guaranteed by the FHLMC. FHLMC guarantees either ultimate collection or timely payment of all principal payments on the underlying mortgage loans. When the FHLMC does not guarantee timely payment of principal, FHLMC may remit the amount due on account of its guarantee of ultimate payment of principal at any time after default on an underlying mortgage, but in no event later than one year after it becomes payable.
33

In 2012 the Federal Housing Finance Agency (“FHFA”) initiated a strategic plan to develop a program of credit risk transfer intended to reduce Fannie Mae's and Freddie Mac's overall risk through the creation of credit risk transfer assets (“CRTs”). CRTs come in two primary series: Structured Agency Credit Risk (“STACRs”) for Freddie Mac and Connecticut Avenue Securities (“CAS”) for Fannie Mae, although other series may be developed in the future. CRTs are typically structured as unsecured general obligations of either entities guaranteed by a government-sponsored stockholder-owned corporation, though not backed by the full faith and credit of the United States (such as by Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac (collectively, the “GSEs”)) or special purpose entities, and their cash flows are based on the performance of a pool of reference loans. Unlike traditional residential MBS securities, bond payments typically do not come directly from the underlying mortgages. Instead, the GSEs either make the payments to CRT investors, or the GSEs make certain payments to the special purpose entities and the special purpose entities make payments to the investors. In certain structures, the special purpose entities make payments to the GSEs upon the occurrence of credit events with respect to the underlying mortgages, and the obligation of the special purpose entity to make such payments to the GSE is senior to the obligation of the special purpose entity to make payments to the CRT investors. CRTs are typically floating rate securities and may have multiple tranches with losses first allocated to the most junior or subordinate tranche. This structure results in increased sensitivity to dramatic housing downturns, especially for the subordinate tranches. Many CRTs also have collateral performance triggers (e.g., based on credit enhancement, delinquencies or defaults, etc.) that could shut off principal payments to subordinate tranches. Generally, GSEs have the ability to call all of the CRT tranches at par in 10 years.
Collateralized Mortgage Obligations (“CMOs”) and Multiclass Pass-Through Securities. CMOs are a more complex form of mortgage-backed security in that they are multiclass debt obligations which are collateralized by mortgage loans or pass-through certificates. As a result of changes prompted by the Tax Reform Act of 1986, most CMOs are today issued as Real Estate Mortgage Investment Conduits (“REMICs”). From the perspective of the investor, REMICs and CMOs are virtually indistinguishable. However, REMICs differ from CMOs in that REMICs provide certain tax advantages for the issuer of the obligation. Multiclass pass-through securities are interests in a trust composed of whole loans or private pass-throughs (collectively hereinafter referred to as “Mortgage Assets”). Unless the context indicates otherwise, all references herein to CMOs include REMICs and multiclass pass-through securities.
Often, CMOs are collateralized by GNMA, Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac Certificates, but also may be collateralized by Mortgage Assets. Unless the context indicates otherwise, all references herein to CMOs include REMICs and multiclass pass-through securities. Payments of principal and interest on the Mortgage Assets, and any reinvestment income thereon, provide the funds to pay debt service on the CMOs or make scheduled distributions on the multiclass pass-through securities. CMOs may be issued by agencies or instrumentalities of the U.S. government, or by private originators of, or investors in, mortgage loans, including savings and loan associations, mortgage banks, commercial banks, investment banks and special purpose subsidiaries of the foregoing.
In order to form a CMO, the issuer assembles a package of traditional mortgage-backed pass-through securities, or actual mortgage loans, and uses them as collateral for a multiclass security. Each class of CMOs, often referred to as a “tranche,” is issued at a specified fixed or floating coupon rate and has a stated maturity or final distribution date. Principal prepayments on the Mortgage Assets may cause the CMOs to be retired substantially earlier than their stated maturities or final distribution dates. Interest is paid or accrues on all classes of the CMOs on a monthly, quarterly or semiannual basis. The principal of and interest on the Mortgage Assets may be allocated among the several classes of a series of a CMO in innumerable ways. In one structure, payments of principal, including any principal prepayments, on the Mortgage Assets are applied to the classes of a CMO in the order of their respective stated maturities or final distribution dates, so that no payment of principal will be made on any class of CMOs until all other classes having an earlier stated maturity or final distribution date have been paid in full. As market conditions change, and particularly during periods of rapid or unanticipated changes in market interest rates, the attractiveness of the CMO classes and the ability of the structure to provide the anticipated investment characteristics may be significantly reduced. Such changes can result in volatility in the market value, and in some instances reduced liquidity, of the CMO class.
A Fund may also invest in, among other types of CMOs, parallel pay CMOs and Planned Amortization Class CMOs (“PAC Bonds”). Parallel pay CMOs are structured to provide payments of principal on each payment date to more than one class. These simultaneous payments are taken into account in calculating the stated maturity date or final distribution date of each class, which, as with other CMO structures, must be retired by its stated maturity date or a final distribution date but may be retired earlier. PAC Bonds are a type of CMO tranche or series designed to provide relatively predictable payments of principal provided that, among other things, the actual prepayment experience on the underlying mortgage loans falls within a predefined range. If the actual prepayment experience on the underlying mortgage loans is at a rate faster or slower than the
34

predefined range or if deviations from other assumptions occur, principal payments on the PAC Bond may be earlier or later than predicted. The magnitude of the predefined range varies from one PAC Bond to another; a narrower range increases the risk that prepayments on the PAC Bond will be greater or smaller than predicted. Because of these features, PAC Bonds generally are less subject to the risks of prepayment than are other types of mortgage-backed securities.
Stripped Mortgage Securities. Stripped mortgage securities are derivative multiclass mortgage securities. Stripped mortgage securities may be issued by agencies or instrumentalities of the U.S. government, or by private originators of, or investors in, mortgage loans, including savings and loan associations, mortgage banks, commercial banks, investment banks and special purpose subsidiaries of the foregoing. Stripped mortgage securities have greater volatility than other types of mortgage securities. Although stripped mortgage securities are purchased and sold by institutional investors through several investment banking firms acting as brokers or dealers, the market for such securities has not yet been fully developed. Accordingly, stripped mortgage securities are generally illiquid.
Stripped mortgage securities are structured with two or more classes of securities that receive different proportions of the interest and principal distributions on a pool of mortgage assets. A common type of stripped mortgage security will have at least one class receiving only a small portion of the interest and a larger portion of the principal from the mortgage assets, while the other class will receive primarily interest and only a small portion of the principal. In the most extreme case, one class will receive all of the interest (“IO” or interest-only class), while the other class will receive the entire principal (“PO” or principal-only class). The yield to maturity on IOs, POs and other mortgage-backed securities that are purchased at a substantial premium or discount generally are extremely sensitive not only to changes in prevailing interest rates but also to the rate of principal payments (including prepayments) on the related underlying mortgage assets, and a rapid rate of principal payments may have a material adverse effect on such securities’ yield to maturity. If the underlying mortgage assets experience greater than anticipated prepayments of principal, a Fund may fail to fully recoup its initial investment in these securities even if the securities have received the highest rating by an NRSRO.
In addition to the stripped mortgage securities described above, certain Funds may invest in similar securities such as Super POs and Levered IOs which are more volatile than POs, IOs and IOettes. Risks associated with instruments such as Super POs are similar in nature to those risks related to investments in POs. IOettes represent the right to receive interest payments on an underlying pool of mortgages with similar risks as those associated with IOs. Unlike IOs, the owner also has the right to receive a very small portion of the principal. Risks connected with Levered IOs and IOettes are similar in nature to those associated with IOs. Such Funds may also invest in other similar instruments developed in the future that are deemed consistent with its investment objective, policies and restrictions. See “Additional General Tax Information for All Funds” in this SAI.
A Fund may also purchase stripped mortgage-backed securities for hedging purposes to protect that Fund against interest rate fluctuations. For example, since an IO will tend to increase in value as interest rates rise, it may be utilized to hedge against a decrease in value of other fixed-income securities in a rising interest rate environment. Stripped mortgage-backed securities may exhibit greater price volatility than ordinary debt securities because of the manner in which their principal and interest are returned to investors. The market value of the class consisting entirely of principal payments can be extremely volatile in response to changes in interest rates. The yields on stripped mortgage-backed securities that receive all or most of the interest are generally higher than prevailing market yields on other mortgage-backed obligations because their cash flow patterns are also volatile and there is a greater risk that the initial investment will not be fully recouped. The market for CMOs and other stripped mortgage-backed securities may be less liquid if these securities lose their value as a result of changes in interest rates; in that case, a Fund may have difficulty in selling such securities.
TBA Commitments. The Funds may enter into “to be announced” or “TBA” commitments. TBA commitments are forward agreements for the purchase or sale of securities, including mortgage-backed securities for a fixed price, with payment and delivery on an agreed upon future settlement date. The specific securities to be delivered are not identified at the trade date. However, delivered securities must meet specified terms, including issuer, rate and mortgage terms. See “When-Issued Securities and Delayed-Delivery Transactions” below.
Asset-Backed Securities. Asset-backed securities have structural characteristics similar to mortgage-backed securities. However, the underlying assets are not first-lien mortgage loans or interests therein; rather the underlying assets are often consumer or commercial debt contracts such as motor vehicle installment sales contracts, other installment loan contracts, home equity loans, leases of various types of property and receivables from credit card and other revolving credit arrangements. However, almost any type of fixed-income assets may be used to create an asset-backed security, including
35

other fixed-income securities or derivative instruments such as swaps. Payments or distributions of principal and interest on asset-backed securities may be supported by non-governmental credit enhancements similar to those utilized in connection with mortgage-backed securities. Asset-backed securities, though, present certain risks that are not presented by mortgage-backed securities. The credit quality of most asset-backed securities depends primarily on the credit quality of the assets underlying such securities, how well the entity issuing the security is insulated from the credit risk of the originator or any other affiliated entities, and the amount and quality of any credit enhancement of the securities. To the extent a security interest exists, it may be more difficult for the issuer to enforce the security interest as compared to mortgage-backed securities.
Municipal Securities
Each of the Fixed-Income Funds, except the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, may invest in municipal securities. Municipal securities include debt obligations issued by governmental entities to obtain funds for various public purposes, such as the construction of a wide range of public facilities, the refunding of outstanding obligations, the payment of general operating expenses, and the extension of loans to other public institutions and facilities. Private activity bonds that are issued by or on behalf of public authorities to finance various privately-operated facilities are deemed to be municipal securities, only if the interest paid thereon is exempt from federal taxes. 2017 legislation commonly known as the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (“TCJA”) repealed the exclusion from gross income for interest paid on pre-refunded municipal securities effective for such bonds issued after December 31, 2017.
Other types of municipal securities include short-term General Obligation Notes, Tax Anticipation Notes, Bond Anticipation Notes, Revenue Anticipation Notes, Project Notes, Tax-Exempt Commercial Paper, Construction Loan Notes and other forms of short-term tax-exempt loans. Such instruments are issued with a short-term maturity in anticipation of the receipt of tax funds, the proceeds of bond placements or other revenues.
Project Notes are issued by a state or local housing agency and are sold by the Department of Housing and Urban Development. While the issuing agency has the primary obligation with respect to its Project Notes, they are also secured by the full faith and credit of the United States through agreements with the issuing authority which provide that, if required, the federal government will lend the issuer an amount equal to the principal of and interest on the Project Notes.
The two principal classifications of municipal securities consist of “general obligation” and “revenue” issues. The Funds may also acquire “moral obligation” issues, which are normally issued by special purpose authorities. There are, of course, variations in the quality of municipal securities, both within a particular classification and between classifications, and the yields on municipal securities depend upon a variety of factors, including the financial condition of the issuer, general conditions of the municipal bond market, the size of a particular offering, the maturity of the obligation and the rating of the issue. Ratings represent the opinions of an NRSRO as to the quality of municipal securities. It should be emphasized, however, that ratings are general and are not absolute standards of quality, and municipal securities with the same maturity, interest rate and rating may have different yields, while municipal securities of the same maturity and interest rate with different ratings may have the same yield. Subsequent to purchase, an issue of municipal securities may cease to be rated or its rating may be reduced below the minimum rating required for purchase. A Fund's portfolio management will consider such an event in determining whether a Fund should continue to hold the obligation.
An issuer’s obligations under its municipal securities are subject to the provisions of bankruptcy, insolvency, and other laws affecting the rights and remedies of creditors, such as the federal bankruptcy code, and laws, if any, which may be enacted by Congress or state legislatures extending the time for payment of principal or interest, or both, or imposing other constraints upon the enforcement of such obligations or upon the ability of municipalities to levy taxes. The power or ability of an issuer to meet its obligations for the payment of interest on and principal of its municipal securities may be materially adversely affected by litigation or other conditions.
General Obligation Bonds. General obligation bonds are secured by the issuer’s pledge of its full faith, credit and taxing power for the payment of principal and interest. The taxing power of any governmental entity may be limited, however, by provisions of its state constitution or laws, and an entity’s creditworthiness will depend on many factors, including potential erosion of its tax base due to population declines, natural disasters, declines in the state’s industrial base or inability to attract new industries, economic limits on the ability to tax without eroding the tax base, state legislative proposals or voter initiatives to limit ad valorem real property taxes and the extent to which the entity relies on federal or state aid, access to
36

capital markets or other factors beyond the state’s or entity’s control. Accordingly, the capacity of the issuer of a general obligation bond as to the timely payment of interest and the repayment of principal when due is affected by the issuer’s maintenance of its tax base.
Revenue Bonds. Revenue bonds are payable only from the revenues derived from a particular facility or class of facilities or, in some cases, from the proceeds of a special excise tax or other specific revenue source such as payments from the user of the facility being financed; accordingly, the timely payment of interest and the repayment of principal in accordance with the terms of the revenue or special obligation bond is a function of the economic viability of such facility or such revenue source.
Revenue bonds issued by state or local agencies to finance the development of low-income, multi-family housing involve special risks in addition to those associated with municipal bonds generally, including that the underlying properties may not generate sufficient income to pay expenses and interest costs. Such bonds are generally non-recourse against the property owner, may be junior to the rights of others with an interest in the properties, may pay interest that changes based in part on the financial performance of the property, may be prepayable without penalty and may be used to finance the construction of housing developments which, until completed and rented, do not generate income to pay interest. Increases in interest rates payable on senior obligations may make it more difficult for issuers to meet payment obligations on subordinated bonds.
Private activity bonds. Private activity bonds (“PABs”) are, in most cases, tax-exempt securities issued by states, municipalities or public authorities to provide funds, usually through a loan or lease arrangement, to a private entity for the purpose of financing construction or improvement of a facility to be used by the entity. Such bonds are secured primarily by revenues derived from loan repayments or lease payments due from the entity, which may or may not be guaranteed by a parent company or otherwise secured. PABs generally are not secured by a pledge of the taxing power of the issuer of such bonds. Therefore, an investor should understand that repayment of such bonds generally depends on the revenues of a private entity and be aware of the risks that such an investment may entail. The continued ability of an entity to generate sufficient revenues for the payment of principal and interest on such bonds will be affected by many factors including the size of the entity, its capital structure, demand for its products or services, competition, general economic conditions, government regulation and the entity’s dependence on revenues for the operation of the particular facility being financed.
Natural Disaster/Epidemic Risk
Natural or environmental disasters, such as earthquakes, fires, floods, hurricanes, tsunamis and other severe weather-related phenomena generally, and widespread disease, including pandemics and epidemics, have been and can be highly disruptive to economies and markets, adversely impacting individual companies, sectors, industries, markets, currencies, interest and inflation rates, credit ratings, investor sentiment, and other factors affecting the value of the Funds' investments. Given the increasing interdependence among global economies and markets, conditions in one country, market, or region are increasingly likely to adversely affect markets, issuers, and/or foreign exchange rates in other countries, including the U.S. These disruptions could prevent the Funds from executing advantageous investment decisions in a timely manner and negatively impact the Funds' ability to achieve their investment objectives. Any such event(s) could have a significant adverse impact on the value and risk profile of the Funds.
The “COVID-19” strain of coronavirus has resulted in instances of market closures and dislocations, extreme volatility, liquidity constraints and increased trading costs. Efforts to contain its spread have resulted in travel restrictions, disruptions of healthcare systems, business operations (including business closures) and supply chains, layoffs, lower consumer demand and employee availability, and defaults and credit downgrades, among other significant economic impacts that have disrupted global economic activity across many industries. Such economic impacts may exacerbate other pre-existing political, social and economic risks locally or globally and cause general concern and uncertainty. The full economic impact and ongoing effects of COVID-19 (or other future epidemics or pandemics) at the macro-level and on individual businesses are unpredictable and may result in significant and prolonged effects on the Funds' performance.
37

Operational and Technology Risk/Cyber Security Risk
A Fund, its service providers, and other market participants depend on complex information technology and communications systems to conduct business functions. These systems are subject to a number of different threats or risks that could adversely affect a Fund and its shareholders, despite the efforts of a Fund and its service providers to adopt technologies, processes, and practices intended to mitigate these risks.
For example, a Fund and its service providers may be susceptible to operational and information security risks resulting from cyber incidents. In general, cyber incidents can result from deliberate attacks or unintentional events. Cyber attacks include, but are not limited to, gaining unauthorized access to digital systems (e.g., through “hacking” or malicious software coding) for purposes of misappropriating assets or sensitive information, corrupting data, or causing operational disruption. Cyber attacks also may be carried out in a manner that does not require gaining unauthorized access, such as causing denial-of-service attacks on websites (i.e., efforts to make network services unavailable to intended users). Cyber security failures or breaches by a Fund's adviser, and other service providers (including, but not limited to, Fund accountants, custodians, subadvisers, transfer agents and administrators), and the issuers of securities in which the Funds invest, have the ability to cause disruptions and impact business operations, potentially resulting in financial losses, interference with a Fund's ability to calculate its net asset value, impediments to trading, the inability of a Fund's shareholders to transact business, violations of applicable privacy and other laws, regulatory fines, penalties, reputational damage, reimbursement or other compensation costs, or additional compliance costs. In addition, substantial costs may be incurred in order to prevent any cyber incidents in the future. While a Fund and its service providers have established business continuity plans in the event of, and systems designed to reduce the risks associated with, such cyber attacks, there are inherent limitations in such plans and systems including the possibility that certain risks have not been identified.
In addition, power or communications outages, acts of God, information technology equipment malfunctions, operational errors, and inaccuracies within software or data processing systems may also disrupt business operations or impact critical data. Market events also may trigger a volume of transactions that overloads current information technology and communication systems and processes, impacting the ability to conduct a Fund's operations.
The Funds cannot control the cyber security plans and systems put in place by service providers to the Funds and issuers in which the Funds invest. The Funds and their shareholders could be negatively impacted as a result.
Preferred Stocks, Convertible Securities and Other Equity Securities
Each of the Funds, except for the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, may invest in preferred stocks and other forms of convertible securities. In some instances, a Fixed-Income Fund (except the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund) may receive common stock, warrants or other types of equity securities resulting from a corporate action by or bankruptcy of an issuer of debt securities held by the Fund. In such instances, unless such equity securities are preferred stocks or convertible securities, the Fund will sell such equity securities as soon as reasonably practicable. Preferred stocks, like many debt obligations, are generally fixed-income securities. Shareholders of preferred stocks normally have the right to receive dividends at a fixed rate when and as declared by the issuer’s board of directors, but do not participate in other amounts available for distribution by the issuing corporation. In some countries, dividends on preferred stocks may be variable, rather than fixed. Dividends on the preferred stock may be cumulative, and all cumulative dividends usually must be paid prior to common shareholders of common stock receiving any dividends. Because preferred stock dividends must be paid before common stock dividends, preferred stocks generally entail less risk than common stocks. Upon liquidation, preferred stocks are entitled to a specified liquidation preference, which is generally the same as the par or stated value, and are senior in right of payment to common stock. Preferred stocks are, however, equity securities in the sense that they do not represent a liability of the issuer and, therefore, do not offer as great a degree of protection of capital or assurance of continued income as investments in corporate debt securities. Preferred stocks are generally subordinated in right of payment to all debt obligations and creditors of the issuer, and convertible preferred stocks may be subordinated to other preferred stock of the same issuer.
Convertible securities are bonds, debentures, notes, preferred stocks, or other securities that may be converted into or exchanged for a specified amount of common stock of the same or a different issuer within a particular period of time at a specified price or formula. Convertible securities have general characteristics similar to both debt obligations and equity securities. The value of a convertible security is a function of its “investment value” (determined by its yield in comparison with the yields of other securities of comparable maturity and quality that do not have a conversion privilege) and its
38

“conversion value” (the security’s worth, at market value, if converted into the underlying common stock). The investment value of a convertible security is influenced by changes in interest rates, the credit standing of the issuer and other factors. The market value of convertible securities tends to decline as interest rates increase and, conversely, tends to increase as interest rates decline. The conversion value of a convertible security is determined by the market price of the underlying common stock. The market value of convertible securities tends to vary with fluctuations in the market value of the underlying common stock and therefore will react to variations in the general market for equity securities. If the conversion value is low relative to the investment value, the price of the convertible security is governed principally by its investment value. Generally, the conversion value decreases as the convertible security approaches maturity. To the extent the market price of the underlying common stock approaches or exceeds the conversion price, the price of the convertible security will be increasingly influenced by its conversion value. A convertible security generally will sell at a premium over its conversion value by the extent to which investors place value on the right to acquire the underlying common stock while holding a fixed-income security. While no securities investments are without risk, investments in convertible securities generally entail less risk than investments in common stock of the same issuer.
A convertible security entitles the holder to receive interest normally paid or accrued on debt or the dividend paid on preferred stock until the convertible security matures or is redeemed, converted, or exchanged. Convertible securities have unique investment characteristics in that they generally (i) have higher yields than common stocks, but lower yields than comparable non-convertible securities, (ii) are less subject to fluctuation in value than the underlying stock since they have fixed-income characteristics, and (iii) provide the potential for capital appreciation if the market price of the underlying common stock increases. Most convertible securities currently are issued by U.S. companies, although a substantial Eurodollar convertible securities market has developed, and the markets for convertible securities denominated in local currencies are increasing.
A convertible security may be subject to redemption at the option of the issuer at a price established in the convertible security’s governing instrument. If a convertible security held by a Fund is called for redemption, a Fund will be required to permit the issuer to redeem the security, convert it into the underlying common stock, or sell it to a third party.
Convertible securities generally are subordinated to other similar but non-convertible securities of the same issuer, although convertible bonds, as corporate debt obligations, generally enjoy seniority in right of payment to all equity securities, and convertible preferred stock is senior to common stock of the same issuer. Because of the subordination feature, however, some convertible securities typically are rated below investment grade or are not rated, depending on the general creditworthiness of the issuer.
Certain Funds may invest in convertible preferred stocks that offer enhanced yield features, such as Preferred Equity Redemption Cumulative Stocks (“PERCS”), which provide an investor, such as a Fund, with the opportunity to earn higher dividend income than is available on a company’s common stock. PERCS are preferred stocks that generally feature a mandatory conversion date, as well as a capital appreciation limit, which is usually expressed in terms of a stated price. Most PERCS expire three years from the date of issue, at which time they are convertible into common stock of the issuer. PERCS are generally not convertible into cash at maturity. Under a typical arrangement, after three years PERCS convert into one share of the issuer’s common stock if the issuer’s common stock is trading at a price below that set by the capital appreciation limit, and into less than one full share if the issuer’s common stock is trading at a price above that set by the capital appreciation limit. The amount of that fractional share of common stock is determined by dividing the price set by the capital appreciation limit by the market price of the issuer’s common stock. PERCS can be called at any time prior to maturity, and hence do not provide call protection. If called early, however, the issuer must pay a call premium over the market price to the investor. This call premium declines at a preset rate daily, up to the maturity date.
A Fund may also invest in other classes of enhanced convertible securities. These include but are not limited to Automatically Convertible Equity Securities (“ACES”), Participating Equity Preferred Stock (“PEPS”), Preferred Redeemable Increased Dividend Equity Securities (“PRIDES”), Stock Appreciation Income Linked Securities (“SAILS”), Term Convertible Notes (“TECONS”), Quarterly Income Cumulative Securities (“QICS”), and Dividend Enhanced Convertible Securities (“DECS”). ACES, PEPS, PRIDES, SAILS, TECONS, QICS, and DECS all have the following features: they are issued by the company, the common stock of which will be received in the event the convertible preferred stock is converted; unlike PERCS they do not have a capital appreciation limit; they seek to provide the investor with high current income with some prospect of future capital appreciation; they are typically issued with three- or four-year maturities; they typically have some built-in call protection for the first two to three years; and, upon maturity, they will convert into either cash or a specified number of shares of common stock.
39

Similarly, there may be enhanced convertible debt obligations issued by the operating company, whose common stock is to be acquired in the event the security is converted, or by a different issuer, such as an investment bank. These securities may be identified by names such as Equity Linked Securities (“ELKS”) or similar names. Typically they share most of the salient characteristics of an enhanced convertible preferred stock but will be ranked as senior or subordinated debt in the issuer’s corporate structure according to the terms of the debt indenture. There may be additional types of convertible securities not specifically referred to herein, which may be similar to those described above in which a Fund may invest, consistent with its goals and policies.
An investment in an enhanced convertible security or any other security may involve additional risks to the Fund. A Fund may have difficulty disposing of such securities because there may be a thin trading market for a particular security at any given time. Reduced liquidity may have an adverse impact on market price and a Fund’s ability to dispose of particular securities, when necessary, to meet the Fund’s liquidity needs or in response to a specific economic event, such as the deterioration in the creditworthiness of an issuer. Reduced liquidity in the secondary market for certain securities may also make it more difficult for a Fund to obtain market quotations based on actual trades for purposes of valuing the Fund’s portfolio. Each Fund, however, intends to acquire liquid securities, though there can be no assurances that it will always be able to do so.
Certain Funds may also invest in zero coupon convertible securities. Zero coupon convertible securities are debt securities which are issued at a discount to their face amount and do not entitle the holder to any periodic payments of interest prior to maturity. Rather, interest earned on zero coupon convertible securities accretes at a stated yield until the security reaches its face amount at maturity. Zero coupon convertible securities are convertible into a specific number of shares of the issuer’s common stock. In addition, zero coupon convertible securities usually have put features that provide the holder with the opportunity to sell the securities back to the issuer at a stated price before maturity. Generally, the prices of zero coupon convertible securities may be more sensitive to market interest rate fluctuations than conventional convertible securities. For more information about zero coupon securities generally, see “Zero Coupon Securities, Step-Coupon Securities, Pay-In-Kind Bonds (“PIK Bonds”) and Deferred Payment Securities” below.
Current federal income tax law requires the holder of zero coupon securities to accrue income with respect to these securities prior to the receipt of cash payments. Accordingly, to avoid liability for federal income and excise taxes, a Fund may be required to distribute income accrued with respect to these securities and may have to dispose of portfolio securities under disadvantageous circumstances in order to generate cash to satisfy these distribution requirements.
Contingent Convertible Securities. A contingent convertible security (“CoCo”) is a hybrid debt security typically issued by a non-U.S. bank that, upon the occurrence of a specified trigger event, may be (i) convertible into equity securities of the issuer at a predetermined share price; or (ii) written down in liquidation value. Trigger events are identified in the document’s requirements. CoCos are designed to behave like bonds in times of economic health yet absorb losses when the trigger event occurs.
With respect to CoCos that provide for conversion of the CoCo into common shares of the issuer in the event of a trigger event, the conversion would deepen the subordination of the investor, subjecting the Fund to a greater risk of loss in the event of bankruptcy. In addition, because the common stock of the issuer may not pay a dividend, investors in such instruments could experience reduced yields (or no yields at all). With respect to CoCos that provide for the write-down in liquidation value of the CoCo in the event of a trigger event, it is possible that the liquidation value of the CoCo may be adjusted downward to below the original par value or written off entirely under certain circumstances. For instance, if losses have eroded the issuer’s capital levels below a specified threshold, the liquidation value of the CoCo may be reduced in whole or in part. The write-down of the CoCo’s par value may occur automatically and would not entitle holders to institute bankruptcy proceedings against the issuer. In addition, an automatic write-down could result in a reduced income rate if the dividend or interest payment associated with the CoCo is based on par value. Coupon payments on CoCos may be discretionary and may be canceled by the issuer for any reason or may be subject to approval by the issuer’s regulator and may be suspended in the event there are insufficient distributable reserves.
CoCos are subject to the credit, interest rate, high-yield securities, foreign securities and market risks associated with bonds and equity securities, and to the risks specified to convertible securities in general. They are also subject to other specific risks. CoCos typically are structurally subordinated to traditional convertible bonds in the issuer’s capital structure,
40

which increases the risk that the Fund may experience a loss. In certain scenarios, investors in CoCos may suffer a loss of capital ahead of equity holders or when equity holders do not. CoCos are generally speculative and the prices of CoCos may be volatile. There is no guarantee that the Fund will receive return of principal on CoCos.
Publicly Traded Limited Partnerships and Limited Liability Companies
Entities such as limited partnerships, limited liability companies, business trusts and companies organized outside the United States may issue securities comparable to common or preferred stock. Each of the Equity Funds may invest in interests in limited liability companies, as well as publicly traded limited partnerships (limited partnership interests or units), which represent equity interests in the assets and earnings of the company’s or partnership’s trade or business. Unlike common stock in a corporation, limited partnership interests have limited or no voting rights. However, many of the risks of investing in common stocks are still applicable to investments in limited partnership interests. In addition, limited partnership interests are subject to risks not present in common stock. For example, income derived from a limited partnership deemed not to be a “qualified publicly traded partnership” will be treated as “qualifying income” under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (“Internal Revenue Code”) only to the extent such income is attributable to items of income of the partnership that would be qualifying income if realized directly by the Funds. See “Additional General Tax Information for All Funds” below. Also, since publicly traded limited partnerships and limited liability companies are a less common form of organizational structure than corporations, their units may be less liquid than publicly traded common stock. Also, because of the difference in organizational structure, the fair value of limited liability company or limited partnership units in a Fund’s portfolio may be based either upon the current market price of such units, or if there is no current market price, upon the pro rata value of the underlying assets of the company or partnership. Limited partnership units also have the risk that the limited partnership might, under certain circumstances, be treated as a general partnership giving rise to broader liability exposure to the limited partners for activities of the partnership. Further, the general partners of a limited partnership may be able to significantly change the business or asset structure of a limited partnership without the limited partners having any ability to disapprove any such changes. In certain limited partnerships, limited partners may also be required to return distributions previously made in the event that excess distributions have been made by the partnership, or in the event that the general partners, or their affiliates, are entitled to indemnification.
Put Bonds
Each of the Fixed-Income Funds, except the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, may invest in “put” bonds. “Put” bonds are securities (including securities with variable interest rates) that may be sold back to the issuer of the security at face value at the option of the holder prior to their stated maturity. A Fund’s portfolio management intends to purchase only those put bonds for which the put option is an integral part of the security as originally issued. The option to “put” the bond back to the issuer prior to the stated final maturity can cushion the price decline of the bond in a rising interest rate environment. However, the premium paid, if any, for an option to put will have the effect of reducing the yield otherwise payable on the underlying security. For the purpose of determining the “maturity” of securities purchased subject to an option to put, and for the purpose of determining the dollar weighted average maturity of a Fund holding such securities, the Fund will consider “maturity” to be the first date on which it has the right to demand payment from the issuer.
Real Estate Investment Trusts
Although no Fund invests in real estate directly, the Equity Funds may invest in securities of real estate investment trusts (“REITs”) and other real estate industry companies or companies with substantial real estate investments and, as a result, such Funds may be subject to certain risks associated with direct ownership of real estate and with the real estate industry in general. These risks include, among others: possible declines in the value of real estate; possible lack of availability of mortgage funds; extended vacancies of properties; risks related to general and local economic conditions; overbuilding; increases in competition, property taxes and operating expenses; changes in zoning laws; costs resulting from the clean-up of, and liability to third parties for damages resulting from, environmental problems; casualty or condemnation losses; uninsured damages from floods, earthquakes or other natural disasters; limitations on and variations in rents; and changes in interest rates.
REITs are pooled investment vehicles which invest primarily in income-producing real estate or real estate-related loans or interests. REITs are generally classified as equity REITs, mortgage REITs or hybrid REITs. Equity REITs invest the majority of their assets directly in real property and derive income primarily from the collection of rents. Equity REITs can also realize capital gains by selling properties that have appreciated in value. Mortgage REITs invest the majority of their
41

assets in real estate mortgages and derive income from the collection of interest payments. Hybrid REITs combine the investment strategies of equity REITs and mortgage REITs. REITs are not taxed on income distributed to shareholders provided they comply with several requirements of the Internal Revenue Code. The Funds pay the fees and expenses of the REITs, which, ultimately, are paid by a Fund’s shareholders.
Repurchase Agreements
Each Fund may enter into repurchase agreements. In connection with the purchase by a Fund of a repurchase agreement from member banks of the Federal Reserve System or certain non-bank dealers, the Fund’s custodian, or a sub-custodian, will have custody of, and will earmark or segregate securities acquired by the Fund under such repurchase agreement. Repurchase agreements are contracts under which the buyer of a security simultaneously commits to resell the security to the seller at an agreed-upon price and date. Any portion of a repurchase agreement that is not collateralized fully is considered by the staff of the SEC to be a loan by the Fund. To the extent that a repurchase agreement is not collateralized fully, a Fund will include any collateral that the Fund receives in calculating the Fund’s total assets in determining whether a Fund has loaned more than one-third of its assets. Repurchase agreements may be entered into with respect to securities of the type in which the Fund may invest or government securities regardless of their remaining maturities, and will require that additional securities be deposited as collateral if the value of the securities purchased should decrease below resale price. Repurchase agreements involve certain risks in the event of default or insolvency by the other party, including possible delays or restrictions upon a Fund’s ability to dispose of the underlying securities, the risk of a possible decline in the value of the underlying securities during the period in which a Fund seeks to assert its rights to them, the risk of incurring expenses associated with asserting those rights and the risk of losing all or part of the income from the repurchase agreement. A Fund’s portfolio management reviews the creditworthiness of those banks and other recognized financial institutions with which a Fund enters into repurchase agreements to evaluate these risks.
Restricted, Non-Publicly Traded and Illiquid Securities
Each Fund may not invest more than 15% (5% with respect to the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund) of its net assets, in the aggregate, in illiquid securities, including repurchase agreements which have a maturity of longer than seven days, time deposits maturing in more than seven days and securities that are illiquid because of the absence of a readily available market or legal or contractual restrictions on resale or other factors limiting the marketability of the security. Repurchase agreements subject to demand are deemed to have a maturity equal to the notice period.
Historically, illiquid securities have included securities subject to contractual or legal restrictions on resale because they have not been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), securities which are otherwise not readily marketable and repurchase agreements having a maturity of longer than seven days. In addition, a security is illiquid if it cannot be sold or disposed of in current market conditions in seven calendar days or less without the sale or disposition significantly changing the market value of the investment. Securities which have not been registered under the Securities Act are referred to as private placements or restricted securities and are purchased directly from the issuer or in the secondary market. Unless subsequently registered for sale, these securities can only be sold in privately negotiated transactions or pursuant to an exemption from registration. The Funds typically do not hold a significant amount of these restricted or other illiquid securities because of the potential for delays on resale and uncertainty in valuation. Limitations on resale may have an adverse effect on the marketability of portfolio securities, and a Fund might be unable to dispose of restricted or other illiquid securities promptly or at reasonable prices and might thereby experience difficulty satisfying redemptions within seven days. A Fund might also have to register such restricted securities in order to dispose of them, resulting in additional expense and delay. Adverse market conditions could impede such a public offering of securities.
A large institutional market exists for certain securities that are not registered under the Securities Act including repurchase agreements, commercial paper, foreign securities, municipal securities and corporate bonds and notes. Institutional investors depend on an efficient institutional market in which the unregistered security can be readily resold or on an issuer’s ability to honor a demand for repayment. The fact that there are contractual or legal restrictions on resale to the general public or to certain institutions may not be indicative of the liquidity of such investments.
The SEC has adopted Rule 144A, which allows for a broader institutional trading market for securities otherwise subject to restriction on resale to the general public. Rule 144A establishes a “safe harbor” from the registration requirements of the Securities Act for resales of certain securities to qualified institutional buyers.
42

Any such restricted securities will be considered to be illiquid for purposes of a Fund’s limitations on investments in illiquid securities unless, pursuant to procedures adopted by the Board of Trustees of the Trust, a Fund’s portfolio management has determined such securities to be liquid because such securities are eligible for resale pursuant to Rule 144A and are readily saleable, or if such securities may be readily saleable in foreign markets. To the extent that qualified institutional buyers may become uninterested in purchasing Rule 144A securities, a Fund’s level of illiquidity may increase.
A Fund’s portfolio management will monitor the liquidity of restricted securities in the portion of a Fund it manages. In reaching liquidity decisions, the following factors are considered: (1) the unregistered nature of the security; (2) the frequency of trades and quotes for the security; (3) the number of dealers wishing to purchase or sell the security and the number of other potential purchasers; (4) dealer undertakings to make a market in the security; and (5) the nature of the security and the nature of the marketplace trades (e.g., the time needed to dispose of the security, the method of soliciting offers and the mechanics of the transfer).
Pursuant to Rule 22e-4 under the 1940 Act, a Fund (other than the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund) assesses, manages, and periodically reviews its liquidity risk. The Nationwide Government Money Market Fund manages its liquidity pursuant to the requirements of Rule 2a-7.
The SEC has recently proposed amendments to Rule 22e-4 under the 1940 Act and Rule 22c-1 under the 1940 Act that, if adopted, would, among other things, cause more investments to be treated as illiquid, and could prevent a Fund from investing in securities that the Adviser or a subadviser believes are appropriate or desirable.
Private Placement Commercial Paper. Commercial paper eligible for resale under Section 4(a)(2) of the Securities Act (“Section 4(2) paper”) is offered only to accredited investors. Rule 506 of Regulation D in the Securities Act lists investment companies as an accredited investor.
Section 4(2) paper not eligible for resale under Rule 144A under the Securities Act shall be deemed liquid if: (1) the Section 4(2) paper is not traded flat or in default as to principal and interest; (2) the Section 4(2) paper is rated in one of the two highest rating categories by at least two NRSROs, or if only one NRSRO rates the security, it is rated in one of the two highest categories by that NRSRO; and (3) the Fund’s portfolio management believes that, based on the trading markets for such security, such security can be disposed of in current market conditions in seven calendar days or less without the sale or disposition significantly changing the market value of the investment.
Reverse Repurchase Agreements and Mortgage Dollar Rolls
The Funds may engage in reverse repurchase agreements to facilitate portfolio liquidity, a practice common in the mutual fund industry, or for arbitrage transactions discussed below. In a reverse repurchase agreement, a Fund would sell a security and enter into an agreement to repurchase the security at a specified future date and price. A Fund generally retains the right to interest and principal payments on the security. Since a Fund receives cash upon entering into a reverse repurchase agreement, it may be considered a borrowing under the 1940 Act (see “Borrowing”). When required by guidelines of the SEC, a Fund will segregate or earmark permissible liquid assets to secure its obligations to repurchase the security. At the time a Fund enters into a reverse repurchase agreement, it will establish and maintain segregated or earmarked liquid assets with an approved custodian having a value not less than the repurchase price (including accrued interest). The segregated or earmarked liquid assets will be marked-to-market daily and additional assets will be segregated or earmarked on any day in which the assets fall below the repurchase price (plus accrued interest). A Fund's liquidity and ability to manage its assets might be affected when it sets aside cash or portfolio securities to cover such commitments. Reverse repurchase agreements involve the risk that the market value of the securities retained in lieu of sale may decline below the price of the securities the Fund has sold but is obligated to repurchase. In the event the buyer of securities under a reverse repurchase agreement files for bankruptcy or becomes insolvent, such buyer or its trustee or receiver may receive an extension of time to determine whether to enforce the Fund’s obligation to repurchase the securities, and the Fund’s use of the proceeds of the reverse repurchase agreement may effectively be restricted pending such determination.
The Fixed-Income Funds also may invest in mortgage dollar rolls, which are arrangements in which a Fund would sell mortgage-backed securities for delivery in the current month and simultaneously contract to purchase substantially similar securities on a specified future date. While a Fund would forego principal and interest paid on the mortgage-backed securities during the roll period, the Fund would be compensated by the difference between the current sales price and the
43

lower price for the future purchase as well as by any interest earned on the proceeds of the initial sale. A Fund also could be compensated through the receipt of fee income equivalent to a lower forward price. Mortgage dollar roll transactions may be considered a borrowing by the Funds (See “Borrowing”).
Mortgage dollar rolls and reverse repurchase agreements may be used as arbitrage transactions in which a Fund will maintain an offsetting position in investment grade debt obligations or repurchase agreements that mature on or before the settlement date on the related mortgage dollar roll or reverse repurchase agreements. Since a Fund will receive interest on the securities or repurchase agreements in which it invests the transaction proceeds, such transactions may involve leverage. However, since such securities or repurchase agreements will be high quality and will mature on or before the settlement date of the mortgage dollar roll or reverse repurchase agreement, the Fund’s portfolio management believes that such arbitrage transactions do not present the risks to the Fund that are associated with other types of leverage.
Securities of Investment Companies
As permitted by the 1940 Act, a Fund may generally invest up to 10% of its total assets, calculated at the time of investment, in the securities of other open-end or closed-end investment companies. No more than 5% of a Fund’s total assets may be invested in the securities of any one investment company nor may it acquire more than 3% of the voting securities of any other investment company. Notwithstanding these restrictions, each Fund may invest any amount, pursuant to Rule 12d1-1 under the 1940 Act, in affiliated or unaffiliated investment companies that hold themselves out as “money market funds” and which operate in accordance with Rule 2a-7 of the 1940 Act. In addition, a Fund may invest in other investment companies in excess of these limits pursuant to Rule 12d1-4 under the 1940 Act. A Fund will indirectly bear its proportionate share of any management fees paid by an investment company in which it invests in addition to the advisory fee paid by the Fund. Some of the countries in which a Fund may invest may not permit direct investment by outside investors. Investments in such countries may only be permitted through foreign government-approved or government-authorized investment vehicles, which may include other investment companies.
Exchange-Traded Funds. The Funds (except for the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund) may invest in exchange-traded funds (“ETFs”). ETFs are regulated as registered investment companies under the 1940 Act. Many ETFs acquire and hold securities of all of the companies or other issuers, or a representative sampling of companies or other issuers that are components of a particular index. Such ETFs typically are intended to provide investment results that, before expenses, generally correspond to the price and yield performance of the corresponding market index, and the value of their shares should, under normal circumstances, closely track the value of the index’s underlying component securities. Because an ETF has operating expenses and transaction costs, while a market index does not, ETFs that track particular indices typically will be unable to match the performance of the index exactly. ETF shares may be purchased and sold in the secondary trading market on a securities exchange, in lots of any size, at any time during the trading day. More recently, actively managed ETFs have been created that are managed similarly to other investment companies.
The shares of an ETF may be assembled in a block known as a creation unit and redeemed in-kind for a portfolio of the underlying securities (based on the ETF’s net asset value) together with a cash payment generally equal to accumulated dividends as of the date of redemption. Conversely, a creation unit may be purchased from the ETF by depositing a specified portfolio of the ETF’s underlying securities, as well as a cash payment generally equal to accumulated dividends of the securities (net of expenses) up to the time of deposit. ETF shares, as opposed to creation units, are generally purchased and sold by smaller investors in a secondary market on a securities exchange. ETF shares can be traded in lots of any size, at any time during the trading day. Although a Fund, like most other investors in ETFs, intends to purchase and sell ETF shares primarily in the secondary trading market, a Fund may redeem creation units for the underlying securities (and any applicable cash), and may assemble a portfolio of the underlying securities and use it (and any required cash) to purchase creation units, if the investment manager believes it is in the Fund’s best interest to do so.
An investment in an ETF is subject to all of the risks of investing in the securities held by the ETF and has the same risks as investing in a closed-end fund. In addition, because of the ability of large market participants to arbitrage price differences by purchasing or redeeming creation units, the difference between the market value and the net asset value of ETF shares should in most cases be small. An ETF may be terminated and need to liquidate its portfolio securities at a time when the prices for those securities are falling.
44

Short Selling of Securities
The Index Funds may engage in short selling of securities consistent with their respective strategies. In a short sale of securities, a Fund sells stock which it does not own, making delivery with securities “borrowed” from a broker. The Fund is then obligated to replace the borrowed security by purchasing it at the market price at the time of replacement. This price may or may not be less than the price at which the security was sold by the Fund. Until the security is replaced, the Fund is required to pay the lender any dividends or interest which accrue during the period of the loan. In order to borrow the security, the Fund also may have to pay a premium and/or interest which would increase the cost of the security sold. The proceeds of the short sale will be retained by the broker, to the extent necessary to meet margin requirements, until the short position is closed out. In addition, the broker may require the deposit of collateral (generally, up to 50% of the value of the securities sold short).
A Fund will incur a loss as a result of the short sale if the price of the security increases between the date of the short sale and the date on which the Fund replaces the borrowed security. A Fund will realize a gain if the security declines in price between those two dates. The amount of any gain will be decreased and the amount of any loss will be increased by any premium or interest the Fund may be required to pay in connection with the short sale. When a cash dividend is declared on a security for which a Fund has a short position, the Fund incurs the obligation to pay an amount equal to that dividend to the lender of the shorted security. However, any such dividend on a security sold short generally reduces the market value of the shorted security, thus increasing the Fund’s unrealized gain or reducing the Fund’s unrealized loss on its short-sale transaction. Whether a Fund will be successful in utilizing a short sale will depend, in part, on its portfolio management’s ability to correctly predict whether the price of a security it borrows to sell short will decrease.
In a short sale, the seller does not immediately deliver the securities sold and is said to have a short position in those securities until delivery occurs.
A Fund also may engage in short sales if at the time of the short sale the Fund owns or has the right to obtain without additional cost an equal amount of the security being sold short. This investment technique is known as a short sale “against the box.” The Funds do not intend to engage in short sales against the box for investment purposes. A Fund may, however, make a short sale as a hedge, when it believes that the price of a security may decline, causing a decline in the value of a security owned by the Fund (or a security convertible or exchangeable for such security), or when the Fund wants to sell the security at an attractive current price. In such case, any future losses in the Fund’s long position should be offset by a gain in the short position and, conversely, any gain in the long position should be reduced by a loss in the short position. The extent to which such gains or losses are reduced will depend upon the amount of the security sold short relative to the amount the Fund owns. There will be certain additional transaction costs associated with short sales against the box. For tax purposes a Fund that enters into a short sale “against the box” may be treated as having made a constructive sale of an “appreciated financial position” causing the Fund to realize a gain (but not a loss).
Short-Term Instruments
Each Fund may invest in short-term instruments, including money market instruments. Short-term instruments may include the following types of instruments:
shares of money market mutual funds, including those that may be advised by a Fund’s portfolio management;
obligations issued or guaranteed as to interest and principal by the U.S. government, its agencies, or instrumentalities, or any federally chartered corporation;
obligations of sovereign foreign governments, their agencies, instrumentalities and political subdivisions;
obligations of municipalities and states, their agencies and political subdivisions;
high-quality asset-backed commercial paper;
repurchase agreements;
bank or savings and loan obligations;
high-quality commercial paper (including asset-backed commercial paper), which are short-term unsecured promissory notes issued by corporations in order to finance their current operations. It also may be issued by foreign issuers, such as foreign governments, states and municipalities;
high-quality bank loan participation agreements representing obligations of corporations having a high-quality short-term rating, at the date of investment, and under which a Fund will look to the creditworthiness of the lender bank, which is obligated to make payments of principal and interest on the loan, as well as to creditworthiness of the borrower;
45

high-quality short-term corporate obligations;
certain variable-rate and floating-rate securities with maturities longer than 397 days, but which are subject to interest rate resetting provisions and demand features within 397 days;
extendable commercial notes, which differ from traditional commercial paper because the issuer can extend the maturity of the note up to 397 days with the option to call the note any time during the extension period. Because extension will occur when the issuer does not have other viable options for lending, these notes may be considered illiquid, particularly during the extension period; and
unrated short-term debt obligations that are determined by a Fund’s portfolio management to be of comparable quality to the securities described above.
Bank Obligations. Bank obligations include certificates of deposit, bankers’ acceptances and fixed time deposits. A certificate of deposit is a short-term negotiable certificate issued by a commercial bank against funds deposited in the bank and is either interest-bearing or purchased on a discount basis. A bankers’ acceptance is a short-term draft drawn on a commercial bank by a borrower, usually in connection with an international commercial transaction. The borrower is liable for payment as is the bank, which unconditionally guarantees to pay the draft at its face amount on the maturity date. Fixed time deposits are obligations of branches of U.S. banks or foreign banks which are payable at a stated maturity date and bear a fixed rate of interest. Although fixed time deposits do not have a market, there are no contractual restrictions on the right to transfer a beneficial interest in the deposit to a third party.
Bank obligations may be general obligations of the parent bank or may be limited to the issuing branch by the terms of the specific obligations or by government regulation. Bank obligations may be issued by domestic banks (including their branches located outside the United States), domestic and foreign branches of foreign banks and savings and loan associations.
Eurodollar and Yankee Obligations. Eurodollar bank obligations are dollar-denominated certificates of deposit and time deposits issued outside the U.S. capital markets by foreign branches of U.S. banks and by foreign banks. Yankee bank obligations are dollar-denominated obligations issued in the U.S. capital markets by foreign banks.
Eurodollar and Yankee bank obligations are subject to the same risks that pertain to domestic issues, notably credit risk, market risk and liquidity risk. Additionally, Eurodollar (and to a limited extent, Yankee) bank obligations are subject to certain sovereign risks and other risks associated with foreign investments. One such risk is the possibility that a sovereign country might prevent capital, in the form of dollars, from flowing across their borders. Other risks include: adverse political and economic developments; the extent and quality of government regulation of financial markets and institutions; the imposition of foreign withholding taxes, and the expropriation or nationalization of foreign issues. However, Eurodollar and Yankee bank obligations held in a Fund will undergo the same credit analysis as domestic issuers in which the Fund invests, and will have at least the same financial strength as the domestic issuers approved for the Fund.
Small- and Medium-Cap Companies and Emerging Growth Stocks
The Equity Funds may invest in small- and medium-cap companies and emerging growth stocks. Investing in securities of small-sized companies, including micro-capitalization companies and emerging growth companies, may involve greater risks than investing in the stocks of larger, more established companies, including possible risk of loss. Also, because these securities may have limited marketability, their prices may be more volatile than securities of larger, more established companies or the market averages in general. Because small-sized, medium-cap and emerging growth companies normally have fewer shares outstanding than larger companies, it may be more difficult for a Fund to buy or sell significant numbers of such shares without an unfavorable impact on prevailing prices. Small-sized and emerging growth companies may have limited product lines, markets or financial resources and may lack management depth. In addition, small-sized, medium-cap and emerging growth companies are typically subject to wider variations in earnings and business prospects than are larger, more established companies. There is typically less publicly available information concerning small-sized, medium-cap and emerging growth companies than for larger, more established ones.
Special Situation Companies
The Equity Funds may invest in “special situation companies,” which include those involved in an actual or prospective acquisition or consolidation; reorganization; recapitalization; merger, liquidation or distribution of cash, securities or other assets; a tender or exchange offer; a breakup or workout of a holding company; or litigation which, if resolved favorably,
46

would improve the value of the company’s stock. If the actual or prospective situation does not materialize as anticipated, the market price of the securities of a “special situation company” may decline significantly. Therefore, an investment in a fund that invests a significant portion of its assets in these securities may involve a greater degree of risk than an investment in other mutual funds that seek long-term growth of capital by investing in better-known, larger companies. The portfolio management of such Fund believes, however, that if it analyzes “special situation companies” carefully and invests in the securities of these companies at the appropriate time, the Fund may achieve capital growth. There can be no assurance, however, that a special situation that exists at the time a Fund makes its investment will be consummated under the terms and within the time period contemplated, if it is consummated at all.
Standby Commitment Agreements
Except for the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, each Fixed-Income Fund may enter into standby commitment agreements. Standby commitment agreements commit a Fund, for a stated period of time, to purchase a stated amount of fixed-income securities that may be issued and sold to the Fund at the option of the issuer. The price and coupon of the security is fixed at the time of the commitment. At the time of entering into the agreement the Fund is paid a commitment fee, regardless of whether or not the security is ultimately issued. A Fund may enter into such agreements for the purpose of investing in the security underlying the commitment at a yield and price that is considered advantageous to the Fund.
There can be no assurance that the securities subject to a standby commitment will be issued and the value of the security, if issued, on the delivery date may be more or less than its purchase price. Since the issuance of the security underlying the commitment is at the option of the issuer, a Fund may bear the risk of a decline in the value of such security and may not benefit from appreciation in the value of the security during the commitment period if the security is not ultimately issued.
The purchase of a security subject to a standby commitment agreement and the related commitment fee will be recorded on the date on which the security can reasonably be expected to be issued, and the value of the security will thereafter be reflected in the calculation of a Fund's net asset value. The cost basis of the security will be adjusted by the amount of the commitment fee. In the event the security is not issued, the commitment fee will be recorded as income on the expiration date of the standby commitment.
Strip Bonds
The Fixed-Income Funds, except the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, may invest in strip bonds. Strip bonds are debt securities that are stripped of their interest (usually by a financial intermediary) after the securities are issued. The market value of these securities generally fluctuates more in response to changes in interest rates than interest paying securities of comparable maturity.
Supranational Entities
The Fixed-Income Funds may invest in debt securities of supranational entities. Examples of such entities include the International Bank for Reconstruction and Development (World Bank), the European Steel and Coal Community, the Asian Development Bank and the Inter-American Development Bank. The government members, or “stockholders,” usually make initial capital contributions to the supranational entity and in many cases are committed to make additional capital contributions if the supranational entity is unable to repay its borrowings. There is no guarantee that one or more stockholders of a supranational entity will continue to make any necessary additional capital contributions. If such contributions are not made, the entity may be unable to pay interest or repay principal on its debt securities, and a Fund may lose money on such investments.
Temporary Investments
Generally, each of the Funds will be fully invested in accordance with its investment objective and strategies. However, pending investment of cash balances, in anticipation of redemptions or for other cash management purposes, or if a Fund’s subadviser believes that business, economic, political or financial conditions warrant, a Fund may invest without limit in high-quality fixed-income securities, cash or money market cash equivalents, as described herein and, subject to the limits of the 1940 Act, shares of other investment companies that invest in securities in which the Fund may invest. Should this occur, a Fund will not be pursuing its investment objective and may miss potential market upswings. Each Index Fund uses an
47

indexing strategy and does not attempt to manage market volatility, use defensive strategies or reduce the effects of any long-term periods of poor securities performance, although each Index Fund may use temporary investments pending investment of cash balances or to manage anticipated redemption activity.  See also “Short-Term Instruments.”
U.S. Government Securities and U.S. Government Agency Securities
Each of the Fixed-Income Funds may invest in a variety of securities which are issued or guaranteed as to the payment of principal and interest by the U.S. government (including U.S. Treasury securities), and by various agencies or instrumentalities which have been established or sponsored by the U.S. government. Each of the Equity Funds may invest in U.S. Treasury securities.
U.S. Treasury securities are backed by the “full faith and credit” of the United States. Securities issued or guaranteed by federal agencies and U.S. government-sponsored instrumentalities may or may not be backed by the full faith and credit of the United States. In the case of securities not backed by the full faith and credit of the United States, investors in such securities look principally to the agency or instrumentality issuing or guaranteeing the obligation for ultimate repayment, and may not be able to assert a claim against the United States itself in the event the agency or instrumentality does not meet its commitment. Agencies which are backed by the full faith and credit of the United States include the Export-Import Bank, Farmers Home Administration, Federal Financing Bank, and others. Certain agencies and instrumentalities, such as the GNMA, are, in effect, backed by the full faith and credit of the United States through provisions in their charters that they may make “indefinite and unlimited” drawings on the U.S. Treasury if needed to service its debt. Debt from certain other agencies and instrumentalities, including the Federal Home Loan Banks and FNMA, are not guaranteed by the United States, but those institutions are protected by the discretionary authority for the U.S. Treasury to purchase certain amounts of their securities to assist the institutions in meeting their debt obligations. Finally, other agencies and instrumentalities, such as the Farm Credit System and the FHLMC, are federally chartered institutions under U.S. government supervision, but their debt securities are backed only by the creditworthiness of those institutions, not the U.S. government.
Some of the U.S. government agencies that issue or guarantee securities include the Export-Import Bank of the United States, Farmers Home Administration, Federal Housing Administration, Maritime Administration, Small Business Administration, and the Tennessee Valley Authority.
An instrumentality of a U.S. government agency is a government agency organized under Federal charter with government supervision. Instrumentalities issuing or guaranteeing securities include, among others, Federal Home Loan Banks, the Federal Land Banks, Central Bank for Cooperatives, Federal Intermediate Credit Banks and the FNMA.
The maturities of such securities usually range from three months to 30 years. While such securities may be guaranteed as to principal and interest by the U.S. government or its instrumentalities, their market values may fluctuate and are not guaranteed, which may, along with the other securities in a Fund's portfolio, cause the Fund’s daily net asset value to fluctuate.
The Federal Reserve creates STRIPS (Separate Trading of Registered Interest and Principal of Securities) by separating the coupon payments and the principal payment from an outstanding Treasury security and selling them as individual securities. To the extent a Fund purchases the principal portion of STRIPS, the Fund will not receive regular interest payments. Instead STRIPS are sold at a deep discount from their face value. Because the principal portion of the STRIPS does not pay current income, its price can be volatile when interest rates change. In calculating its dividend, a Fund takes into account as income a portion of the difference between the principal portion of the STRIPS’ purchase price and its face value.
In September 2008, the U.S. Treasury Department and the Federal Housing Finance Administration (“FHFA”) placed FNMA and FHLMC into a conservatorship under FHFA. As conservator, the FHFA assumed all the powers of the shareholders, directors and officers with the goal of preserving and conserving the assets and property of FNMA and FHLMC. However, FNMA and FHLMC continue to operate legally as business corporations and FHFA has delegated to the Chief Executive Officer and Board of Directors the responsibility for much of the day-to-day operations of the companies. FNMA and FHLMC must follow the laws and regulations governing financial disclosure, including SEC requirements. The long-term effect that this conservatorship will have on these companies’ debt and equity securities is unclear.
48

The total public debt of the United States and other countries around the globe as a percent of gross domestic product has grown rapidly since the beginning of the 2008 financial downturn and has accelerated in connection with the U.S. government's response to the COVID-19 pandemic. Although high debt levels do not necessarily indicate or cause economic problems, they may create certain systemic risks if sound debt management practices are not implemented. A high national debt level may increase market pressures to meet government funding needs, which may drive debt cost higher and cause a country to sell additional debt, thereby increasing refinancing risk. A high national debt also raises concerns that a government will not be able to make principal or interest payments when they are due.
Unsustainable debt levels can cause devaluations of currency, prevent a government from implementing effective counter-cyclical fiscal policy in economic downturns, and contribute to market volatility. In addition, the high and rising national debt may adversely impact the U.S. economy and securities in which a Fund may invest. From time to time, uncertainty regarding the status of negotiations in the U.S. government to increase the statutory debt ceiling could: increase the risk that the U.S. government may default on payments on certain U.S. government securities; cause the credit rating of the U.S. government to be downgraded or increase volatility in both stock and bond markets; result in higher interest rates; reduce prices of U.S. Treasury securities; and/or increase the costs of certain kinds of debt.
Inflation-Protected Bonds. Treasury Inflation-Protected Securities (“TIPS”) are fixed-income securities issued by the U.S. Treasury whose principal value is periodically adjusted according to the rate of inflation. The U.S. Treasury uses a structure that accrues inflation into the principal value of the bond. Inflation-indexed securities issued by the U.S. Treasury have maturities of five, ten or thirty years, although it is possible that securities with other maturities will be issued in the future. TIPS bonds typically pay interest on a semiannual basis, equal to a fixed percentage of the inflation-adjusted amount.
If the periodic adjustment rate measuring inflation falls, the principal value of inflation-indexed bonds will be adjusted downward, and consequently the interest payable on these securities (calculated with respect to a smaller principal amount) will be reduced. Repayment of the original bond principal upon maturity (as adjusted for inflation) is guaranteed in the case of U.S. Treasury inflation-indexed bonds, even during a period of deflation. However, the current market value of the bonds is not guaranteed and will fluctuate. The Funds may also invest in other inflation-related bonds which may or may not provide a similar guarantee. If a guarantee of principal is not provided, the adjusted principal value of the bond repaid at maturity may be less than the original principal.
The value of inflation-indexed bonds is expected to change in response to changes in real interest rates. Real interest rates in turn are tied to the relationship between nominal interest rates and the rate of inflation. Therefore, if inflation were to rise at a faster rate than nominal interest rates, real interest rates might decline, leading to an increase in value of inflation-indexed bonds. In contrast, if nominal interest rates increased at a faster rate than inflation, real interest rates might rise, leading to a decrease in value of inflation-indexed bonds.
Investors in an inflation-indexed mutual fund who do not reinvest the portion of the income distribution that is attributable to inflation adjustments will not maintain the purchasing power of the investment over the long term. This is because interest earned depends on the amount of principal invested, and that principal will not grow with inflation if the investor fails to reinvest the principal adjustment paid out as part of a Fund's income distributions.
While these securities are expected to be protected from long-term inflationary trends, short-term increases in inflation may lead to a decline in value. If interest rates rise due to reasons other than inflation (for example, due to changes in currency exchange rates), investors in these securities may not be protected to the extent that the increase is not reflected in the bond’s inflation measure.
The periodic adjustment of U.S. inflation-indexed bonds is tied to the Consumer Price Index for Urban Consumers (“CPI-U”), which is calculated monthly by the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics. The CPI-U is a measurement of changes in the cost of living, made up of components such as housing, food, transportation and energy. Inflation-indexed securities issued by a foreign government are generally adjusted to reflect a comparable inflation index, calculated by that government. There can be no assurance that the CPI-U or any foreign inflation index will accurately measure the real rate of inflation in the prices of goods and services. Moreover, there can be no assurance that the rate of inflation in a foreign country will be correlated to the rate of inflation in the United States.
Any increase in the principal amount of an inflation-indexed bond will be considered taxable ordinary income, even though investors do not receive their principal until maturity.
49

Warrants and Rights
Each of the Equity Funds may invest in or hold warrants and rights. Warrants are securities giving the holder the right, but not the obligation, to buy the stock of an issuer at a given price (generally higher than the value of the stock at the time of issuance), on a specified date, during a specified period, or perpetually. Rights are similar to warrants, but normally have a shorter duration. Warrants and rights may be acquired separately or in connection with the acquisition of securities. Warrants and rights do not carry with them the right to dividends or voting rights with respect to the securities that they entitle their holder to purchase, and they do not represent any rights in the assets of the issuer. As a result, warrants and rights may be considered more speculative than certain other types of investments. In addition, the value of a warrant or right does not necessarily change with the value of the underlying securities, and a warrant or right ceases to have value if it is not exercised prior to its expiration date.
When-Issued Securities and Delayed-Delivery Transactions
Each of the Fixed-Income Funds may invest in when-issued securities and engage in delayed-delivery transactions. When securities are purchased on a “when-issued” basis or purchased for delayed delivery, payment and delivery occur beyond the normal settlement date at a stated price and yield. When-issued transactions normally settle within 45 days. The payment obligation and the interest rate that will be received on when-issued securities are fixed at the time the buyer enters into the commitment. Due to fluctuations in the value of securities purchased or sold on a when-issued or delayed-delivery basis, the yields obtained on such securities may be higher or lower than the yields available in the market on the dates when the investments are actually delivered to the buyers. The greater a Fund’s outstanding commitments for these securities, the greater the exposure to potential fluctuations in the net asset value of the Fund. Purchasing when-issued or delayed-delivery securities may involve the additional risk that the yield or market price available in the market when the delivery occurs may be higher or the market price lower than that obtained at the time of commitment.
When a Fund engages in when-issued or delayed-delivery transactions, it relies on the other party to consummate the trade. Failure of the seller to do so may result in the Fund incurring a loss or missing an opportunity to obtain a price considered to be advantageous.
Zero Coupon Securities, Step-Coupon Securities, Pay-In-Kind Bonds (“PIK Bonds”) and Deferred Payment Securities
Each of the Fixed-Income Funds may invest in zero coupon securities and step-coupon securities. In addition, each of the Fixed-Income Funds, except the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, may invest in PIK Bonds and deferred payment securities. Zero coupon securities are debt securities that pay no cash income but are sold at substantial discounts from their value at maturity. Step-coupon securities are debt securities that do not make regular cash interest payments and are sold at a deep discount to their face value. When a zero coupon security is held to maturity, its entire return, which consists of the amortization of discount, comes from the difference between its purchase price and its maturity value. This difference is known at the time of purchase, so that investors holding zero coupon securities until maturity know at the time of their investment what the expected return on their investment will be. Zero coupon securities may have conversion features. PIK bonds pay all or a portion of their interest in the form of debt or equity securities. Deferred payment securities are securities that remain zero coupon securities until a predetermined date, at which time the stated coupon rate becomes effective and interest becomes payable at regular intervals. Deferred payment securities are often sold at substantial discounts from their maturity value.
Zero coupon securities, PIK bonds and deferred payment securities tend to be subject to greater price fluctuations in response to changes in interest rates than are ordinary interest-paying debt securities with similar maturities. The value of zero coupon securities appreciates more during periods of declining interest rates and depreciates more during periods of rising interest rates than ordinary interest-paying debt securities with similar maturities. Zero coupon securities, PIK bonds and deferred payment securities may be issued by a wide variety of corporate and governmental issuers. Although these instruments are generally not traded on a national securities exchange, they are widely traded by brokers and dealers and, to such extent, will not be considered illiquid for the purposes of a Fund’s limitation on investments in illiquid securities.
50

Current federal income tax law requires the holder of zero coupon securities, certain PIK bonds and deferred payment securities acquired at a discount (such as Brady Bonds) to accrue income with respect to these securities prior to the receipt of cash payments. Accordingly, to avoid liability for federal income and excise taxes, a Fund may be required to distribute income accrued with respect to these securities and may have to dispose of portfolio securities under disadvantageous circumstances in order to generate cash to satisfy these distribution requirements.
THE INDEX FUNDS
Nationwide Bond Index Fund. The investment objective of the Nationwide Bond Index Fund is to match the performance of the Bloomberg U.S. Aggregate Bond Index (the “Aggregate Index”) as closely as possible before the deduction of Fund expenses. The Aggregate Index is composed primarily of U.S. dollar denominated investment grade bonds of different types, including U.S. government securities; U.S. government agency securities; corporate bonds issued by U.S. and foreign companies; mortgage-backed securities; securities of foreign governments and their agencies; and securities of supranational entities, such as the World Bank. There can be no assurance that the investment objective of the Fund will be achieved.
Nationwide International Index Fund. The investment objective of the Nationwide International Index Fund is to match the performance of the MSCI EAFE® Index (the “EAFE Index”) as closely as possible before the deduction of Fund expenses. The EAFE Index is a market-weighted index composed of common stocks of companies from various industrial sectors whose primary trading markets are located outside the United States. There can be no assurance that the investment objective of the Fund will be achieved.
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund. The investment objective of the Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund is to match the performance of the Standard & Poor’s Mid Cap 400® Index (the “S&P 400 Index”) as closely as possible before the deduction of Fund expenses. There can be no assurance that the investment objective of the Fund will be achieved.
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund. The investment objective of the Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund is to seek to provide investment results that correspond to the price and yield performance of publicly traded common stocks as represented by the Standard & Poor’s 500® Index (the “S&P 500 Index”). There can be no assurance that the investment objective of the Fund will be achieved.
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund. The investment objective of the Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund is to match the performance of the Russell 2000® Index (the “Russell 2000”) as closely as possible before the deduction of Fund expenses. The Russell 2000 is a market-weighted index composed of approximately 2000 common stocks of smaller U.S. companies in a wide range of businesses chosen by Russell Investments based on a number of factors, including industry representation, market value, economic sector and operating/financial condition. There can be no assurance that the investment objective of the Fund will be achieved.
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund. The investment objective of the Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund is to track the total return of the NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index before deducting for Fund expenses. The NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index, which consists of at least 100 individual technology-related securities, is a price-weighted index of stocks of companies from different industries that produce or deploy innovative technologies to conduct their business. There can be no assurance that the investment objective of the Fund will be achieved.
About Indexing. The Index Funds are not managed according to traditional methods of “active” investment management, which involve the buying and selling of securities based upon economic, financial, and market analyses and investment judgment. Instead, each Index Fund, utilizing essentially a “passive” or “indexing” investment approach, seeks to replicate, before each Fund’s expenses (which can be expected to reduce the total return of the Fund), the total return of its respective index.
Indexing and Managing the Funds. Each Index Fund will be substantially invested in securities in the applicable index, and invests at least 80% of its net assets in securities or other financial instruments which are contained in or correlated with securities in the applicable index (with the exception of the Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund, which invests at least 90% of its net assets in securities or other financial instruments which are contained in or correlated with the securities in the NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index).
51

Because each Index Fund seeks to replicate the total return of its respective index, its subadviser generally will not attempt to judge the merits of any particular security as an investment but will seek only to replicate the total return of the securities in the relevant index. However, the subadviser may omit or remove a security which is included in an index from the portfolio of an Index Fund if, following objective criteria, the subadviser judges the security to be insufficiently liquid, believes the merit of the investment has been substantially impaired by extraordinary events or financial conditions, or determines that the security is no longer useful in attempting to replicate the total return of the index.
An Index Fund subadviser may acquire certain financial instruments based upon individual securities or based upon or consisting of one or more baskets of securities (which basket may be based upon a target index). Certain of these instruments may represent an indirect ownership interest in such securities or baskets. Others may provide for the payment to an Index Fund or by an Index Fund of amounts based upon the performance (positive, negative or both) of a particular security or basket. The subadviser will select such instruments when it believes that the use of the instrument will correlate substantially with the expected total return of a target security or index. In connection with the use of such instruments, the subadviser may enter into short sales in an effort to adjust the weightings of particular securities represented in the basket to more accurately reflect such securities weightings in the target index.
The ability of each Index Fund to satisfy its investment objective depends to some extent on the subadviser’s ability to manage cash flow (primarily from purchases and redemptions and distributions from the Fund’s investments). An Index Fund subadviser will make investment changes to an Index Fund’s portfolio to accommodate cash flow while continuing to seek to replicate the total return of the target index. Investors should also be aware that the investment performance of each index is a hypothetical number which does not take into account brokerage commissions and other transaction costs, custody and other costs of investing, and any incremental operating costs (e.g., transfer agency, accounting) that will be borne by the Index Funds.
Each Index Fund’s ability to replicate the total return of its respective index may be affected by, among other things, transaction costs, administration and other expenses incurred by the Index Fund, taxes (including foreign withholding taxes, which will affect the Nationwide International Index Fund and the Nationwide Bond Index Fund due to foreign tax withholding practices), and changes in either the composition of the index or the assets of an Index Fund. In addition, each Index Fund’s total return will be affected by incremental operating costs (e.g., investment advisory, transfer agency, accounting) that will be borne by the Fund.
Additional Information Concerning the Indices
Aggregate Index. The Nationwide Bond Index Fund is not promoted, sponsored or endorsed by, nor in any way affiliated with Bloomberg. Bloomberg does not have responsibility for and does not participate in the Nationwide Bond Index Fund’s management.
Russell 2000 Index. Russell Investment Group is the source and owner of the trademarks, service marks and copyrights related to the Russell 2000 Index. Russell® is a trademark of Russell Investment Group (“Russell Investments”).The Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund is not promoted, sponsored or endorsed by, nor in any way affiliated with Russell Investments. Russell Investments is not responsible for and has not reviewed the Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund nor any associated literature or publications and Russell Investments makes no representation or warranty, express or implied, as to their accuracy, or completeness, or otherwise.
Russell Investments reserves the right, at any time and without notice, to alter, amend, terminate or in any way change the Russell 2000 Index. Russell Investments has no obligation to take the needs of any particular fund or its shareholders or any other product or person into consideration in determining, composing or calculating the Russell 2000 Index. Russell Investments’ publication of the Russell 2000 Index in no way suggests or implies an opinion by Russell Investments as to the attractiveness or appropriateness of investment in any or all securities upon which the Russell 2000 Index is based. RUSSELL INVESTMENTS MAKES NO REPRESENTATION, WARRANTY, OR GUARANTEE AS TO THE ACCURACY, COMPLETENESS, RELIABILITY, OR OTHERWISE OF THE RUSSELL 2000 INDEX OR ANY DATA INCLUDED IN THE RUSSELL 2000 INDEX. RUSSELL INVESTMENTS MAKES NO REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY REGARDING THE USE, OR THE RESULTS OF USE, OF THE RUSSELL 2000 INDEX OR ANY DATA INCLUDED THEREIN, OR ANY SECURITY (OR COMBINATION THEREOF) COMPRISING THE RUSSELL 2000 INDEX. RUSSELL INVESTMENTS MAKES NO OTHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTY, AND EXPRESSLY
52

DISCLAIMS ANY WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, ANY WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE WITH RESPECT TO THE RUSSELL 2000 INDEX OR ANY DATA OR ANY SECURITY (OR COMBINATION THEREOF) INCLUDED THEREIN.
EAFE Index. The Nationwide International Index Fund is not sponsored, endorsed, sold or promoted by MSCI Inc. (“MSCI”), any of its affiliates, any of its information providers or any other third party involved in, or related to, compiling, computing or creating any MSCI index (collectively, the “MSCI Parties”), including the EAFE Index. The EAFE Index is the exclusive property of MSCI. MSCI and the EAFE Index are service mark(s) of MSCI or its affiliates and have been licensed for use for certain purposes by Nationwide Fund Advisors, as the investment adviser to the Nationwide International Index Fund. None of the MSCI Parties makes any representation or warranty, express or implied, to the issuer or shareholders of the Nationwide International Index Fund or any other person or entity regarding the advisability of investing in funds generally or in the Nationwide International Index Fund particularly or the ability of any MSCI index to track corresponding stock market performance. MSCI or its affiliates are the licensors of certain trademarks, service marks and trade names and of the MSCI indices which are determined, composed and calculated by MSCI without regard to the Nationwide International Index Fund or its shareholders or any other person or entity. None of the MSCI Parties has any obligation to take the needs of the Nationwide International Index Fund or its shareholders or any other person or entity into consideration in determining, composing or calculating the MSCI indices. None of the MSCI Parties is responsible for or has participated in the determination of the timing of, prices at, or quantities of the Nationwide International Index Fund to be issued or in the determination or calculation of the equation by or the consideration into which the Nationwide International Index Fund is redeemable. Further, none of the MSCI Parties has any obligation or liability to the Nationwide International Index Fund or its shareholders or any other person or entity in connection with the administration, marketing or offering of the Nationwide International Index Fund.
Although MSCI shall obtain information for inclusion in or for use in the calculation of the MSCI indices from sources that MSCI considers reliable, none of the MSCI Parties warrants or guarantees the originality, accuracy and/or the completeness of any MSCI index or any data included therein. None of the MSCI Parties makes any warranty, express or implied, as to results to be obtained by the Nationwide International Index Fund, its shareholders, or any other person or entity, from the use of any MSCI index or any data included therein. None of the MSCI Parties shall have any liability for any errors, omissions or interruptions of or in connection with any MSCI index or any data included therein. Further, none of the MSCI Parties makes any express or implied warranties of any kind, and the MSCI Parties hereby expressly disclaim all warranties of merchantability and fitness for a particular purpose, with respect to each MSCI index and any data included therein. Without limiting any of the foregoing, in no event shall any of the MSCI Parties have any liability for any direct, indirect, special, punitive, consequential or any other damages (including lost profits) even if notified of the possibility of such damages.
No purchaser, seller or holder of shares of the Nationwide International Index Fund, or any other person or entity, should use or refer to any MSCI trade name, trademark or service mark to sponsor, endorse, market or promote this security without first contacting MSCI to determine whether MSCI’s permission is required. Under no circumstances may any person or entity claim any affiliation with MSCI without the prior written permission of MSCI.
S&P 500 Index and S&P 400 Index. Standard & Poor’s 500®, S&P 500®, Standard & Poor’s MidCap 400®, S&P MidCap 400®, and S&P 400® are trademarks of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. Pursuant to an agreement with McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., on behalf of the Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund and Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund, the Funds are authorized to use the trademarks of the McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. The Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund and the Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund are not sponsored, endorsed, sold or promoted by Standard & Poor’s, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. (“S&P”). S&P makes no representation or warranty, expressed or implied, to the shareholders of the Funds or any member of the public regarding the advisability of investing in securities generally or in the Funds particularly or the ability of the S&P 500® Index or the S&P 400® Index to track general stock market performance. S&P’s only relationship to the Funds, the adviser or subadvisers is the licensing of certain trademarks and trade names of S&P and of the S&P 500® and S&P 400® indices which are determined, composed and calculated by S&P without regard to the Funds. S&P has no obligation to take the needs of the Funds or their shareholders into consideration in determining, composing or calculating the S&P 500® and S&P 400® Indices. S&P is not responsible for or has not participated in the determination of the prices and amount of the Funds’ shares or the timing of the issuance or sale of Fund shares or in the determination or calculation of the equation by which Fund shares are redeemed. S&P has no obligation or liability in connection with the administration, marketing or trading of the Funds. S&P does not guarantee the accuracy makes no warranty, expressed or implied as to the results to be obtained by the Funds, shareholders of the Funds, or any other person or
53

entity from the use of the S&P 500® or S&P 400® Indices or any data included therein. Without limiting any of the foregoing, in no event shall S&P 500® and S&P 400® Indices have any liability for any special, punitive, indirect, or consequential damages, including lost profits even if notified of the possibility of such damages.
NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index. “Archipelago®”, “ARCA®”, “ARCAEX®”, “NYSE®”, “NYSE ARCASM” and “NYSE Arca Tech 100SM” are trademarks of the NYSE Group, Inc. and Archipelago Holdings, Inc. and have been licensed for use by Nationwide Fund Advisors, on behalf of the Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund. The Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund is not sponsored, endorsed, sold or promoted by Archipelago Holdings, Inc. or by NYSE Group, Inc. Neither Archipelago Holdings, Inc. nor NYSE Group, Inc. makes any representation or warranty regarding the advisability of investing in securities generally, in the Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund particularly, or the ability of the NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index to track general stock market performance.
NYSE GROUP, INC. MAKES NO EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, AND HEREBY EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE WITH RESPECT TO THE NYSE ARCA TECH 100 INDEX OR ANY DATA INCLUDED THEREIN. IN NO EVENT SHALL NYSE GROUP, INC. HAVE ANY LIABILITY FOR ANY SPECIAL, PUNITIVE, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING LOST PROFITS), EVEN IF NOTIFIED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
Portfolio Turnover
The portfolio turnover rate for each Fund is calculated by dividing the lesser of purchases and sales of portfolio securities for the year by the monthly average value of the portfolio securities, excluding securities whose maturities at the time of purchase were one year or less. High portfolio turnover rates generally will result in higher brokerage expenses, and may increase the volatility of the Fund. The table below shows any significant variation in the Funds' portfolio turnover rate for the fiscal years ended October 31, 2023 and 2022, or any anticipated variation in the portfolio turnover rate from that reported for the last fiscal year:
Fund
For the Fiscal
Year Ended
October 31, 2023
For the Fiscal
Year Ended
October 31, 2022
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund1
49.85%
75.11%
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund1
257.75%
283.03%
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund1
44.23%
103.72%
Nationwide Bond Fund1
42.21%
145.73%
Nationwide Bond Index Fund2
83.82%
66.27%
Nationwide Fund2
72.63%
53.21%
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund2
42.83%
28.25%
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund1
204.87%
221.61%
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund1
24.68%
44.89%
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund1
40.07%
104.12%
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund1
12.63%
47.91%
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund1
267.27%
342.05%
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund2
227.46%
172.73%
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund1
19.48%
34.24%
1 The portfolio managers for the Funds are not limited by portfolio turnover in their management style, and a Fund’s portfolio turnover will fluctuate based on particular market conditions and stock valuations. In the fiscal year ended October 31, 2023, the portfolio managers made fewer changes than they deemed necessary during the fiscal year ended October 31, 2022.
2 The portfolio managers for the Funds are not limited by portfolio turnover in their management style, and a Fund’s portfolio turnover will fluctuate based on particular market conditions and stock valuations. In the fiscal year ended October 31, 2023, the portfolio managers made more changes than they deemed necessary during the fiscal year ended October 31, 2022.
54

 Investment Restrictions
The following are fundamental investment restrictions of each Fund which cannot be changed without the vote of the majority of the outstanding shares of the Fund for which a change is proposed. The vote of the majority of the outstanding shares means the vote of (A) 67% or more of the voting securities present at a meeting, if the holders of more than 50% of the outstanding voting securities are present or represented by proxy or (B) a majority of the outstanding voting securities, whichever is less.
Each of the Funds:
May not (except the Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund) purchase securities of any one issuer, other than obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities, if, immediately after such purchase, more than 5% of the Fund’s total assets would be invested in such issuer or the Fund would hold more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of the issuer, except that 25% or less of the Fund’s total assets may be invested without regard to such limitations. There is no limit to the percentage of assets that may be invested in U.S. Treasury bills, notes, or other obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities. The Nationwide Government Money Market Fund will be deemed to be in compliance with this restriction so long as it is in compliance with Rule 2a-7 under the 1940 Act, as such Rule may be amended from time to time.
May not (except the Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund, Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund and Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund) borrow money or issue senior securities, except that each Fund may enter into reverse repurchase agreements and may otherwise borrow money and issue senior securities as and to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act or any rule, order or interpretation thereunder.
May not act as an underwriter of another issuer’s securities, except to the extent that the Fund may be deemed an underwriter within the meaning of the Securities Act in connection with the purchase and sale of portfolio securities.
May not purchase or sell commodities or commodities contracts, except to the extent disclosed in the current Prospectus or Statement of Additional Information of the Fund.
May not (except the Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund and the Index Funds (except the Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund)) purchase the securities of any issuer if, as a result, 25% or more (taken at current value) of the Fund’s total assets would be invested in the securities of issuers, the principal activities of which are in the same industry. This limitation does not apply to securities issued by the U.S. government or its agencies or instrumentalities. The following industries are considered separate industries for purposes of this investment restriction: electric, natural gas distribution, natural gas pipeline, combined electric and natural gas, and telephone utilities, captive borrowing conduit, equipment finance, premium finance, leasing finance, consumer finance and other finance.
May not lend any security or make any other loan, except that each Fund may in accordance with its investment objective and policies (i) lend portfolio securities, (ii) purchase and hold debt securities or other debt instruments, including but not limited to loan participations and subparticipations, assignments, and structured securities, (iii) make loans secured by mortgages on real property, (iv) enter into repurchase agreements, and (v) make time deposits with financial institutions and invest in instruments issued by financial institutions, and enter into any other lending arrangement as and to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act or any rule, order or interpretation thereunder.
May not purchase or sell real estate, except that each Fund may (i) acquire real estate through ownership of securities or instruments and sell any real estate acquired thereby, (ii) purchase or sell instruments secured by real estate (including interests therein), and (iii) purchase or sell securities issued by entities or investment vehicles that own or deal in real estate (including interests therein).
For those Funds listed above as exceptions to the investment restrictions, see the discussion below regarding each such Fund’s applicable investment restriction.
The Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund:
May not purchase securities of one issuer, other than obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities, if at the end of each fiscal quarter, (a) more than 5% of the Fund’s total assets (taken at current value) would be invested in such issuer (except that up to 50% of the Fund’s total assets may be invested without regard to such 5% limitation), and (b) more than 25% of its total assets (taken at current value) would be invested in securities of a single issuer. There is no limit to the percentage of assets that may be invested in U.S. Treasury bills, notes, or other obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities.
55

The Index Funds (except the Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund):
May not purchase the securities of any issuer if, as a result, 25% or more than (taken at current value) of the Fund’s total assets would be invested in the securities of issuers, the principal activities of which are in the same industry; provided, that in replicating the weightings of a particular industry in its target index, a Fund may invest more than 25% of its total assets in securities of issuers in that industry.
The Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund, Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund and Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund:
May not borrow money or issue senior securities, except that each Fund may sell securities short, enter into reverse repurchase agreements and may otherwise borrow money and issue senior securities as and to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act or any rule, order or interpretation thereunder.
The following are the non-fundamental operating policies of the Funds, which may be changed by the Board of Trustees without shareholder approval:
Each Fund may not:
Except the Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund and Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund, sell securities short unless the Fund owns or has the right to obtain securities equivalent in kind and amount to the securities sold short or unless it segregates or earmarks other liquid assets it owns as required by the current rules and positions of the SEC or its staff, and provided that short positions in forward currency contracts, options, futures contracts, options on futures contracts, or other derivative instruments are not deemed to constitute selling securities short.
Purchase securities on margin, except that the Fund may obtain such short-term credits as are necessary for the clearance of transactions; and provided that margin deposits in connection with options, futures contracts, options on futures contracts, transactions in currencies or other derivative instruments shall not constitute purchasing securities on margin. In addition, the Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund, Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund and Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund, may use margin to the extent necessary to engage in short sales of securities.
Purchase or otherwise acquire any security if, as a result, more than 15% (5% with respect to the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund) of its net assets would be invested in securities that are illiquid.
Pledge, mortgage or hypothecate any assets owned by the Fund except as may be necessary in connection with permissible borrowings or investments and then such pledging, mortgaging, or hypothecating may not exceed 33  13% of the Fund’s total assets.
Except the Nationwide Bond Index Fund, Nationwide International Index Fund, Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund, Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund and Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund, purchase securities of other investment companies except (a) in connection with a merger, consolidation, acquisition, reorganization or offer of exchange, or (b) to the extent permitted by the 1940 Act or any rules or regulations thereunder or pursuant to any exemptions therefrom.
The Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund, Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund and Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund may not:
Sell securities short unless it covers such short sales or segregates or earmarks liquid assets as required by the current rules and positions of the SEC or its staff, and provided that short positions in forward currency contracts, options, futures contracts, options on futures contracts, or other derivative instruments are not deemed to constitute selling securities short.
A Fund’s obligation not to pledge, mortgage, or hypothecate assets in excess of 33  13% of the Fund’s total assets with respect to permissible borrowings or investments, as described above, is a continuing obligation and such asset segregation and coverage must be maintained on an ongoing basis. For any other percentage restriction or requirement described above that is satisfied at the time of investment, a later increase or decrease in such percentage resulting from a change in net asset value will not constitute a violation of such restriction or requirement. However, should a change in net asset value or other external events cause a Fund’s investments in illiquid securities including repurchase agreements with maturities in excess of
56

seven days, to exceed the limit set forth above for such Fund’s investment in illiquid securities, a Fund will act to cause the aggregate amount of such securities to come within such limit as soon as reasonably practicable. In such event, however, such Fund would not be required to liquidate any portfolio securities where a Fund would suffer a loss on the sale of such securities.
Certain Funds have adopted a non-fundamental policy, as required by Rule 35d-1 under the 1940 Act, to invest, under normal circumstances, at least 80% the Fund’s net assets in the type of investment suggested by the Fund’s name (“80 Percent Policy”). The scope of the 80 Percent Policy includes Fund names suggesting that each Fund focuses its investments in: (i) a particular type of investment or investments; (ii) a particular industry or group of industries; or (iii) certain countries or geographic regions. For purposes of the 80 Percent Policy, 80% of the Fund’s net assets shall mean 80% of the Fund’s net assets plus the amount of any borrowings for investment purposes. Each Fund that has adopted the 80 Percent Policy also has adopted a policy to provide its shareholders with at least 60 days’ prior written notice of any change in such investment policy.
Internal Revenue Code Restrictions
In addition to the investment restrictions above, each Fund must be diversified according to Internal Revenue Code requirements. Specifically, at each tax quarter end, each Fund’s holdings must be diversified so that (a) at least 50% of the market value of its total assets is represented by cash and cash items (including receivables), U.S. government securities, securities of other U.S. regulated investment companies, and securities of other issuers, limited so that no one issuer has a value greater than 5% of the value of the Fund’s total assets and that the Fund holds no more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of such issuer, and (b) not more than 25% of the value of the Fund’s assets is invested in the securities (other than those of the U.S. government or other U.S. regulated investment companies) of any one issuer or of two or more issuers which the Fund controls and which are engaged in the same, similar, or related trades or businesses, or, in the securities of one or more qualified publicly traded partnerships.
Disclosure of Portfolio Holdings
The Board of Trustees has adopted policies and procedures regarding the disclosure of portfolio holdings information to protect the interests of Fund shareholders and to address potential conflicts of interest that could arise between the interests of Fund shareholders and the interests of the Funds' investment adviser, principal underwriter or affiliated persons of the Funds' investment adviser or principal underwriter. The Trust’s overall policy with respect to the release of portfolio holdings is to release such information consistent with applicable legal requirements and the fiduciary duties owed to shareholders. Subject to the limited exceptions described below, the Trust will not make available to anyone non-public information with respect to its portfolio holdings until such time as the information is made available to all shareholders or the general public.
The policies and procedures are applicable to NFA and any subadviser to the Funds. Pursuant to the policy, the Funds, NFA, any subadviser, and any service provider acting on their behalf are obligated to:
Act in the best interests of Fund shareholders by protecting non-public and potentially material portfolio holdings information;
Ensure that portfolio holdings information is not provided to a favored group of clients or potential clients; and
Adopt such safeguards and controls around the release of client information so that no client or group of clients is unfairly disadvantaged as a result of such release.
Portfolio holdings information that is not publicly available will be released selectively only pursuant to the exceptions described below. In most cases, even where an exception applies, the release of portfolio holdings is strictly prohibited until the information is at least 15 calendar days old. Nevertheless, NFA’s Leadership Team or its duly authorized delegate may authorize, where circumstances dictate, the release of more current portfolio holdings information.
Except for the Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund, Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund and Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund, each Fund posts onto the Trust’s internet site (nationwide.com/mutualfunds) substantially all of its securities holdings as of the end of each month. Such portfolio holdings are available no earlier than 15 calendar days after the end of the previous month, and generally remain available on the internet site until the Fund files its next portfolio holdings report on Form N-CSR or Form N-PORT with the SEC. The Nationwide Government Money Market Fund posts onto the Trust's internet site, no later than the fifth business day of each month, a schedule of its investments as of the last
57

business day or subsequent calendar day of the prior month and maintains such portfolio holdings information for no less than six months after posting. All Funds (including the Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund, Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund and Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund) disclose their complete portfolio holdings information to the SEC using Form N-PORT within 60 days of the end of the third month of the first and third quarters of the Funds' fiscal year and on Form N-CSR on the second and fourth quarters of the Funds' fiscal year. The Nationwide Government Money Market Fund discloses its complete portfolio holdings information to the SEC on Form N-CSR and files monthly reports using Form N-MFP. Shareholders receive either complete portfolio holdings information or summaries of Fund portfolio holdings with their annual and semiannual reports.
Exceptions to the portfolio holdings release policy described above can only be authorized by NFA’s Leadership Team or its duly authorized delegate and will be made only when:
A Fund has a legitimate business purpose for releasing portfolio holdings information in advance of release to all shareholders or the general public;
The recipient of the information provides written assurances that the non-public portfolio holdings information will remain confidential and that persons with access to the information will be prohibited from trading based on the information; and
The release of such information would not otherwise violate the antifraud provisions of the federal securities laws or the Funds' fiduciary duties.
Under this policy, the receipt of compensation by a Fund, NFA, a subadviser, or an affiliate as consideration for disclosing non-public portfolio holdings information will not be deemed a legitimate business purpose.
The Funds have ongoing arrangements to distribute information about the Funds' portfolio holdings to the Funds' third-party service providers described herein (e.g., investment adviser, subadvisers, registered independent public accounting firm, administrator, transfer agent, sub-administrator, sub-transfer agent, custodian and legal counsel) as well as Wolters Kluwer Financial Services, Inc. (GainsKeeper); SunGard Financial Systems (Wall Street Concepts); Style Research, Inc.; Synthesis Technology; Ernst & Young, LLP; Institutional Shareholder Services, Inc.; Lipper Inc., Morningstar, Inc.; Bloomberg LP; Global Trading Analytics; RiskMetrics Group, Inc.; FactSet Research Systems, Inc.; the Investment Company Institute; AllVue Everest; Amazon Web Services (AWS); Confluence/InvestmentMetrics/Style Analytics; Microsoft; RIMES; SmartStream Technologies; Snowflake; Trioptima; TS Imagine Inc.; Bank of New York; MSCI Inc.; ICE Data Pricing & Reference Data LLC; GTA Babelfish, LLC; KPMG LLC; Qontigo (Aximoa Risk System); Financial Recovery Technologies; and, on occasion, to transition managers such as BlackRock Institutional Trust Company; Fidelity Capital Markets (a division of National Financial Services, LLC); Capital Institutional Services; State Street Bank and Trust Company; Electra Information Systems; Virtu Americas LLC; Russell Investments Implementation Services, LLC; or Macquarie Capital (USA) Inc.; where such transition manager provides portfolio transition management assistance (e.g., upon change of subadviser, etc.). These organizations are required to keep such information confidential, and are prohibited from trading based on the information or otherwise using the information except as necessary in providing services to the Funds. No compensation or other consideration is received by the Funds, NFA or any other party in connection with each such ongoing arrangement.
NFA conducts periodic reviews of compliance with the policy and the Funds' Chief Compliance Officer provides annually a report to the Board of Trustees regarding the operation of the policy and any material changes recommended as a result of such review. NFA’s compliance staff also will submit annually to the Board of Trustees a list of exceptions granted to the policy, including an explanation of the legitimate business purpose of the Fund that was served as a result of the exception.
Trustees and Officers of the Trust
Management Information
Each Trustee who is deemed an “interested person,” as such term is defined in the 1940 Act, is referred to as an “Interested Trustee.” Those Trustees who are not “interested persons,” as such term is defined in the 1940 Act, are referred to as “Independent Trustees.” The name, year of birth, position and length of time served with the Trust, number of portfolios overseen, principal occupation(s) and other directorships/trusteeships held during the past five years, and additional information related to experience, qualifications, attributes, and skills of each Trustee and Officer are shown below. There are
58

47 series of the Trust, all of which are overseen by the Board of Trustees and Officers of the Trust. The address for each Trustee and Officer is c/o Nationwide Investment Management Group, One Nationwide Plaza, Mail Code 5-02-210, Columbus, OH 43215.
Independent Trustees
Kristina Junco Bradshaw
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Trust and
Length of Time Served1
Number of Portfolios Overseen in
the Nationwide Fund Complex
1980
Trustee since January 2023
116
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Retired. Ms. Bradshaw was a Portfolio Manager on the Dividend Value team at Invesco from August 2006 to August 2020.
Prior to this time, Ms. Bradshaw was an investment banker in the Global Energy & Utilities group at Morgan Stanley from
June 2002 to July 2004.
Other Directorships held During the Past Five Years2
Board Member of Southern Smoke Foundation from August 2020 to present, Advisory Board Member of Dress for Success
from April 2013 to present, Trustee/Executive Board Member of Houston Ballet from September 2011 to present and
President since July 2022, and Board Member of Hermann Park Conservancy from August 2011 to present, serving as
Board Chair since 2020.
Experience, Qualifications, Attributes, and Skills for Board Membership
Ms. Bradshaw has significant board experience; significant portfolio management experience in the investment
management industry and is a Chartered Financial Analyst.
Lorn C. Davis
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Trust and
Length of Time Served1
Number of Portfolios Overseen in
the Nationwide Fund Complex
1968
Trustee since January 2021
116
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Mr. Davis has been a Managing Partner of College Hill Capital Partners, LLC (private equity) since June 2016. From
September 1998 until May 2016, Mr. Davis originated and managed debt and equity investments for John Hancock Life
Insurance Company (U.S.A.)/Hancock Capital Management, LLC, serving as a Managing Director from September 2003
through May 2016.
Other Directorships held During the Past Five Years2
Board Member of The Pine Street Inn from 2009 to present, currently serving as Chair of the Board, Member of the
Advisory Board (non-fiduciary) of Mearthane Products Corporation from September 2019 to present, Board Member of
The College of Holy Cross since July 2022, and Member of Board of Managers of the College Circle Creamery Holdings
since February 2023.
Experience, Qualifications, Attributes, and Skills for Board Membership
Mr. Davis has significant board experience; significant past service at a large asset management company and significant
experience in the investment management industry. Mr. Davis is a Chartered Financial Analyst and earned a Certificate of
Director Education from the National Association of Corporate Directors in 2008.
Barbara I. Jacobs
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Trust and
Length of Time Served1
Number of Portfolios Overseen in
the Nationwide Fund Complex
1950
Trustee since December 2004
116
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Retired. From 1988 through 2003, Ms. Jacobs was a Managing Director and European Portfolio Manager of CREF
Investments (Teachers Insurance and Annuity Association—College Retirement Equities Fund). Ms. Jacobs also served as
Chairman of the Board of Directors of KICAP Network Fund, a European (United Kingdom) hedge fund, from January
2001 through January 2006.
Other Directorships held During the Past Five Years2
Trustee and Board Chair of Project Lede from 2013 to present.
Experience, Qualifications, Attributes, and Skills for Board Membership
Ms. Jacobs has significant board experience and significant executive and portfolio management experience in the
investment management industry.
59

Keith F. Karlawish
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Trust and
Length of Time Served1
Number of Portfolios Overseen in
the Nationwide Fund Complex
1964
Trustee since March 2012; Chairman
since January 2021
116
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
As of January 1, 2024, Mr. Karlawish is a Partner, Senior Wealth Advisor with Curi RMB Capital. Previously, he was
Senior Director of Wealth Management with Curi Wealth Management which acquired Park Ridge Asset Management,
LLC in August 2022. Prior to this time, Mr. Karlawish was a partner with Park Ridge Asset Management, LLC since
December 2008 and also served as a portfolio manager. From May 2002 until October 2008, Mr. Karlawish was the
President of BB&T Asset Management, Inc., and was President of the BB&T Mutual Funds and BB&T Variable Insurance
Funds from February 2005 until October 2008.
Other Directorships held During the Past Five Years2
None
Experience, Qualifications, Attributes, and Skills for Board Membership
Mr. Karlawish has significant board experience, including past service on the boards of BB&T Mutual Funds and BB&T
Variable Insurance Funds; significant executive experience, including past service at a large asset management company
and significant experience in the investment management industry.
Carol A. Kosel
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Trust and
Length of Time Served1
Number of Portfolios Overseen in
the Nationwide Fund Complex
1963
Trustee since March 2013
116
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Retired. Ms. Kosel was a consultant to the Evergreen Funds Board of Trustees from October 2005 to December 2007. She
was Senior Vice President, Treasurer, and Head of Fund Administration of the Evergreen Funds from April 1997 to October
2005.
Other Directorships held During the Past Five Years2
None
Experience, Qualifications, Attributes, and Skills for Board Membership
Ms. Kosel has significant board experience, including past service on the boards of Evergreen Funds and Sun Capital
Advisers Trust; significant executive experience, including past service at a large asset management company and
significant experience in the investment management industry.
Douglas F. Kridler
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Trust and
Length of Time Served1
Number of Portfolios Overseen in
the Nationwide Fund Complex
1955
Trustee since September 1997
116
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Since 2002, Mr. Kridler has served as the President and Chief Executive Officer of The Columbus Foundation, a
$2.5 billion community foundation with 2,000 funds in 55 Ohio counties and 37 states in the U.S.
Other Directorships held During the Past Five Years2
None
Experience, Qualifications, Attributes, and Skills for Board Membership
Mr. Kridler has significant board experience; significant executive experience, including service as president and chief
executive officer of one of America’s largest community foundations and significant service to his community and the
philanthropic field in numerous leadership roles.
Charlotte Tiedemann Petersen
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Trust and
Length of Time Served1
Number of Portfolios Overseen in
the Nationwide Fund Complex
1960
Trustee since January 2023
116
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Self-employed as a private real estate investor/principal since January 2011. Ms. Petersen served as Chief Investment
Officer at Alexander Capital Management from April 2006 to December 2010. From July 1993 to June 2002, Ms. Petersen
was a Portfolio Manager, Partner and Management Committee member of Denver Investment Advisors LLC.
60

Other Directorships held During the Past Five Years2
Investment Committee for the University of Colorado Foundation from February 2015 to June 2022.
Experience, Qualifications, Attributes, and Skills for Board Membership
Ms. Petersen has significant board experience including past service as a Trustee of Scout Funds and Director of Fischer
Imaging, where she chaired committees for both entities; significant experience in the investment management industry
and is a Chartered Financial Analyst.
David E. Wezdenko
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Trust and
Length of Time Served1
Number of Portfolios Overseen in
the Nationwide Fund Complex
1963
Trustee since January 2021
116
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Mr. Wezdenko is a Co-Founder of Blue Leaf Ventures (venture capital firm, founded May 2018). From November 2008
until December 2017, Mr. Wezdenko was Managing Director of JPMorgan Chase & Co.
Other Directorships held During the Past Five Years2
Independent Trustee for National Philanthropic Trust from October 2021 to present and Board Member for Saint Vincent de
Paul of Palm Beach County from May 2023 to present.
Experience, Qualifications, Attributes, and Skills for Board Membership
Mr. Wezdenko has significant board experience; significant past service at a large asset and wealth management company
and significant experience in the investment management industry.
Interested Trustee
M. Diane Koken3
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Trust and
Length of Time Served1
Number of Portfolios Overseen in
the Nationwide Fund Complex
1952
Trustee since April 2019
116
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Self-employed as a legal/regulatory consultant since 2007. Ms. Koken served as Insurance Commissioner of Pennsylvania,
for three governors, from 1997–2007, and as the President of the National Association of Insurance Commissioners (NAIC)
from September 2004 to December 2005. Prior to becoming Insurance Commissioner of Pennsylvania, she held multiple
legal roles, including vice president, general counsel and corporate secretary of a national life insurance company.
Other Directorships held During the Past Five Years2
Director of Nationwide Mutual Insurance Company 2007-present, Director of Nationwide Mutual Fire Insurance Company
2007-present, Director of Nationwide Corporation 2007-present, Director of Capital BlueCross 2011-2022, Director of
NORCAL Mutual Insurance Company 2009-2021, Director of Medicus Insurance Company 2009-2021, Director of
Hershey Trust Company 2016-present, Manager of Milton Hershey School Board of Managers 2016-present, Director of
Hershey Foundation 2016-present, and Director of The Hershey Company 2017-present.
Experience, Qualifications, Attributes, and Skills for Board Membership
Ms. Koken has significant board experience and significant executive, legal and regulatory experience, including past
service as a cabinet-level state insurance commissioner and general counsel of a national life insurance company.
1
Length of time served includes time served with the Trust’s predecessors. The tenure of each Trustee is subject to the Board’s retirement policy, which states that a Trustee shall retire from the Boards of Trustees of the Trusts effective on December 31 of the calendar year during which he or she turns 75 years of age; provided this policy does not apply to a person who became a Trustee prior to September 11, 2019.
2
Directorships held in: (1) any other investment companies registered under the 1940 Act, (2) any company with a class of securities registered pursuant to Section 12 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), or (3) any company subject to the requirements of Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act, which are required to be disclosed in this SAI. In addition, certain other directorships not meeting the aforementioned requirements may be included for certain Trustees such as board positions on non-profit organizations.
3
Ms. Koken is considered an interested person of the Trust because she is a Director of the parent company of, and several affiliates of, the Trust’s investment adviser and distributor.
Officers of the Trust
Kevin T. Jestice
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Funds and Length of Time Served
1980
President, Chief Executive Officer and Principal Executive Officer since March
2023
61

Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Mr. Jestice is President and Chief Executive Officer of Nationwide Investment Management Group and is a Senior Vice
President of Nationwide Mutual Insurance Company.1 He previously served as Vice President of Internal Sales and Service
(ISS) and Institutional Investments Distribution (IID) for Nationwide Financial Services, Inc. Prior to joining Nationwide
in 2020, Mr. Jestice served as Principal, Head of Enterprise Advice and as Principal, Head of Institutional Investor Services
at The Vanguard Group, Inc. for more than 13 years.
Lee T. Cummings
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Funds and Length of Time Served
1963
Senior Vice President and Head of Fund Operations since December 2015
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Mr. Cummings is Senior Vice President and Head of Fund Operations of Nationwide Investment Management Group, and
is a Vice President of Nationwide Mutual Insurance Company.1 He previously served as the Trust’s Treasurer and Principal
Financial Officer, and served temporarily as the Trust’s President, Chief Executive Officer and Principal Executive Officer
from September 2022 until March 2023.
David Majewski
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Funds and Length of Time Served
1976
Treasurer and Principal Financial Officer since September 2022
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Mr. Majewski previously served as the Trust’s Assistant Secretary and Assistant Treasurer.
Kevin Grether
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Funds and Length of Time Served
1970
Senior Vice President and Chief Compliance Officer since December 2021
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Mr. Grether is Vice President of NFA and Chief Compliance Officer of NFA and the Trust. He is also a Vice President of
Nationwide Mutual Insurance Company.1 He previously served as the VP, Chief Compliance Officer for the Nationwide
Office of Investments and its registered investment adviser, Nationwide Asset Management, LLC.
Stephen R. Rimes
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Funds and Length of Time Served
1970
Secretary, Senior Vice President and General Counsel since December 2019
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Mr. Rimes is Vice President, Associate General Counsel and Secretary for Nationwide Investment Management Group, and
Vice President of Nationwide Mutual Insurance Company.1 He previously served as Assistant General Counsel for Invesco
from 2000-2019.
Christopher C. Graham
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Funds and Length of Time Served
1971
Senior Vice President, Head of Investment Strategies, Chief Investment Officer
and Portfolio Manager since September 2016
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Mr. Graham is Senior Vice President, Head of Investment Strategies and Portfolio Manager for Nationwide Investment
Management Group, and is a Vice President of Nationwide Mutual Insurance Company.1
Benjamin Hoecherl
Year of Birth
Positions Held with Funds and Length of Time Served
1976
Senior Vice President, Head of Business and Product Development since
December 2023
Principal Occupation(s) During the Past Five Years (or Longer)
Mr. Hoecherl is Vice President, Head of Business and Product Development for Nationwide Investment Management
Group, and is a Vice President of Nationwide Mutual Insurance Company.1He previously served as AVP for Nationwide
ProAccount within Nationwide Retirement Solutions.
1
These positions are held with an affiliated person or principal underwriter of the Funds.
62

Responsibilities of the Board of Trustees
The Board of Trustees (the “Board”) has oversight responsibility for the conduct of the affairs of the Trust. The Board approves policies and procedures regarding the operation of the Trust, regularly receives and reviews reports from NFA regarding the implementation of such policies and procedures, and elects the Officers of the Trust to perform the daily functions of the Trust. The Chairman of the Board is an Independent Trustee.
Board Leadership Structure
The Board approves financial arrangements and other agreements between the Funds, on the one hand, and NFA, any subadvisers or other affiliated parties, on the other hand. The Independent Trustees meet regularly as a group in executive session and with independent legal counsel. The Board has determined that the efficient conduct of the Board’s affairs makes it desirable to delegate responsibility for certain specific matters to Committees of the Board (“Committees”), as described below. The Committees meet as often as necessary, either in conjunction with regular meetings of the Board or otherwise. The membership and chair of each Committee are appointed by the Board upon recommendation of the Nominating and Fund Governance Committee.
This structure is reviewed by the Board periodically, and the Board believes it to be appropriate and effective. The Board also completes an annual self-assessment during which it reviews its leadership and Committee structure, and considers whether its structure remains appropriate in light of the Funds' current operations.
Each Trustee shall hold office for the lifetime of the Trust or until such Trustee’s earlier death, resignation, removal, retirement, or inability otherwise to serve, or, if sooner than any of such events, until the next meeting of shareholders called for the purpose of electing Trustees or consent of shareholders in lieu thereof for the election of Trustees, and until the election and qualification of his or her successor. The Board may fill any vacancy on the Board provided that, after such appointment, at least two-thirds of the Trustees have been elected by shareholders. Any Trustee may be removed by the Board, with or without cause, by action of a majority of the Trustees then in office, or by a vote of shareholders at any meeting called for that purpose. In addition to conducting an annual self-assessment, the Board completes biennial peer evaluations, which focus on the performance and effectiveness of the individual members of the Board.
The Officers of the Trust are appointed by the Board, or, to the extent permitted by the Trust’s By-laws, by the President of the Trust, and each shall serve at the pleasure of the Board, or, to the extent permitted by the Trust’s By-laws, and except for the Chief Compliance Officer, at the pleasure of the President of the Trust, subject to the rights, if any, of an Officer under any contract of employment. The Trust’s Chief Compliance Officer must be approved by a majority of the Independent Trustees. Subject to the rights, if any, of an Officer under any contract of employment, any Officer may be removed, with or without cause, by the Board at any regular or special meeting of the Board, or, to the extent permitted by the Trust’s By-laws, by the President of the Trust; provided, that only the Board may remove, with or without cause, the Chief Compliance Officer of the Trust.
Board Oversight of Trust Risk
The Board’s role is one of oversight, including oversight of the Funds' risks, rather than active management. The Trustees believe that the Board’s Committee structure enhances the Board’s ability to focus on the oversight of risk as part of its broader oversight of the Funds' affairs. While risk management is the primary responsibility of NFA and the Funds' subadvisers, the Trustees regularly receive reports from NFA, Nationwide Fund Management LLC (“NFM”), and various service providers, including the subadvisers, regarding investment risks and compliance risks. The Committee structure allows separate Committees to focus on different aspects of these risks and their potential impact on some or all of the Nationwide Funds and to discuss with NFA or the Funds’ subadvisers how they monitor and control such risks. In addition, the Officers of the Funds, all of whom are employees of NFA, including the President and Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Compliance Officer and Chief Operating Officer, report to the Board and to the Chairs of its Committees on a variety of risk-related matters, including the risks inherent in each Officer’s area of responsibility, at regular meetings of the Board and on an ad hoc basis.
The Funds have retained NFA as the Funds' investment adviser and NFM as the Funds' administrator. NFA and NFM are responsible for the day-to-day operations of the Funds. NFA has delegated the day-to-day management of the investment activities of each Fund, with the exception of the Fund-of-Funds, to one or more subadvisers. NFA and NFM are primarily
63

responsible for the Funds' operations and for supervising the services provided to the Funds by each service provider, including risk management services provided by the Funds' subadvisers, if any. The Board also meets periodically with the Trust’s Chief Compliance Officer to receive reports regarding the compliance of each Fund with the federal securities laws and the Fund’s internal compliance policies and procedures. The Board also reviews the Chief Compliance Officer’s annual report, including the Chief Compliance Officer’s compliance risk assessments for the Funds. The Board meets periodically with the portfolio managers of the Funds to receive reports regarding the management of the Funds, including each Fund’s investment risks.
Committees of the Board
The Board has three standing committees: Audit and Operations Committee, Nominating and Fund Governance Committee, and Investment Committee. The function of each Committee is oversight. In addition, each Committee may from time to time delegate certain of its functions to an ad hoc committee comprised of members of the Board that will report to the Committee or the Board with its recommendations, as determined at the time of such delegation.
The purposes of the Audit and Operations Committee are to: (a) oversee the Trust's accounting and financial reporting policies and practices, its internal controls and, as appropriate, the internal controls of certain of its service providers; it is the intention of the Board that it is management’s responsibility to maintain appropriate systems for accounting and internal control, and the independent auditors’ responsibility to plan and carry out a proper audit–the independent auditors are ultimately accountable to the Board and the Committee, as representatives of the Trust’s shareholders; (b) oversee the quality and integrity of the Trust's financial statements and the independent audit thereof, including periodic review of the performance of the independent auditors; (c) ascertain the independence of the Trust's independent auditors; (d) act as a liaison between the Trust's independent auditors and the Board; (e) approve the engagement of the Trust's independent auditors; (f) meet and consider the reports of the Trust's independent auditors; (g) oversee the Trust’s written policies and procedures adopted under Rule 38a-1 of the 1940 Act and oversee the appointment and performance of the Trust’s designated Chief Compliance Officer; (h) review information provided to the Committee regarding SEC examinations of the Trust and its service providers; (i) to review and oversee the actions of the principal underwriter and investment advisers with respect to distribution of the Nationwide Funds’ shares including the operation of the Trust’s 12b-1 Plans and Administrative Services Plans; (j) review and evaluate the transfer agency services, administrative services, custody services, and such other services as may be assigned from time to time to the Committee by the Board; (k) assist the Board in the design and oversight of the process for reviewing and evaluating payments made from the assets of any of the Funds to financial intermediaries for sub-transfer agency services, shareholder services, administrative services, and similar services; (l) assist the board in its oversight and evaluation of policies, procedures, and activities of the Trust and of service providers to the Trust relating to cybersecurity and data security; (m) review and evaluate the services received by the Trust in respect of, and the Trust’s contractual arrangements relating to, securities lending services; (n) assist the Board in its review, consideration and oversight of any credit facilities entered into for the benefit of the Trust or any of the Funds and the use thereof by the Funds, including any interfund lending facility; (o) assist the Board in its review and consideration of insurance coverages to be obtained by or for the benefit of the Trust or the Trustees of the Trust; and (p) undertake such other responsibilities as may be delegated to the Committee by the Board. The Audit and Operations Committee met five times during the past fiscal year, and currently consists of the following Trustees: Mr. Karlawish, Ms. Kosel (Chair), Ms. Petersen and Mr. Wezdenko, each of whom is not an interested person of the Trust, as defined in the 1940 Act.
The purposes of the Nominating and Fund Governance Committee are to: (a) assist the Board in its review and oversight of governance matters; (b) assist the Board with the selection and nomination of candidates to serve on the Board; (c) oversee legal counsel; (d) assist the Board in its review and oversight of shareholder communications to the Board; and (e) undertake such other responsibilities as may be delegated to the Committee by the Board. The Nominating and Fund Governance Committee met four times during the past fiscal year, and currently consists of all the Independent Trustees.
The Nominating and Fund Governance Committee has adopted procedures regarding its review of recommendations for trustee nominees, including those recommendations presented by shareholders. When considering whether to add additional or substitute trustees to the Board, the Trustees shall take into account any proposals for candidates that are properly submitted to the Trust's Secretary. Shareholders wishing to present one or more candidates for trustee for consideration may do so by submitting a signed written request to the Trust's Secretary at Attn: Secretary, Nationwide Mutual Funds, One Nationwide Plaza, Mail Code 5-02-210, Columbus, OH 43215, which includes the following information: (i) name and address of the shareholder and, if applicable, name of broker or record holder; (ii) number of shares owned; (iii) name of Fund(s) in which shares are owned; (iv) whether the proposed candidate(s) consent to being identified in any proxy statement
64

utilized in connection with the election of Trustees; (v) the name, background information, and qualifications of the proposed candidate(s); and (vi) a representation that the candidate or candidates are willing to provide additional information about themselves, including assurances as to their independence.
The purposes of the Investment Committee are to: (a) assist the Board in its review and oversight of the Funds’ performance; (b) assist the Board in the design and oversight of the process for the renewal and amendment of the Funds' investment advisory and subadvisory contracts subject to the requirements of Section 15 of the 1940 Act; (c) assist the Board in its oversight of a liquidity risk management program for the Funds pursuant to Rule 22e-4 under the 1940 Act; (d) assist the Board in its review and oversight of the valuation of the Trust’s portfolio assets; (e) assist the Board with its review and oversight of the implementation and operation of the Trust’s various policies and procedures relating to money market funds under Rule 2a-7 under the 1940 Act; (f) review and oversee the investment advisers’ brokerage practices, including the use of “soft dollars”; (g) assist the Board with its review and oversight of the implementation and operation of the Trust’s various policies and procedures relating to transactions involving affiliated persons of a Trust, or affiliated persons of such affiliated persons; (h) assist the Board in its review and oversight of proxy voting by the series of the Trust; and (i) undertake such other responsibilities as may be delegated to the Committee by the Board. The Investment Committee met four times during the past fiscal year, and currently consists of the following Trustees: Ms. Bradshaw, Mr. Davis, Ms. Jacobs and Mr. Kridler (Chair), each of whom is not an interested person of the Trust, as defined in the 1940 Act, and Ms. Koken, who is an interested person of the Trust, as defined in the 1940 Act.
Ownership of Shares of Nationwide Mutual Funds as of December 31, 2023
Name of Trustee
Dollar Range of Equity Securities and/or
Shares in the Funds
Aggregate Dollar Range of Equity Securities
and/or Shares in All Registered Investment
Companies Overseen by Trustee in Family of
Investment Companies
Independent Trustees
Kristina Bradshaw
Over $100,000
Over $100,000
Lorn C. Davis
Over $100,000
Over $100,000
Barbara I. Jacobs
Over $100,000
Over $100,000
Keith F. Karlawish
Over $100,000
Over $100,000
Carol A. Kosel
Over $100,000
Over $100,000
Douglas F. Kridler
Over $100,000
Over $100,000
Charlotte Petersen
Over $100,000
Over $100,000
David E. Wezdenko
Over $100,000
Over $100,000
Interested Trustee
M. Diane Koken
Over $100,000
Over $100,000
Ownership in the Funds' Investment Adviser1, Subadvisers2 or Distributor3 as of December 31, 2023
Trustees who are not Interested Persons (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Trust
Name of Trustee
Name of Owners and
Relationships to Trustee
Name of Company
Title of Class
of Security
Value of Securities
Percent of Class
Kristina Bradshaw
N/A
N/A
N/A
None
N/A
Lorn C. Davis
N/A
N/A
N/A
None
N/A
Barbara I. Jacobs
N/A
N/A
N/A
None
N/A
Keith F. Karlawish
N/A
N/A
N/A
None
N/A
Carol A. Kosel
N/A
N/A
N/A
None
N/A
Douglas F. Kridler
N/A
N/A
N/A
None
N/A
Charlotte Petersen
N/A
N/A
N/A
None
N/A
David E. Wezdenko
N/A
N/A
N/A
None
N/A
1
Nationwide Fund Advisors.
2
As of December 31, 2023, subadvisers to the Trust included: Amundi Asset Management US, Inc.; Bailard, Inc.; BlackRock Investment Management, LLC; Brown Capital Management, LLC; Dreyfus, a division of Mellon Investments Corporation; Geneva Capital Management LLC; Goldman Sachs Asset Management, L.P.; GQG Partners LLC; Insight North America LLC; Jacobs Levy Equity Management, Inc.; Janus Henderson Investors US LLC;
65

Loomis, Sayles & Company, L.P.; Mellon Investments Corporation; Nationwide Asset Management, LLC; Neuberger Berman Investment Advisers LLC; Newton Investment Management North America, LLC; UBS Asset Management (Americas) Inc.; WCM Investment Management; Wellington Management Company LLP; and Western Asset Management Company, LLC.
3
Nationwide Fund Distributors LLC or any company, other than an investment company, that controls a Fund’s adviser or distributor.
Compensation of Trustees
The Independent Trustees receive fees and reimbursement for expenses of attending board meetings from the Trust. The Compensation Table below sets forth the total compensation paid to the Independent Trustees, before reimbursement of any expenses incurred by them, for the fiscal year ended October 31, 2023. In addition, the Compensation Table sets forth the total compensation paid to the Independent Trustees from all the funds in the Fund Complex for the twelve months ended October 31, 2023. Trust officers receive no compensation from the Trust in their capacity as officers. The Adviser or an affiliate of the Adviser pays the fees, if any, and expenses of any Trustees who are interested persons of the Trust. Accordingly, Ms. Koken was not compensated by the funds in the Fund Complex and, therefore, is not included in the Compensation Table below.
The Trust does not maintain any pension or retirement plans for the Officers or Trustees of the Trust.
Name of Trustee
Aggregate
Compensation
from the Trust
Pension
Retirement
Benefits Accrued
as Part of Trust
Expenses
Estimated Annual
Benefits Upon
Retirement
Total Compensation
from the Fund
Complex1
Kristina Bradshaw
$81,887
N/A
N/A
$302,500
Lorn C. Davis
101,849
N/A
N/A
376,250
Barbara I. Jacobs
102,864
N/A
N/A
380,000
Keith F. Karlawish
127,227
N/A
N/A
470,000
Carol A. Kosel
108,278
N/A
N/A
400,000
Douglas F. Kridler
108,276
N/A
N/A
400,000
Charlotte Petersen
81,931
N/A
N/A
302,500
David E. Wezdenko
98,804
N/A
N/A
365,000
1
As of October 31, 2023, the Fund Complex included two trusts comprised of 117 investment company funds or series.
Each of the Trustees and officers and their families are eligible to purchase Class A shares at net asset value without any sales charge. Each Trustee is also eligible to purchase Class R6 shares at net asset value. Class R6 shares are sold without a sales charge and are not subject to Rule 12b-1 fees or administrative services fees.
Code of Ethics
Federal law requires the Trust, each of its investment advisers and subadvisers, and its principal underwriter to adopt codes of ethics which govern the personal securities transactions of their respective personnel. Accordingly, each such entity has adopted a code of ethics pursuant to which their respective personnel may invest in securities for their personal accounts (including securities that may be purchased or held by the Trust). Copies of these Codes of Ethics are on file with the SEC and are available to the public.
Proxy Voting Guidelines
Federal law requires the Trust and each of its investment advisers and subadvisers to adopt procedures for voting proxies (the “Proxy Voting Guidelines”) and to provide a summary of those Proxy Voting Guidelines used to vote the securities held by a Fund. The Funds' proxy voting policies and procedures and information regarding how the Funds voted proxies relating to portfolio securities during the most recent 12-month period ended June 30 are available without charge (i) upon request, by calling 800-848-0920, (ii) on the Funds' website at https://www.nationwide.com/personal/investing/mutual-funds/proxy-voting/, or (iii) on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov. The summary of such Proxy Voting Guidelines is attached as Appendix B to this SAI.
66

Investment Advisory and Other Services
Trust Expenses
The Trust pays, on behalf of the Funds, the compensation of the Trustees who are not interested persons (as described in the 1940 Act) of the Trust, and all expenses (other than those assumed by the Adviser), including governmental fees; interest charges; taxes; membership dues in the Investment Company Institute allocable to the Trust; investment advisory fees and any Rule 12b-1 fees; fees under the Trust’s Fund Administration and Transfer Agency Agreement, which include the expenses of calculating the Funds’ net asset values; fees and expenses of independent certified public accountants and legal counsel of the Trust and to the Independent Trustees; expenses of preparing, printing, and mailing shareholder reports, notices, proxy statements, and reports to governmental offices and commissions; expenses connected with the execution, recording, and settlement of portfolio security transactions; short sale dividend expenses; insurance premiums; administrative services fees under an Administrative Services Plan; fees and expenses of the custodian for all services to the Trust; expenses of shareholder meetings; and expenses relating to the issuance, registration, and qualification of shares of the Trust. NFA may, from time to time, agree to voluntarily or contractually waive advisory fees, and if necessary reimburse expenses, in order to limit total operating expenses for certain Funds and/or classes, as described below. These expense limitations apply to the classes described; if a particular class is not referenced, there is no expense limitation for that class.
Investment Adviser
NFA, located at One Nationwide Plaza, Mail Code 5-02-210, Columbus, OH 43215, is a wholly owned subsidiary of Nationwide Financial Services, Inc. (“NFS”), a holding company which is a direct wholly owned subsidiary of Nationwide Corporation. All of the common stock of Nationwide Corporation is held by Nationwide Mutual Insurance Company, which is a mutual company owned by its policy holders.
Under the Investment Advisory Agreement (“Agreement”) with the Trust, NFA manages the Funds in accordance with the policies and procedures established by the Board of Trustees. NFA operates primarily as a “Manager-of-Managers” under which NFA, rather than managing most Funds directly, instead oversees one or more subadvisers.
NFA provides investment management evaluation services in initially selecting and monitoring on an ongoing basis the performance of one or more subadvisers who manage the investment portfolio of a particular Fund. NFA is also authorized to select and place portfolio investments on behalf of such subadvised Funds; however, NFA does not intend to do so as a routine matter at this time. The Adviser and the Trust have received two exemptive orders from the SEC for a multi-manager structure. The first order allows the Adviser, subject to the approval of the Board of Trustees, to hire, replace or terminate a subadviser (excluding hiring a subadviser which is an affiliate of the Adviser) without the approval of shareholders. The first order also allows the Adviser to revise a subadvisory agreement with an unaffiliated subadviser with the approval of the Board of Trustees but without shareholder approval. The second order allows the aforementioned approvals to be taken at a Board of Trustees meeting held via any means of communication that allows the Trustees to hear each other simultaneously during the meeting.
If a new unaffiliated subadviser is hired for a Fund, shareholders will receive information about the new subadviser within 90 days of the change. The exemptive orders allow the Funds greater flexibility, enabling them to operate more efficiently.
All of the Funds to which this SAI relates are subadvised.
NFA pays the compensation of the officers of the Trust employed by NFA and pays the compensation and expenses of any Trustees who are interested persons of the Trust. NFA also furnishes, at its own expense, all necessary administrative services, office space, equipment, and clerical personnel for servicing the investments of the Trust and maintaining its investment advisory facilities, and executive and supervisory personnel for managing the investments and effecting the portfolio transactions of the Trust. In addition, NFA pays, out of its legitimate profits, broker-dealers, trust companies, transfer agents and other financial institutions in exchange for their selling of shares of the Trust’s series or for recordkeeping or other shareholder related services.
67

The Agreement also specifically provides that NFA, including its directors, officers, and employees, shall not be liable for any error of judgment, or mistake of law, or for any loss arising out of any investment, or for any act or omission in the execution and management of the Trust, except for willful misfeasance, bad faith, or gross negligence in the performance of its duties, or by reason of reckless disregard of its obligations and duties under the Agreement. The Agreement continues in effect for an initial period of no more than two years and thereafter shall continue automatically for successive annual periods provided such continuance is specifically approved at least annually by the Trustees, or by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Trust, and, in either case, by a majority of the Trustees who are not parties to the Agreement or interested persons of any such party. The Agreement terminates automatically in the event of its “assignment,” as defined under the 1940 Act. It may be terminated at any time as to a Fund, without penalty, by vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of that Fund, by the Board of Trustees or NFA on not more than 60 days’ written notice. The Agreement further provides that NFA may render similar services to others.
For services provided under the Agreement, NFA receives an annual fee paid monthly based on average daily net assets of the applicable Fund according to the following schedule:
Fund
Assets
Investment Advisory Fee
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
$0 up to $500 million
$500 million and more
0.55%
0.50%
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
$0 up to $500 million
$500 million and more
0.75%
0.70%
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
$0 up to $1 billion
$1 billion and more
0.75%
0.70%
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
$0 up to $500 million
$500 million up to $1 billion
$1 billion and more
0.75%
0.70%
0.65%
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
$0 up to $500 million
$500 million up to $1 billion
$1 billion up to $1.5 billion
$1.5 billion and more
0.45%
0.425%
0.40%
0.39%
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
$0 up to $5 billion
$5 billion and more
0.45%
0.425%
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund
$0 up to $1 billion
$1 billion and more
0.60%
0.575%
Nationwide Bond Fund
$0 up to $250 million
$250 million up to $1 billion
$1 billion up to $2 billion
$2 billion up to $5 billion
$5 billion and more
0.41%
0.385%
0.36%
0.335%
0.31%
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
$0 up to $1.5 billion
$1.5 billion up to $3 billion
$3 billion and more
0.185%
0.145%
0.135%
Nationwide Fund
$0 up to $250 million
$250 million up to $1 billion
$1 billion up to $2 billion
$2 billion up to $5 billion
$5 billion and more
0.54%
0.53%
0.52%
0.495%
0.47%
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
$0 up to $250 million
$250 million up to $500 million
$500 million and more
0.65%
0.60%
0.55%
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
$0 up to $250 million
$250 million up to $500 million
$500 million and more
0.84%
0.79%
0.74%
68

Fund
Assets
Investment Advisory Fee
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
$0 up to $250 million
$250 million up to $500 million
$500 million up to $1 billion
$1 billion and more
0.65%
0.60%
0.58%
0.55%
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund
$0 up to $1 billion
$1 billion up to $2 billion
$2 billion up to $5 billion
$5 billion and more
0.30%
0.28%
0.26%
0.24%
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund
Up to $1 billion
$1 billion and more
0.45%
0.42%
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
$0 up to $1 billion
$1 billion and more
0.25%
0.23%
Nationwide International Index Fund
$0 up to $1.5 billion
$1.5 billion up to $3 billion
$3 billion and more
0.245%
0.205%
0.195%
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
Up to $500 million
$500 million up to $1 billion
$1 billion and more
0.95%
0.925%
0.90%
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
$0 up to $200 million
$200 million up to $500 million
$500 million and more
0.70%
0.68%
0.65%
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
$0 up to $1 billion
$1 billion and more
0.80%
0.775%
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
$0 up to $250 million
$250 million up to $1 billion
$1 billion up to $2 billion
$2 billion up to $5 billion
$5 billion and more
0.41%
0.385%
0.36%
0.335%
0.31%
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
$0 up to $500 million
$500 million up to $1 billion
$1 billion up to $3 billion
$3 billion up to $5 billion
$5 billion up to $10 billion
$10 billion and more
0.35%
0.34%
0.325%
0.30%
0.285%
0.275%
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
$0 up to $1.5 billion
$1.5 billion up to $3 billion
$3 billion and more
0.195%
0.175%
0.165%
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
$0 up to $50 million
$50 million up to $250 million
$250 million up to $500 million
$500 million and more
0.448%
0.248%
0.198%
0.148%
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
$0 up to $1.5 billion
$1.5 billion up to $3 billion
$3 billion and more
0.125%
0.105%
0.095%
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
$0 up to $1.5 billion
$1.5 billion up to $3 billion
$3 billion and more
0.19%
0.17%
0.16%
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
$0 up to $500 million
$500 million and more
0.84%
0.79%
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
$0 up to $500 million
$500 million and more
0.75%
0.70%
69

Limitation of Fund Expenses
In the interest of limiting the expenses of the Funds, NFA may from time to time waive some, or all, of its investment advisory fee or reimburse other fees for any of the Funds. In this regard, NFA has entered into an expense limitation agreement with the Trust on behalf of certain of the Funds (the “Expense Limitation Agreement”). Pursuant to the Expense Limitation Agreement, NFA has agreed to waive or limit its fees and to assume other expenses to the extent necessary to limit the total annual operating expenses of each class of each such Fund to the limits described below. The waiver of such fees will cause the total return and yield of a Fund to be higher than they would otherwise be in the absence of such a waiver.
NFA may request and receive reimbursement from the Funds for the advisory fees waived or limited and other expenses reimbursed by NFA pursuant to the Expense Limitation Agreement at a later date when a Fund has reached a sufficient asset size to permit reimbursement to be made without causing the total annual operating expense ratio of the Fund to exceed the limits that were in the Expense Limitation Agreement at the time that NFA waived the fees or reimbursed the expenses. No reimbursement will be made to a Fund unless: (i) such Fund’s assets exceed $100 million; (ii) the total annual expense ratio of the class making such reimbursement is less than the limit set forth above; and (iii) the payment of such reimbursement is made no more than three years from the date in which the corresponding waiver or reimbursement to the Fund was made. Except as provided for in the Expense Limitation Agreement, reimbursement of amounts previously waived or assumed by NFA is not permitted.
Until at least February 28, 2026, NFA has agreed contractually to waive advisory fees and, if necessary, reimburse expenses in order to limit total annual fund operating expenses, excluding any taxes, interest, brokerage commissions and other costs incurred in connection with the purchase and sale of portfolio securities, acquired fund fees and expenses, compensation payable to parties not affiliated with NFA for the recovery of tax reclaims, short sale dividend expenses, Rule 12b-1 fees, fees paid pursuant to an Administrative Services Plan, fees paid to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (as the Trust’s sub-administrator) related to the SEC’s Financial Reporting Modernization and Liquidity Risk Management Program Rules, as provided for in Amendment No. 10 to the Sub-Administration Agreement between JPMorgan and Nationwide Fund Management LLC, dated July 1, 2018, other expenditures which are capitalized in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, expenses incurred by a Fund in connection with any merger or reorganization and may exclude other nonroutine expenses not incurred in the ordinary course of the Fund’s business, for all share classes of the following Funds of the Trust:
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund to 0.49%
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund to 1.07%
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund to 1.10%
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund to 1.05%
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund to 0.70%
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund to 0.50%
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund to 0.60%
Nationwide Bond Fund to 0.44%
Nationwide Bond Index Fund to 0.22%
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund to 0.98%
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund to 1.22%
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund to 0.80%
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund to 0.59%1
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund to 0.49%
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund to 0.30%
Nationwide International Index Fund to 0.29%
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund to 0.89%
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund to 0.72%
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund to 0.82%
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund to 0.35%
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund to 0.45%
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund to 0.30%
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund to 0.68%
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund to 0.21%
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund to 0.28%
70

Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund to 0.94%
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund to 0.80%
1In addition, with respect to the Service Class of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, effective until at least February 28, 2026, the Fund Operating Expenses including the Rule 12b-1 fees and fees paid pursuant to an Administrative Services Plan shall be limited to 0.75%.
In addition to the foregoing, until at least February 28, 2026, NFA also has agreed contractually to waive advisory fees in respect of the following Funds, equal to the amounts shown in the table below, calculated monthly based on each Fund’s average daily net assets. NFA shall not be entitled to reimbursements of amounts waived pursuant to these separate fee waiver agreements.
Name of Fund
Amount of Advisory Fee Waiver
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
0.0379% per annum
Nationwide Fund
0.045% per annum
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund
0.027% per annum
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
0.02% per annum
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
0.01% per annum
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
0.02% per annum
71

Investment Advisory Fees Paid
During the fiscal years ended October 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, the Funds listed below paid NFA fees for investment advisory services, after waivers and reimbursements,
as follows:
 
Years Ended October 31,
 
2023
2022
2021
Fund
Gross Fees
Net Fees
Gross Fees
Net Fees
Gross Fees
Net Fees
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
$837,358
$510,640
$780,527
$446,395
$848,424
$477,612
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
678,783
678,783
746,610
746,610
723,612
723,612
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
1,267,487
1,267,487
1,320,806
1,320,806
1,536,900
1,536,900
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
953,057
953,056
1,092,841
1,092,841
1,400,479
1,400,479
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
2,566,093
2,566,093
3,202,990
2,995,605
4,864,335
4,742,008
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
5,148,745
4,747,656
5,865,291
5,440,989
6,024,648
5,478,027
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund
3,419,886
3,195,632
3,562,934
3,248,955
3,428,972
3,061,617
Nationwide Bond Fund
1,129,816
941,013
1,240,758
997,030
1,408,169
1,149,658
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
487,904
260,495
610,119
407,289
1,392,340
1,241,829
Nationwide Fund
5,985,162
5,985,162
6,256,792
5,726,175
6,602,066
6,041,235
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
1,431,858
1,431,858
2,086,122
2,086,122
3,214,671
3,214,671
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
10,644,579
10,644,579
10,797,251
10,797,251
12,755,203
12,755,203
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
1,035,126
1,006,408
406,935
307,312
448,328
298,014
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund
1,674,460
1,674,317
1,646,946
675,784
1,788,897
0
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund1
423,010
320,305
323,225
129,637
204,019
11,593
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
494,969
384,077
583,368
447,986
660,807
504,054
Nationwide International Index Fund
2,457,552
1,993,957
2,756,286
2,416,071
3,335,995
3,335,995
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
5,619,760
4,822,449
5,881,513
5,473,783
6,473,985
6,332,896
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
836,810
595,932
1,636,236
1,383,740
2,073,039
1,823,429
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
1,749,170
1,554,547
2,668,768
2,512,234
3,153,432
3,019,120
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
1,786,272
1,786,272
2,179,994
2,179,994
2,393,476
2,393,476
Nationwide Loomis Short-Term Bond Fund
506,244
433,914
622,741
536,926
723,997
627,811
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
1,283,222
1,283,222
1,446,520
1,372,322
1,662,012
1,576,775
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
1,306,683
1,306,682
1,435,744
1,435,744
1,588,954
1,588,954
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
1,505,829
1,505,830
1,513,532
1,513,532
1,547,800
1,547,800
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
425,015
326,164
468,664
244,462
542,059
430,217
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
1,183,054
1,162,061
1,520,997
1,496,411
2,471,895
2,469,583
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
1,441,946
1,302,887
1,480,476
1,330,780
1,386,702
1,192,454
1 Fund commenced operations on January 26, 2021.
72

Subadvisers
The subadvisers for the Funds are as follows:
Fund
Subadviser
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
Amundi Asset Management US, Inc.
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
Bailard, Inc.
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
Bailard, Inc.
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
Bailard, Inc.
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
Insight North America LLC
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
Newton Investment Management North America, LLC
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income
Fund
Newton Investment Management North America, LLC
Nationwide Bond Fund
Nationwide Asset Management, LLC
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
BlackRock Investment Management, LLC
Nationwide Fund
Wellington Management Company LLP
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
Geneva Capital Management LLC
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
Geneva Capital Management LLC
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
UBS Asset Management (Americas) Inc.
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund
Dreyfus, a division of Mellon Investments Corporation
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund
GQG Partners LLC
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
Nationwide Asset Management, LLC
Nationwide International Index Fund
BlackRock Investment Management, LLC
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
Wellington Management Company LLP
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
Janus Henderson Investors US LLC
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
Loomis, Sayles & Company, L.P.
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
Loomis, Sayles & Company, L.P.
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
Loomis, Sayles & Company, L.P.
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
BlackRock Investment Management, LLC
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
Mellon Investments Corporation
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
BlackRock Investment Management, LLC
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
BlackRock Investment Management, LLC
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
Brown Capital Management, LLC
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
WCM Investment Management, LLC
Amundi Asset Management US, Inc. (“Amundi US”) is located at 60 State Street, Boston, Massachusetts, 02109. Amundi US is a Delaware corporation and is registered with the SEC as an investment adviser. Amundi US is a wholly owned subsidiary of Amundi US, Inc. and an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of Amundi. Amundi, one of the world’s largest asset managers, is based in Paris, France.
Bailard, Inc. (“Bailard”), located at 950 Tower Lane, Suite 1900, Foster City, CA 94404, is organized as a California corporation. As of December 31, 2023, Bailard had approximately $5.8 billion in assets under management. Bailard has been providing investment management services since 1972.
BlackRock Investment Management, LLC (“BlackRock”), located at 1 University Square Drive, Princeton, New Jersey 08540-6455, is a wholly owned indirect subsidiary of BlackRock, Inc., a Delaware corporation. BlackRock was organized in 1999 and is a registered investment adviser and a registered commodity pool operator.
Brown Capital Management, LLC (“Brown Capital”), located at 1201 North Calvert Street, Baltimore, Maryland 21202, has been an investment adviser since 1983.
73

Dreyfus (“Dreyfus”), a division of Mellon Investments Corporation (“MIC”), a U.S.-registered investment adviser organized under the laws of the State of Delaware, is located at 201 Washington Street, Boston, MA 02108. MIC is a wholly owned subsidiary of MBC Investments Corporation, which in turn is a wholly owned subsidiary of The Bank of New York Mellon Corporation. Dreyfus offers money market funds and strategies to U.S. and non-U.S. investors.
Geneva Capital Management LLC (“Geneva”), located at 411 E. Wisconsin Ave., Suite 2320, Milwaukee, WI 53202, is a majority employee-owned Delaware limited liability company. As of December 31, 2023, Geneva had approximately $5.8 billion in assets under management. Geneva has been providing investment management services since 1987.
GQG Partners LLC (“GQG”), located at 450 East Las Olas Boulevard, Suite 750, Fort Lauderdale, Florida 33301, is a Delaware limited liability company founded in 2016 and is an SEC registered investment adviser. GQG is a wholly owned subsidiary of GQG Partners Inc., a Delaware corporation that is listed on the Australian Securities Exchange. The majority owner of GQG Partners Inc. is QVFT, LLC, which is controlled by Rajiv Jain, GQG’s Chairman and Chief Investment Officer. GQG provides investment management services for institutions, mutual funds and other investors using emerging markets, global, international and US equity investment strategies.
Insight North America LLC (“Insight”) is located at 200 Park Avenue, New York, NY 10166. Insight is a New York limited liability company formed as a subsidiary of The Bank of New York Mellon Corporation in 2004 and has been registered as an investment adviser since 2009.
Janus Henderson Investors US LLC (“Janus”) is located at 151 Detroit Street, Denver, CO 80206. Janus is a registered investment adviser and a wholly-owned subsidiary of Janus Henderson Group plc, which conducts business as Janus Henderson Investors. Janus, through its predecessors, has provided investment management services since 1969.
Loomis, Sayles & Company, L.P. (“Loomis Sayles”), located at One Financial Center, Boston, Massachusetts 02111, was founded in 1926 and is one of the oldest investment advisory firms in the United States with over $335.2 billion in assets under management as of December 31, 2023. Loomis Sayles is a Delaware limited partnership. Loomis Sayles’ general partner, Loomis, Sayles & Company, Inc., is directly owned by Natixis Investment Managers, LLC (“Natixis LLC”). Natixis LLC is an indirect subsidiary of Natixis Investment Managers, an international asset management group based in Paris, France, that is in turn owned by Natixis, a French investment banking and financial services firm. Natixis is wholly-owned by Groupe BPCE, France’s second largest banking group. Groupe BPCE is owned by banks comprising two autonomous and complementary retail banking networks consisting of the Caisse d’Epargne regional savings banks and the Banque Populaire regional cooperative banks. The registered address of Natixis is 30, avenue Pierre Mendès France, 75013 Paris, France. The registered address of Groupe BPCE is 50, avenue Pierre Mendès France, 75013 Paris, France.
Mellon Investments Corporation (“Mellon”), is located at BNY Mellon Center, 201 Washington Street, Boston, MA 02108. Mellon was founded in 1933 and is an indirect subsidiary of BNY Mellon Corporation.
Nationwide Asset Management, LLC (“NWAM”), located at One Nationwide Plaza, Mail Code 1-20-19, Columbus, OH 43215, provides investment advisory services to registered investment companies and other types of accounts, such as institutional separate accounts. NWAM was organized in 2007, in part, to serve as investment subadviser for fixed-income funds. NWAM is a wholly owned subsidiary of Nationwide Mutual Insurance Company, and thus an affiliate of NFA.
Newton Investment Management North America, LLC (“NIMNA”) is located at BNY Mellon Center, 201 Washington Street, Boston, MA 02108. NIMNA is a Delaware limited liability company formed as an indirect subsidiary of The Bank of New York Mellon Corporation in 2021 and is registered as an investment adviser.
UBS Asset Management (Americas) Inc. (“UBS AM”) is located at 787 Seventh Avenue, New York, NY 10019. UBS AM is an indirect asset management subsidiary of UBS Group AG (“UBS”) and a member of the UBS Asset Management Division. UBS, with headquarters in Zurich, Switzerland, is an internationally diversified organization, with operations in many areas of the financial services industry.
WCM Investment Management, LLC (“WCM”) is a Delaware limited liability company located at 281 Brooks Street, Laguna Beach, California 92651. WCM is independently managed by active employees.
74

Wellington Management Company LLP (“Wellington Management”) is a Delaware limited liability partnership with principal offices at 280 Congress Street, Boston, Massachusetts 02210. Wellington Management is a professional investment counseling firm which provides investment services to investment companies, employee benefit plans, endowments, foundations and other institutions. Wellington Management and its predecessor organizations have provided investment advisory services for over 80 years. Wellington Management is owned by the partners of Wellington Management Group LLP, a Massachusetts limited liability partnership. As of December 31, 2023, Wellington Management and its investment advisory affiliates had investment management authority with respect to approximately $1.2 trillion in assets.
Subject to oversight by NFA and the Board of Trustees, each of the subadvisers will manage all or a portion of the assets of the Funds listed above in accordance with each Fund’s investment objectives and policies. Each subadviser makes investment decisions for the Fund and, in connection with such investment decisions, places purchase and sell orders for securities. For the investment management services they provide to the Funds, the subadvisers receive annual fees from NFA, calculated at an annual rate based on the average daily net assets of the Funds.
Each subadviser provides investment advisory services to one or more Funds pursuant to a Subadvisory Agreement. Each of the Subadvisory Agreements specifically provides that the subadviser shall not be liable for any error of judgment, or mistake of law, or for any loss arising out of any investment, or for any act or omission in the execution and management of the Fund, except for willful misfeasance, bad faith, or gross negligence in the performance of its duties, or by reason of reckless disregard of its obligations and duties under such agreement.
After an initial period of not more than two years, each Subadvisory Agreement must be approved each year by the Trust’s Board of Trustees or by shareholders in order to continue. Subadvisory Agreements entered into with the Adviser prior to November 13, 2017, may be terminated, at any time, without penalty, by vote of a majority of the Trust’s Board of Trustees, by “vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities” of the Fund (as defined in the 1940 Act), by the Adviser or by the applicable subadviser upon not more than 60 days’ written notice. Except as previously noted, Subadvisory Agreements entered into on or after November 13, 2017, may be terminated, at any time, without penalty, by vote of a majority of the Trust’s Board of Trustees, by “vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities” of the Fund (as defined in the 1940 Act), or by the Adviser, in each case, upon not more than 60 days’ written notice to the subadviser, or by the subadviser upon not less than 120 days’ written notice to the Adviser and the Trust. Each Subadvisory Agreement terminates automatically if it is assigned.
Subadvisory Fees Paid
During the fiscal years ended October 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, NFA paid to the subadvisers of the Funds listed below, the following amounts:
 
Fiscal Year Ended October 31,
Fund
2023
2022
2021
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
$373,541
$345,541
$369,374
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
339,391
373,304
361,805
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
633,742
660,401
768,448
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
476,523
546,419
700,238
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
809,417
1,195,040
1,940,012
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
2,047,393
2,311,470
2,395,313
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund
1,709,938
1,781,462
1,714,482
Nationwide Bond Fund
409,030
445,050
499,386
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
53,105
62,108
122,213
Nationwide Fund
1,840,402
1,918,992
2,019,457
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
660,854
960,909
1,577,338
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
6,432,484
6,525,459
7,715,951
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
414,049
213,223
239,109
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund
215,604
213,207
232,463
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund1
265,478
201,118
126,946
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
148,491
175,011
198,243
75

 
Fiscal Year Ended October 31,
Fund
2023
2022
2021
Nationwide International Index Fund
303,119
329,872
390,212
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
2,970,142
3,281,075
3,728,451
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
417,412
784,590
1,114,501
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
929,247
1,468,157
1,773,806
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
622,164
749,995
819,289
Nationwide Loomis Short-Term Bond Fund
127,092
177,927
206,857
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
112,910
125,795
140,502
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
168,555
194,689
225,846
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
99,330
99,796
96,560
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
65,505
71,692
80,517
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
774,582
995,895
1,618,532
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
865,165
888,283
832,016
1 Fund commenced operations on January 26, 2021.
Manager-of-Managers Structure
NFA and the Trust have received from the SEC two exemptive orders for a manager-of-managers structure. The first order allows NFA, subject to the approval of the Board of Trustees, to hire, replace or terminate unaffiliated subadvisers without the approval of shareholders. The first order also allows NFA to revise a subadvisory agreement with an unaffiliated subadviser without shareholder approval. The second order allows the aforementioned approvals to be taken at a Board of Trustees meeting held via any means of communication that allows the Trustees to hear each other simultaneously during the meeting. If a new unaffiliated subadviser is hired, the change will be communicated to shareholders within 90 days of such change, and all changes are subject to approval by the Board of Trustees, including a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons of the Trust or NFA. The orders are intended to facilitate the efficient operation of the Funds and afford the Trust increased management flexibility.
Pursuant to the exemptive orders, NFA monitors and evaluates any subadvisers, which includes performing initial due diligence on prospective subadvisers for the Funds and thereafter monitoring the performance of the subadvisers through quantitative and qualitative analysis as well as periodic in-person, telephonic and written consultations with the subadvisers. NFA has responsibility for communicating performance expectations and evaluations to the subadviser and ultimately recommending to the Board of Trustees whether a subadviser’s contract should be renewed, modified or terminated; however, NFA does not expect to recommend changes of subadvisers frequently. NFA will regularly provide written reports to the Board of Trustees regarding the results of their evaluation and monitoring functions. Although NFA will monitor the performance of the subadvisers, there is no certainty that the subadvisers or the Funds will obtain favorable results at any given time.
Portfolio Managers
Appendix C contains the following information regarding the portfolio managers identified in the Funds' Prospectuses: (i) the dollar range of the portfolio manager’s investments in each Fund; (ii) a description of the portfolio manager’s compensation structure; and (iii) information regarding other accounts managed by the portfolio manager and potential conflicts of interest that might arise from the management of multiple accounts.
Distributor
Nationwide Fund Distributors LLC (“NFD” or the “Distributor”), One Nationwide Plaza, Mail Code 5-02-210, Columbus, OH 43215, serves as underwriter for each Fund in the continuous distribution of its shares pursuant to an Underwriting Agreement dated May 1, 2007 (the “Underwriting Agreement”). Unless otherwise terminated, the Underwriting Agreement will continue for an initial period of two years and from year to year thereafter for successive annual periods, if, as to each Fund, such continuance is approved at least annually by (i) the Board of Trustees or by the vote of a majority of the outstanding shares of the Fund, and (ii) the vote of a majority of the Trustees of the Trust who are not parties to the Underwriting Agreement or interested persons (as defined in the 1940 Act) of any party to the Underwriting
76

Agreement, cast in person at a meeting called for the purpose of voting on such approval. The Underwriting Agreement may be terminated in the event of any assignment, as defined in the 1940 Act. NFD is a wholly owned subsidiary of NFS Distributors, Inc., which in turn is a wholly owned subsidiary of NFS. The following entities or people are affiliates of the Trust and are also affiliates of NFD:
Nationwide Fund Advisors
Nationwide Fund Management LLC
Nationwide Life Insurance Company
Nationwide Life and Annuity Insurance Company
Jefferson National Life Insurance Company
Jefferson National Life Insurance Company of New York
Nationwide Financial Services, Inc.
Nationwide Corporation
Nationwide Mutual Insurance Company
Christopher Graham
Kevin Grether
M. Diane Koken
Kevin T. Jestice
Lee T. Cummings
Stephen R. Rimes
David Majewski
Benjamin Hoecherl
In its capacity as Distributor, NFD solicits orders for the sale of shares, advertises and pays the costs of distributions, advertising, office space and the personnel involved in such activities. NFD receives no compensation under the Underwriting Agreement with the Trust, but may retain all or a portion of the 12b-1 fee, if any, imposed on sales of shares of each Fund.
The table below sets forth the aggregate amount of underwriting commissions received (which includes front-end sales charges and contingent deferred sales charges) by the Funds’ Distributor from the sale of fund shares and the amounts retained by the Fund’s Distributor after reallowances to dealers for the Funds listed below for the fiscal years ended October 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021:
 
Fiscal Year Ended October 31,
 
2023
2022
2021
Fund
Aggregate
Amount
of
Underwriting
Commissions
Amount
Retained
by
Distributor
Aggregate
Amount of
Underwriting
Commissions
Amount
Retained by
Distributor
Aggregate
Amount
of
Underwriting
Commissions
Amount
Retained by
Distributor
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income
Fund
$10,568
$1,667
$3,222
$345
$2,371
$347
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value
Fund
8,744
1,305
14,964
2,145
1,536
203
Nationwide Bailard International
Equities Fund
2,399
312
1,330
230
2,879
411
Nationwide Bailard Technology &
Science Fund
7,564
592
4,996
718
16,127
2,326
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus
Bond ESG Fund
2,549
310
5,092
719
4,791
622
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic
U.S. Core Fund
71,163
10,394
77,852
11,945
162,898
23,198
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic
U.S. Equity Income Fund
7,103
1,021
3,682
554
1,588
235
Nationwide Bond Fund
355
48
644
90
2,019
394
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
578
60
404
66
951
117
77

 
Fiscal Year Ended October 31,
 
2023
2022
2021
Fund
Aggregate
Amount
of
Underwriting
Commissions
Amount
Retained
by
Distributor
Aggregate
Amount of
Underwriting
Commissions
Amount
Retained by
Distributor
Aggregate
Amount
of
Underwriting
Commissions
Amount
Retained by
Distributor
Nationwide Fund
33,257
4,903
30,944
4,245
42,763
5,882
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth
Fund
12,054
1,756
19,748
2,849
23,413
3,418
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap
Growth Fund
23,685
3,641
11,318
1,668
29,982
5,596
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity
Fund
1,135
188
392
146
3,894
576
Nationwide Government Money
Market Fund
-
-
-
-
-
-
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity
Fund1
2,985
460
3,026
446
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Inflation-Protected
Securities Fund
1,559
252
4,368
740
4,192
291
Nationwide International Index Fund
679
93
536
76
1,213
172
Nationwide International Small Cap
Fund
126
16
231
30
1,760
255
Nationwide Janus Henderson
Overseas Fund
1,475
197
1,506
212
20,272
2,790
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth
Fund
12,392
1,653
2,443
366
7,180
1,067
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
175
43
1,398
197
6,302
413
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond
Fund
1,726
203
637
112
2,646
330
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index
Fund
8,250
1,158
10,145
1,477
4,912
703
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100
Index Fund
138,096
19,739
112,324
15,898
118,576
16,799
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
48,154
6,633
45,201
6,588
67,598
9,476
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
5,957
856
6,885
1,075
5,370
707
Nationwide Small Company Growth
Fund
929
120
1,033
144
4,356
612
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap
Fund
4,650
633
2,742
393
9,155
1,306
1 Fund commenced operations on January 26, 2021.
The amount of front-end sales load that NFD reallows to dealers with respect to Class A shares of each Fund, as a percentage of the offering price of such Class A shares, appears under “Additional Information on Purchases and Sales Class A Sales Charges.”
Distribution Plan
The Trust has adopted a Distribution Plan under Rule 12b-1 (“Rule 12b-1 Plan”) of the 1940 Act with respect to certain classes of shares. The Rule 12b-1 Plan permits the Funds to compensate NFD, as the Funds' principal underwriter, for expenses associated with the distribution of certain classes of shares of the Funds. Under the Rule 12b-1 Plan, NFD is paid an annual fee in the following amounts:
0.25% of the average daily net assets of Class A shares of each applicable Fund (distribution or service fee);
78

0.50% of the average daily net assets of the Class R shares of each applicable Fund (0.25% of which will be a distribution fee and 0.25% of which will be considered a service fee);
0.15% of the average daily net assets of Service Class shares of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund and Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund (distribution or service fee);
0.10% of the average daily net assets of Class K shares of the Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund (distribution or service fee).
The table below sets forth the distribution fees paid to the Fund’s Distributor under the Rule 12b-1 Plan from the following Funds for the fiscal year ended October 31, 2023:
Fund
Class A
Class R
Service Class
Class K
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
$19,434
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
1,956
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
8,735
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
11,686
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
28,874
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
129,533
$5,229
N/A
N/A
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund
3,408
N/A
N/A
$566,278
Nationwide Bond Fund
19,923
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
595,494
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Fund
412,565
154
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
198,645
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
200,204
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
91,631
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund
N/A
N/A
$2,512
N/A
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund
40,843
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
24,207
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide International Index Fund
747,929
132,088
N/A
N/A
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
766
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
3,050
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
14,268
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
25,152
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
44,716
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
552,018
88,771
N/A
N/A
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
758,046
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
302,621
737,079
347,055
N/A
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
341,886
112,360
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
6,390
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
31,402
N/A
N/A
N/A
The following expenditures were made during the fiscal year ended October 31, 2023, using the 12b-1 fees received by NFD with respect to the Funds listed below:
Fund
Prospectus
Printing &
Mailing1
Distributor
Compensation
& Costs1
Broker-Dealer
Compensation
& Costs
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
$0
$(2,308)
$21,742
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
0
103
1,853
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
0
614
8,121
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
0
1,896
9,790
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
0
1,939
26,935
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
0
9,886
124,876
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund
0
384,072
185,614
Nationwide Bond Fund
0
1,578
18,345
79

Fund
Prospectus
Printing &
Mailing1
Distributor
Compensation
& Costs1
Broker-Dealer
Compensation
& Costs
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
0
77
595,418
Nationwide Fund
0
49,855
362,864
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
0
8,116
190,529
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
0
(4,449)
204,653
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
0
6,539
85,092
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund
0
(1,990)
4,502
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund
0
6,903
33,940
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
0
1,177
23,030
Nationwide International Index Fund
0
1,924
878,092
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
0
(1,443)
2,209
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
0
134
2,917
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
0
288
13,981
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
0
4,552
20,600
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
0
966
43,751
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
0
4,223
636,566
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
0
45,109
712,937
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
0
9,826
1,376,929
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
0
1,217
453,029
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
0
387
6,003
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
0
1,651
29,751
1
Printing and mailing of prospectuses to other than current Fund shareholders.
As required by Rule 12b-1, the Rule 12b-1 Plan was approved by the Board of Trustees, including a majority of the Trustees who are not interested persons of the Trust and who have no direct or indirect financial interest in the operation of the Rule 12b-1 Plan (the “12b-1 Independent Trustees”). The Trust’s current Rule 12b-1 Plan was initially approved by the Board of Trustees on May 1, 2007, and is amended from time to time upon approval by the Board of Trustees. The Rule 12b-1 Plan may be terminated as to a class of a Fund by vote of a majority of the 12b-1 Independent Trustees, or by vote of a majority of the outstanding shares of that class. Any change in the Rule 12b-1 Plan that would materially increase the distribution cost to a class requires shareholder approval. The Trustees review quarterly a written report of such costs and the purposes for which such costs have been incurred. The Rule 12b-1 Plan may be amended by vote of the Trustees, including a majority of the 12b-1 Independent Trustees, cast in person at a meeting called for that purpose. For so long as the Rule 12b-1 Plan is in effect, selection and nomination of those Trustees who are not interested persons of the Trust shall be committed to the discretion of such disinterested persons. All agreements with any person relating to the implementation of the Rule 12b-1 Plan may be terminated at any time on 60 days’ written notice without payment of any penalty, by vote of a majority of the 12b-1 Independent Trustees or by a vote of the majority of the outstanding shares of the applicable class. The Rule 12b-1 Plan will continue in effect for successive one-year periods, provided that each such continuance is specifically approved (i) by the vote of a majority of the 12b-1 Independent Trustees, and (ii) by a vote of a majority of the entire Board of Trustees cast in person at a meeting called for that purpose. The Board of Trustees has a duty to request and evaluate such information as may be reasonably necessary for it to make an informed determination of whether the Rule 12b-1 Plan should be implemented or continued. In addition, the Trustees in approving the Rule 12b-1 Plan as to a Fund must determine that there is a reasonable likelihood that the Rule 12b-1 Plan will benefit such Fund and its shareholders.
NFD has entered into, and will enter into, from time to time, agreements with selected dealers pursuant to which such dealers will provide certain services in connection with the distribution of a Fund’s shares including, but not limited to, those discussed above. NFD, or an affiliate of NFD, pays additional amounts from its own resources to dealers or other financial intermediaries, including its affiliate, NFS or its subsidiaries, for aid in distribution or for aid in providing administrative services to shareholders.
80

A Fund may not recoup the amount of unreimbursed expenses in a subsequent fiscal year and does not generally participate in joint distribution activities with other Nationwide Funds. To the extent that certain Nationwide Funds utilize the remaining Rule 12b-1 fees not allocated to “Broker-Dealer Compensation and Costs” or “Printing and Mailing” (as shown in the table above) of a prospectus which covers multiple Funds, such other Funds may benefit indirectly from the distribution of the Fund paying the Rule 12b-1 fees.
Administrative Services Plan
Under the terms of an Administrative Services Plan, Nationwide Fund Management LLC is permitted to enter into, on behalf of the Trust, Servicing Agreements with servicing organizations, such as broker-dealers, insurance companies and other financial institutions, who agree to provide certain administrative support services for the Funds. Such administrative support services include, but are not limited to, the following: establishing and maintaining shareholder accounts, processing purchase and redemption transactions, arranging for bank wires, performing shareholder sub-accounting, answering inquiries regarding the Funds, providing periodic statements, showing the account balance for beneficial owners or for plan participants or contract holders of insurance company separate accounts, transmitting proxy statements, periodic reports, updated prospectuses and other communications to shareholders and, with respect to meetings of shareholders, collecting, tabulating and forwarding to the Trust executed proxies and obtaining such other information and performing such other services as may reasonably be required. With respect to the Class R shares, these types of administrative support services will be exclusively provided for retirement plans and their plan participants.
As authorized by the particular Administrative Services Plan, the Trust has entered into Servicing Agreements for the Funds pursuant to which NFS has agreed to provide certain administrative support services in connection with the applicable Fund shares held beneficially by its customers. NFS is a wholly owned subsidiary of Nationwide Corporation, and is the parent company of NFA, and the indirect parent company of Nationwide Fund Management LLC. In consideration for providing administrative support services, NFS and other entities with which the Trust or its agent may enter into Servicing Agreements will receive a fee, computed at the annual rate of up to a) 0.25% of the average daily net assets of the Class A Shares of the Funds; b) 0.25% of the average daily net assets of the Class R Shares of the Funds; c) 0.25% of the average daily net assets of the Service Class Shares of the Funds; d) 0.25% of the average daily net assets of the Institutional Service Class Shares of the Funds; e) 0.25% of the average daily net assets of the Investor Shares of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund; and f) 0.10% of the average daily net assets of the Eagle Class Shares of the Funds. Many intermediaries do not charge the maximum permitted fee or even a portion thereof and the Board of Trustees has implemented limits on the amounts of payments under the Plan for certain types of shareholder accounts.
During the fiscal years ended October 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, NFS and its affiliates received $5,970,528, $6,149,125, and $7,083,708, respectively, in administrative services fees from the Funds.
Fund Administration and Transfer Agency Services
Under the terms of the Joint Fund Administration and Transfer Agency Agreement (the “Joint Administration Agreement”) dated May 1, 2010, Nationwide Fund Management LLC (“NFM”), an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of NFS, provides various administration and accounting services to the Trust and Nationwide Variable Insurance Trust (another trust also advised by NFA), including daily valuation of the Funds' shares, preparation of financial statements, tax returns, and regulatory reports, and presentation of quarterly reports to the Board of Trustees. NFM also serves as transfer agent and dividend disbursing agent for the Funds. NFM is located at One Nationwide Plaza, Mail Code 5-02-210, Columbus, OH 43215. Under the Joint Administration Agreement, NFM is paid an annual fee for fund administration and transfer agency services based on the sum of the following: (i) the amount payable by NFM to J.P. Morgan Chase Bank, N.A. (“JPMorgan”) under the Sub-Administration Agreement between NFM and JPMorgan (see “Sub-Administration” below); and (ii) the amount payable by NFM to U.S. Bancorp Fund Services, LLC dba U.S. Bank Global Fund Services (“US Bancorp”) under the Sub-Transfer Agent Servicing Agreement between NFM and US Bancorp (see “Sub-Transfer Agency” below); and (iii) a percentage of the combined average daily net assets of the Trust and Nationwide Variable Insurance Trust. In addition, the Trust also pays out-of-pocket expenses reasonably incurred by NFM in providing services to the Funds and Trust, including, but not limited to, the cost of pricing services that NFM utilizes.
81

During the fiscal years ended October 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, NFM earned fund administration and transfer agency fees, including reimbursement for payment of networking fees, from the Funds listed below, as follows:
 
Fiscal Year Ended October 31,
Fund
2023
2022
2021
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
$84,176
$100,474
$125,617
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
61,997
85,318
113,690
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
78,920
104,048
137,396
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
70,566
96,531
133,925
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
194,616
239,678
370,054
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
341,043
401,928
426,839
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund
177,781
210,767
220,178
Nationwide Bond Fund
112,625
138,155
170,229
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
107,916
128,079
282,997
Nationwide Fund
313,400
364,747
402,290
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
91,941
139,454
199,445
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
381,502
430,822
512,035
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
70,187
78,853
103,391
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund
173,959
191,076
221,644
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund1
46,081
83,324
51,176
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
86,503
117,295
147,293
Nationwide International Index Fund
298,439
354,359
429,869
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
200,337
224,910
244,490
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
81,007
117,853
156,519
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
104,557
142,001
178,534
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
154,546
198,370
228,051
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
73,476
104,139
136,403
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
206,597
251,796
293,659
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
174,706
226,751
266,031
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
352,078
373,167
402,183
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
106,991
121,913
155,617
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
71,937
108,483
152,208
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
86,579
108,973
131,664
1 Fund commenced operations on January 26, 2021.
Securities Lending Agent
The Board has approved certain Funds’ participation in a securities lending program. Under the securities lending program, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. served as the Funds’ securities lending agent (the “Securities Lending Agent”) during the fiscal year ended October 31, 2023.
82

For the fiscal year ended October 31, 2023, the income earned by those Funds that engaged in securities lending, as well as the fees and/or compensation earned by such Funds (in dollars) pursuant to a securities lending agreement between the Trust with respect to the Funds and the Securities Lending Agent, were as follows:
Fund
Gross
Income
from
Securities
Lending
Activities
Fees
Paid to
Securities
Lending
Agent
from
Revenue
Split
Fees Paid
for Cash
Collateral
Management
Services
(including
fees deducted
from a pooled
cash collateral
reinvestment
vehicle) not
included in
Revenue Split
Rebates
Paid to
Borrowers
Aggregate
Fees/
Compensation
for Securities
Lending
Activities
Net
Income
from
Securities
Lending
Activities
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
$203,657
$(2,777)
$-
$(175,855)
$(178,632)
$25,025
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
93,508
(2,595)
-
(67,386)
(69,981)
23,527
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
78,520
(2,562)
-
(52,883)
(55,445)
23,075
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
14,949
(1,001)
-
(4,928)
(5,929)
9,020
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG
Fund
347,870
(4,820)
-
(299,629)
(304,449)
43,421
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core
Fund
100,647
(5,254)
-
(47,818)
(53,072)
47,575
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity
Income Fund
157,974
(11,243)
-
(45,514)
(56,757)
101,217
Nationwide Bond Fund
111,919
(1,611)
-
(95,784)
(97,395)
14,524
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
106,756
(1,972)
-
(86,899)
(88,871)
17,885
Nationwide Fund
208,153
(6,758)
-
(140,492)
(147,250)
60,903
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
51,239
(1,653)
-
(34,687)
(36,340)
14,899
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
240,402
(21,010)
-
(30,139)
(51,149)
189,253
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
95,002
(5,558)
-
(39,387)
(44,945)
50,057
Nationwide GQQ US Quality Equity Fund
37,318
(1,244)
-
(24,845)
(26,089)
11,229
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
12,572
(16)
-
(12,412)
(12,428)
144
Nationwide International Index Fund
351,662
(15,176)
-
(199,788)
(214,964)
136,698
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
514,207
(12,547)
-
(388,607)
(401,154)
113,053
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
28,995
(558)
-
(23,418)
(23,976)
5,019
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
144,231
(3,843)
-
(105,745)
(109,588)
34,643
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
246,398
(3,406)
-
(212,306)
(215,712)
30,686
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
72,854
(966)
-
(63,176)
(64,142)
8,712
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
457,324
(22,991)
-
(227,100)
(250,091)
207,233
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
181,489
(2,477)
-
(156,687)
(159,164)
22,325
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
102,012
(5,550)
-
(46,279)
(51,829)
50,183
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
604,709
(32,696)
-
(275,664)
(308,360)
296,349
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
157,411
(3,201)
-
(125,337)
(128,538)
28,873
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
154,538
(2,989)
-
(124,571)
(127,560)
26,978
The Funds paid no administrative, indemnification or other fees not included in the revenue split with the Securities Lending Agent.
For the fiscal year ended October 31, 2023, the Securities Lending Agent performed various services related to securities lending, including the following:
lending a Fund’s portfolio securities to institutions that are approved borrowers;
determining whether a loan of a portfolio security shall be made and negotiating and establishing the terms and conditions of the loan with the borrower;
ensuring that all dividends and other distributions paid with respect to loaned securities are credited to the applicable Fund’s account;
83

receiving and holding, on behalf of a Fund, or transferring to a Fund’s custodial account, collateral from borrowers to secure obligations of borrowers with respect to any loan of available portfolio securities;
marking-to-market each business day the market value of securities loaned relative to the market value of the collateral posted by the borrowers;
obtaining additional collateral, to the extent necessary, in order to maintain the value of collateral at the levels required by the Securities Lending Agency Agreement, relative to the market value of securities loaned;
at the termination of a loan, returning the collateral to the borrower upon the return of the loaned securities;
investing cash collateral in permitted investments as directed by the Funds; and
maintaining records relating to the Funds’ securities lending activities and providing the Funds monthly statements describing, among other things, the loans made during the period, the income derived from the loans (or losses incurred) and the amounts of any fees or payments paid with respect to each loan.
Sub-Administration
NFM has entered into a Sub-Administration Agreement with JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., dated May 22, 2009, to provide certain fund sub-administration services for each Fund. NFM pays JPMorgan a fee for these services.
Sub-Transfer Agency
NFM has entered into a Sub-Transfer Agent Servicing Agreement with U.S. Bancorp Fund Services, LLC dba U.S. Bank Global Fund Services, dated September 1, 2012, to provide certain sub-transfer agency services for each Fund. NFM pays US Bancorp a fee for these services.
Custodian
JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., 383 Madison Avenue, Floor 11, New York, NY 10179, is the custodian for the Funds and makes all receipts and disbursements under a Global Custody Agreement. The custodian performs no managerial or policy-making functions for the Funds.
Legal Counsel
Stradley Ronon Stevens & Young, LLP, 2000 K Street, N.W., Suite 700, Washington, D.C. 20006-1871, serves as the Trust’s legal counsel.
Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
[____________], serves as the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm for the Trust.
Brokerage Allocation
NFA or a subadviser is responsible for decisions to buy and sell securities and other investments for the Funds, the selection of brokers and dealers to effect the transactions and the negotiation of brokerage commissions, if any. In transactions on stock and commodity exchanges in the United States, these commissions are negotiated, whereas on foreign stock and commodity exchanges these commissions are generally fixed and are generally higher than brokerage commissions in the United States. In the case of securities or derivatives traded on the over-the-counter markets or for securities traded on a principal basis, there is generally no commission, but the price includes a spread between the dealer’s purchase and sale price. This spread is the dealer’s profit. Bilaterally negotiated derivatives may include a fee payable to a Fund’s counterparty. In underwritten offerings, the price includes a disclosed, fixed commission or discount. Most short-term obligations are normally traded on a “principal” rather than agency basis. This may be done through a dealer (e.g., a securities firm or bank) who buys or sells for its own account rather than as an agent for another client, or directly with the issuer.
Except as described below, the primary consideration in portfolio security transactions is best price and execution of the transaction, i.e., execution at the most favorable prices and in the most effective manner possible. “Best price-best execution” encompasses many factors affecting the overall benefit obtained by the client account in the transaction including, but not necessarily limited to, the price paid or received for a security, the commission charged, the promptness, availability and
84

reliability of execution, the confidentiality and placement accorded the order, and customer service. Therefore, “best price-best execution” does not necessarily mean obtaining the best price alone but is evaluated in the context of all the execution services provided. NFA and any subadvisers have complete freedom as to the markets in and the broker-dealers through which they seek this result.
Subject to the primary consideration of seeking best price-best execution and as discussed below, securities may be bought or sold through broker-dealers who have furnished statistical, research, and other information or services to NFA or a subadviser. In placing orders with such broker-dealers, NFA or the subadviser will, where possible, take into account the comparative usefulness of such information. Such information is useful to NFA or a subadviser even though its dollar value may be indeterminable, and its receipt or availability generally does not reduce NFA’s or a subadviser’s normal research activities or expenses.
There may be occasions when portfolio transactions for the Fund are executed as part of concurrent authorizations to purchase or sell the same security for trusts or other accounts (including other mutual funds) served by NFA or a subadviser or by an affiliated company thereof. Although such concurrent authorizations potentially could be either advantageous or disadvantageous to a Fund, they are effected only when NFA or the subadviser believes that to do so is in the interest of the Fund. When such concurrent authorizations occur, the executions will be allocated in an equitable manner.
In purchasing and selling investments for the Funds, it is the policy of NFA or a subadviser to seek to obtain best execution at the most favorable prices through responsible broker-dealers. The determination of what may constitute best execution in a securities transaction by a broker involves a number of considerations, including the overall direct net economic result to the Fund (involving both price paid or received and any commissions and other costs paid), the efficiency with which the transaction is effected, the ability to effect the transaction at all when a large block is involved, the availability of the broker to stand ready to execute possibly difficult transactions in the future, the professionalism of the broker, and the financial strength and stability of the broker. These considerations are judgmental and are weighed by NFA or a subadviser in determining the overall reasonableness of securities executions and commissions paid. In selecting broker-dealers, NFA or a subadviser will consider various relevant factors, including, but not limited to, the size and type of the transaction; the nature and character of the markets for the security or asset to be purchased or sold; the execution efficiency, settlement capability, and financial condition of the broker-dealer’s firm; the broker-dealer’s execution services, rendered on a continuing basis; and the reasonableness of any commissions.
NFA or a subadviser may cause a Fund to pay a broker-dealer who furnishes brokerage and/or research services a commission that is in excess of the commission another broker-dealer would have received for executing the transaction if it is determined, pursuant to the requirements of Section 28(e) of the Exchange Act, that such commission is reasonable in relation to the value of the brokerage and/or research services provided. Such research services may include, among other things, analyses and reports concerning issuers, industries, securities, economic factors and trends, portfolio strategy, analytic or modeling software, market data feeds and historical market information. Any such research and other information provided by brokers to NFA or a subadviser is considered to be in addition to and not in lieu of services required to be performed by it under the respective advisory or subadvisory agreement. The fees paid to NFA or a subadviser pursuant to the respective advisory or subadvisory agreement are not reduced by reason of its receiving any brokerage and research services. The research services provided by broker-dealers can be useful to NFA or a subadviser in serving its other clients. All research services received from the brokers to whom commissions are paid are used collectively, meaning such services may not actually be utilized in connection with each client account that may have provided the commission paid to the brokers providing such services. NFA and any subadviser are prohibited from considering a broker-dealer’s sale of shares of any fund for which it serves as investment adviser or subadviser, except as may be specifically permitted by law.
Commission Recapture Program. NFA may instruct subadvisers to direct certain brokerage transactions, using best efforts, and subject always to seeking to obtain best execution, to broker-dealers in connection with a commission recapture program that is used to offset the Funds' operating expenses. Commission recapture is a form of institutional discount brokerage that returns commission dollars directly to the Fund. It provides a way to gain control over the commission expenses incurred by a subadviser, which can be significant over time, and thereby reduces expenses. If a subadviser does not believe it can obtain best execution from such broker-dealers, there is no obligation to execute portfolio transactions through such broker-dealers. Commissions recaptured by the Fund will be included in realized gain (loss) on securities in a Funds' appropriate financial statements.
85

Fund portfolio transactions may be effected with broker-dealers who have assisted investors in the purchase of variable annuity contracts or variable insurance policies issued by Nationwide Life Insurance Company, Nationwide Life & Annuity Insurance Company, Jefferson National Insurance Company or Jefferson National Life Insurance Company of New York. However, neither such assistance nor sale of other investment company shares is a qualifying or disqualifying factor in a broker-dealer’s selection, nor is the selection of any broker-dealer based on the volume of shares sold.
Under the 1940 Act, “affiliated persons” of a Fund are prohibited from dealing with it as a principal in the purchase and sale of securities unless an exemptive order allowing such transactions is obtained from the SEC. However, the Fund may purchase securities from underwriting syndicates of which a subadviser or any of its affiliates, as defined in the 1940 Act, is a member under certain conditions, in accordance with Rule 10f-3 under the 1940 Act.
Each of the Funds contemplates that, consistent with the policy of seeking to obtain best execution, brokerage transactions may be conducted through “affiliated brokers or dealers,” as defined in the 1940 Act. Under the 1940 Act, commissions paid by a fund to an “affiliated broker or dealer” in connection with a purchase or sale of securities offered on a securities exchange may not exceed the usual and customary broker’s commission. Accordingly, it is the Funds' policy that the commissions to be paid to an affiliated broker-dealer must, in the judgment of NFA or the appropriate subadviser, be (1) at least as favorable as those that would be charged by other brokers having comparable execution capability and (2) at least as favorable as commissions contemporaneously charged by such broker or dealer on comparable transactions for the broker’s or dealer’s most favored unaffiliated customers. NFA and the subadvisers do not necessarily deem it practicable or in the Funds' best interests to solicit competitive bids for commissions on each transaction. However, NFA and the subadvisers regularly give consideration to information concerning the prevailing level of commissions charged on comparable transactions by other brokers during comparable periods of time.
For the fiscal year ended October 31, 2023, the following Funds, through their respective subadvisers, directed the dollar amount of transactions and related commissions for transactions to a broker because of research services provided, as summarized in the table below1:
Fund Name
Total Dollar Amount
of Transactions
Total Commissions Paid
on Such Transactions
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
$402,473,284
$450,715
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
90,381,385
119,831
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
67,657,690
20,898
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund
344,271,510
96,483
Nationwide Fund
1,142,496,250
55,813
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
85,036,037
30,994
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
224,158,081
207,470
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
68,941
31,463
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
554,898,355
54,257
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
59,106,997
26,091
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
12,712,346
8,134
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
61,425,349
101,274
1
This information has been provided by the respective Fund’s subadviser(s) and the information is believed to be reliable; however, the Funds have not independently verified it.
86

During the fiscal years ended October 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, the following brokerage commissions were paid by the Funds listed below:
 
Fiscal Year Ended October 31,
Fund Name
2023
2022
2021
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
$13,405
$11,306
$10,520
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
528,571
601,052
347,879
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
150,354
220,799
205,125
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
21,368
23,314
35,255
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
15,550
32,357
1,750
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
44,364
55,898
68,927
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income Fund
279,542
368,652
338,073
Nationwide Bond Fund
8,810
20,847
44,712
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide Fund
340,064
219,678
269,383
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
48,807
48,646
83,299
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
306,894
259,983
260,683
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
71,616
9,676
12,590
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund
N/A
N/A
N/A
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund1
37,702
34,498
19,832
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
415
3,221
5,294
Nationwide International Index Fund
106,564
68,272
174,451
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
499,726
484,403
471,931
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
63,266
161,907
37,808
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
26,092
73,874
35,211
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
5,999
5,262
1,385
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
1,977
1,900
1,944
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
54,499
47,504
54,220
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
3,063
4,632
4,340
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
14,129
10,982
23,296
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
54,438
55,689
35,830
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
61,112
74,525
61,974
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
101,274
108,412
93,852
1 Fund commenced operations on January 26, 2021.
As of the fiscal year ended October 31, 2023, the Funds listed below held investments in securities of their regular broker-dealers as follows:
Fund
Approximate Aggregate
Value of Issuer's
Securities Owned by the
Fund as of fiscal year
end October 31, 2023
Name of Broker or Dealer
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
$2,440,759
Barclays Capital, Inc.
 
2,317,058
BofA Securities, Inc.
 
641,379
Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
 
907,212
J.P. Morgan Securities LLC
 
887,850
Mizuho Securities USA LLC
 
2,136,686
Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC
 
1,385,487
Wells Fargo Securities, LLC
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
599,076
Virtu Americas LLC
Nationwide Bond Fund
1,252,201
BofA Securities, Inc.
 
365,319
Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
87

Fund
Approximate Aggregate
Value of Issuer's
Securities Owned by the
Fund as of fiscal year
end October 31, 2023
Name of Broker or Dealer
 
374,907
Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC
 
1,123,244
J.P. Morgan Securities LLC
 
520,358
Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC
 
1,878,929
UBS Securities LLC
 
753,644
Wells Fargo Securities, LLC
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
627,758
Barclays Capital, Inc.
 
1,696,096
BofA Securities, Inc.
 
1,253,335
Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
 
878,284
Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC
 
1,658,006
J.P. Morgan Securities LLC
 
1,034,368
Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC
 
175,339
Nomura Securities International, Inc.
 
151,792
RBC Capital Markets, LLC
 
805,821
Wells Fargo Securities, LLC
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
6,332,001
BofA Securities, Inc.
 
4,785,419
Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
 
6,068,873
Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC
 
9,375,304
J.P. Morgan Securities LLC
 
5,975,893
Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC
 
442,038
UBS Securities LLC
 
1,497,533
Wells Fargo Securities, LLC
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
5,000,280
BofA Securities, Inc.
 
2,088,152
Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
 
2,748,581
Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC
 
11,096,849
J.P. Morgan Securities LLC
 
2,481,108
Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income
Fund
4,534,112
Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC
 
19,619,419
J.P. Morgan Securities LLC
 
4,203,663
Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC
Nationwide Fund
25,568,267
J.P. Morgan Securities LLC
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
2,176,986
Raymond James & Associates, Inc.
Nationwide International Index Fund
1,535,091
Barclays Capital, Inc.
 
1,009,991
Societe Generale
 
4,789,078
UBS Securities LLC
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
643,272
BNP Paribas Securities Corp.
 
1,363,469
BofA Securities, Inc.
 
2,489,528
Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
 
396,001
Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC
 
2,048,774
Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC
 
2,193,004
J.P. Morgan Securities LLC
 
1,358,632
Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
1,143,474
BofA Securities, Inc.
 
815,908
Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
 
211,420
Deutsche Bank Securities Inc.
 
692,822
Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC
 
666,027
J.P. Morgan Securities LLC
 
1,882,389
Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC
88

Fund
Approximate Aggregate
Value of Issuer's
Securities Owned by the
Fund as of fiscal year
end October 31, 2023
Name of Broker or Dealer
 
1,431,002
Wells Fargo Securities, LLC
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
6,144,358
BofA Securities, Inc.
 
2,565,942
Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
 
3,377,358
Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC
 
13,635,945
J.P. Morgan Securities LLC
 
3,048,801
Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC
During the fiscal years ended October 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, the remaining Funds did not pay brokerage commissions to affiliated brokers of NFA.
Other Dealer Compensation
In addition to the dealer commissions and payments under the Funds' 12b-1 Plan, from time to time, NFA and/or its affiliates may make payments for distribution and/or shareholder servicing activities out of their past profits and from their own resources. NFA and/or its affiliates may make payments for marketing, promotional, or related services provided by dealers and other financial intermediaries, and may be in exchange for factors that include, without limitation, differing levels or types of services provided by the intermediary, the expected level of assets or sales of shares, the placing of some or all of the Funds on a preferred or recommended list, access to an intermediary’s personnel, and other factors. The amount of these payments is determined by NFA.
In addition to these payments described above, NFA or its affiliates may offer other sales incentives in the form of sponsorship of educational or client seminars relating to current products and issues, assistance in training and educating the intermediary’s personnel, and/or entertainment or meals. These payments also may include, at the direction of a retirement plan’s named fiduciary, amounts to intermediaries for certain plan expenses or otherwise for the benefit of plan participants and beneficiaries. As permitted by applicable law, NFA or its affiliates may pay or allow other incentives or payments to intermediaries.
The payments described above are often referred to as “revenue sharing payments.” The recipients of such payments may include:
the Distributor and other affiliates of NFA,
broker-dealers,
financial institutions, and
other financial intermediaries through which investors may purchase shares of a Fund.
Payments may be based on current or past sales; current or historical assets; or a flat fee for specific services provided. In some circumstances, such payments may create an incentive for an intermediary or its employees or associated persons to recommend or sell shares of a Fund to you instead of shares of funds offered by competing fund families. NFA does not seek reimbursement by the Funds for such payments.
Additional Compensation to Affiliated Financial Institution. Nationwide Fund Advisors (“NFA”) and Nationwide Fund Distributors LLC (“NFD”), pursuant to an agreement by the parties, pay their affiliate, Nationwide Financial Services, Inc. various amounts under the terms of the agreement.
Additional Compensation to Financial Institutions. The unaffiliated financial institutions that receive additional compensation (as described in the Prospectus) from NFA, NFM or NFD, from their own resources, include the following (the information set forth below is considered complete as of the date of this SAI, and as supplemented; however, agreements may be entered into, terminated, or amended, from time to time, without notice or change to the SAI):
Ameriprise Financial Services, Inc. (“Ameriprise”)
NFD, pursuant to a written agreement, pays Ameriprise monthly at the annual rates as follows: (i) 0.08% (8 basis points)
89

of the average daily aggregate value of shares of each respective Nationwide Target Destination Fund and each respective Nationwide Investor Destinations Fund held by Ameriprise’s customers during the month through all sales platforms, as set forth in the agreement; (ii) 0.08% (8 basis points) of the average daily aggregate value of shares of the Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund held by Ameriprise’s customers in its fee-based platforms; (iii) 0.00% (0 basis points) of the average daily aggregate value of shares of the following Funds that are held by Ameriprise’s customers during the month through all sales platforms, as set forth in the agreement: Nationwide Bond Index Fund; Nationwide International Index Fund; Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund; Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund; Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund; and Nationwide Government Money Market Fund; and (iii) 0.10% (10 basis points) of the average daily aggregate value of shares of all other series of the Trust held by Ameriprise’s customers during the month through all platforms, as set forth in the agreement In addition, NFD pays Ameriprise $8 for each networked account position. Each Fund’s administrative servicing fees pay for the service components, to the extent permitted by the Trust’s Administrative Services Plan. NFA pays out of its own resources for any overages.
Cadaret Grant & Co., Inc.; CUSO Financial Services, L.P.; Sorrento Pacific Financial LLC; Next Financial Group, Inc.; Western International Securities, Inc.; and SCF Securities, Inc. (collectively “Atria Wealth Solutions”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement, has agreed to pay to the affiliated broker dealers of Atria Wealth Solutions a sales fee of 10 bps and an asset based fee commencing after 1 year of 5 bps. Shares held in Index Funds, Nationwide Government Money Market Fund and Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund will not be subject to any fees.
Bailard, Inc. (“Bailard”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement, pays Bailard monthly at the following annual rates: (i) 0.275% (27.5 basis points) of the daily net assets of the Class M shares of the Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund; and (ii) 0.305% (30.5 basis points) of the daily net assets of the Class M shares of the Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund and the Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund. Clients of Bailard pay investment advisory fees to Bailard in connection with the management of the clients’ assets, a portion of which may be invested in one or more of the Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund, the Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund and the Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund. Bailard has agreed with its clients that the amount of the advisory fee paid by the client (whether directly to Bailard or indirectly through Bailard’s management of investment vehicles in which the client invests) will equal a fixed percentage of the value of the client’s account with Bailard. As a result, the direct fee that Bailard receives from its clients will be reduced by a portion of the investment advisory fee (i.e., the fee paid to NFA) that such clients indirectly incur as shareholders of such Funds. The additional payments by NFA out of its own resources, as described above, are credited by Bailard to its clients who are shareholders of such Funds. These periodic payments, which are solely the obligation of NFA are separate from and in addition to the subadvisory fees paid to Bailard.
B.C. Ziegler & Company, Inc. (“B.C. Ziegler”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement, pays B.C. Ziegler the following (i) 0.10% (10 basis points) on the average daily net asset value of Fund shares held by customers of B.C. Ziegler in the following Funds: Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund, Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund, Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund, Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund, Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund and Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund, and (ii) 0.05% (5 basis points) on the average daily net asset value of Fund shares held by customers of B.C. Ziegler in the following Funds: Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund and Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund.
Cambridge Investment Research, Inc. (“Cambridge”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement with Cambridge, reimburses Cambridge a ten dollar ($10.00) ticket charge for each Fund share purchase that is (1) equal to or greater than $5,000, (2) on a single ticket that includes only Nationwide Funds, and (3) entered and executed through one of Cambridge’s clearing firms, National Financial, LLC and/or Pershing, LLC. Excluded from this arrangement are (i) redemptions or exchanges, (ii) purchases subject to no-transaction fees, (iii) purchases by check and application direct to the Funds’ transfer agent, or (iv) any Fund that is not available for purchase by new investors or is otherwise only available for purchase by existing shareholders pursuant to the terms of the Fund’s then-current prospectus.
Charles Schwab & Co., Inc. (“Schwab”)
90

Pursuant to a written agreement, Schwab receives 0.40% (40 basis points) of the average daily value of shares held in accounts at Schwab (excluding the value of shares held in such accounts prior to the effectiveness of the written agreement) or $1,000 per month for each Fund, whichever is greater. Each Fund’s Rule 12b-1 and administrative servicing fees pay for distribution and service components, respectively. NFA pays for any overage.
Fidelity Brokerage Services LLC (“Fidelity Brokerage”) and National Financial Services LLC (“National Financial”)
Pursuant to a written agreement, Fidelity Brokerage and National Financial receive monthly 0.40% (40 basis points) of the daily market value of the number of Fund shares held in accounts at Fidelity Brokerage and National Financial. Each Fund’s Rule 12b-1 and administrative servicing fees pay for distribution and service components, respectively. NFA pays for any overage.
First Allied Securities, Inc. (“First Allied”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement of the parties, pays First Allied quarterly a service fee at the annual rate as follows: (i) 0.20% (20 basis points) of the net asset value of Class A shares of the following Funds sold subject to a front-end sales charge (as may be reduced by rights of accumulation, if applicable), by First Allied to its customers: Nationwide Target Destination Funds, Nationwide Investor Destinations Funds, Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund, Nationwide International Index Fund, Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund, Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund, and Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund; and (ii) 0.05% (5 basis points) on the net asset value of Class A shares of the following Funds, sold subject to a front-end sales charge (as may be reduced by rights of accumulation, if applicable), by First Allied to its customers: Nationwide Bond Fund and Nationwide Bond Index Fund. Any annual aggregate minimum with respect to the foregoing payments have been waived.
Great West Life & Annuity Insurance Company (“Great West”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement between the parties, pays Great West an annual fee of $1,500 for each class of fund that is an investment option on the retirement platform.
LPL Financial LLC (“LPL”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement with LPL, pays LPL a ticket charge of $10.00 for each Fund purchase order entered and executed electronically by LPL on its brokerage platform. Ticket charges do not apply to redemptions, exchanges, purchases by check and application direct to the Funds’ transfer agent or to purchase orders with respect to the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund. A $4.50 ticket charge will be paid on eligible fee based account purchases in Institutional Service Class shares. The Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund and the Nationwide Index Funds are excluded from this arrangement. In addition, NFA pays LPL a service fee at the annual rate of 0.10% (10 basis points) of the average daily net assets of the Institutional Service Class shares held in the Strategic Wealth Management advisory platform and 0.09% (9 basis points) of the average daily net asset value of brokerage (load/commissionable non-ERISA) and advisory assets (excluding assets held in Institutional Service Class shares in the Strategic Wealth Management advisory platform) above a base rate established January 1, 2014, of the Funds, with the exception of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, in any asset class owned beneficially or of record from time to time by customers or owned of record by LPL. NFA will pay a fee of 0.05% (5 basis points) on the advisory asset base established on January 1, 2014. For purposes of this service fee, Fund shareholder accounts may be held at LPL in street name or at the Fund’s transfer agent. In addition, NFM pays LPL $4 for certain networked account positions. Each Fund’s administrative servicing fees pay for the service components, to the extent permitted by the Trust’s Administrative Services Plan. NFA pays out of its own resources for any overages.
MSCS Financial Services, Inc. (“MSCS”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement of the parties, pays MSCS monthly a service fee at the annual rate of 0.25% (25 basis points) on shares held at Merrill Lynch that are subject to a service fee.
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated (“Merrill Lynch”)
NFD, pursuant to a written agreement of the parties, pays Merrill Lynch the following fees: (i) a monthly fee of 0.25%
91

(25 basis points) of total new gross sales of shares of any class of each Fund (excluding sales from reinvestment of distributions and exchanges of shares of one or more Funds for any other Fund or Funds), payable in arrears; and (ii) an annual fee, payable quarterly, of 0.10% (10 basis points) of the value of Fund shares (including sales from exchanges of shares of one or more Funds for any other Fund or Funds) held by Merrill Lynch’s customers for more than one year, for Merrill Lynch’s continuing due diligence, training and marketing. In addition, NFA pays for administrative services that exceed the amount available under the Trust’s Administrative Services Plan for shares held on Merrill Lynch’s retirement plan platform.
Morgan Stanley Smith Barney LLC (“Morgan Stanley”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement of the parties, pays Morgan Stanley quarterly a mutual fund support fee on all brokerage and advisory assets, excluding money market, ERISA, SEP-IRA and SIMPLE-IRA assets at the following rates based on the Fund’s management fee stated in the then-current prospectus:
92

Support Fee
Fee Paid
Up to 0.25%
1 bps
0.25%-0.29%
2 bps
0.30%-0.34%
4 bps
0.35%-0.39%
5 bps
0.40% and above
10 bps
In addition, NFM pays Morgan Stanley 0.06% (6 basis points) for each customer account position. Each Fund’s administrative servicing fees pay for the service components, to the extent permitted by the Trust’s Administrative Services Plan. NFA pays out of its own resources for any overages.
Osaic Wealth, Inc.; SagePoint Financial Advisors, Inc.; FSC Securities Corporation; Woodbury Financial, Inc.; Triad Advisors LLC; Securities America, Inc.; and Royal Alliance Associates, Inc. (collectively, “Osaic Inc.”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement, pays each respective member of the Osaic Inc. quarterly at the annual rates as follows: (i) 0.07% (7 basis points) of the average daily net asset value of shares of each respective Nationwide Target Destination Fund and each respective Nationwide Investor Destinations Fund that are sold by the Osaic Inc. to their customers; (ii) 0.00% (0 basis points) of the average daily net asset value of shares of the following Funds that are sold by the Osaic Inc. to their customers: Nationwide Bond Index Fund; Nationwide International Index Fund; Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund; Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund; Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund; and Nationwide Government Money Market Fund; and (iii) 0.10% (10 basis points) of the average daily net asset value of shares of all other series of the Trust that are sold by the Osaic Inc. to their customers. Excluded from this arrangement are shares of the Funds in ERISA retirement plans and individual retirement accounts held in fee-based platforms (“qualified advisory accounts”).
An annual partnership fee of $5,000 will be paid with respect to qualified advisory accounts.
Pershing LLC (“Pershing”)
NFD, pursuant to a written agreement of the parties, pays Pershing $14 for each customer account position, with the exception of the Class R6, for which NFD has agreed to pay $12 for each customer account position in all series of the shares. A Fund’s administrative servicing fees pay for the service components, to the extent permitted by the Trust’s Administrative Services Plan. NFA pays out of its own resources for any overages.
Principal Life Insurance Company (“Principal”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement between the parties, pays Principal an annual fee of $1,000 for each class of fund that is an investment option on the retirement platform.
The Prudential Insurance Company of America (“Prudential”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement of the parties, pays Prudential monthly a service fee at the annual rate as follows: (i) 0.40% (40 basis points) of the average daily net assets of Class A and Institutional Service Class shares for the Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund, Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund, Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund, Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund and Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund; (ii) 0.30% (30 basis points) of the average daily net assets of Class A and Institutional Service Class shares for the Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund and Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund; and (iii) 0.20% (20 basis points) of the average daily net assets of Class A and Institutional Service Class shares for the Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund and the Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund. Each Fund’s administrative servicing fees pay for the service components, to the extent permitted by the Trust’s Administrative Services Plan. NFA pays out of its own resources for any overages.
Raymond James & Associates, Inc. and Raymond James Financial Services, Inc. (collectively, “Raymond James”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement, pays Raymond James an annual fee calculated quarterly against the total value of Fund shares held by customers of Raymond James according to the following schedule:
93

(i)
0.20% (20 basis points) of the average daily value of shares held in Nationwide Equity Funds;
(ii)
0.15% (15 basis points) of the average daily value of shares held in Nationwide Fixed-Income Funds; and
(iii)
0.10% (10 basis points) of the average daily value of shares held in Nationwide Index Funds.
For purposes of this agreement, the following funds are deemed to be Index Funds: Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund, Nationwide Bond Index Fund, Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund, Nationwide International Index Fund, Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund, Nationwide Investor Destinations Funds (all series) and Nationwide Target Destination Funds (all series). Excluded from this agreement are the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund and the Class R6 of all series of the Funds.
In addition, a $15 ticket charge fee will be paid on purchases in non-taxable accounts in the IMPAC and Passport fee-based programs. Purchases in the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund and Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund are excluded.
RBC Capital Markets, LLC (“RBC”)
NFM, pursuant to a written agreement between the parties, pays RBC an annual fee of $6 for each customer’s account position. Each Fund's administrative servicing fees pays for the service components, to the extent permitted by the Trust's Administrative Services Fee Plan. NFA pays out of its own resources for any overages.
Sanctuary Wealth Group, LLC (“Sanctuary Wealth”)
Nationwide Life and Annuity Insurance Company (“Nationwide Life”), an affiliate of NFA and NFM, entered into a strategic partner sponsorship agreement with Sanctuary Wealth that pays a support fee to Sanctuary Wealth of $230,000 per year in exchange for allowing Nationwide Life and its affiliates (including NFA) to participate in various events that include seminars, conferences and meetings as determined and agreed to by both parties; as well as provides access to research teams and additional data. Neither NFA nor NFM make any direct payments to Sanctuary Wealth. NFA may reimburse Nationwide Life proportionate to NFA participation.
Stifel, Nicolaus & Company, Inc. (“Stifel”)
NFM, pursuant to a written agreement between the parties, pays Stifel an annual fee of $6 for each customers account position. Each Fund's administrative servicing fees pays for the service components, to the extent permitted by the Trust's Administrative Services Fee Plan. NFA pays out of its own resources for any overages.
UBS Financial Services Inc. (“UBS”)
NFD, pursuant to a written agreement, pays UBS quarterly fees based on the following schedule or $75,000, whichever is greater: (i) the annual rate of 0.15% (15 basis points) of the value of the average monthly non-Index equity assets; (ii) the annual rate of 0.10% (10 basis points) of the average value of the average monthly non-Index fixed-income assets, and; (iii) the annual rate of 0.075% (7.5 basis points) of the value of the average monthly fixed-income assets in each of its retail and wrap programs that are invested in each Fund. In addition, NFA pays UBS a quarterly sales fee at the annual rate of 0.05% (5 basis points) of all sales of non-Index Fund shares and 0.08% (8 basis points), excluding the sales of Fund shares in InsightOne, PACE, Strategic Advisor or Diversified Return Strategies. For the purposes of this agreement, the following funds are deemed to be Index funds; Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund, Nationwide Bond Index Fund, Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund, Nationwide International Index Fund, Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund, Nationwide Investor Destinations Funds (all series) and Nationwide Target Destination Funds (all series). Excluded from this agreement are the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund and the Class R6 of all series of the Funds. In addition, in exchange for omnibus account services provided, NFM pays UBS $19 for each client account position in a Fund share class subject to a CDSC fee, and $18 for each client account position in a Fund share class not subject to a CDSC fee. Each Fund’s administrative servicing fees pay for the service components, to the extent permitted by the Trust’s Administrative Services Plan. NFA pays out of its own resources for any overages.
U.S. Bancorp Investments, Inc. (“U.S. Bancorp”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement of the parties, pays U.S. Bancorp quarterly at the following annual rates: (i) 0.07%
94

(7 basis points) of the average daily aggregate value of shares of each respective Nationwide Target Destination Fund and each Nationwide Investor Destinations Fund held by customers of U.S. Bancorp, excluding Fund shares that are held in any fee-based ERISA or individual retirement account; (ii) 0.00% (0 basis points) of the average daily aggregate value of shares of the following Funds that are held by U.S. Bancorp’s customers, excluding Fund shares that are held in any fee-based ERISA or individual retirement account: Nationwide Bond Index Fund; Nationwide International Index Fund; Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund; Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund; Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund; and Nationwide Government Money Market Fund; and (iii) 0.10% (10 basis points) of the average daily aggregate value of shares of all other series of the Trust held by U.S. Bancorp’s customers, excluding Fund shares that are held in any fee-based ERISA or individual retirement account.
U.S. Bank N.A. (“U.S. Bank”)
NFA, pursuant to a written agreement of the parties, pays U.S. Bank monthly a service fee at the annual rate as follows: (i) 0.40% (40 basis points) of the average daily net assets of the Institutional Service Class for the Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund, Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund, Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund, Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund, and Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund; and (ii) 0.30% (30 basis points) of the average daily net assets of the Institutional Service Class for the Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund and Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund. Each Fund’s administrative servicing fees pays for the service components, to the extent permitted by the Trust’s Administrative Services Plan. NFA pays out of its own resources for any overages.
Wells Fargo Clearing Services, LLC and Wells Fargo Advisors Financial Network, LLC (collectively, “Wells Fargo”)
NFD, pursuant to a written agreement of the parties, pays Wells Fargo the following fees in exchange for Wells Fargo’s continuing due diligence, training, operations and systems support, and marketing provided to unaffiliated broker-dealers based on the following schedule or $250,000, whichever is greater: (i) the annual rate of 0.07% (7 basis points) of the net asset value of shares of Index Funds sold by Wells Fargo to its customers; (ii) the annual rate of 0.09% (9 basis points) of the net asset value of shares of the Nationwide Target Destination Funds and Nationwide Investor Destinations Funds sold by Wells Fargo to its customers; (iii) the annual rate of 0.12% (12 basis points) of the net asset value of shares of Nationwide Fixed-Income and Nationwide Equity Funds; and (iv) the annual rate of 0.13% (13 basis points) of the net asset value of shares of the other Nationwide Funds sold by Wells Fargo to its customers. Excluded from this agreement are the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund and Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund. In addition, in exchange for omnibus account services provided, NFM pays Wells Fargo $19 for each client account position in a Fund share class subject to a CDSC fee, and $16 for each client account position in a Fund share class not subject to a CDSC fee. Each Fund’s administrative servicing fees pay for the service components, to the extent permitted by the Trust’s Administrative Services Plan. NFA pays out of its own resources for any overages.
Additional Information on Purchases and Sales
Class A Sales Charges
The following tables show the Class A sales charges, which decrease as the amount of your investment increases.
Shareholders purchasing Class A shares of a Fund through certain financial intermediaries may be eligible for a sales charge waiver or discount. For more information, see Appendix A: Intermediary Sales Charge Discounts and Waivers of the applicable Fund’s Prospectus.
Class A Shares of the Equity Funds
Amount of purchase
Sales charge as %
of offering price
Sales charge as %
of net amount invested
Dealer Commission as a % of offering price
less than $50,000
5.75%
6.10%
5.00%
$50,000 to $99,999
4.75
4.99
4.00
$100,000 to $249,999
3.50
3.63
3.00
$250,000 to $499,999
2.50
2.56
2.00
$500,000 to $999,999
2.00
2.04
1.75
$1 million or more
None
None
None
95

Class A Shares of the Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
Amount of purchase
Sales charge as %
of offering price
Sales charge as %
of net amount invested
Dealer Commission as a % of offering price
less than $100,000
4.25%
4.44%
3.75%
$100,000 to $249,999
3.50
3.63
3.00
$250,000 to $499,999
2.50
2.56
2.00
$500,000 to $999,999
2.00
2.04
1.75
$1 million or more
None
None
None
Class A Shares of the Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund, Nationwide Bond Fund, Nationwide Bond Index Fund and Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
Amount of purchase
Sales charge as %
of offering price
Sales charge as %
of net amount invested
Dealer Commission as a % of offering price
less than $100,000
2.25%
2.30%
2.00%
$100,000 to $249,999
1.75
1.78
1.50
$250,000 to $499,999
1.25
1.27
1.00
$500,000 or more
None
None
None
Class A Shares of the Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund and Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
Amount of purchase
Sales charge as %
of offering price
Sales charge as %
of net amount invested
Dealer Commission as a % of offering price
less than $100,000
2.25%
2.30%
2.00%
$100,000 to $249,999
1.75
1.78
1.50
$250,000 or more
None
None
None
Waiver of Class A Sales Charges
You may qualify for a waiver of the Class A sales charge if you own or are purchasing shares of a Fund. More information about purchasing shares through certain financial intermediaries appears in Appendix A to the applicable Fund’s Prospectus. To receive the sales charge waiver, you must inform the Trust, your financial advisor or your financial intermediary at the time of your purchase that you qualify for such a waiver. If you do not inform the Trust, your financial advisor or your financial intermediary that you are eligible for a sales charge waiver, you may not receive the waiver to which you are entitled. You may have to produce evidence that you qualify for a sales charge waiver before you will receive it.
Due to the reduced marketing effort required by NFD, the sales charge applicable to Class A shares may be waived for sales of shares to:
(a)
current shareholders of a Nationwide Fund who, as of February 28, 2017, owned their shares directly with the Trust in an account for which NFD was identified as the broker-dealer of record;
(b)
investors who participate in a self-directed investment brokerage account program offered by a financial intermediary that may or may not charge its customers a transaction fee;
(c)
owners of an account held directly with the Trust in which the previous broker-dealer of record had transferred such account to NFD;
(d)
employer-sponsored 401(k) plans, 457 plans, 403(b) plans, health savings plans, profit sharing and money purchase pension plans, defined benefit plans and nonqualified deferred compensation plans. For purposes of this provision, employer-sponsored plans do not include SEP IRAs, Simple IRAs, SAR-SEPs or Keogh plans;
(e)
owners of individual retirement accounts (“IRA”) investing assets formerly in retirement plans that were subject to the automatic rollover provisions under Section 401(a)(31)(B) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended;
(f)
Trustees and retired Trustees of the Trust (including its predecessor Trusts);
(g)
directors, officers, full-time employees, sales representatives and their employees, and retired directors, officers, employees, and sale representatives, their spouses (including domestic partners), children or immediate relatives (immediate relatives include mother, father, brothers, sisters, grandparents, grandchildren (“Immediate Relatives”)), and Immediate Relatives of deceased employees of any member of the Nationwide Insurance and Nationwide Financial companies;
96

(h)
directors, officers, and full-time employees, their spouses (including domestic partners), children or Immediate Relatives of any current subadviser to the Trust;
(i)
any directors, officers, full-time employees, sales representatives and their employees, their spouses (including domestic partners), children or Immediate Relatives of a broker-dealer having a dealer/selling agreement with the Distributor;
(j)
any qualified pension or profit sharing plan established by a Nationwide sales representative for himself/herself and his/her employees;
(k)
registered investment advisers, trust companies and bank trust departments exercising discretionary investment authority with respect to the amounts to be invested in a Fund; and
(l)
any investor who purchases Class A Shares of a Fund (the “New Fund”) with proceeds from sales of Class K or Eagle Class shares of another Nationwide Fund, where the New Fund does not offer Class K or Eagle Class shares.
Reduction of Class A Sales Charges
You may qualify for a reduced Class A sales charge if you own or are purchasing shares of a Fund. To receive the reduced sales charge, you must inform the Trust, your financial advisor or your financial intermediary at the time of your purchase that you qualify for such a reduction. If you do not inform the Trust, your financial advisor or your financial intermediary that you are eligible for a reduced sales charge, you may not receive the discount to which you are entitled. You may have to produce evidence that you qualify for a reduced sales charge or waiver before you will receive it.
Shareholders can reduce or eliminate Class A shares’ initial sales charge through one or more of the discounts described below:
A larger investment. The sales charge decreases as the amount of your investment increases.
Rights of accumulation. You and members of your family who live at the same address can add the current value of your Class A investments in the Nationwide Funds (except shares of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund), that you currently own or are currently purchasing to the value of your Class A purchase, possibly reducing the sales charge.
No sales charge on a repurchase. If you sell Fund shares from your account, we allow you a privilege to reinvest some or all of the proceeds in shares of the same class. Generally, you will not pay a sales charge on Class A shares that you buy within 30 days of selling Class A shares of an equal or greater amount if you have already paid a sales charge. Remember, if you realize a gain or a loss on your sale of shares, the transaction is taxable and reinvestment may affect the amount of capital gains tax that is due (see, “Sales, Exchanges and Redemptions of Fund Shares - Deferral of basis” under “ADDITIONAL GENERAL TAX INFORMATION FOR ALL FUNDS” below). If you realize a loss on your sale and you reinvest, some or all of the loss may not be allowed as a tax deduction depending on the amount you reinvest.
Letter of Intent discount. State in writing that during a 13-month period you or a group of family members who live at the same address will purchase and hold at least $50,000 (or $100,000 in certain Nationwide Funds as identified in their respective prospectuses) in Class A shares (excluding the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund) and your sales charge will be based on the total amount you intend to invest. Your accumulated holdings (as described and calculated under “Rights of accumulation” above) are eligible to be aggregated as of the start of the 13-month period and will be credited toward satisfying the Letter of Intent. Your Letter of Intent is not a binding obligation to buy shares of the Fund; it is merely a statement of intent. Call 800-848-0920 for more information.
Class A Shares - Contingent Deferred Sales Charge (“CDSC”)
An investor may purchase $1 million, $500,000 or $250,000, or more, depending on the Fund, as indicated below, of Class A shares in one or more of the Nationwide Funds and avoid the front-end sales charge. However, unless an investor is otherwise eligible to purchase Class A shares without a sales charge, the investor will pay a CDSC (as shown below) if he or she redeems such Class A shares within 18 months of the date of purchase. With respect to such purchases, the Distributor may pay dealers a finder’s fee on investments made in Class A shares with no initial sales charge. The CDSC applies only if the Distributor paid a finder’s fee to the selling dealer. The CDSC does not apply to shares acquired through reinvestment of dividends or capital gains distributions.
The applicable CDSC will be determined on a pro rata basis according to the amount of the redemption from each particular Fund. Any CDSC is based on the original purchase price or the current market value of the shares being redeemed, whichever is less.
Amount of Finder’s Fee/Contingent Deferred Sales Charge
97

Contingent Deferred Sales Charge on Certain Redemptions of Class A Shares of the Equity Funds
Amount of Purchase
$1 million or more
If sold within
18 months
Amount of CDSC
1.00%
Contingent Deferred Sales Charge on Certain Redemptions of Class A Shares of the Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
Amount of Purchase
$1 million or more
If sold within
18 months
Amount of CDSC
0.75%
Contingent Deferred Sales Charge on Certain Redemptions of Class A Shares of the Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund, Nationwide Bond Fund, Nationwide Bond Index Fund, and Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
Amount of Purchase
$500,000 or more
If sold within
18 months
Amount of CDSC
0.75%
Contingent Deferred Sales Charge on Certain Redemptions of Class A Shares of the Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund and Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
Amount of Purchase
$250,000 or more
If sold within
18 months
Amount of CDSC
0.50%
Waiver of CDSC for Class A Shares
Shareholders purchasing Class A shares of a Fund through certain financial intermediaries may be eligible for a sales charge waiver or discount. For more information, see Appendix A: Intermediary Sales Charge Discounts and Waivers of the applicable Fund's Prospectus. Generally, the CDSC is waived on:
the redemption of Class A shares purchased through reinvested dividends or distributions;
Class A shares redeemed following the death or disability of a shareholder, provided the redemption occurs within one year of the shareholder’s death or disability; and
mandatory withdrawals of Class A shares from traditional IRA accounts after age 70 12 (for shareholders who reached the age of 70 12 on or prior to December 31, 2019) or the age of 72 (for shareholders who turned 70 12 after December 31, 2019) and for other required distributions from retirement accounts.
If you qualify for a waiver of a CDSC, you must notify the Fund’s transfer agent, your financial advisor or other intermediary at the time of purchase and must also provide any required evidence showing that you qualify.
Class A Broker Exchanges
Class A shares purchased by accounts participating in certain fee-based programs sponsored by and/or controlled by financial intermediaries (“Programs”) may be exchanged by the financial intermediary on behalf of the shareholder for Institutional Service Class shares of the same Fund under certain circumstances. Such exchange will be on the basis of the net asset values per share, without the imposition of any sales load, fee or other charge. If a shareholder of Institutional Service Class shares has ceased his or her participation in the Program, the financial intermediary may exchange all such Institutional Service Class shares for Class A shares of a Fund, whichever class of shares the shareholder held prior to the entry into such Program. Such exchange will be on the basis of the relative net asset values of the shares, without imposition of any sales load, fee or other charge.
Holders of Class A shares that are subject to a CDSC are generally not eligible for this exchange privilege until the applicable CDSC period has expired. The applicable CDSC period for certain Class A shares that were purchased without the
98

imposition of a front-end sales load is 18 months after the purchase of such Class A shares.
Exchanges of Class A shares for Institutional Service Class shares of the same Fund, or the exchange of Institutional Service Class shares for Class A shares of the same Fund, under these particular circumstances, will be tax-free for federal income tax purposes. You should also consult with your tax advisor regarding the state and local tax consequences of such an exchange of Fund shares.
This exchange privilege is subject to termination and may be amended from time to time.
Class R Shares
Class R shares generally are available only to 401(k) plans, 457 plans, 403(b) plans, profit sharing and money purchase pension plans, defined benefit plans, non-qualified deferred compensation plans and other retirement accounts (collectively, “retirement plans”) whereby the retirement plan or the retirement plan’s financial service firm has an agreement with NFD to utilize such shares in certain investment products or programs. Class R shares generally are available to small- and mid-sized retirement plans having at least $1 million in assets. In addition, Class R shares also generally are available only to retirement plans where Class R shares are held on the books of the Funds through omnibus accounts (either at the plan level or at the level of the financial services firm) and where the plans are introduced by an intermediary, such as a broker, third party administrator, registered investment adviser or other retirement plan service provider. Class R shares are not available to retail or institutional non-retirement accounts, traditional and Roth IRAs, Coverdell Education Savings Accounts, SEPs, SAR-SEPs, one person Keogh plans, SIMPLE IRAs, or individual 403(b) plans, or through 529 Plan accounts.
A retirement plan’s intermediaries can help determine which class is appropriate for that retirement plan. If a retirement plan qualifies to purchase other shares of a Fund, one of these other classes may be more appropriate than Class R shares. Specifically, if a retirement plan eligible to purchase Class R shares is otherwise qualified to purchase Class A shares at net asset value or at a reduced sales charge or to purchase Institutional Service Class or Service Class shares, one of these classes may be selected where the retirement plan does not require the distribution and administrative support services typically required by Class R share investors and/or the retirement plan’s intermediaries have elected to forgo the level of compensation that Class R shares provide. Plan fiduciaries of retirement plans subject to the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (“ERISA”) should consider their obligations under ERISA in determining which class is an appropriate investment for a retirement plan. A retirement plan’s intermediaries may receive different compensation depending upon which class is chosen.
Redemptions
Generally, a Fund will typically issue payment for the shares that you redeem within two days after your redemption request is received by check or electronic transfer, except as noted below. If you are selling shares that were recently purchased by check or through ACH, redemption proceeds may not be available until your check has cleared or the ACH transaction has been completed (which may take up to 10 business days from your date of purchase). A Fund may delay forwarding redemption proceeds for up to seven days if the Fund believes that the investor redeeming shares is engaged in excessive trading, or if the amount of the redemption request otherwise would be disruptive to efficient portfolio management, or would adversely affect the Fund. The Trust may suspend the right of redemption for such periods as are permitted under the 1940 Act and under the following unusual circumstances: (a) when the Exchange is closed (other than weekends and holidays) or trading is restricted; (b) when an emergency exists, making disposal of portfolio securities or the valuation of net assets not reasonably practicable; or (c) during any period when the SEC has by order permitted a suspension of redemption for the protection of shareholders.
Under normal circumstances, a Fund expects to satisfy redemption requests through the sale of investments held in cash or cash equivalents. However, a Fund may also use the proceeds from the sale of portfolio securities or a bank line of credit to meet redemption requests if consistent with management of the Fund or in stressed market conditions. Under extraordinary circumstances, a Fund, in its sole discretion, may elect to honor redemption requests by transferring some of the securities held by a Fund directly to an account holder as a redemption in-kind.
In-Kind Redemptions
As described in the Prospectuses, each Fund reserves the right, in circumstances where in its sole discretion it
99

determines that cash redemption payments would be undesirable, taking into account the best interests of all Fund shareholders, to honor any redemption request by transferring some of the securities held by the Fund directly to a redeeming shareholder (“redemption in-kind”). Redemptions in-kind generally will be pro-rata slices of the Fund’s portfolio or a representative basket of securities. Redemptions in-kind may also be used in stressed market conditions.
The Board has adopted procedures for redemptions in-kind to affiliated persons of a Fund. Affiliated persons of a Fund include shareholders who are affiliates of the Fund’s investment adviser and shareholders of a Fund owning 5% or more of the outstanding shares of that Fund. These procedures provide that a redemption in-kind shall be effected at approximately the affiliated shareholder’s proportionate share of the distributing Fund’s current net assets, and they are designed so that redemptions will not favor the affiliated shareholder to the detriment of any other shareholder. The procedures also require that the distributed securities be valued in the same manner as they are valued for purposes of computing the distributing Fund’s net asset value and that neither the affiliated shareholder nor any other party with the ability and pecuniary incentive to influence the redemption in-kind selects, or influences the selection of, the distributed securities. Use of the redemption in-kind procedures will allow a Fund to avoid having to sell significant portfolio assets to raise cash to meet the shareholder’s redemption request, thus limiting the potential adverse effect on the distributing Fund’s net asset value.
Accounts with Low Balances
Unless an account actively participates in an Automatic Asset Accumulation Plan, if the value of an account falls below $2,000 ($1,000 for IRA accounts) for any reason, including market fluctuation, a shareholder is generally subject to a $5 quarterly fee, which is deposited into the Fund to offset the expenses of small accounts. The Fund will sell shares from an account quarterly to cover the fee.
The Trust reserves the right to sell the rest of a shareholder’s shares and close its account if that shareholder makes a sale that reduces the value of its account to less than $2,000 ($1,000 for IRA accounts). Before the account is closed, the Trust will give a shareholder notice and allow that shareholder 60 days to purchase additional shares to avoid this action. The Trust does this because of the high cost of maintaining small accounts.
A redemption of your remaining shares may be a taxable event for you. See “Sales, Exchanges and Redemptions of Fund Shares” below.
If the monthly average balance of an account holding Investor Shares of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund falls below $500, you are generally subject to a $2/month fee.
Valuation of Shares
All investments in the Trust are credited to the shareholder’s account in the form of full and fractional shares of the designated Fund (rounded to the nearest 1/1000 of a share). The Trust does not issue share certificates. Subject to the sole discretion of NFA, each Fund may accept payment for shares in the form of securities that are permissible investments for such Fund.
The net asset value per share (“NAV”) of each Fund is determined once daily, as of the close of regular trading on the New York Stock Exchange (the “Exchange”) (generally 4 p.m. Eastern time) on each business day the Exchange is open for regular trading (the “Valuation Time”). To the extent that a Fund’s investments are traded in markets that are open when the Exchange is closed, the value of the Funds' investments may change on days when shares cannot be purchased or redeemed.
The Trust will not compute NAV for the Funds on customary national business holidays, including the following: New Year’s Day, Martin Luther King, Jr. Day, Presidents’ Day, Good Friday, Memorial Day, Juneteenth National Independence Day, Independence Day, Labor Day, Thanksgiving Day and Christmas Day, and other days when the Exchange is closed.
Each Fund reserves the right to not determine NAV when: (i) a Fund has not received any orders to purchase, sell or exchange shares and (ii) changes in the value of the Fund’s portfolio do not affect the Fund’s NAV.
The offering price for orders placed before the close of the Exchange, on each business day the Exchange is open for trading, will be based upon calculation of the NAV at the close of regular trading on the Exchange. For orders placed after the close of regular trading on the Exchange, or on a day on which the Exchange is not open for trading, the offering price is
100

based upon NAV at the close of the Exchange on the next day thereafter on which the Exchange is open for trading. The NAV of each class of a Fund on which offering and redemption prices are based is determined by adding the value of all securities and other assets of a Fund attributable to the class, deducting liabilities attributable to that class, and dividing by the number of that class’s shares outstanding. Each Fund may reject any order to buy shares and may suspend the sale of shares at any time.
Securities for which market-based quotations are readily available are valued as of the Valuation Time. Equity securities are generally valued at the last quoted sale price, or if there is no sale price, the last quoted bid price provided by a third-party pricing service approved by the Board. Securities traded on NASDAQ generally are valued at the NASDAQ Official Closing Price. Prices are taken from the primary market or exchange in which each security trades. Debt and other fixed-income securities are generally valued at the bid evaluation price provided by a third-party pricing service.
Securities for which market-based quotations are either not readily available (e.g., a third-party pricing service does not provide a value) or are deemed unreliable, in the judgment of NFA are valued at fair value in good faith by the Adviser. The Board of Trustees has designated the Adviser as “valuation designee” to perform fair value determinations for all of the Funds’ investments pursuant to Rule 2a-5 under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, subject to the general oversight of the Board of Trustees. In addition, fair value determinations are required for securities whose value is affected by a significant event that will materially affect the value of a security and which occurs subsequent to the time of the close of the principal market on which such security trades but prior to the calculation of the Funds' NAVs. The Fair Value Committee monitors the results of fair valuation determinations and regularly reports the results to the Board or a committee of the Board. Fair value determinations may require subjective determinations. There can be no assurance that the fair value of an asset is the price at which the asset could have been sold during the period in which the particular fair value was used in determining a Fund’s NAV.
The Fair Value Committee monitors the continuing appropriateness of the valuation methodology with respect to each security. In the event that NFA or a subadviser believes that the valuation methodology being used to value a security does not produce a fair value for such security, the Fair Value Committee is notified so that it may meet to determine what adjustment should be made.
To the extent that a Fund invests in foreign securities, the following would be applicable. Generally, trading in foreign securities markets is completed each day at various times prior to the Valuation Time. Due to the time differences between the closings of the relevant foreign securities exchanges and the time that a Fund’s NAV is calculated, a Fund may fair value its foreign investments more frequently than it does other securities. When fair value prices are utilized, these prices will attempt to reflect the impact of the financial markets’ perceptions and trading activities on the Fund’s investments since their last closing prices were calculated on their primary securities markets or exchanges. When a Fund uses fair value pricing, the values assigned to the Fund’s foreign equity investments may not be the quoted or published prices of the investments on their primary markets or exchanges.
In addition to performing fair value determinations, the Adviser, as the valuation designee, is responsible for periodically assessing any material risks associated with the determination of the fair value of a Fund's investments; establishing and applying fair value methodologies; testing the appropriateness of fair value methodologies; and overseeing and evaluating third-party pricing services. The Adviser has established a fair value committee to assist with its designated responsibilities as valuation designee.
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund (the “Fund”)
The Fund operates as a “Government Money Market Fund,” as defined in Rule 2a-7 under the 1940 Act. This means that the Fund invests at least 99.5% of its total assets in (1) securities that are issued by the U.S. government, its agencies or instrumentalities, (2) repurchase agreements that are collateralized fully by such securities or cash, (3) cash, and/or (4) other money market mutual funds that operate as Government Money Market Funds.
The value of portfolio securities in the Fund is determined on the basis of the amortized cost method of valuation in accordance with Rule 2a-7 of the 1940 Act. This method involves valuing a security at its cost and thereafter assuming a constant amortization to maturity of any discount or premium, regardless of the impact of fluctuating interest rates on the market value of the instrument. While this method provides certainty in valuation, it may result in periods during which value, as determined by amortized cost, is higher or lower than the price the Fund would receive if it sold the instrument.
101

The Board has adopted procedures whereby the extent of deviation, if any, of the current NAV calculated using available market quotations from the Fund’s amortized cost price per share will be determined. In the event such deviation from the Fund’s amortized cost price per share exceeds 1/2 of 1 percent, NFA or the Chairman of the Board’s Valuation and Operations Committee (or, in his absence, the Chairman of the Board) shall promptly convene a meeting of the Board to consider what action, if any, should be taken. Where the Board believes that the extent of any deviation from the Fund’s amortized cost per share may result in material dilution or other unfair results to shareholders, it shall cause the Fund to take such action as it deems appropriate to eliminate or reduce, to the extent reasonably practicable, such dilution or unfair result. Such action might include: reducing or withholding dividends; redeeming shares in-kind; selling portfolio instruments prior to maturity to realize capital gains or losses to shorten the Fund’s average portfolio maturity; or utilizing an NAV as determined by using available market quotations.
In addition, in accordance with applicable legal requirements, the Fund may suspend redemptions if: (i) the Fund, at the end of a business day, has invested less than ten percent of its total assets in weekly liquid assets or the Fund’s price per share as computed for the purpose of distribution, redemption and repurchase, rounded to the nearest one percent, has deviated from the stable price established by the Board of Trustees, including a majority of its non-interested Trustees, determines that such a deviation is likely to occur; (ii) the Board, including a majority of its non-interested Trustees, irrevocably approve the liquidation of the Fund; and (iii) the Fund, prior to suspending redemptions, has notified the SEC of the decision to liquidate the Fund and suspend redemptions.
Pursuant to its objective of maintaining a stable net asset value per share, the Fund will only purchase investments deemed under Rule 2a-7 to have a remaining maturity of 397 calendar days or less, with certain exceptions permitted by applicable regulations, and will maintain a dollar weighted average portfolio maturity of 60 calendar days or less and a dollar-weighted average life of 120 calendar days or less that is determined without reference to certain interest rate readjustments. The adoption of proposed amendments to Rule 2a-7 may impact the Fund in ways that could have a negative impact on the Fund's investment performance, ability to achieve its investment objective, or otherwise adversely impact an investment in the Fund.
Systematic Investment Strategies
Directed Dividends –This strategy provides the security of principal that the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund offers plus the opportunity for greater long-term capital appreciation or income through reinvestment of dividends in another Fund.
An initial investment of $5,000 or more is made in the Investor Shares of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, and monthly dividends are then automatically invested into one or more of the Nationwide Funds chosen by you at such Fund’s current offering price. Nationwide Government Money Market Fund dividends reinvested into one of the other Funds are subject to applicable sales charges.
Automatic Asset Accumulation – This is a systematic investment strategy which combines automatic monthly transfers from your personal checking account to your mutual fund account with the concept of Dollar Cost Averaging. With this strategy, you invest a fixed amount monthly over an extended period of time, during both market highs and lows. Dollar Cost Averaging can allow you to achieve a favorable average share cost over time since your fixed monthly investment buys more shares when share prices fall during low markets, and fewer shares at higher prices during market highs. Although no formula can assure a profit or protect against loss in a declining market, systematic investing has proven a valuable investment strategy in the past.
You may open an account that is subject to an Automatic Asset Accumulation plan with no minimum investment, so long as each monthly purchase is at least $50 (per Fund). Another way to take advantage of the benefits that Dollar Cost Averaging can offer is through Directed Dividends, as described above.
Automatic Asset Transfer – This systematic investment plan allows you to transfer $50 or more to one Fund from another Fund systematically, monthly or quarterly, after Fund minimums have been met. The money is transferred on the day of the month the shareholder selects, or the following business day, if the date selected is a weekend or holiday. Dividends of any amount can be moved automatically from one Fund to another at the time they are paid. This strategy can provide investors with the benefits of Dollar Cost Averaging through an opportunity to achieve a favorable average share cost over time. With this plan, your fixed monthly or quarterly transfer from the Fund to any other Fund you select buys more shares
102

when share prices fall during low markets and fewer shares at higher prices during market highs. Although no formula can assure a profit or protect against loss in a declining market, systematic investing has proven a valuable investment strategy in the past. For transfers from the Investor Shares of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund to another Fund, sales charges may apply if not already paid.
Automatic Withdrawal Plan ($50 or More) – You may have checks for any fixed amount of $50 or more automatically sent bi-monthly, monthly, quarterly, semiannually or annually, to you (or anyone you designate) from your account. Complete the appropriate section of the New Account Form or contact your financial intermediary or the Fund. Your account value must meet the minimum initial investment amount at the time the program is established. This program may reduce and eventually deplete your account. Generally, it is not advisable to continue to purchase Class A shares subject to a sales charge while simultaneously redeeming shares under the program. The $50 minimum is waived for required minimum distributions from IRAs.
NOTE: If you are withdrawing more shares than your account receives in dividends, you will be decreasing your total shares owned, which will reduce your future dividend potential.
Investor Privileges
The Funds offer the following privileges to shareholders. Additional information may be obtained by calling NFD toll free at 800-848-0920.
No Sales Charge on Reinvestments – All dividends and capital gains will be automatically reinvested free of charge in the form of additional shares within the same Fund and class or another specifically requested Fund (but the same class) unless you have chosen to receive them in cash on your application. Unless requested in writing by the shareholder, the Trust will not mail checks for dividends and capital gains but instead they will automatically be reinvested in the form of additional shares.
Exchange Privilege – The exchange privilege is a convenient way to exchange shares from one Fund to another Fund in order to respond to changes in your goals or in market conditions. The registration of the account to which you are making an exchange must be exactly the same as that of the Nationwide Fund account from which the exchange is made, and the amount you exchange must meet the applicable minimum investment of the Fund being purchased. The exchange privilege may be limited due to excessive trading or market timing of Fund shares.
Exchanges among Nationwide Funds
Exchanges may be made among any of the Nationwide Funds within the same class of shares, so long as both accounts have the same registration, and your first purchase in the new Fund meets the new Fund’s minimum investment requirement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, no minimum investment requirement shall apply to holders of Institutional Service Class or Class R6 shares of a Nationwide Fund seeking to exchange shares for Institutional Service Class or Class R6 shares (as appropriate) of another Nationwide Fund, where such Institutional Service Class or Class R6 shares had been designated as Class D shares at the close of business on July 31, 2012.
Because Class R shares of the Funds are held within retirement plans, exchange privileges with other Class R shares of the Nationwide Funds may not be available unless the Class R shares of the other Nationwide Funds, as applicable, are also available within a plan. Please contact your retirement plan administrator for information on how to exchange your Class R shares within your retirement plan.
Generally, there is no sales charge for exchanges of shares. However, if your exchange involves certain Class A shares, you may have to pay the difference between the sales charges if a higher sales charge applies to the Fund into which you are exchanging. If you exchange your Class A shares of a Fund that are subject to a CDSC into another Nationwide Fund and then redeem those Class A shares within 18 months of the original purchase, the applicable CDSC will be the CDSC for the original Fund. If you exchange Investor Shares of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund into another fund, you must pay the applicable sales charge, unless it has already been paid prior to an exchange into the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund. Exchanges into the Investor Shares of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund are permitted only from Class A, Class R, Class M and Institutional Service Class shares of other Nationwide Funds. If you exchange certain Class A shares subject to a CDSC for Investor Shares of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, the time
103

you hold the shares in the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund will not be counted for purposes of calculating any CDSC. As a result, if you then sell your Investor Shares of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund, you will pay the sales charge that would have been charged if the initial certain Class A shares had been sold at the time they were originally exchanged into the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund. If you exchange your Investor Shares of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund back into certain Class A shares, the time you held certain Class A shares prior to the initial exchange into the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund will be counted for purposes of calculating the CDSC. If you wish to purchase shares of a Fund or class for which the exchange privilege does not apply, you will pay any applicable CDSC at the time you redeem your shares and pay any applicable front-end load on the new Fund you are purchasing unless a sales charge waiver otherwise applies.
Free Checking Writing Privilege (Investor Shares of the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund Only) – You may request a supply of free checks for your personal use and there is no monthly service fee. You may use them to make withdrawals of $500 or more from your account at any time. Your account will continue to earn daily income dividends until your check clears your account. There is no limit on the number of checks you may write. Cancelled checks will not be returned to you. However, your monthly statement will provide the check number, date and amount of each check written. You also will be able to obtain copies of cancelled checks, the first five free and $2.00 per copy thereafter, by contacting one of our service representatives at 800-848-0920.
Exchanges May Be Made Four Convenient Ways:
By Telephone
Automated Voice Response System – You can automatically process exchanges for a Fund by calling 800-848-0920, 24 hours a day, seven days a week. However, if you declined the option on the application, you will not have this automatic exchange privilege. This system also gives you quick, easy access to mutual fund information. Select from a menu of choices to conduct transactions and hear fund price information, mailing and wiring instructions as well as other mutual fund information. You must call our toll-free number by the Valuation Time to receive that day’s closing share price. The Valuation Time is the close of regular trading of the New York Stock Exchange, which is usually 4:00 p.m. Eastern time.
Customer Service Line – By calling 800-848-0920, you may exchange shares by telephone. Requests may be made only by the account owner(s). You must call our toll-free number by the Valuation Time to receive that day’s closing share price.
The Funds may record all instructions to exchange shares. The Funds reserve the right at any time without prior notice to suspend, limit or terminate the telephone exchange privilege or its use in any manner by any person or class.
All of the classes of the Funds will employ the same procedure described under “Buying, Selling and Exchanging Fund Shares” in the applicable Fund’s Prospectus to confirm that the instructions are genuine.
No Fund will be liable for any loss, injury, damage, or expense as a result of acting upon instructions communicated by telephone reasonably believed to be genuine, and each Fund will be held harmless from any loss, claims or liability arising from its compliance with such instructions. These options are subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the Prospectus and all telephone transaction calls may be recorded. The Funds reserve the right to revoke this privilege at any time without notice to shareholders and request the redemption in writing, signed by all shareholders.
By Mail – Write to Nationwide Funds, P.O. Box 701, Milwaukee, WI 53201-0701. Please be sure that your letter is signed exactly as your account is registered and that your account number and the name of the Fund from which you wish to make the exchange are included. For example, if your account is registered “John Doe and Mary Doe”, “Joint Tenants with Right of Survivorship,” then both John and Mary must sign the exchange request. The exchange will be processed effective the date the signed letter is received.
By Online Access – Log on to our website nationwide.com/mutualfunds 24 hours a day, seven days a week, for easy access to your mutual fund accounts. Once you have reached the website, you will be instructed on how to select a password and perform transactions. You can choose to receive information on all Nationwide Funds as well as your own personal accounts. You also may perform transactions, such as purchases, redemptions and exchanges. The Funds may terminate the ability to buy Fund shares on its website at any time, in which case you may continue to exchange shares by mail, wire or
104

telephone pursuant to the Prospectus.
Investor Services
Automated Voice Response System – Our toll-free number 800-848-0920 will connect you 24 hours a day, seven days a week to the system. Through a selection of menu options, you can conduct transactions, hear fund price information, mailing and wiring instructions and other mutual fund information.
Toll Free Information and Assistance – Customer service representatives are available to answer questions regarding the Funds and your account(s) between the hours of 9 a.m. and 8 p.m. Eastern time (Monday through Friday). Call toll-free: 800-848-0920.
Retirement Plans and Accounts – Shares of the Funds may be purchased for Self-Employed Retirement Plans, Individual Retirement Accounts (IRAs), Roth IRAs and Simplified Employee Pension Plans. For a free information kit, call 800-848-0920.
Shareholder Confirmations – You will receive a confirmation statement each time a requested transaction is processed. However, no confirmations are mailed on certain pre-authorized or systematic transactions. Instead, these will appear on your next consolidated statement.
Consolidated Statements – Fund shareholders receive quarterly statements as of the end of March, June, September and December. Please review your statement carefully and notify us immediately if there is a discrepancy or error in your account.
For shareholders with multiple accounts, your consolidated statement will reflect all your current holdings in the Funds. Your accounts are consolidated by Social Security number, address and zip code. Only transactions during the reporting period will be reflected on the statements. An annual summary statement reflecting all calendar-year transactions in all your Funds will be sent after year-end.
Shareholder Reports – All shareholders will receive reports semiannually detailing the financial operations of the Funds.
Prospectuses – Updated prospectuses will be mailed to you at least annually.
Undeliverable Mail – If mail from the Funds to a shareholder is returned as undeliverable on two or more consecutive occasions, the Funds will not send any future mail to the shareholder unless it receives notification of a correct mailing address for the shareholder. With respect to any dividend/capital gain distribution checks that are returned as undeliverable or not presented for payment within six months, the Trust reserves the right to reinvest the check proceeds and any future distributions in shares of the particular Fund at the then-current NAV of such Fund until the Funds receive further instructions from the shareholder.
Abandoned Property – Please be advised that abandoned or unclaimed property laws for certain states (to which your account may be subject) require financial organizations to transfer (escheat) unclaimed property (including shares of a fund) to the appropriate state if no activity occurs in an account for a period of time specified by state law. For IRA accounts escheated to a state under these abandoned property laws, the escheatment will generally be treated as a taxable distribution to you; federal and any applicable state income tax will be withheld. This may apply to your Roth IRA as well.
Additional Information
Description of Shares
The Second Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust permits the Board to issue an unlimited number of full and fractional shares of beneficial interest of each Fund and to divide or combine such shares into a greater or lesser number of shares without thereby exchanging the proportionate beneficial interests in the Trust. Each share of a Fund represents an equal proportionate interest in that Fund with each other share. The Trust reserves the right to create and issue a number of different funds. Shares of each Fund would participate equally in the earnings, dividends, and assets of that particular fund.
105

Upon liquidation of a Fund, shareholders are entitled to share pro rata in the net assets of such Fund available for distribution to shareholders.
The Trust is authorized to offer the following series of shares of beneficial interest, without par value and with the various classes listed:
Series
Share Classes
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
Class A, Class M, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
Class A, Class M, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
Class A, Class M, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class,
Eagle Class
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income
Fund1
Class A, Class K, Class R6, Institutional Service Class,
Eagle Class
Nationwide Bond Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Bond Portfolio*
Class R6
Nationwide Destination 2025 Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Destination 2030 Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Destination 2035 Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Destination 2040 Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Destination 2045 Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Destination 2050 Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Destination 2055 Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Destination 2060 Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Destination 2065 Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Destination Retirement Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Fund
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Fundamental All Cap Equity Portfolio*
Class R6
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Government Money Market Fund
Investor Shares, Class R6, Service Class
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class, Eagle Class
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide International Index Fund
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Investor Destinations Aggressive Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class,
Service Class
Nationwide Investor Destinations Conservative Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class,
Service Class
Nationwide Investor Destinations Moderate Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class,
Service Class
Nationwide Investor Destinations Moderately Aggressive
Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class,
Service Class
Nationwide Investor Destinations Moderately Conservative
Fund*
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class,
Service Class
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class, Eagle Class
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class, Eagle Class
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class, Eagle Class
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
106

Series
Share Classes
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Multi-Cap Portfolio*
Class R6
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Service Class, Institutional
Service Class
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
Class A, Class R, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
Class A, Institutional Service Class
Nationwide U.S. 130/30 Equity Portfolio*
Class R6
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
Class A, Class R6, Institutional Service Class
*
Information on these Nationwide Funds is contained in separate Statements of Additional Information.
1
Name change effective March 16, 2023. Formerly, Nationwide BNY Mellon Disciplined Value Fund.
You have an interest only in the assets of the Fund whose shares you own. Shares of a particular class are equal in all respects to the other shares of that class. In the event of liquidation of a Fund, shares of the same class will share pro rata in the distribution of the net assets of the Fund with all other shares of that class. All shares are without par value and when issued and paid for, are fully paid and nonassessable by the Trust. Shares may be exchanged or converted as described in this SAI and in the Prospectus but will have no other preference, conversion, exchange or pre-emptive rights.
Voting Rights
Shareholders of each class of shares have one vote for each share held and a proportionate fractional vote for any fractional share held. Shareholders may vote in the election of Trustees and on other matters submitted to meetings of shareholders. Shares, when issued, are fully paid and nonassessable. Generally, amendment may not be made to the Second Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust without the affirmative vote of a majority of the outstanding voting securities of the Trust. The Trustees may, however, further amend the Second Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust without the vote or consent of shareholders to:
(1)
designate series of the Trust; or
(2)
change the name of the Trust; or
(3)
apply any omission, cure, correct, or supplement any ambiguous, defective, or inconsistent provision to conform the Second Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust to the requirements of applicable federal laws or regulations if they deem it necessary.
An annual or special meeting of shareholders to conduct necessary business is not required by the Second Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust, the 1940 Act or other authority, except, under certain circumstances, to amend the Second Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust, the Investment Advisory Agreement, fundamental investment objectives, investment policies and investment restrictions, to elect and remove Trustees, to reorganize the Trust or any series or class thereof and to act upon certain other business matters. In regard to termination, sale of assets, modification or change of the Investment Advisory Agreement, or change of investment restrictions with respect to a Fund, the right to vote is limited to the holders of shares of that Fund. However, shares of all Nationwide Funds vote together, and not by Fund, in the election of Trustees. If an issue must be approved by a majority as defined in the 1940 Act, a “majority of the outstanding voting securities” means the lesser of (i) 67% or more of the shares present at a meeting when the holders of more than 50% of the outstanding shares are present or represented by proxy, or (ii) more than 50% of the outstanding shares. For the election of Trustees only a plurality is required. Holders of shares subject to a Rule 12b-1 fee will vote as a class and not with holders of any other class with respect to the approval of the Rule 12b-1 Plan.
Additional General Tax Information for All Funds
The following is a summary of certain additional tax considerations generally affecting a Fund (sometimes referred to as “the Fund”) and its shareholders that are not described in the Prospectus. No attempt is made to present a detailed explanation of the tax treatment of the Fund or its shareholders, and the discussion here and in the Prospectus is not intended as a substitute for careful tax planning.
This “ADDITIONAL GENERAL TAX INFORMATION FOR ALL FUNDS” section is based on the Internal Revenue Code and applicable regulations in effect on the date of this Statement of Additional Information. Future legislative,
107

regulatory or administrative changes, including provisions of current law that sunset and thereafter no longer apply, or court decisions may significantly change the tax rules applicable to the Fund and its shareholders. Any of these changes or court decisions may have a retroactive effect.
This is for general information only and not tax advice. All investors should consult their own tax advisors as to the federal, state, local and foreign tax provisions applicable to them.
The information discussed in this section applies generally to all of the Funds, but is supplemented or modified in additional separate sections that are provided below for the Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund, Nationwide Bond Fund, Nationwide Bond Index Fund, Nationwide International Index Fund, Nationwide Government Money Market Fund and Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund.
Taxation of the Fund
The Fund has elected and intends to qualify, or, if newly organized, intends to elect and qualify, each year as a regulated investment company (sometimes referred to as a “regulated investment company,” “RIC” or “fund”) under Subchapter M of the Internal Revenue Code. If the Fund so qualifies, the Fund will not be subject to federal income tax on the portion of its investment company taxable income (that is, generally, taxable interest, dividends, net short-term capital gains, and other taxable ordinary income, net of expenses, without regard to the deduction for dividends paid) and net capital gain (that is, the excess of net long-term capital gains over net short-term capital losses) that it distributes to shareholders.
In order to qualify for treatment as a regulated investment company, the Fund must satisfy the following requirements:
Distribution Requirement the Fund must distribute an amount equal to the sum of at least 90% of its investment company taxable income and 90% of its net tax-exempt income, if any, for the tax year (including, for purposes of satisfying this distribution requirement, certain distributions made by the Fund after the close of its taxable year that are treated as made during such taxable year).
Income Requirement the Fund must derive at least 90% of its gross income from dividends, interest, certain payments with respect to securities loans, and gains from the sale or other disposition of stock, securities or foreign currencies, or other income (including, but not limited to, gains from options, futures or forward contracts) derived from its business of investing in such stock, securities or currencies and net income derived from qualified publicly traded partnerships (“QPTPs”).
Asset Diversification Test the Fund must satisfy the following asset diversification test at the close of each quarter of the Fund’s tax year: (1) at least 50% of the value of the Fund’s assets must consist of cash and cash items, U.S. government securities, securities of other regulated investment companies, and securities of other issuers (as to which the Fund has not invested more than 5% of the value of the Fund’s total assets in securities of an issuer and as to which the Fund does not hold more than 10% of the outstanding voting securities of the issuer); and (2) no more than 25% of the value of the Fund’s total assets may be invested in the securities of any one issuer (other than U.S. government securities or securities of other regulated investment companies) or of two or more issuers which the Fund controls and which are engaged in the same or similar trades or businesses, or, in the securities of one or more QPTPs.
In some circumstances, the character and timing of income realized by the Fund for purposes of the Income Requirement or the identification of the issuer for purposes of the Asset Diversification Test is uncertain under current law with respect to a particular investment, and an adverse determination or future guidance by the Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) with respect to such type of investment may adversely affect the Fund’s ability to satisfy these requirements. See, “Tax Treatment of Portfolio Transactions” below with respect to the application of these requirements to certain types of investments. In other circumstances, the Fund may be required to sell portfolio holdings in order to meet the Income Requirement, Distribution Requirement, or Asset Diversification Test, which may have a negative impact on the Fund’s income and performance.
The Fund may use “equalization accounting” (in lieu of making some cash distributions) in determining the portion of its income and gains that has been distributed. If the Fund uses equalization accounting, it will allocate a portion of its undistributed investment company taxable income and net capital gain to redemptions of Fund shares and will correspondingly reduce the amount of such income and gains that it distributes in cash. If the IRS determines that the Fund’s allocation is improper and that the Fund has under distributed its income and gain for any taxable year, the Fund may be
108

liable for federal income and/or excise tax. If, as a result of such adjustment, the Fund fails to satisfy the Distribution Requirement, the Fund will not qualify that year as a regulated investment company the effect of which is described in the following paragraph.
If for any taxable year the Fund does not qualify as a regulated investment company, all of its taxable income (including its net capital gain) would be subject to tax at the corporate income tax rate without any deduction for dividends paid to shareholders, and the dividends would be taxable to the shareholders as ordinary income (or possibly as qualified dividend income) to the extent of the Fund’s current and accumulated earnings and profits. Failure to qualify as a regulated investment company would thus have a negative impact on the Fund’s income and performance. Subject to savings provisions for certain inadvertent failures to satisfy the Income Requirement or Asset Diversification Test which, in general, are limited to those due to reasonable cause and not willful neglect, it is possible that the Fund will not qualify as a regulated investment company in any given tax year. Even if such savings provisions apply, the Fund may be subject to a monetary sanction of $50,000 or more. Moreover, the Board of Trustees reserves the right not to maintain the qualification of the Fund as a regulated investment company if it determines such a course of action to be beneficial to shareholders.
Portfolio turnover. For investors that hold their Fund shares in a taxable account, a high portfolio turnover rate (except in a money market fund that maintains a stable net asset value) may result in higher taxes. This is because a fund with a high turnover rate is likely to accelerate the recognition of capital gains and more of such gains are likely to be taxable as short-term rather than long-term capital gains in contrast to a comparable fund with a low turnover rate. Any such higher taxes would reduce the Fund’s after-tax performance. See, “Taxation of Fund Distributions Distributions of capital gains” below. For non-U.S. investors, any such acceleration of the recognition of capital gains that results in more short-term and less long-term capital gains being recognized by the Fund may cause such investors to be subject to increased U.S. withholding taxes. See, “Non-U.S. Investors In general” below.
Capital loss carryovers. The capital losses of the Fund, if any, do not flow through to shareholders. Rather, the Fund may use its capital losses, subject to applicable limitations, to offset its capital gains without being required to pay taxes on or distribute to shareholders such gains that are offset by the losses. If the Fund has a “net capital loss” (that is, capital losses in excess of capital gains), the excess (if any) of the Fund's net short-term capital losses over its net long-term capital gains is treated as a short-term capital loss arising on the first day of the Fund's next taxable year, and the excess (if any) of the Fund's net long-term capital losses over its net short-term capital gains is treated as a long-term capital loss arising on the first day of the Fund's next taxable year. Any such net capital losses of the Fund that are not used to offset capital gains may be carried forward indefinitely to reduce any future capital gains realized by the Fund in succeeding taxable years. The amount of capital losses that can be carried forward and used in any single year is subject to an annual limitation if there is a more than 50% “change in ownership” of the Fund. An ownership change generally results when shareholders owning 5% or more of the Fund increase their aggregate holdings by more than 50 percentage points over a three-year look-back period. An ownership change could result in capital loss carryovers being used at a slower rate, thereby reducing the Fund’s ability to offset capital gains with those losses. An increase in the amount of taxable gains distributed to the Fund’s shareholders could result from an ownership change. The Fund undertakes no obligation to avoid or prevent an ownership change, which can occur in the normal course of shareholder purchases and redemptions or as a result of engaging in a tax-free reorganization with another fund. Moreover, because of circumstances beyond the Fund’s control, there can be no assurance that the Fund will not experience, or has not already experienced, an ownership change. In addition, if the Fund engages in a tax-free reorganization with another fund, the effect of these and other rules not discussed herein may be to disallow or postpone the use by the Fund of its capital loss carryovers (including any current year losses and built-in losses when realized) to offset its own gains or those of the other fund, or vice versa, thereby reducing the tax benefits Fund shareholders would otherwise have enjoyed from use of such capital loss carryovers.
Deferral of late year losses. The Fund may elect to treat part or all of any “qualified late year loss” as if it had been incurred in the succeeding taxable year in determining the Fund’s taxable income, net capital gain, net short-term capital gain, and earnings and profits. The effect of this election is to treat any such “qualified late year loss” as if it had been incurred in the succeeding taxable year in characterizing Fund distributions for any calendar year (see, “Taxation of Fund Distributions Distributions of capital gains” below). A “qualified late year loss” includes:
any net capital loss incurred after October 31 of the current taxable year, or, if there is no such loss, any net long-term capital loss or any net short-term capital loss incurred after October 31 of the current taxable year (“post-October capital losses”), and
the sum of (1) the excess, if any, of (a) specified losses incurred after October 31 of the current taxable year, over (b)
109

specified gains incurred after October 31 of the current taxable year and (2) the excess, if any, of (a) ordinary losses incurred after December 31 of the current taxable year, over (b) the ordinary income incurred after December 31 of the current taxable year.
The terms “specified losses” and “specified gains” mean ordinary losses and gains from the sale, exchange, or other disposition of property (including the termination of a position with respect to such property), foreign currency losses and gains, and losses and gains resulting from holding stock in a passive foreign investment company (“PFIC”) for which a mark-to-market election is in effect. The terms “ordinary losses” and “ordinary income” mean other ordinary losses and income that are not described in the preceding sentence. Since the Fund has a fiscal year ending in October, the amount of qualified late-year losses (if any) is computed without regard to any items of income, gain, or loss that are (a) post-October losses, (b) specified losses, and (c) specified gains.
Undistributed capital gains. The Fund may retain or distribute to shareholders its net capital gain for each taxable year. The Fund currently intends to distribute net capital gains. If the Fund elects to retain its net capital gain, the Fund will be taxed thereon (except to the extent of any available capital loss carryovers) at the corporate income tax rate. If the Fund elects to retain its net capital gain, it is expected that the Fund also will elect to have shareholders treated as if each received a distribution of its pro rata share of such gain, with the result that each shareholder will be required to report its pro rata share of such gain on its tax return as long-term capital gain, will receive a refundable tax credit for its pro rata share of tax paid by the Fund on the gain, and will increase the tax basis for its shares by an amount equal to the deemed distribution less the tax credit.
Federal excise tax. To avoid a 4% non-deductible excise tax, the Fund must distribute by December 31 of each year an amount equal to at least: (1) 98% of its ordinary income for the calendar year, (2) 98.2% of capital gain net income (that is, the excess of the gains from sales or exchanges of capital assets over the losses from such sales or exchanges) for the one-year period ended on October 31 of such calendar year, and (3) any prior year undistributed ordinary income and capital gain net income. The Fund may elect to defer to the following year any net ordinary loss incurred for the portion of the calendar year which is after the beginning of the Fund’s taxable year. Also, the Fund will defer any “specified gain” or “specified loss” which would be properly taken into account for the portion of the calendar year after October 31. Any net ordinary loss, specified gain, or specified loss deferred shall be treated as arising on January 1 of the following calendar year. Generally, the Fund intends to make sufficient distributions prior to the end of each calendar year to avoid any material liability for federal income and excise tax, but can give no assurances that all or a portion of such liability will be avoided. In addition, under certain circumstances, temporary timing or permanent differences in the realization of income and expense for book and tax purposes can result in the Fund having to pay an excise tax.
Foreign income tax. Investment income received by the Fund from sources within foreign countries may be subject to foreign income tax withheld at the source and the amount of tax withheld generally will be treated as an expense of the Fund. The United States has entered into tax treaties with many foreign countries, which entitle the Fund to a reduced rate of, or exemption from, tax on such income. Some countries require the filing of a tax reclaim or other forms to receive the benefit of the reduced tax rate; whether or when the Fund will receive the tax reclaim is within the control of the individual country. Information required on these forms may not be available such as shareholder information; therefore, the Fund may not receive the reduced treaty rates or potential reclaims. Other countries have conflicting and changing instructions and restrictive timing requirements which may cause the Fund not to receive the reduced treaty rates or potential reclaims. Other countries may subject capital gains realized by the Fund on sale or disposition of securities of that country to taxation. These and other factors may make it difficult for the Fund to determine in advance the effective rate of foreign tax on its investments in certain countries. Under certain circumstances, the Fund may elect to pass-through certain eligible foreign income taxes paid by the Fund to shareholders, although it reserves the right not to do so. If the Fund makes such an election and obtains a refund of foreign taxes paid by the Fund in a prior year, the Fund may be eligible to reduce the amount of foreign taxes reported by the Fund to its shareholders, generally by the amount of the foreign taxes refunded, for the year in which the refund is received. See, “Taxation of Fund Distributions Pass-through of foreign tax credits.”
Taxation of Fund Distributions
The Fund anticipates distributing substantially all of its investment company taxable income and net capital gain for each taxable year. Distributions by the Fund will be treated in the manner described below regardless of whether such distributions are paid in cash or reinvested in additional shares of the Fund (or of another fund). The Fund will send you information annually as to the federal income tax consequences of distributions made (or deemed made) during the year.
110

Distributions of net investment income. The Fund receives ordinary income generally in the form of dividends and/or interest on its investments. The Fund also may recognize ordinary income from other sources, including, but not limited to, certain gains on foreign currency-related transactions. This income, less expenses incurred in the operation of the Fund, constitutes the Fund's net investment income from which dividends may be paid to you. If you are a taxable investor, distributions of net investment income generally are taxable as ordinary income to the extent of the Fund’s earnings and profits. In the case of a Fund whose strategy includes investing in stocks of corporations, a portion of the income dividends paid to you may be qualified dividends eligible to be taxed to noncorporate taxpayers at reduced rates or for the dividends-received deduction available to corporations. See the discussion below under the headings, “—Qualified dividend income for individuals” and “—Dividends-received deduction for corporations.”
Distributions of capital gains. The Fund may derive capital gain and loss in connection with sales or other dispositions of its portfolio securities. Distributions derived from the excess of net short-term capital gain over net long-term capital loss will be taxable to you as ordinary income. Distributions paid from the excess of net long-term capital gain over net short-term capital loss will be taxable to you as long-term capital gain, regardless of how long you have held your shares in the Fund. Any net short-term or long-term capital gain realized by the Fund (net of any capital loss carryovers) generally will be distributed once each year and may be distributed more frequently, if necessary, in order to reduce or eliminate federal excise or income taxes on the Fund.
Returns of capital. Distributions by the Fund that are not paid from earnings and profits will be treated as a return of capital to the extent of (and in reduction of) the shareholder's tax basis in his shares; any excess will be treated as gain from the sale of his shares. Thus, the portion of a distribution that constitutes a return of capital will decrease the shareholder’s tax basis in his Fund shares (but not below zero), and will result in an increase in the amount of gain (or decrease in the amount of loss) that will be recognized by the shareholder for tax purposes on the later sale of such Fund shares. Return of capital distributions can occur for a number of reasons including, among others, the Fund over-estimates the income to be received from certain investments such as those classified as partnerships or equity REITs (see, “Tax Treatment of Portfolio TransactionsInvestments in U.S. REITs” below).
Qualified dividend income for individuals. Ordinary income dividends reported by the Fund to shareholders as derived from qualified dividend income will be taxed in the hands of individuals and other noncorporate shareholders at the rates applicable to long-term capital gain. “Qualified dividend income” means dividends paid to the Fund (a) by domestic corporations, (b) by foreign corporations that are either (i) incorporated in a possession of the United States, or (ii) are eligible for benefits under certain income tax treaties with the United States that include an exchange of information program, or (c) with respect to stock of a foreign corporation that is readily tradable on an established securities market in the United States. Both the Fund and the investor must meet certain holding period requirements to qualify Fund dividends for this treatment. Specifically, the Fund must hold the stock for at least 61 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the stock becomes ex-dividend. Similarly, investors must hold their Fund shares for at least 61 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the Fund distribution goes ex-dividend. Income derived from investments in derivatives, fixed-income securities, PFICs, and income received “in lieu of” dividends in a securities lending transaction generally is not eligible for treatment as qualified dividend income. If the qualifying dividend income received by the Fund is equal to or greater than 95% of the Fund's gross income (exclusive of net capital gain) in any taxable year, all of the ordinary income dividends paid by the Fund will be qualifying dividend income.
Qualified REIT dividends. Under the TCJA, “qualified REIT dividends” (i.e., ordinary REIT dividends other than capital gain dividends and portions of REIT dividends designated as qualified dividend income) are treated as eligible for a 20% deduction by noncorporate taxpayers. This deduction, if allowed in full, equates to a maximum effective tax rate of 29.6% (37% top rate applied to income after 20% deduction). A Fund may choose to report the special character of “qualified REIT dividends” to its shareholders, provided both the Fund and the shareholder meet certain holding period requirements. The amount of a RIC’s dividends eligible for the 20% deduction for a taxable year is limited to the excess of the RIC’s qualified REIT dividends for the taxable year over allocable expenses. A noncorporate shareholder receiving such dividends would treat them as eligible for the 20% deduction, provided the shareholder meets certain holding period requirements for its shares in the RIC (i.e., generally, RIC shares must be held by the shareholder for more than 45 days during the 91-day period beginning on the date that is 45 days before the date on which the shares become ex-dividend with respect to such dividend).
Business interest income. Under Section 163(j) of the Code, enacted by the TCJA, generally, the amount of business interest that a taxpayer can deduct for any year is limited to the taxpayer’s (i) business interest income (which is the amount of
111

interest includible in the gross income of the taxpayer which is properly allocable to a trade or business, but does not include investment income) plus (ii) 30% of adjusted taxable income (but not less than zero) plus (iii) floor plan financing interest. A Fund is permitted to pass-through its net business interest income (generally the Fund’s interest income less applicable expenses and deductions) as a “Section 163(j) interest dividend.” The amount passed through to shareholders is considered interest income and can then be used to determine such shareholder’s business interest deduction under Section 163(j), if any, subject to holding period requirements and other limitations. A Fund may choose not to report such Section 163(j) interest dividends.
Dividends-received deduction for corporations. For corporate shareholders, a portion of the dividends paid by the Fund may qualify for the 50% corporate dividends-received deduction. The portion of dividends paid by the Fund that so qualifies will be reported by the Fund to shareholders each year and cannot exceed the gross amount of dividends received by the Fund from domestic (U.S.) corporations. The availability of the dividends-received deduction is subject to certain holding period and debt financing restrictions that apply to both the Fund and the investor. Specifically, the amount that the Fund may report as eligible for the dividends-received deduction will be reduced or eliminated if the shares on which the dividends earned by the Fund were debt-financed or held by the Fund for less than a minimum period of time, generally 46 days during a 91-day period beginning 45 days before the stock becomes ex-dividend. Similarly, if your Fund shares are debt-financed or held by you for less than a 46-day period then the dividends-received deduction for Fund dividends on your shares also may be reduced or eliminated. Income derived by the Fund from investments in derivatives, fixed-income and foreign securities, and income received “in lieu of ” dividends in a securities lending transaction generally is not eligible for this treatment.
Impact of realized but undistributed income and gains, and net unrealized appreciation of portfolio securities. At the time of your purchase of shares (except in a money market fund that maintains a stable net asset value), the Fund’s net asset value may reflect undistributed income, undistributed capital gains, or net unrealized appreciation of portfolio securities held by the Fund. A subsequent distribution to you of such amounts, although constituting a return of your investment, would be taxable, and would be taxed as ordinary income (some portion of which may be taxed as qualified dividend income), capital gains, or some combination of both, unless you are investing through a tax-advantaged arrangement, such as a 401(k) plan or an individual retirement account. The Fund may be able to reduce the amount of such distributions from capital gains by utilizing its capital loss carryovers, if any.
Pass-through of foreign tax credits. If more than 50% of the value of the Fund’s total assets at the end of a fiscal year is invested in foreign securities, the Fund may elect to pass-through to you your pro rata share of foreign taxes paid by the Fund. If this election is made, the Fund may report more taxable income to you than it actually distributes. You will then be entitled either to deduct your share of these taxes in computing your taxable income, or to claim a foreign tax credit for these taxes against your U.S. federal income tax (subject to limitations for certain shareholders). The Fund will provide you with the information necessary to claim this deduction or credit on your personal income tax return if it makes this election. No deduction for foreign tax may be claimed by a noncorporate shareholder who does not itemize deductions or who is subject to the alternative minimum tax. Shareholders may be unable to claim a credit for the full amount of their proportionate shares of the foreign income tax paid by the Fund due to certain limitations that may apply. The Fund reserves the right not to pass-through to its shareholders the amount of foreign income taxes paid by the Fund. In addition, any foreign tax withheld on payments made “in lieu of” dividends or interest will not qualify for the pass-through of foreign tax credits to shareholders. See, “Tax Treatment of Portfolio Transactions Securities lending” below.
Tax credit bonds. If the Fund holds, directly or indirectly, one or more “tax credit bonds” (including build America bonds, clean renewable energy bonds and qualified tax credit bonds) on one or more applicable dates during a taxable year, the Fund may elect to permit its shareholders to claim a tax credit on their income tax returns equal to each shareholder’s proportionate share of tax credits from the applicable bonds that otherwise would be allowed to the Fund. In such a case, shareholders must include in gross income (as interest) their proportionate share of the income attributable to their proportionate share of those offsetting tax credits. A shareholder’s ability to claim a tax credit associated with one or more tax credit bonds may be subject to certain limitations imposed by the Internal Revenue Code. Under the TCJA, the build America bonds, clean renewable energy bonds and certain other qualified bonds may no longer be issued after December 31, 2017. Even if the Fund is eligible to pass-through tax credits to shareholders, the Fund may choose not to do so.
U.S. government securities. Income earned on certain U.S. government obligations is exempt from state and local personal income taxes if earned directly by you. States also grant tax-free status to dividends paid to you from interest earned on direct obligations of the U.S. government, subject in some states to minimum investment or reporting requirements that must be met by the Fund. Income on investments by the Fund in certain other obligations, such as repurchase agreements
112

collateralized by U.S. government obligations, securities lending agreements, commercial paper and federal agency-backed obligations (e.g., GNMA or FNMA obligations), generally does not qualify for tax-free treatment. The rules on exclusion of this income are different for corporations.
Dividends declared in December and paid in January. Ordinarily, shareholders are required to take distributions by the Fund into account in the year in which the distributions are made. However, dividends declared in October, November or December of any year and payable to shareholders of record on a specified date in such a month will be deemed to have been received by the shareholders (and made by the Fund) on December 31 of such calendar year if such dividends are actually paid in January of the following year. Shareholders will be advised annually as to the U.S. federal income tax consequences of distributions made (or deemed made) during the year in accordance with the guidance that has been provided by the IRS.
Medicare tax. A 3.8% Medicare tax is imposed on net investment income earned by certain individuals, estates and trusts. “Net investment income,” for these purposes, means investment income, including ordinary dividends and capital gain distributions received from the Fund and net gains from redemptions or other taxable dispositions of Fund shares, reduced by the deductions properly allocable to such income. In the case of an individual, the tax will be imposed on the lesser of (1) the shareholder’s net investment income or (2) the amount by which the shareholder’s modified adjusted gross income exceeds $250,000 (if the shareholder is married and filing jointly or a surviving spouse), $125,000 (if the shareholder is married and filing separately) or $200,000 (in any other case).This Medicare tax, if applicable, is reported by you on, and paid with, your federal income tax return.
Sales, Exchanges and Redemptions of Fund Shares
Sales, exchanges and redemptions (including redemptions in-kind) of Fund shares are taxable transactions for federal and state income tax purposes. If you redeem your Fund shares, the IRS requires you to report any gain or loss on your redemption. If you held your shares as a capital asset, the gain or loss that you realize will be a capital gain or loss and will be long-term or short-term, generally depending on how long you have held your shares. Any redemption fees you incur on shares redeemed will decrease the amount of any capital gain (or increase any capital loss) you realize on the sale. Capital losses in any year are deductible only to the extent of capital gains plus, in the case of a noncorporate taxpayer, $3,000 of ordinary income.
Tax basis information. The Fund is required to report to you and the IRS annually on Form 1099-B the cost basis of shares purchased or acquired on or after January 1, 2012 where the cost basis of the shares is known by the Fund (referred to as “covered shares”) and which are disposed of after that date. However, cost basis reporting is not required for certain shareholders, including shareholders investing in the Fund through a tax-advantaged retirement account, such as a 401(k) plan or an individual retirement account, or shareholders investing in a money market fund that maintains a stable net asset value. When required to report cost basis, the Fund will calculate it using the Fund’s default method of average cost, unless you instruct the Fund in writing to use a different calculation method. In general, average cost is the total cost basis of all your shares in an account divided by the total number of shares in the account. To determine whether short-term or long-term capital gains taxes apply, the IRS presumes you redeem your oldest shares first.
The IRS permits the use of several methods to determine the cost basis of mutual fund shares. The method used will determine which specific shares are deemed to be sold when there are multiple purchases on different dates at differing share prices, and the entire position is not sold at one time. The Fund does not recommend any particular method of determining cost basis, and the use of other methods may result in more favorable tax consequences for some shareholders. It is important that you consult with your tax advisor to determine which method is best for you and then notify the Fund in writing if you intend to utilize a method other than average cost for covered shares.
In addition to the Fund’s default method of average cost, other cost basis methods offered by Nationwide Mutual Funds, which you may elect to apply to covered shares, include:
FIFO (First In, First Out) - the shares purchased first are sold first.
LIFO (Last In, First Out) - the shares purchased last are sold first.
High Cost - the shares with the highest cost per share are sold first.
Low Cost - the shares with the lowest cost per share are sold first.
Loss/Gain Utilization - groups of shares (lots) are selected and sold based on generating losses first (short-term then long-term) and gains last (long-term then short-term).
113

Specific Lot Identification - you must specify the share lots to be sold at the time of redemption. This method requires you to elect a secondary method in the event the lots you designate for redemption are unavailable. The secondary method options include first in, first out; last in, first out; low cost; high cost; and loss/gain utilization. If a secondary method is not elected, first in, first out will be used.
You may elect any of the available methods detailed above for your covered shares. If you do not notify the Fund in writing of your elected cost basis method upon the initial purchase into your account, the default method of average cost will be applied to your covered shares. The cost basis for covered shares will be calculated separately from any shares purchased prior to January 1, 2012 or shares acquired on or after January 1, 2012 for which cost basis information is not known by the Fund (“noncovered shares”) you may own. You may change from average cost to another cost basis method for covered shares at any time by notifying the Fund in writing, but only for shares acquired after the date of the change (the change is prospective). The basis of the shares that were averaged before the change will remain averaged after the date of the change.
With the exception of the specific lot identification method, Nationwide Mutual Funds first depletes noncovered shares with unknown cost basis in first in, first out order and then noncovered shares with known basis in first in, first out order before applying your elected method to your remaining covered shares. If you want to deplete your shares in a different order, then you must elect specific lot identification and choose the lots you wish to deplete first.
The Fund will compute and report the cost basis of your Fund shares sold or exchanged by taking into account all of the applicable adjustments to cost basis and holding periods as required by the Internal Revenue Code and Treasury regulations for purposes of reporting these amounts to you and the IRS. However, the Fund is not required to, and in many cases the Fund does not possess the information to, take all possible basis, holding period or other adjustments into account in reporting cost basis information to you. Therefore, shareholders should carefully review the cost basis information provided by the Fund and make any additional basis, holding period or other adjustments that are required by the Internal Revenue Code and Treasury regulations when reporting these amounts on their federal income tax returns. Shareholders remain solely responsible for complying with all federal income tax laws when filing their federal income tax returns.
If you hold your Fund shares through a broker (or other nominee), please contact that broker (nominee) with respect to reporting of cost basis and available elections for your account.
Wash sales. All or a portion of any loss that you realize on a redemption of your Fund shares will be disallowed to the extent that you buy other shares in the Fund (through reinvestment of dividends or otherwise) within 30 days before or after your share redemption. Any loss disallowed under these rules will be added to your tax basis in the new shares.
Redemptions at a loss within six months of purchase. Any capital loss incurred on a redemption or exchange of shares held for six months or less will be treated as long-term capital loss to the extent of any long-term capital gain distributed to you by the Fund on those shares.
Deferral of basis. If a shareholder (a) incurs a sales load in acquiring shares of the Fund, (b) disposes of such shares less than 91 days after they are acquired, and (c) subsequently acquires shares of the Fund or another fund by January 31 of the calendar year following the calendar year in which the disposition of the original shares occurred at a reduced sales load pursuant to a right to reinvest at such reduced sales load acquired in connection with the acquisition of the shares disposed of, then the sales load on the shares disposed of (to the extent of the reduction in the sales load on the shares subsequently acquired) shall not be taken into account in determining gain or loss on the shares disposed of, but shall be treated as incurred on the acquisition of the shares subsequently acquired. The wash sale rules also may limit the amount of loss that may be taken into account on disposition after such adjustment.
Conversion or exchange of shares into shares of the same Fund. The conversion or exchange of shares of one class into another class of the same Fund is not taxable for federal income tax purposes. For example, the exchange of Class A shares for Institutional Service Class shares of the same Fund in certain Programs sponsored by and/or controlled by financial intermediaries, or the exchange of Institutional Service Class shares for Class A shares of the same Fund by certain holders who cease participation in such Programs, will be tax-free for federal income tax purposes. This is true whether the conversion occurs automatically pursuant to the terms of the class or is initiated by the shareholder. Shareholders also should consult their tax advisors regarding the state and local tax consequences of a conversion or exchange of shares.
Reportable transactions. Under Treasury regulations, if a shareholder recognizes a loss with respect to the Fund’s shares
114

of $2 million or more for an individual shareholder or $10 million or more for a corporate shareholder (or certain greater amounts over a combination of years), the shareholder must file with the IRS a disclosure statement on Form 8886. The fact that a loss is reportable under these regulations does not affect the legal determination of whether the taxpayer’s treatment of the loss is proper. Shareholders should consult their tax advisors to determine the applicability of these regulations in light of their individual circumstances.
Tax Treatment of Portfolio Transactions
Set forth below is a general description of the tax treatment of certain types of securities, investment techniques and transactions that may apply to a fund and, in turn, affect the amount, character and timing of dividends and distributions payable by the fund to its shareholders. This section should be read in conjunction with the discussion above under “ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ON PORTFOLIO INSTRUMENTS, STRATEGIES AND INVESTMENT POLICIES” for a detailed description of the various types of securities and investment techniques that apply to the Fund.
In general. In general, gain or loss recognized by a fund on the sale or other disposition of portfolio investments will be a capital gain or loss. Such capital gain and loss may be long-term or short-term depending, in general, upon the length of time a particular investment position is maintained and, in some cases, upon the nature of the transaction. Property held for more than one year generally will be eligible for long-term capital gain or loss treatment. The application of certain rules described below may serve to alter the manner in which the holding period for a security is determined or may otherwise affect the characterization as long-term or short-term, and also the timing of the realization and/or character of certain gains or losses.
Certain fixed-income investments. Gain recognized on the disposition of a debt obligation purchased by a fund at a market discount (generally, at a price less than its principal amount) will be treated as ordinary income to the extent of the portion of the market discount which accrued during the period of time the fund held the debt obligation unless the fund made a current inclusion election to accrue market discount into income as it accrues. If a fund purchases a debt obligation (such as a zero coupon security or pay-in-kind security) that was originally issued at a discount, the fund generally is required to include in gross income each year the portion of the original issue discount which accrues during such year. Therefore, a fund’s investment in such securities may cause the fund to recognize income and make distributions to shareholders before it receives any cash payments on the securities. To generate cash to satisfy those distribution requirements, a fund may have to sell portfolio securities that it otherwise might have continued to hold or to use cash flows from other sources such as the sale of fund shares.
Investments in debt obligations that are at risk of or in default present tax issues for a fund. Tax rules are not entirely clear about issues such as whether and to what extent a fund should recognize market discount on a debt obligation, when a fund may cease to accrue interest, original issue discount or market discount, when and to what extent a fund may take deductions for bad debts or worthless securities and how a fund should allocate payments received on obligations in default between principal and income. These and other related issues will be addressed by a fund in order to ensure that it distributes sufficient income to preserve its status as a regulated investment company.
Options, futures, forward contracts, swap agreements and hedging transactions. In general, option premiums received by a fund are not immediately included in the income of the fund. Instead, the premiums are recognized when the option contract expires, the option is exercised by the holder, or the fund transfers or otherwise terminates the option (e.g., through a closing transaction). If an option written by a fund is exercised and the fund sells or delivers the underlying stock, the fund generally will recognize capital gain or loss equal to (a) the sum of the strike price and the option premium received by the fund minus (b) the fund’s basis in the stock. Such gain or loss generally will be short-term or long-term depending upon the holding period of the underlying stock. If securities are purchased by a fund pursuant to the exercise of a put option written by it, the fund generally will subtract the premium received from its cost basis in the securities purchased. The gain or loss with respect to any termination of a fund’s obligation under an option other than through the exercise of the option and related sale or delivery of the underlying stock generally will be short-term gain or loss depending on whether the premium income received by the fund is greater or less than the amount paid by the fund (if any) in terminating the transaction. Thus, for example, if an option written by a fund expires unexercised, the fund generally will recognize short-term gain equal to the premium received.
The tax treatment of certain futures contracts entered into by a fund as well as listed non-equity options written or purchased by the fund on U.S. exchanges (including options on futures contracts, broad-based equity indices and debt
115

securities) may be governed by section 1256 of the Internal Revenue Code (“section 1256 contracts”). Gains or losses on section 1256 contracts generally are considered 60% long-term and 40% short-term capital gains or losses (“60/40”), although certain foreign currency gains and losses from such contracts may be treated as ordinary in character. Also, any section 1256 contracts held by a fund at the end of each taxable year (and, for purposes of the 4% excise tax, on certain other dates as prescribed under the Internal Revenue Code) are “marked to market” with the result that unrealized gains or losses are treated as though they were realized and the resulting gain or loss is treated as ordinary or 60/40 gain or loss, as applicable. Section 1256 contracts do not include any interest rate swap, currency swap, basis swap, interest rate cap, interest rate floor, commodity swap, equity swap, equity index swap, credit default swap, or similar agreement.
In addition to the special rules described above in respect of options and futures transactions, a fund’s transactions in other derivative instruments (including options, forward contracts and swap agreements) as well as its other hedging, short sale, or similar transactions, may be subject to one or more special tax rules (including the constructive sale, notional principal contract, straddle, wash sale and short sale rules). These rules may affect whether gains and losses recognized by a fund are treated as ordinary or capital or as short-term or long-term, accelerate the recognition of income or gains to the fund, defer losses to the fund, and cause adjustments in the holding periods of the fund’s securities. These rules, therefore, could affect the amount, timing and/or character of distributions to shareholders. Moreover, because the tax rules applicable to derivative instruments are in some cases uncertain under current law, an adverse determination or future guidance by the IRS with respect to these rules (which determination or guidance could be retroactive) may affect whether a fund has made sufficient distributions, and otherwise satisfied the relevant requirements, to maintain its qualification as a regulated investment company and avoid a fund-level tax.
Certain of a fund’s investments in derivatives and foreign currency-denominated instruments, and the fund’s transactions in foreign currencies and hedging activities, may produce a difference between its book income and its taxable income. If a fund’s book income is less than the sum of its taxable income and net tax-exempt income (if any), the fund could be required to make distributions exceeding book income to qualify as a regulated investment company. If a fund’s book income exceeds the sum of its taxable income and net tax-exempt income (if any), the distribution of any such excess will be treated as (i) a dividend to the extent of the fund’s remaining earnings and profits (including current earnings and profits arising from tax-exempt income, reduced by related deductions), (ii) thereafter, as a return of capital to the extent of the recipient’s basis in the shares, and (iii) thereafter, as gain from the sale or exchange of a capital asset.
Foreign currency transactions. A fund’s transactions in foreign currencies, foreign currency-denominated debt obligations and certain foreign currency options, futures contracts and forward contracts (and similar instruments) may give rise to ordinary income or loss to the extent such income or loss results from fluctuations in the value of the foreign currency concerned. This treatment could increase or decrease a fund's ordinary income distributions to you, and may cause some or all of the fund's previously distributed income to be classified as a return of capital. In certain cases, a fund may make an election to treat such gain or loss as capital.
PFIC investments. A fund may invest in securities of foreign companies that may be classified under the Internal Revenue Code as PFICs. In general, a foreign company is classified as a PFIC if at least one-half of its assets constitute investment-type assets or 75% or more of its gross income is investment-type income. When investing in PFIC securities, a fund intends to mark-to-market these securities under certain provisions of the Internal Revenue Code and recognize any unrealized gains as ordinary income at the end of the fund’s fiscal and excise tax years. Deductions for losses are allowable only to the extent of any current or previously recognized gains. These gains (reduced by allowable losses) are treated as ordinary income that a fund is required to distribute, even though it has not sold or received dividends from these securities. You also should be aware that the designation of a foreign security as a PFIC security will cause its income dividends to fall outside of the definition of qualified foreign corporation dividends. These dividends generally will not qualify for the reduced rate of taxation on qualified dividends when distributed to you by a fund. Foreign companies are not required to identify themselves as PFICs. Due to various complexities in identifying PFICs, a fund can give no assurances that it will be able to identify portfolio securities in foreign corporations that are PFICs in time for the fund to make a mark-to-market election. If a fund is unable to identify an investment as a PFIC and thus does not make a mark-to-market election, the fund may be subject to U.S. federal income tax on a portion of any “excess distribution” or gain from the disposition of such shares even if such income is distributed as a taxable dividend by the fund to its shareholders. Additional charges in the nature of interest may be imposed on a fund in respect of deferred taxes arising from such distributions or gains.
Investments in U.S. REITs. A U.S. REIT is not subject to federal income tax on the income and gains it distributes to shareholders. Dividends paid by a U.S. REIT, other than capital gain distributions, will be taxable as ordinary income up to
116

the amount of the U.S. REIT’s current and accumulated earnings and profits. Capital gain dividends paid by a U.S. REIT to a fund will be treated as long-term capital gains by the fund and, in turn, may be distributed by the fund to its shareholders as a capital gain distribution. Because of certain noncash expenses, such as property depreciation, an equity U.S. REIT’s cash flow may exceed its taxable income. The equity U.S. REIT, and in turn a fund, may distribute this excess cash to shareholders in the form of a return of capital distribution. However, if a U.S. REIT is operated in a manner that fails to qualify as a U.S. REIT, an investment in the U.S. REIT would become subject to double taxation, meaning the taxable income of the U.S. REIT would be subject to federal income tax at the corporate income tax rate without any deduction for dividends paid to shareholders and the dividends would be taxable to shareholders as ordinary income (or possibly as qualified dividend income) to the extent of the U.S. REIT’s current and accumulated earnings and profits. Also, see, “Tax Treatment of Portfolio Transactions Investment in taxable mortgage pools (excess inclusion income)” and “Non-U.S. Investors Investment in U.S. real property” below with respect to certain other tax aspects of investing in U.S. REITs.
Investment in non-U.S. REITs. While non-U.S. REITs often use complex acquisition structures that seek to minimize taxation in the source country, an investment by a fund in a non-U.S. REIT may subject the fund, directly or indirectly, to corporate taxes, withholding taxes, transfer taxes and other indirect taxes in the country in which the real estate acquired by the non-U.S. REIT is located. A fund’s pro rata share of any such taxes will reduce the fund’s return on its investment. A fund’s investment in a non-U.S. REIT may be considered an investment in a PFIC, as discussed above in “PFIC investments.” In addition, foreign withholding taxes on distributions from the non-U.S. REIT may be reduced or eliminated under certain tax treaties, as discussed above in “Taxation of the Fund Foreign income tax.” Also, a fund in certain limited circumstances may be required to file an income tax return in the source country and pay tax on any gain realized from its investment in the non-U.S. REIT under rules similar to those in the United States, which tax foreign persons on gain realized from dispositions of interests in U.S. real estate.
Investment in taxable mortgage pools (excess inclusion income). Under a Notice issued by the IRS, the Internal Revenue Code and Treasury regulations to be issued, a portion of a fund’s income from a U.S. REIT that is attributable to the REIT’s residual interest in a real estate mortgage investment conduit (“REMIC”) or equity interests in a “taxable mortgage pool” (referred to in the Internal Revenue Code as an excess inclusion) will be subject to federal income tax in all events. The excess inclusion income of a regulated investment company, such as a fund, will be allocated to shareholders of the regulated investment company in proportion to the dividends received by such shareholders, with the same consequences as if the shareholders held the related REMIC residual interest or, if applicable, taxable mortgage pool directly. In general, excess inclusion income allocated to shareholders (i) cannot be offset by net operating losses (subject to a limited exception for certain thrift institutions), (ii) will constitute unrelated business taxable income (“UBTI”) to entities (including qualified pension plans, individual retirement accounts, 401(k) plans, Keogh plans or other tax-exempt entities) subject to tax on UBTI, thereby potentially requiring such an entity that is allocated excess inclusion income, and otherwise might not be required to file a tax return, to file a tax return and pay tax on such income, and (iii) in the case of a foreign stockholder, will not qualify for any reduction in U.S. federal withholding tax. In addition, if at any time during any taxable year a “disqualified organization” (which generally includes certain cooperatives, governmental entities, and tax-exempt organizations not subject to UBTI) is a record holder of a share in a regulated investment company, then the regulated investment company will be subject to a tax equal to that portion of its excess inclusion income for the taxable year that is allocable to the disqualified organization, multiplied by the corporate income tax rate. The Notice imposes certain reporting requirements upon regulated investment companies that have excess inclusion income. There can be no assurance that a fund will not allocate to shareholders excess inclusion income.
These rules are potentially applicable to a fund with respect to any income it receives from the equity interests of certain mortgage pooling vehicles, either directly or, as is more likely, through an investment in a U.S. REIT. It is unlikely that these rules will apply to a fund that has a non-REIT strategy.
Investments in partnerships and QPTPs. For purposes of the Income Requirement, income derived by a fund from a partnership that is not a QPTP will be treated as qualifying income only to the extent such income is attributable to items of income of the partnership that would be qualifying income if realized directly by the fund. While the rules are not entirely clear with respect to a fund investing in a partnership outside a master-feeder structure, for purposes of testing whether a fund satisfies the Asset Diversification Test, the fund generally is treated as owning a pro rata share of the underlying assets of a partnership. See, “Taxation of the Fund.” In contrast, different rules apply to a partnership that is a QPTP. A QPTP is a partnership (a) the interests in which are traded on an established securities market, (b) that is treated as a partnership for federal income tax purposes, and (c) that derives less than 90% of its income from sources that satisfy the Income Requirement (e.g., because it invests in commodities). All of the net income derived by a fund from an interest in a QPTP
117

will be treated as qualifying income but the fund may not invest more than 25% of its total assets in one or more QPTPs. However, there can be no assurance that a partnership classified as a QPTP in one year will qualify as a QPTP in the next year. Any such failure to annually qualify as a QPTP might, in turn, cause a fund to fail to qualify as a regulated investment company. Although, in general, the passive loss rules of the Internal Revenue Code do not apply to RICs, such rules do apply to a fund with respect to items attributable to an interest in a QPTP. Fund investments in partnerships, including in QPTPs, may result in the fund being subject to state, local or foreign income, franchise or withholding tax liabilities.
Securities lending. While securities are loaned out by a fund, the fund generally will receive from the borrower amounts equal to any dividends or interest paid on the borrowed securities. For federal income tax purposes, payments made “in lieu of” dividends are not considered dividend income. These distributions will neither qualify for the reduced rate of taxation for individuals on qualified dividends nor the 50% dividends-received deduction for corporations. Also, any foreign tax withheld on payments made “in lieu of” dividends or interest will not qualify for the pass-through of foreign tax credits to shareholders.
Investments in convertible securities. Convertible debt is ordinarily treated as a “single property” consisting of a pure debt interest until conversion, after which the investment becomes an equity interest. If the security is issued at a premium (i.e., for cash in excess of the face amount payable on retirement), the creditor-holder may amortize the premium unrelated to the conversion feature of the security over the life of the bond. If the security is issued for cash at a price below its face amount, the creditor-holder must accrue original issue discount in income over the life of the debt. The creditor-holder's exercise of the conversion privilege is treated as a nontaxable event. Mandatorily convertible debt (e.g., an exchange-traded note or ETN issued in the form of an unsecured obligation that pays a return based on the performance of a specified market index, exchange currency, or commodity) is often, but not always, treated as a contract to buy or sell the reference property rather than debt. Similarly, convertible preferred stock with a mandatory conversion feature is ordinarily, but not always, treated as equity rather than debt. Dividends received may be qualified dividend income and eligible for the corporate dividends-received deduction. In general, conversion of preferred stock for common stock of the same corporation is tax-free. Conversion of preferred stock for cash is a taxable redemption. Any redemption premium for preferred stock that is redeemable by the issuing company might be required to be amortized under original issue discount principles. A change in the conversion ratio or conversion price of a convertible security on account of a dividend paid to the issuer’s other shareholders may result in a deemed distribution of stock to the holders of the convertible security equal to the value of their increased interest in the equity of the issuer. Thus, an increase in the conversion ratio of a convertible security can be treated as a taxable distribution of stock to a holder of the convertible security (without a corresponding receipt of cash by the holder) before the holder has converted the security.
Investments in securities of uncertain tax character. A fund may invest in securities the U.S. federal income tax treatment of which may not be clear or may be subject to recharacterization by the IRS. To the extent the tax treatment of such securities or the income from such securities differs from the tax treatment expected by a fund, it could affect the timing or character of income recognized by the fund, requiring the fund to purchase or sell securities, or otherwise change its portfolio, in order to comply with the tax rules applicable to regulated investment companies under the Internal Revenue Code.
Backup Withholding
By law, the Fund may be required to withhold a portion of your taxable dividends and sales proceeds unless you:
provide your correct social security or taxpayer identification number,
certify that this number is correct,
certify that you are not subject to backup withholding, and
certify that you are a U.S. person (including a U.S. resident alien).
The Fund also must withhold if the IRS instructs it to do so. When withholding is required, the amount will be 24% of any distributions or proceeds paid. Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld may be credited against the shareholder’s U.S. federal income tax liability, provided the appropriate information is furnished to the IRS. Certain payees and payments are exempt from backup withholding and information reporting. The special U.S. tax certification requirements applicable to non-U.S. investors to avoid backup withholding are described under the “Non-U.S. Investors” heading below.
118

Non-U.S. Investors
Non-U.S. investors (shareholders who, as to the United States, are nonresident alien individuals, foreign trusts or estates, foreign corporations, or foreign partnerships) may be subject to U.S. withholding and estate tax and are subject to special U.S. tax certification requirements. Non-U.S. investors should consult their tax advisors about the applicability of U.S. tax withholding and the use of the appropriate forms to certify their status.
In general. The United States imposes a flat 30% withholding tax (or a withholding tax at a lower treaty rate) on U.S. source dividends, including on income dividends paid to you by the Fund. Exemptions from this U.S. withholding tax are provided for capital gain dividends paid by the Fund from its net long-term capital gains, interest-related dividends paid by the Fund from its qualified net interest income from U.S. sources, and short-term capital gain dividends.
However, the Fund may choose not to utilize the exemptions for interest-related dividends paid and short- term capital gains dividends paid. Moreover, notwithstanding such exemptions from U.S. withholding at the source, any dividends and distributions of income and capital gains, including the proceeds from the sale of your Fund shares, will be subject to backup withholding at a rate of 24% if you fail to properly certify that you are not a U.S. person.
Net investment income from dividends on stock and foreign source interest income continue to be subject to withholding tax; foreign tax credits. Ordinary dividends paid by the Fund to non-U.S. investors on the income earned on portfolio investments in (i) the stock of domestic and foreign corporations and (ii) the debt of foreign issuers continue to be subject to U.S. withholding tax. Foreign shareholders may be subject to U.S. withholding tax at a rate of 30% on the income resulting from an election to pass-through foreign tax credits to shareholders, but may not be able to claim a credit or deduction with respect to the withholding tax for the foreign tax treated as having been paid by them.
Income effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business. If the income from the Fund is effectively connected with a U.S. trade or business carried on by a foreign shareholder, then ordinary income dividends, capital gain dividends and any gains realized upon the sale or redemption of shares of the Fund will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at the rates applicable to U.S. citizens or domestic corporations and require the filing of a nonresident U.S. income tax return.
Investment in U.S. real property. The Foreign Investment in Real Property Tax Act of 1980 (“FIRPTA”) makes non-U.S. persons subject to U.S. tax on disposition of a U.S. real property interest (“USRPI”) as if he or she were a U.S. person. Such gain is sometimes referred to as FIRPTA gain. The Fund may invest in equity securities of corporations that invest in USRPI, including U.S. REITs, which may trigger FIRPTA gain to the Fund’s non-U.S. shareholders.
The Internal Revenue Code provides a look-through rule for distributions of FIRPTA gain when a RIC is classified as a qualified investment entity. A RIC will be classified as a qualified investment entity if, in general, 50% or more of the RIC’s assets consist of interests in U.S. REITs, USRPIs and other U.S. real property holding corporations (“USRPHC”). If a RIC is a qualified investment entity and the non-U.S. shareholder owns more than 5% of a class of Fund shares at any time during the one-year period ending on the date of the FIRPTA distribution, the FIRPTA distribution to the non-U.S. shareholder is treated as gain from the disposition of a USRPI, causing the distribution to be subject to U.S. withholding tax at the corporate income tax rate (unless reduced by future regulations), and requiring the non-U.S. shareholder to file a nonresident U.S. income tax return. In addition, even if the non-U.S. shareholder does not own more than 5% of a class of Fund shares, but the Fund is a qualified investment entity, the FIRPTA distribution will be taxable as ordinary dividends (rather than as a capital gain or short-term capital gain dividend) subject to withholding at 30% or lower treaty rate.
Because the Fund expects to invest less than 50% of its assets at all times, directly or indirectly, in U.S. real property interests, the Fund expects that neither gain on the sale or redemption of Fund shares nor Fund dividends and distributions would be subject to FIRPTA reporting and tax withholding.
U.S. estate tax. Transfers by gift of shares of the Fund by a foreign shareholder who is a nonresident alien individual will not be subject to U.S. federal gift tax. An individual who, at the time of death, is a non-U.S. shareholder will nevertheless be subject to U.S. federal estate tax with respect to Fund shares at the graduated rates applicable to U.S. citizens and residents, unless a treaty exemption applies. If a treaty exemption is available, a decedent’s estate may nonetheless need to file a U.S. estate tax return to claim the exemption in order to obtain a U.S. federal transfer certificate. The transfer certificate will identify the property (i.e., Fund shares) as to which the U.S. federal estate tax lien has been released. In the absence of a treaty, there is a $13,000 statutory estate tax credit (equivalent to U.S. situs assets with a value of $60,000). For estates with
119

U.S. situs assets of not more than $60,000, the Fund may accept, in lieu of a transfer certificate, an affidavit from an appropriate individual evidencing that decedent’s U.S. situs assets are below this threshold amount.
U.S. tax certification rules. Special U.S. tax certification requirements may apply to non-U.S. shareholders both to avoid U.S. backup withholding imposed at a rate of 24% and to obtain the benefits of any treaty between the U.S. and the shareholder’s country of residence. In general, if you are a non-U.S. shareholder, you must provide a Form W-8 BEN (or other applicable Form W-8) to establish that you are not a U.S. person, to claim that you are the beneficial owner of the income and, if applicable, to claim a reduced rate of, or exemption from, withholding as a resident of a country with which the United States has an income tax treaty. A Form W-8 BEN provided without a U.S. taxpayer identification number will remain in effect for a period beginning on the date signed and ending on the last day of the third succeeding calendar year unless an earlier change of circumstances makes the information on the form incorrect. Certain payees and payments are exempt from backup withholding.
The tax consequences to a non-U.S. shareholder entitled to claim the benefits of an applicable tax treaty may be different from those described herein. Non-U.S. shareholders are urged to consult their own tax advisors with respect to the particular tax consequences to them of an investment in the Fund, including the applicability of foreign tax.
Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act (“FATCA”). Under FATCA, the Fund will be required to withhold a 30% tax on income dividends made by the Fund to certain foreign entities, referred to as foreign financial institutions (“FFI”) or nonfinancial foreign entities (“NFFE”). After December 31, 2018, FATCA withholding also would have applied to certain capital gain distributions, return of capital distributions and the proceeds arising from the sale of Fund shares; however, based on proposed regulations issued by the IRS, which can be relied upon currently, such withholding is no longer required unless final regulations provide otherwise (which is not expected). The FATCA withholding tax generally can be avoided: (a) by an FFI, if it reports certain direct and indirect ownership of foreign financial accounts held by U.S. persons with the FFI and (b) by an NFFE, if it meets certification requirements described below. The U.S. Treasury has negotiated intergovernmental agreements (“IGA”) with certain countries and is in various stages of negotiations with a number of other foreign countries with respect to one or more alternative approaches to implement FATCA; an entity in one of those countries may be required to comply with the terms of an IGA instead of U.S. Treasury regulations.
An FFI can avoid FATCA withholding if it is deemed compliant or by becoming a “participating FFI,” which requires the FFI to enter into a U.S. tax compliance agreement with the IRS under section 1471(b) of the Internal Revenue Code (“FFI agreement”) under which it agrees to verify, report and disclose certain of its U.S. accountholders and meet certain other specified requirements. The FFI will either report the specified information about the U.S. accounts to the IRS, or, to the government of the FFI’s country of residence (pursuant to the terms and conditions of applicable law and an applicable IGA entered into between the U.S. and the FFI’s country of residence), which will, in turn, report the specified information to the IRS. An FFI that is resident in a country that has entered into an IGA with the U.S. to implement FATCA will be exempt from FATCA withholding provided that the FFI shareholder and the applicable foreign government comply with the terms of such agreement.
An NFFE that is the beneficial owner of a payment from the Fund can avoid the FATCA withholding tax generally by certifying that it does not have any substantial U.S. owners or by providing the name, address and taxpayer identification number of each substantial U.S. owner. The NFFE will report the information to the Fund or other applicable withholding agent, which will, in turn, report the information to the IRS.
Such foreign shareholders also may fall into certain exempt, excepted or deemed compliant categories as established by U.S. Treasury regulations, IGAs, and other guidance regarding FATCA. An FFI or NFFE that invests in the Fund will need to provide the Fund with documentation properly certifying the entity’s status under FATCA in order to avoid FATCA withholding. Non-U.S. investors should consult their own tax advisors regarding the impact of these requirements on their investment in the Fund. The requirements imposed by FATCA are different from, and in addition to, the U.S. tax certification rules to avoid backup withholding described above. Shareholders are urged to consult their tax advisors regarding the application of these requirements to their own situation.
Effect of Future Legislation; Local Tax Considerations
The foregoing general discussion of U.S. federal income tax consequences is based on the Internal Revenue Code and the regulations issued thereunder as in effect on the date of this Statement of Additional Information. Future legislative or
120

administrative changes, including provisions of current law that sunset and thereafter no longer apply, or court decisions may significantly change the conclusions expressed herein, and any such changes or decisions may have a retroactive effect with respect to the transactions contemplated herein. Rules of state and local taxation of ordinary income, qualified dividend income and capital gain dividends may differ from the rules for U.S. federal income taxation described above. Distributions also may be subject to additional state, local and foreign taxes depending on each shareholder's particular situation. Non-U.S. shareholders may be subject to U.S. tax rules that differ significantly from those summarized above. Shareholders are urged to consult their tax advisors as to the consequences of these and other state and local tax rules affecting investment in the Fund.
Additional Tax Information with Respect to the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund
The tax information described in “Additional General Tax Information for All Funds” above applies to the Nationwide Government Money Market Fund (the “Money Market Fund”), except as noted in this section.
Distributions of net investment income
The Money Market Fund typically declares dividends from its daily net income each day that its NAV is calculated and pays such dividends monthly. The Money Market Fund’s daily net income includes accrued interest and any original issue or acquisition discount, plus or minus any gain or loss on the sale of portfolio securities and changes in unrealized appreciation or depreciation in portfolio securities (to the extent required to maintain a stable $1 share price), less the estimated expenses of the Money Market Fund. Any distributions by the Money Market Fund from such income will be taxable to you as ordinary income, whether you receive them in cash or in additional shares.
Distributions of capital gain
The Money Market Fund may derive capital gain or loss in connection with sales or other dispositions of its portfolio securities. If you are a taxable investor, distributions from net short-term capital gain will be taxable to you as ordinary income. Because the Money Market Fund is a money market fund, it is not expected to realize any long-term capital gain.
Maintaining a $1 share price
Gain and loss on the sale of portfolio securities and unrealized appreciation or depreciation in the value of these securities may require the Money Market Fund to adjust distributions, including withholding dividends, to maintain its $1 share price. These procedures may result in under- or over-distributions by the Money Market Fund of its net investment income. This in turn may result in return of capital distributions, the effect of which is described above in “Taxation of Fund Distributions Returns of capital.”
Redemption of Fund shares
Redemptions (including redemptions in kind) and exchanges of Money Market Fund shares are taxable transactions for federal and state income tax purposes. Because the Money Market Fund tries to maintain a stable $1 share price, however, you should not expect to realize any capital gain or loss on the sale or exchange of your shares. For tax purposes, an exchange of your Money Market Fund shares for shares of a different Nationwide Fund is the same as a sale. Shareholders may elect to adopt a simplified “NAV method” for computing gains and losses from taxable sales, exchanges or redemptions of Money Market Fund shares. Under the NAV method, rather than computing gain or loss separately for each taxable disposition of shares as described above, a shareholder would determine gain or loss based on the change in the aggregate value of the shareholder’s shares during a computation period (which could be the shareholder’s taxable year or certain shorter periods), reduced by the shareholder’s net investment (purchases minus taxable sales, exchanges, or redemptions or exchanges) in those shares during that period. Under the NAV method, if a shareholder holds the shares as a capital asset, any resulting net gain or loss would be treated as short-term capital gain or loss.
Wash sale rule
All or a portion of any loss so realized on the sale or redemption of shares in the Money Market Fund may be deferred under the wash sale rules if the shareholder purchases other shares of the same Fund within 30 days before or after the sale or redemption and the shareholder does not elect to adopt the NAV method.
121

Qualified dividend income for individuals
Because the Money Market Fund’s income is derived primarily from interest rather than dividends, none of its distributions are expected to be qualified dividends eligible for taxation by individuals at long-term capital gain rates.
Dividends-received deduction for corporations
Because the Money Market Fund’s income is derived primarily from interest rather than dividends, none of its distributions are expected to qualify for the corporate dividends-received deduction.
ADDITIONAL TAX INFORMATION WITH RESPECT TO THE NATIONWIDE BNY MELLON CORE PLUS BOND ESG FUND, NATIONWIDE BOND FUND, NATIONWIDE BOND INDEX FUND, NATIONWIDE INTERNATIONAL INDEX FUND, NATIONWIDE INFLATION-PROTECTED SECURITIES FUND, NATIONWIDE LOOMIS CORE BOND FUND AND NATIONWIDE LOOMIS SHORT-TERM BOND FUND
The tax information described in “Additional General Tax Information for All Funds” above applies to the Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund, Nationwide Bond Fund, Nationwide Bond Index Fund, Nationwide International Index Fund, Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund, Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund and Nationwide Loomis Short-Term Bond Fund except as noted in this section.
Qualified dividend income for individuals
Because the income of the Nationwide Bond Fund, Nationwide Bond Index Fund, Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund and Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund is derived primarily from interest rather than dividends, generally none or only a small portion of its distributions are expected to be qualified dividends eligible for taxation by individuals at long-term capital gain rates.
Dividends-received deduction for corporations
Because each Fund’s income is derived primarily from interest or foreign securities, generally none or only a small portion of its distributions are expected to qualify for the corporate dividends-received deduction.
Major Shareholders
To the extent NFA and its affiliates directly or indirectly own, control and hold power to vote 25% or more of the outstanding shares of the Funds, it is deemed to have “control” over matters which are subject to a vote of the Funds shares.
NFA, is wholly owned by NFS. NFS, a holding company, is a direct wholly owned subsidiary of Nationwide Corporation. Nationwide Corporation is also a holding company in the Nationwide Insurance Enterprise, which includes Nationwide Investment Management Group. All of the common stock of Nationwide Corporation is held by Nationwide Mutual Insurance Company, which is a mutual company owned by its policyholders.
As of [__________], 2024, the Trustees and Officers of the Trust, as a group, owned beneficially less than 1% of any class of shares of the Fund.
As of [__________], 2024, the record shareholders identified in Appendix D to this SAI held five percent or greater of the shares of a class of the Fund.
122

APPENDIX A
DEBT RATINGS
STANDARD & POOR’S DEBT RATINGS
A Standard & Poor’s corporate or municipal debt rating is an opinion of the general creditworthiness of an obligor, or the creditworthiness of an obligor with respect to a particular debt security or other financial obligation, based on relevant risk factors.
The debt rating does not constitute a recommendation to purchase, sell, or hold a particular security. In addition, a rating does not comment on the suitability of an investment for a particular investor. The ratings are based on current information furnished by the issuer or obtained by Standard & Poor’s from other sources it considers reliable. Standard & Poor’s does not perform an audit in connection with any rating and may, on occasion, rely on unaudited financial information. The ratings may be changed, suspended, or withdrawn as a result of changes in, or unavailability of, such information, or for other circumstances.
The ratings are based, in varying degrees, on the following considerations:
1.
Likelihood of default - capacity and willingness of the obligor as to its financial commitments in a timely manner in accordance with the terms of the obligation.
2.
Nature of and provisions of the obligation.
3.
Protection afforded by, and relative position of, the obligation in the event of bankruptcy, reorganization, or other arrangement under the laws of bankruptcy and other laws affecting creditors’ rights.
INVESTMENT GRADE
AAA
Debt rated ‘AAA’ has the highest rating assigned by Standard & Poor’s. Capacity to meet financial commitments is
extremely strong.
AA
Debt rated ‘AA’ has a very strong capacity to meet financial commitments and differs from the highest rated issues
only in small degree.
A
Debt rated ‘A’ has a strong capacity to meet financial commitments although it is somewhat more susceptible to the
adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions than debt in higher rated categories.
BBB
Debt rated ‘BBB’ is regarded as having an adequate capacity meet financial commitments. Whereas it normally
exhibits adequate protection parameters, adverse economic conditions or changing circumstances are more likely
to lead to a weakened capacity to meet financial commitments for debt in this category than in higher rated
categories.
SPECULATIVE GRADE
Debt rated ‘BB’, ‘B’, ‘CCC’, ‘CC’ and ‘C’ are regarded as having significant speculative characteristics with respect to capacity to pay interest and repay principal. ‘BB’ indicates the least degree of speculation and ‘C’ the highest. While such debt will likely have some quality and protective characteristics, these may be outweighed by large uncertainties or major risk exposures to adverse conditions.
BB
Debt rated ‘BB’ is less vulnerable to nonpayment than other speculative issues. However, it faces major ongoing
uncertainties or exposure to adverse business, financial, or economic conditions which could lead to inadequate
capacity to meet financial commitments.
B
Debt rated ‘B’ has a greater vulnerability to nonpayment than obligations rated BB but currently has the capacity to
meet its financial commitments. Adverse business, financial, or economic conditions will likely impair capacity or
willingness to meet financial commitments.
A-1

CCC
Debt rated ‘CCC’ is currently vulnerable to nonpayment and is dependent upon favorable business, financial, and
economic conditions to meet financial commitments. In the event of adverse business, financial, or economic
conditions, it is not likely to have the capacity to meet its financial commitments.
CC
Debt rated ‘CC’ typically is currently highly vulnerable to nonpayment.
C
Debt rated ‘C’ may signify that a bankruptcy petition has been filed, but debt service payments are continued.
D
Debt rated ‘D’ is in payment default. The ‘D’ rating category is used when interest payments or principal payments
are not made on the date due even if the applicable grace period has not expired, unless Standard & Poor’s believes
that such payments will be made during such grace period. The ‘D’ rating also will be used upon the filing of a
bankruptcy petition if debt service payments are jeopardized.
MOODY’S LONG-TERM DEBT RATINGS
Aaa
Bonds which are rated Aaa are judged to be of the highest quality, with minimal credit risk.
Aa
Bonds which are rated Aa are judged to be of high quality by all standards and are subject to very low credit risk.
A
Bonds which are rated A are to be considered as upper-medium grade obligations and subject to low credit risk.
Baa
Bonds which are rated Baa are considered as medium-grade obligations, subject to moderate credit risk and in fact
may have speculative characteristics.
Ba
Bonds which are rated Ba are judged to have speculative elements and are subject to substantial credit risk.
B
Bonds which are rated B are considered speculative and are subject to high credit risk.
Caa
Bonds which are rated Caa are judged to be of poor standing and are subject to very high credit risk.
Ca
Bonds which are rated Ca represent obligations which are highly speculative. Such issues are likely in default, or
very near, with some prospect of recovery of principal and interest.
C
Bonds which are rated C are the lowest rated class of bonds, and are typically in default. There is little prospect for
recovery of principal or interest.
STATE AND MUNICIPAL NOTES
Excerpts from Moody’s Investors Service, Inc., description of state and municipal note ratings:
MIG-1
Notes bearing this designation are of superior credit quality, enjoying excellent protection by established cash
flows, highly reliable liquidity support, or demonstrated broad based access to the market for refinancing.
MIG-2
Notes bearing this designation are of strong credit quality, with margins of protection ample although not so large
as in the preceding group.
MIG-3
Notes bearing this designation are of acceptable credit quality, with possibly narrow liquidity and cash flow
protection. Market access for refinancing is likely to be less well established.
SG
Notes bearing this designation are of speculative grade credit quality and may lack sufficient margins of
protection.
FITCH, INC. BOND RATINGS
Fitch investment grade bond ratings provide a guide to investors in determining the credit risk associated with a particular security. The ratings represent Fitch’s assessment of the issuer’s ability to meet the obligations of a specific debt issue or class of debt in a timely manner.
The rating takes into consideration special features of the issue, its relationship to other obligations of the issuer, the current and prospective financial condition and operating performance of the issuer and any guarantor, as well as the economic and political environment that might affect the issuer’s future financial strength and credit quality.
A-2

Fitch ratings do not reflect any credit enhancement that may be provided by insurance policies or financial guaranties unless otherwise indicated.
Bonds that have the same rating are of similar but not necessarily identical credit quality since the rating categories do not fully reflect small differences in the degrees of credit risk.
Fitch ratings are not recommendations to buy, sell, or hold any security. Ratings do not comment on the adequacy of market price, the suitability of any security for a particular investor, or the tax-exempt nature or taxability of payments made in respect of any security.
Fitch ratings are based on information obtained from issuers, other obligors, underwriters, their experts, and other sources Fitch believes to be reliable. Fitch does not audit or verify the truth or accuracy of such information. Ratings may be changed, suspended, or withdrawn as a result of changes in, or the unavailability of, information or for other reasons.
AAA
Bonds considered investment grade and representing the lowest expectation of credit risk. The obligor
has an exceptionally strong capacity for timely payment of financial commitments, a capacity that is
highly unlikely to be adversely affected by foreseeable events.
AA
Bonds considered to be investment grade and of very high credit quality. This rating indicates a very
strong capacity for timely payment of financial commitments, a capacity that is not significantly
vulnerable to foreseeable events.
A
Bonds considered to be investment grade and represent a low expectation of credit risk. This rating
indicates a strong capacity for timely payment of financial commitments. This capacity may,
nevertheless, be more vulnerable to changes in economic conditions or circumstances than long term
debt with higher ratings.
BBB
Bonds considered to be in the lowest investment grade and indicates that there is currently low
expectation of credit risk. The capacity for timely payment of financial commitments is considered
adequate, but adverse changes in economic conditions and circumstances are more likely to impair this
capacity.
BB
Bonds are considered speculative. This rating indicates that there is a possibility of credit risk
developing, particularly as the result of adverse economic changes over time; however, business or
financial alternatives may be available to allow financial commitments to be met. Securities rated in
this category are not investment grade.
B
Bonds are considered highly speculative. This rating indicates that significant credit risk is present, but
a limited margin of safety remains. Financial commitments are currently being met; however, capacity
for continued payment is contingent upon a sustained, favorable business and economic environment.
CCC, CC and C
Bonds are considered a high default risk. Default is a real possibility. Capacity for meeting financial
commitments is solely reliant upon sustained, favorable business or economic developments. A ‘CC’
rating indicates that default of some kind appears probable. ‘C’ rating signal imminent default.
DDD, DD and D
Bonds are in default. Such bonds are not meeting current obligations and are extremely speculative.
‘DDD’ designates the highest potential for recovery of amounts outstanding on any securities involved
and ‘D’ represents the lowest potential for recovery.
SHORT-TERM RATINGS
STANDARD & POOR’S COMMERCIAL PAPER RATINGS
A Standard & Poor’s commercial paper rating is a current assessment of the likelihood of timely payment of debt considered short-term in the relevant market.
A-3

Ratings are graded into several categories, ranging from ‘A-1’ for the highest quality obligations to ‘D’ for the lowest. These categories are as follows:
A-1
This highest category indicates that capacity to meet financial commitments is strong. Those issues determined to
possess extremely strong safety characteristics are denoted with a plus sign (+) designation.
A-2
Capacity to meet financial commitments is satisfactory, although more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes
in circumstances and economic conditions than obligations in higher rating categories.
A-3
Issues carrying this designation have adequate protections. They are, however, more vulnerable to adverse economic
conditions or changing circumstances which could weaken capacity to meet financial commitments.
B
Issues rated ‘B’ are regarded as having significant speculative characteristics.
C
This rating is assigned to short-term debt obligations that are vulnerable to nonpayment and dependent on favorable
business, financial, and economic conditions in order to meet financial commitments.
D
Debt rated ‘D’ is in payment default. The ‘D’ rating category is used when interest payments or principal payments
are not made on the date due even if the applicable grace period has not expired, unless Standard & Poor’s believes
that such payments will be made during such grace period. The ‘D’ rating also will be used upon the filing of a
bankruptcy petition if debt service payments are jeopardized.
STANDARD & POOR’S NOTE RATINGS
An S&P note rating reflects the liquidity factors and market-access risks unique to notes. Notes maturing in three years or less will likely receive a note rating. Notes maturing beyond three years will most likely receive a long-term debt rating.
The following criteria will be used in making the assessment:
1.
Amortization schedule - the larger the final maturity relative to other maturities, the more likely the issue is to be treated as a note.
2.
Source of payment - the more the issue depends on the market for its refinancing, the more likely it is to be considered a note.
Note rating symbols and definitions are as follows:
SP-1
Strong capacity to pay principal and interest. Issues determined to possess very strong capacity to pay principal and
interest are given a plus (+) designation.
SP-2
Satisfactory capacity to pay principal and interest, with some vulnerability to adverse financial and economic
changes over the term of the notes.
SP-3
Speculative capacity to pay principal and interest.
MOODY’S SHORT-TERM RATINGS
Moody’s short-term debt ratings are opinions of the ability of issuers to honor short-term financial obligations. These obligations have an original maturity not exceeding thirteen months, unless explicitly noted. Moody’s employs the following three designations to indicate the relative repayment capacity of rated issuers:
P-1
Issuers (or supporting institutions) rated Prime-1 have a superior capacity to repay short-term debt obligations.
P-2
Issuers (or supporting institutions) rated Prime-2 have a strong ability to repay short-term debt obligations.
P-3
Issuers (or supporting institutions) rated Prime-3 have an acceptable ability to repay short-term obligations.
A-4

Issuers rated Not Prime do not fall within any of the Prime rating categories.
MOODY’S NOTE RATINGS
MIG 1/VMIG 1
Notes bearing this designation are of superior credit quality, enjoying excellent protection by established
cash flows, highly reliable liquidity support, or demonstrated broad-based access to the market for
refinancing.
MIG 2/VMIG 2
Notes bearing this designation are of strong credit quality, with margins of protection ample although
not so large as in the preceding group.
MIG 3/VMIG 3
Notes bearing this designation are of acceptable credit quality, with possibly narrow liquidity and cash-
flow protection. Market access for refinancing is likely to be less well established.
SG
Notes bearing this designation are of speculative-grade credit quality and may lack sufficient margins of
protection.
FITCH’S SHORT-TERM RATINGS
Fitch’s short-term ratings apply to debt obligations that are payable on demand or have original maturities of up to three years, including commercial paper, certificates of deposit, medium-term notes, and municipal and investment notes.
The short-term rating places greater emphasis than a long-term rating on the existence of liquidity necessary to meet the issuer’s obligations in a timely manner.
F-1+
Best quality, indicating exceptionally strong capacity to meet financial commitments.
F-1
Best quality, indicating strong capacity to meet financial commitments.
F-2
Good quality with satisfactory capacity to meet financial commitments.
F-3
Fair quality with adequate capacity to meet financial commitments but near term adverse conditions could impact
the commitments.
B
Speculative quality and minimal capacity to meet commitments and vulnerability to short-term adverse changes in
financial and economic conditions.
C
Possibility of default is high and the financial commitments are dependent upon sustained, favorable business and
economic conditions.
D
In default and has failed to meet its financial commitments.
A-5

APPENDIX B
PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES SUMMARIES
AMUNDI ASSET MANAGEMENT US, INC.
POLICY
Each of the Pioneer Funds and certain other clients of Amundi Asset Management US, Inc. (“Amundi US”) have delegated responsibility to vote proxies related to portfolio holdings to Amundi US. Amundi US is a fiduciary that owes each of its clients the duties of care and loyalty with respect to all services undertaken on the client’s behalf, including voting proxies for securities held by the client. When Amundi US has been delegated proxy-voting authority for a client, the duty of care requires Amundi US to monitor corporate events and to vote the proxies. To satisfy its duty of loyalty, Amundi US must place the client’s interests ahead of its own and must cast proxy votes in a manner consistent with the best interest of the client. It is Amundi US’ policy to vote proxies presented to Amundi US in a timely manner in accordance with these principles.
Amundi US’ fundamental concern in voting proxies is the economic effect of the proposal on the value of portfolio holdings, considering both the short- and long-term impact. In many instances, Amundi US believes that supporting the company’s strategy and voting “for” management’s proposals builds portfolio value. In other cases, however, proposals set forth by management may have a negative effect on that value, while some shareholder proposals may hold the best prospects for enhancing it. Amundi US monitors developments in the proxy voting arena and will revise this policy as needed.
Amundi US believes that environmental, social and governance (ESG) factors can affect companies’ long-term prospects for success and the sustainability of their business models. Since ESG factors that may affect corporate performance and economic value are considered by our investment professionals as part of the investment management process, Amundi US also considers these factors when reviewing proxy proposals. This approach is consistent with the stated investment objectives and policies of funds and investment strategies.
It should be noted that the proxy voting guidelines below are guidelines, not rules, and Amundi US reserves the right in all cases to vote contrary to guidelines where doing so is determined to represent the best economic interests of our clients. Further, the Pioneer Funds or other clients of Amundi US may direct Amundi US to vote contrary to guidelines.
Amundi US’ clients may request copies of their proxy voting records and of Amundi US’ proxy voting policies and procedures by either sending a written request to Amundi US’ Proxy Coordinator, or clients may review Amundi US’ proxy voting policies and procedures on-line at amundi.com/usinvestors. Amundi US may describe to clients its proxy voting policies and procedures by delivering a copy of Amundi US’ Form ADV (Part II), by separate notice to the client or by other means.
APPLICABILITY
This Proxy Voting policy and the procedures set forth below are designed to complement Amundi US’ investment policies and procedures regarding its general responsibility to monitor the performance and/or corporate events of companies that are issuers of securities held in accounts managed by Amundi US. This policy sets forth Amundi US’ position on a number of issues for which proxies may be solicited but it does not include all potential voting scenarios or proxy events. Furthermore, because of the special issues associated with proxy solicitations by closed-end Funds, Amundi US will vote shares of closed-end Funds on a case-by-case basis.
PURPOSE
The purpose of this policy is to ensure that proxies for United States (“US”) and non-US companies that are received in a timely manner will be voted in accordance with the principles stated above. Unless the Proxy Voting Oversight Group (as described below) specifically determines otherwise, all shares in a company held by Amundi US-managed accounts for which Amundi US has proxy-voting authority will be voted alike, unless a client has given specific voting instructions on an issue.
Amundi US does not delegate the authority to vote proxies relating to securities held by its clients to any of its affiliates. Any questions about this policy should be directed to Amundi US’ Chief of Staff U.S. Investments (the “Proxy Coordinator”).
B-1

PROCEDURES
Proxy Voting Service
Amundi US has engaged an independent proxy voting service to assist in the voting of proxies. The proxy voting service works with custodians to ensure that all proxy materials are received by the custodians and are processed in a timely fashion. The proxy voting service votes all proxies in accordance with the proxy voting guidelines established by Amundi US and set forth herein, to the extent applicable. The proxy voting service will refer proxy questions to the Proxy Coordinator (described below) for instructions under circumstances where: (1) the application of the proxy voting guidelines is unclear; (2) a particular proxy question is not covered by the guidelines; or (3) the guidelines call for specific instructions on a case-by-case basis. The proxy voting service is also requested to call to the Proxy Coordinator's attention specific proxy questions that, while governed by a guideline, appear to involve unusual or controversial issues. Amundi US reserves the right to attend a meeting in person and may do so when it determines that the company or the matters to be voted on at the meeting are strategically important to its clients.
To supplement its own research and analysis in determining how to vote on a particular proxy proposal, Amundi US may utilize research, analysis or recommendations provided by the proxy voting service on a case-by-case basis. Amundi US does not, as a policy, follow the assessments or recommendations provided by the proxy voting service without its own analysis and determination.
Proxy Coordinator
The Proxy Coordinator coordinates the voting, procedures and reporting of proxies on behalf of Amundi US’ clients. The Proxy Coordinator will deal directly with the proxy voting service and, in the case of proxy questions referred by the proxy voting service, will solicit voting recommendations and instructions from the Portfolio Management Group, or, to the extent applicable, investment sub-advisers. The Proxy Coordinator is responsible for ensuring that these questions and referrals are responded to in a timely fashion and for transmitting appropriate voting instructions to the proxy voting service. The Proxy Coordinator is responsible for verifying with the General Counsel or his or her designee whether Amundi US’ voting power is subject to any limitations or guidelines issued by the client (or in the case of an employee benefit plan, the plan's trustee or other fiduciaries).
Referral Items
The proxy voting service will refer proxy questions to the Proxy Coordinator or his or her designee that are described by Amundi US’ proxy voting guidelines as to be voted on a case-by-case basis, that are not covered by Amundi US’ guidelines or where Amundi US’ guidelines may be unclear with respect to the matter to be voted on. Under such circumstances, the Proxy Coordinator will seek a written voting recommendation from the Chief Investment Officer, U.S or his or her designated equity portfolio-management representative. Any such recommendation will include: (i) the manner in which the proxies should be voted; (ii) the rationale underlying any such decision; and (iii) the disclosure of any contacts or communications made between Amundi US and any outside parties concerning the proxy proposal prior to the time that the voting instructions are provided.
Proxy Voting Oversight Group
The members of the Proxy Voting Oversight Group include Amundi US’ Chief Investment Officer, U.S. or his or her designated equity portfolio management representative, the Chief of Staff, U.S., and the Chief Compliance Officer of the Adviser and Funds. Other members of Amundi US will be invited to attend meetings and otherwise participate as necessary. The Chief of Staff, U.S. will chair the Proxy Voting Oversight Group.
The Proxy Voting Oversight Group is responsible for developing, evaluating, and changing (when necessary) Amundi US’ proxy voting policies and procedures. The Group meets at least annually to evaluate and review this policy and the services of its third-party proxy voting service. In addition, the Proxy Voting Oversight Group will meet as necessary to vote on referral items and address other business as necessary.
Amendments
B-2

Amundi US may not amend this policy without the prior approval of the Proxy Voting Oversight Group. Amendments to this policy with respect to votes to be cast on behalf of any of the Pioneer Funds also shall be presented to the Board of the Pioneer Funds for its review and advance approval.
Form N-PX
The Proxy Coordinator and the Director of Regulatory Reporting are responsible for ensuring that Form NP-X documents receive the proper review by a member of the Proxy Voting Oversight Group prior to a Fund officer signing the forms.
The Proxy Coordinator will provide the Compliance department with a copy of each Form N-PX filing prepared by the proxy voting service.
Compliance files N-PX.
The Compliance department will ensure that a corresponding Form N-PX exists for each Amundi US registered investment company.
Following this review, each Form N-PX is formatted for public dissemination via the EDGAR system.
Prior to submission, each Form N-PX is to be presented to the Fund officer for a final review and signature.
Copies of the Form N-PX filings and their submission receipts are maintained according to Amundi US record keeping policies.
PROXY VOTING GUIDELINES
These can be found within the complete Amundi US Proxy Policy.
SUPERVISION
ESCALATION
It is each associate’s responsibility to contact his or her business unit head, the Proxy Coordinator, a member of the Proxy Voting Oversight Group or Amundi US’ Chief Compliance Officer if he or she becomes aware of any possible noncompliance with this policy.
TRAINING
Amundi US will conduct periodic training regarding proxy voting and this policy. It is the responsibility of the business line policy owner and the applicable Compliance Department to coordinate and conduct such training.
RELATED POLICIES AND PROCEDURES
Amundi US’ Investment Management, Inc. Books and Records Policy and the Books and Records of the Pioneer Funds’ Policy.
RECORD KEEPING
The Proxy Coordinator shall ensure that Amundi US’ proxy voting service:
Retains a copy of each proxy statement received (unless the proxy statement is available from the SEC’s Electronic Data Gathering, Analysis, and Retrieval (EDGAR) system);
Retains a record of the vote cast;
Prepares Form N-PX for filing on behalf of each client that is a registered investment company; and
Is able to promptly provide Amundi US with a copy of the voting record upon its request.
B-3

The Proxy Coordinator shall ensure that for those votes that may require additional documentation (i.e., conflicts of interest, exception votes and case-by-case votes) the following records are maintained:
A record memorializing the basis for each referral vote cast;
A copy of any document created by Amundi US that was material in making the decision on how to vote the subject proxy;
A copy of any recommendation or analysis furnished by the proxy voting service; and
A copy of any conflict notice, conflict consent or any other written communication (including emails or other electronic communications) to or from the client (or in the case of an employee benefit plan, the plan's trustee or other fiduciaries) regarding the subject proxy vote cast by, or the vote recommendation of, Amundi US.
Amundi US shall maintain the above records in the client’s file in accordance with applicable regulations.
BAILARD, INC.
Bailard has adopted proxy voting policies and procedures that are reasonably designed to ensure that we vote proxies in the best interests of our clients. Bailard currently votes domestic and international stock proxies for accounts whose investment advisory agreement includes proxy voting service. The accounts for which Bailard votes proxies include, but are not limited to, mutual funds, our pooled vehicles, certain separately managed institutional accounts, ERISA accounts and (unless otherwise directed) omnibus ballots.
In seeking to avoid material conflicts of interest, we have engaged Institutional Shareholder Services Inc. (“ISS”), a third party service provider, to vote in accordance ISS’ SRI Proxy Voting Guidelines. Bailard generally does not allow the option for clients to direct the votes in a particular solicitation. In certain limited circumstances, ISS may be instructed to use custom guidelines in voting proxies for specific Bailard accounts.
ISS’ SRI Proxy Voting Guidelines generally:
1.
Board of Directors - seeks to support Boards of Directors that serve the interests of shareholders by voting for Board Accountability, Board Responsiveness, Director Independence, and Director Diversity and Competence.
2.
Risk Oversight Failure - votes against or withhold from directors individually, on a committee, or potentially the entire board due to material failures of governance, stewardship, risk oversight, or fiduciary responsibilities at the company, including failure to adequately manage or mitigate ESG risks, or a lack of sustainability reporting in the company’s public documents and/or website in conjunction with a failure to adequately manage or mitigate ESG risks.
3.
Auditor-Related Shareholder Proposals seeks to vote for shareholder proposals to allow shareholders to vote on auditor ratification; for proposals that ask a company to adopt a policy on auditor independence; and for proposals that seek to limit the non-audit services provided by the company’s auditor.
4.
Climate Accountability - for companies that are significant greenhouse gas emitters, through its operations or value chain, generally vote against or withhold from the incumbent chair of the responsible committee (or other directors on a case-by-case basis) in cases where Social Advisory Services determines that the company is not taking the minimum steps needed to be aligned with a Net Zero by 2050 trajectory.
5.
Executive and Director Compensation - seeks to incentivize employees and executives to engage in conduct that will improve the performance of their companies by voting for appropriate pay-for-performance alignment with emphasis on long-term shareholder value; avoiding arrangements that risk “pay for failure; independent and effective compensation committees; clear and comprehensive compensation disclosures; avoiding inappropriate pay to non-executive directors.
In certain circumstances, Bailard may override ISS’ recommendation. Bailard conducts periodic due diligence of ISS as well as periodic monitoring/testing of the services ISS provides.
For accounts where Bailard does not have the authority to vote proxies, clients receive their proxies directly from the custodian, transfer agent or the issuer’s proxy solicitor. If clients have any questions about a particular solicitation, they can email [email protected].
B-4

Ballard’s Proxy Voting Policy sets forth our proxy voting process in more detail. A copy of this policy is available to clients upon request. Moreover, if we are voting proxies on a client’s behalf (including proxies voted by ISS), that client may ask us for information about how her/his securities were voted. To request a copy of our Proxy Voting Policy or information about how their securities were voted, clients should email [email protected].
BLACKROCK INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT, LLC (“BLACKROCK”)
With respect to each series of the Trust (each, a “Fund”) for which BlackRock serves as subadviser, Nationwide Fund Advisors (“NFA”) has directed BlackRock to vote proxies on the portfolio securities held by each Fund in accordance with Institutional Shareholder Services’ (“ISS”) Sustainability U.S. Proxy Voting Guidelines and Sustainability International Proxy Voting Guidelines, as applicable (together, the “Sustainability Policy”). NFA acknowledges that BlackRock has authority to and may exercise discretion when voting recommendations based upon the Sustainability Policy, and thus may deviate from the Sustainability Policy consistent with BlackRock's fiduciary duty and its proxy voting policies and procedures.
ISS has developed proxy voting guidelines that are consistent with the objectives of sustainability-minded investors and fiduciaries. On matters of environmental, social and corporate governance (“ESG”) import, ISS' Sustainability Policy seeks to promote support for recognized global governing bodies promoting sustainable business practices advocating for stewardship of environment, fair labor practices, non-discrimination, and the protection of human rights. Generally, ISS' Sustainability Policy will take as its frame of reference internationally recognized sustainability-related initiatives such as the United Nations Environment Programme Finance Initiative (UNEP FI), United Nations Principles for Responsible Investment (UNPRI), United Nations Global Compact, Global Reporting Initiative (GRI), Carbon Principles, International Labour Organization Conventions (ILO), Ceres Roadmap 2030, Global Sullivan Principles, MacBride Principles, and environmental and social European Union Directives. Each of these efforts promote a fair, unified and productive reporting and compliance environment which advances positive corporate ESG actions that promote practices that present new opportunities or that mitigate related financial and reputational risks.
On matters of corporate governance, executive compensation, and corporate structure, the Sustainability Policy guidelines are based on a commitment to create and preserve economic value and to advance principles of good corporate governance.
ISS notes there may be cases in which the final vote recommendation at a particular company varies from the voting guidelines due to the fact that ISS closely examines the merits of each proposal and consider relevant information and company-specific circumstances in arriving at its decisions. To that end, ISS engages with both interested shareholders as well as issuers to gain further insight into contentious issues facing the company. Where ISS acts as voting agent for clients, it follows each client’s voting policy, which may differ in some cases from the policies outlined in this document. ISS updates its guidelines on an annual basis to take into account emerging issues and trends on environmental, social and corporate governance topics, as well as the evolution of market standards, regulatory changes and client feedback.
Please read the ISS Sustainability U.S. Proxy Voting Guidelines available at  https://www.issgovernance.com/file/policy/active/specialty/Sustainability-US-Voting-Guidelines.pdf and the ISS Sustainability International Proxy Voting Guidelines available at  https://www.issgovernance.com/file/policy/active/specialty/Sustainability-International-Voting-Guidelines.pdf.
BROWN CAPITAL MANAGEMENT, INC.
Policy
Where contractually obligated, Brown Capital Management, LLC, (BCM) as a matter of policy and as a fiduciary to our clients, has responsibility for voting proxies for portfolio securities consistent with the best economic interests of the clients. Proxies are voted on a best efforts basis. Our firm maintains written policies and procedures for the handling, research, voting and reporting of proxy voting and makes appropriate disclosures about our firm’s proxy policies and practices. Our policy and practice includes the responsibility to monitor corporate actions, receive and vote client proxies and disclose any potential conflicts of interest as well as making information available to clients about the voting of proxies for their portfolio securities and maintaining relevant and required records.
B-5

In order to facilitate this proxy voting process, BCM utilizes Glass Lewis & Co. a recognized leader in proxy voting and corporate governance areas to assist in the due diligence process related to making appropriate proxy voting decisions related to client accounts. The BCM operations team monitors corporate actions and investment staff through information received from Advent's corporate actions module or custodian banks. Clients with separately managed accounts may request a copy of this policy or how proxies relating to their securities were voted by contacting BCM directly. Investors in the Brown Capital Management Family of Funds (individually “Fund” or collectively “Funds”) may request a copy of this policy or the Fund’s proxy voting record upon request, without charge, by calling Alps Fund Services at 1-800-773-3863, by reviewing the Fund’s website, if applicable, or by reviewing filings available on the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov.
Glass Lewis & Co.
Glass Lewis & Co. is a leading research and professional services firm assisting institutions globally that have investment, financial or reputational exposure to public companies. The firm provides research and analysis that specializes in providing a variety of fiduciary level proxy related services to institutional investment managers, plan sponsors, custodians, consultants, and other institutional investors. BCM subscribes to the Glass Lewis Standard Voting Policy. The services provided to BCM, include in-depth research, analysis, and voting recommendations. Members of BCM’s investment staff individually determine how each proxy ballot is voted. Glass Lewis's research, analysis, and voting recommendations are utilized as a guideline only. When specifically directed by a client with a separately managed account, BCM will vote as requested.
Background
Proxy voting is an important right of shareholders and reasonable care and diligence must be undertaken to ensure that such rights are properly and timely exercised. Investment advisers registered with the SEC, and which exercise voting authority with respect to client securities, are required by Rule 206(4)-6 of the Advisers Act to (a) adopt and implement written policies and procedures that are reasonably designed to ensure that client securities are voted in the best interests of clients, which must include how an adviser addresses material conflicts that may arise between an adviser's interests and those of its clients; (b) to disclose to clients how they may obtain information from the adviser with respect to the voting of proxies for their securities; (c) to describe to clients a summary of its proxy voting policies and procedures and, upon request, furnish a copy to its clients; and (d) maintain certain records relating to the adviser's proxy voting activities when the adviser does have proxy voting authority.
Responsibility
The Chief Compliance Officer (CCO), in consultation with MRSA and the Proxy Committee have the responsibility for creating and amending our proxy voting policy. The CCO is responsible for implementing, monitoring, and keeping record of the proxy procedures.
Procedure
BCM has adopted procedures to implement the firm’s policy and reviews to monitor and ensure the firm’s policy is observed, implemented properly and amended or updated, as appropriate, which are as follows:
Voting Procedures
The BCM administrative staff coordinates the physical voting process and recordkeeping of votes at both the broader company and individual account levels through the Glass Lewis & Co.'s View Point system.
The Manager Reporting & Systems Administrator (MRSA) or designee follows the following process in voting proxies on a daily basis:
a.
Sends holdings to Glass Lewis for all accounts in the proxy group,
b.
Obtains and prints pending proxy ballots from Glass Lewis website,
c.
Performs a reconciliation of Glass Lewis ballots against BCM accounting records to ensure a ballot exists for each eligible client,
d.
Contacts Glass Lewis to research missing ballots and/or the custodian bank,
B-6

e.
Ungroups any terminated clients from ballot to insure accurate voting,
f.
Distributes pending ballots to designated Portfolio Managers (PMs) for voting,
g.
Votes ballots on-line according to designated PMs instructions,
h.
Generates voted ballot report along with all backup materials, reviews and scans to the System,
i.
Maintains a current list of active accounts for proxy voting based on email notification from portfolio administrators of new and terminated clients.
j.
Notifies Glass Lewis and the custodian bank of all client changes and new clients to ensure accuracy of client lists.
k.
Completes the Missing Ballot Form for proxies that are not voted for clients, submits for approval to CCO or designee, and maintains in a missing ballot folder. Submits copy to the CCO or designee.
Portfolio Managers
a.
PMs vote the proxy, sign the ballot and make any notes that would reflect votes against management/Glass Lewis and returns to CCO or designee Proxy review form for specific clients should be checked and signed by Portfolio Manager.
Reporting
a.
Glass Lewis provides quarterly detailed voted ballots. These reports are sent to clients as requested or upon contractual agreement.
b.
Manager Reporting & Systems Administrator (MRSA) or designee shall distribute appropriate proxy voting reports to portfolio administrators upon request.
Monitoring
a.
The Manager Reporting & Systems Administrator (MRSA) or designee reviews all ballots to ensure proper voting.
b.
The CCO or designee reviews a representative sample of ballots on a periodic basis to confirm proper voting and documentation of any votes against management recommendations.
Policies Prohibiting Voting of Proxies
BCM attempts to vote all proxies for clients where voting authority has been granted BCM by the client. However, in some circumstances BCM may not vote some proxies:
a.
Shares in a stock loan program,
b.
Proxies for securities held in an unsupervised portion of a client’s account,
c.
Proxies that are subject to blocking restrictions,
d.
Proxies that require BCM to travel overseas in order to vote,
e.
Proxies that are written in a language other than English.
Disclosure
a.
BCM provides information in its disclosure document summarizing this proxy voting policy and procedures, including a statement that clients may request information regarding how BCM voted clients’ proxies, and that clients may request a copy of these policies and procedures.
b.
When BCM is contractually obligated to vote proxies for a new client, the MRSA ensures that each new client receives the current proxy policy.
Client Requests for Information
a.
All client requests for information regarding proxy votes, or policies and procedures, received by any employee should be forwarded to the CCO or designee.
b.
The CCO or designee retains client proxy reports on BCM’s computer system. Requested documents are sent via e-mail to the appropriate portfolio administrator, who forwards to the client.
B-7

Voting Guidelines
While BCM’s policy is to review each proxy proposal on its individual merits, BCM has adopted guidelines for certain types of matters to assist the investment staff in the review and voting of proxies. These guidelines are:
Corporate Governance
a.
Election of Directors and Similar Matters
In an uncontested election, BCM will generally vote in favor of management’s proposed directors. In a contested election, BCM will evaluate proposed directors on a case-by-case basis. With respect to proposals regarding the structure of a company’s board of directors, BCM will review any contested proposal on its merits.
b.
Audit Committee Approvals
BCM generally supports proposals that help ensure that a company’s auditors are independent and capable of delivering a fair and accurate opinion of a company’s finances. BCM will generally vote to ratify management’s recommendation and selection of auditors.
c.
Shareholder Rights
BCM may consider all proposals that will have a material effect on shareholder rights on a case-by-case basis.
d.
Anti-Takeover Measures, Corporate Restructuring's and Similar Matters
BCM may review any proposal to adopt an anti-takeover measure, to undergo a corporate restructuring (e.g., change of entity form or state of incorporation, mergers or acquisitions) or to take similar action by reviewing the potential short and long-term effects of the proposal on the company. These effects may include, without limitation, the economic and financial impact the proposal may have on the company, and the market impact that the proposal may have on the company stock.
e.
Capital Structure Proposals
BCM will seek to evaluate capital structure proposals on their own merits on a case-by-case basis.
Compensation
a.
General
BCM generally supports proposals that encourage the disclosure of a company’s compensation policies. In addition, BCM generally supports proposals that fairly compensate executives, particularly those proposals that link executive compensation to performance. BCM may consider any contested proposal related to a company’s compensation policies on a case-by-case basis.
b.
Stock Option Plans
BCM evaluates proposed stock option plans and issuances on a case-by-case basis. In reviewing proposals regarding stock option plans and issuances, BCM may consider, without limitation, the potential dilutive effect on shareholders’ shares, the potential short- and long-term economic effects on the company and shareholders and the actual terms of the proposed options.
Corporate Responsibility and Social Issues
The investment staff’s review is intended to determine if a material conflict of interest exists that should be considered in the vote decision. The investment staff examines business, personal and familial relationships with the subject company and/or interested parties. If a conflict of interest is believed to exist, the investment staff will direct that the proxy issue BCM may vote against corporate responsibility and social issue proposals that BCM believes will have substantial adverse economic or
B-8

other effects on a company, and BCM may vote for corporate responsibility and social issue proposals that BCM believes will have substantial positive economic or other effects on a company. BCM reserves the right to amend and revise this policy without notice at any time.
Conflicts of Interest
The investment staff's review is intended to determine if a material conflict of interest exists that should be considered in the vote decision. The investment staff examines business, personal and familial relationships with the subject company and/or interested parties. If a conflict of interest is believed to exist, the investment staff will direct that the proxy issue must be voted in accordance with Glass Lewis recommendations. In the event Glass Lewis is unable to make a recommendation on a proxy vote regarding an investment held by a Fund, the investment staff will defer the decision to the fund’s proxy voting committee, which is made up of independent trustees. Decisions made by the fund’s proxy voting committee will be used to vote proxies for the fund. For securities not held by a fund, or Glass Lewis is unable to make a recommendation then BCM will either disclose the conflict to the client and obtain its consent before voting or suggest that the client engage another party to determine how the proxies should be voted.
Another conflict of interest could occur should BCM consider either Ontario Teachers’ Pension Plan or Alberta Investment Management Corp. as a client as both entities have an ownership interest in Glass Lewis. If you become aware of this situation, contact the CCO immediately.
Recordkeeping
The CCO or designee retains the following proxy records in accordance with the SEC’s five-year retention requirement.
a.
Proxy voting policies and procedures,
b.
Proxy statements received for client securities,
c.
Records of votes cast on behalf of clients,
d.
Records of client requests for proxy voting information and written responses by BCM are maintained in the client's correspondence folder,
e.
Documents prepared by BCM that were material to making a proxy voting decision or memorialize the basis for the decisions.
All such records are maintained as required by applicable laws and regulations.
DREYFUS, a division of Mellon Investments Corporation
Policy Statement
It is the policy of Mellon Investments Corporation (“MIC”) to fully meet its fiduciary obligations in exercising the power, discretion and responsibility to vote proxies where clients have delegated such authority.
Background
Registered Investment Advisers have a number of responsibilities regarding voting of proxies for client securities that are under its management and that are governed by the Advisers Act. Rule 206(4)-6 requires investments advisers to (a) adopt and implement written policies and procedures that are reasonably designed to ensure that the adviser votes client securities in the best interests of clients, which procedures must include how material conflicts that may arise between an adviser's interests and those of its clients are addressed; (b) disclose to clients how they may obtain information from the adviser with respect to the voting of proxies for their securities; and (c) describe to clients its proxy voting policies and procedures and, upon request, furnish a copy to its clients. Rule 204-2 further requires an investment adviser to retain certain records relating to the exercise of its proxy voting authority.
Policy
As a registered Investment Advisor, MIC is often entrusted with the fiduciary responsibility to vote proxies for shares of corporate stock held on behalf of our clients. Proxy voting is an integral part of the management of the investment in those
B-9

shares. In voting proxies, MIC takes into account long term economic value as we evaluate issues relating to corporate governance, including structures and practices, the nature of long-term business plans, including sustainability policies and practices to address environmental and social factors that are likely to have an impact on shareholder value, and other financial and non-financial measures of corporate performance.
MIC has established a Proxy Voting and Governance Committee to implement and maintain MIC’s Proxy Voting Policy and related proxy voting guidelines (the “Voting Guidelines”). This Committee oversees MIC’s proxy voting activities and ensures that the Voting Guidelines are generally applied consistently and impartially for securities held in accounts for which MIC has proxy voting authority. MIC will make every reasonable effort to ensure that proxies are received and voted in accordance with this policy and the Voting Guidelines. To assist us in that process, MIC retains Institutional Shareholder Services (“ISS”) to provide various services related to proxy voting, such as research, analysis, voting services, proxy vote tracking, recordkeeping, and reporting. In addition, MIC retains Glass Lewis for research services only.
Proxy Voting Conflicts of Interest
MIC has appointed the BNY Mellon Proxy Voting Conflicts Committee to address certain conflicts associated with actual or potential material conflicts of interest involving The Bank of New York Mellon (“Parent Company”). These conflicts typically arise due to a relationship between a proxy issuer and the Parent Company, the Parent Company’s Chief Executive Officer, or a member of the Parent Company’s Board of Directors.
MIC leverages the Mellon Risk and Compliance Committee to assist in conflict mitigation and for interpretation of its Proxy Voting Policy from time to time. These conflicts typically arise at the MIC firm level and are not actual or potential material conflicts of interest involving the Parent Company as referenced above.
MIC may submit (or arrange to submit) proxy votes involving these conflicts in accordance with the recommendation of an independent fiduciary selected and engaged for this purpose; or proposals may be voted in the same proportion as all other voting shareholders (“mirror voting”), and will not be delegated to an independent fiduciary.
However, if “mirror voting” is not operationally feasible or if MIC determines that “mirror voting” in a particular situation may not be in our client’s best interest, the conflicted proxy proposal will be presented to the BNYM Proxy Voting Conflict Committee (as described above) to determine how the proposal should be addressed.
MIC will furnish a copy of its Proxy Voting Policy and its Voting Guidelines upon request to each advisory client that has delegated voting authority.
Voting BNY Mellon Stock
It is the policy of MIC not to vote or make recommendations on how to vote shares of BNY Mellon stock, even where MIC has the legal power to do so under the relevant governing instrument. In order to avoid any appearance of conflict relating to voting BNY Mellon stock, MIC has contracted with an independent fiduciary (ISS) to direct all voting of BNY Mellon Stock held by any MIC accounts on any matter in which shareholders of BNY Mellon Stock are required or permitted to vote.
Voting Non-US Company Proxies
MIC seeks to effect vote decisions through the application of the Voting Guidelines. However, corporate governance practices, disclosure requirements and voting operations vary significantly among the various non-U.S. markets in which clients may invest. In these markets, MIC may face regulatory, compliance, legal or logistical limits with respect to voting securities held in client accounts which can affect the firm’s ability to vote such proxies, as well as the desirability of voting such proxies. Non-U.S. regulatory restrictions or company-specific ownership limits, as well as legal matters related to consolidated groups, may restrict the total percentage of an issuer’s voting securities that MIC can hold for clients and the nature of our voting in such securities. MIC’s ability to vote proxies may also be affected by, among other things: (1) late receipt of meeting notices; (2) requirements to vote proxies in person: (3) restrictions on a foreigner’s ability to exercise votes; (4) potential difficulties in translating the proxy; (5) requirements to provide local agents with unrestricted powers of attorney to facilitate voting instructions; and (6) requirements that investors who exercise their voting rights surrender the right to dispose of their holdings for some specified period in proximity to the shareholder meeting. Absent an issue that is likely to impact clients’ economic interest in a company, MIC generally will not subject clients to the costs (which may
B-10

include a loss of liquidity) that could be imposed by these requirements. In these markets, MIC will weigh the associative costs against the benefit of voting and may refrain from voting certain non-U.S. securities in instances where the items presented are not likely to have a material impact on shareholder value (where the expense and administrative inconvenience or other burdens outweigh the benefits to clients of voting the securities).
Securities Lending
Generally, MIC expects that the projected long-term economic benefit to clients in voting proxies would be exceeded by securities lending income on shares on loan. In our assessment, the resolutions being voted on are typically routine and will not have significant economic consequences and/or because the outcome would not be affected by voting all or a portion of loaned securities.
While most resolutions are routine, from time to time, the Proxy Voting and Governance Committee in conjunction with the investment management team may determine that the expected economic benefit of voting clients’ entire holding is greater than the projected lending revenue. Shares on loan are not recalled to vote unless the case can be made that the optimal voting outcome would be economically beneficial for clients and voting all eligible shares in client portfolios would increase the likelihood of achieving that outcome.
Index/Passive Fixed Income Mandates and Cash Strategies
MIC has elected to forgo proxy voting for certain index and passively managed Fixed Income accounts. MIC typically does not vote proxies on behalf of cash mandates. The operational burden and costs of maintaining such accounts on vendor platforms was considered in making this decision. Recognizing that proxy voting is a rare event in the realm of fixed income investing, MIC has made a determination that the items presented for vote are not likely to have a material impact on shareholder value.
Proxy Voting Disclosure
Clients who have delegated proxy voting authority to MIC may obtain the proxy voting records for their account upon written or verbal request.
Oversight Activities - Operational
The Pune Proxy Operations Team performs periodic oversight of the operational and voting processes implemented on behalf of clients to ensure that proxy ballots are voted in accordance with established guidelines. These activities may include, but are not limited to, monthly account reconciliation between the voting agent and MIC records and forensic testing of the application of vote instruction in relation to policy vote recommendations at the ballot level. These efforts are monitored as a component of our Rule 206(4) -7 compliance program.
Oversight Activities Proxy Advisors
MIC, with the assistance of the BNY Mellon Proxy Research & Governance team, as well as certain BNY Mellon vendor review groups, provides oversight of the Proxy Advisors through various activities. Depending on the particular set of services a Proxy Advisor is engaged to provide, these activities may include, but are not limited to:
Annual request and review of information related to compliance policies and procedures.
Annual compliance due diligence questionnaires, certifications and/or document requests.
Annual and ad hoc due diligence meetings, as well as periodic on-site due diligence meetings.
Periodic meetings, correspondence and telephonic communications, as needed.
Periodic review of the proxy advisor’s systems to assess whether the Voting Guidelines are reflected accurately.
Periodic review and testing of proxy votes, with respect to routine proposals, as well as those proposals which require more analysis.
Periodic review of SSAE 18 and/or other external reports or summaries thereof, where applicable.
Periodic review of BNY Mellon’s (internal and/or external) vendor review groups reports, where applicable.
Maintenance of Required Records
B-11

MIC, with the assistance of engaged service providers, shall maintain such records as required under Rule 204-2.
GENEVA CAPITAL MANAGEMENT LLC (“GENEVA”)
Summary of Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures
Geneva has engaged an independent proxy voting service and industry expert, Glass Lewis & Co. (“Glass Lewis”), to research proxy proposals, provide in-depth analysis, provide voting recommendations and administer client proxy votes. Glass Lewis is responsible for coordinating with the clients’ custodians to ensure that all proxy materials received by the custodians are processed in a timely fashion. In addition, Glass Lewis is responsible for maintaining copies of all proxy statements received from issuers and records of its recommendations, analyses, and votes cast by Geneva. It must promptly provide such materials to Geneva upon request.
With respect to the voting of proxies on behalf of all clients advised by Geneva, for which Geneva has voting responsibility, and the keeping of records relating to proxy voting, Geneva believes proxies should be voted consistent with the best interests of Geneva’s clients. Geneva must not put its own interests ahead of the interests of clients. Geneva views proxy voting as a mechanism for shareholders to protect and promote shareholder wealth. Accordingly, Geneva seeks to vote proxies in a manner designed to maximize the economic value of the clients’ investment. In addition, Geneva will abide by specific voting guidelines on certain policy issues as requested by particular clients on a case-by-case basis.
Geneva has adopted Glass Lewis’s Proxy Paper Guidelines (“Guidelines”) as well as Glass Lewis’ Taft Hartley Addendum (“Addendum”) for those clients that request the Addendum, to determine how each proposal on proxy ballots is to be voted for each applicable client.  If instructed by a client, the Addendum will be utilized. The Guidelines and the Addendum are incorporated, and copies of the Guidelines and Addendum, as revised from time to time, are maintained with Geneva’s proxy voting records. Geneva has determined that the Guidelines and Addendum are consistent with the Guiding Principles described above, and, with respect to ERISA plan clients, they are consistent with Geneva’s obligations to (a) act solely in accordance with the economic interest of the plans and their participants and beneficiaries, (b) consider any costs involved, (c) not subordinate the interest of plan participants and beneficiaries in their retirement income or financial benefits under the plans to any other objective, and (d) evaluate relevant facts that form the basis for any particular proxy vote or other exercise of shareholder rights, and (e) with respect to Glass Lewis, it exercises prudence and diligence in exercising shareholder rights and otherwise advises on and assists Geneva with the exercise of shareholder rights, such as providing research and analysis, recommendations regarding proxy votes, administrative services with voting proxies and recordkeeping and reporting services (the foregoing (a) through (e), are collectively referred to herein as the “ERISA Obligations”). Accordingly, Geneva has instructed Glass Lewis to vote in accordance with the Guidelines or the Addendum, as applicable, unless one of the following exceptions applies:
1.
Override Glass Lewis.  Geneva’s Investment Strategy Group (“ISG”) decides to override the Glass-Lewis vote recommendation for a client based on its determination that the client would best be served with a vote contrary to the Glass Lewis recommendation. Such decision will be documented by Geneva and communicated to Glass Lewis; or
2.
Corporate Events and Contests. On matters involving corporate events (such as merger and acquisition transactions, dissolutions, conversions, or consolidations) and proxy contests, Geneva will determine how to vote the proxies and direct Glass Lewis accordingly; or
3.
No Recommendation. If Glass Lewis does not provide a vote recommendation, Geneva will determine how a particular issue should be voted. In these instances, Geneva, through its ISG, will document the reason(s) used in determining a vote and communicate Geneva’s voting instruction to Glass Lewis.
Glass Lewis retains a record of all proxies voted by Geneva.
GQG PARTNERS LLC (“GQG”)
GQG votes proxies of companies owned by clients who have granted it voting authority and has adopted and implemented written policies and procedures governing the voting of client securities where it has such authority. GQG has retained ISS (the “voting agent”) to assist in the coordination and voting of proxies.
GQG’s policy is to vote proxies in the interest of maximizing value for its clients. To that end, GQG will vote in a way that it believes, consistent with its fiduciary duty, will cause the value of the issue to increase the most or decline the least.
B-12

Consideration will be given to both the short- and long-term implications of the proposal to be voted on when considering the optimal vote. GQG supplements guidance from its voting agent with its evaluation of client proxies.
GQG’s procedures are reasonably designed to assure that GQG votes every eligible share; however, there are circumstances in which GQG may be unable to vote or may determine not to vote a proxy on behalf of a client, including restrictions imposed or impediments to voting in some foreign countries, the untimely receipt of proxy materials, and certain client’s security lending programs may prevent GQG from voting proxies when the underlying securities have been lent out and are therefore unavailable to be voted.
GQG’s proxy voting procedures address potential conflicts of interest in connection with voting proxies. Such a conflict could arise if, for example, the company issuing proxies was affiliated with a client of GQG. Any material conflict between GQG’s interests and those of a client will be resolved in the best interests of the client. In the event GQG becomes aware of such a conflict, GQG will (a) disclose the conflict and obtain the client’s consent before voting its shares, (b) vote in accordance with a pre-determined policy based on the independent analysis and recommendation of our voting agent or (c) make other voting arrangements consistent with its fiduciary obligations.
INSIGHT NORTH AMERICA LLC (“INSIGHT”)
1.
Introduction
Insight seeks to actively exercise its rights and responsibilities in regard to proxy voting on behalf of Clients and is an essential part of maximizing shareholder value, ensuring good governance and delivering investment performance aligned with our Clients’ long-term economic interests.
The Insight Proxy Voting Policy (“Policy”) sets out the arrangements employed by Insight Investment Management (Global) Limited, Insight Investment Management (Europe) Limited, Insight North America LLC and Insight Investment International Limited (collectively “Insight”).
2.
Policy Statement
Insight is committed to supporting good governance practices and also voting all our proxies where it is deemed appropriate and responsible to do so for the relevant asset class. In such cases, Insight's objective is to vote proxies in the best interests of its Clients.
3.Scope
This Policy applies to financial instruments with voting rights where Insight has discretionary voting authority. Alternatively where a Client retains control over the voting decision, Insight will only lodge votes in instances where the client agreement hands responsibility to Insight to cast the votes on their behalf.
4.
Proxy Voting Process
Insight’s proxy voting activity adheres to best-practice standards and is a component of Insight’s Stewardship and Responsible Investment Policies. In implementing its Proxy Voting Policy, Insight will take into account a number of factors used to provide a framework for voting each proxy. These include:
Leadership: Every company should be led by an effective board whose approach is consistent with creating sustainable long-term growth.
Strategy: Company leadership should define a clear purpose and set long term objectives for delivering value to shareholders.
Culture: The board should promote a diverse and inclusive culture which strongly aligns to the values of the company. It should seek to monitor culture and ensure that it is regularly engaging with its workforce.
B-13

Engagement with Shareholders: The board and senior management should be transparent and engaged with existing shareholders. The board should have a clear understanding of the views of shareholders. The board should seek to minimize unnecessary dilution of equity and preserve the rights of existing shareholders.
Sustainability: The board should aim to take account of environmental, social and governance risks and opportunities when setting strategy and in their company monitoring role.
Structure: The board should have clear division of responsibilities.
The Chair: The independent Chair, or Lead Independent Director, of the board should demonstrate objective judgment and promote transparency and facilitate constructive debate to promote overall effectiveness.
The Board: There should be an appropriate balance of executive and non-executive directors. Non-executive directors should be evaluated for independence. No one individual should have unfettered decision-making powers. There should be a clear division of responsibilities, between the independent board members and the executive leadership of the company.
Resources: The board should ensure it has sufficient governance policies, influence and resources to function effectively. Non-executive directors should have sufficient time to fulfil their obligations to the company as directors.
Effectiveness: The board should seek to build strong institutional knowledge to ensure long term efficient and sustainable operations.
Appointment: There should be a formal appointment process, which ensures that the most qualified individuals are selected for the board. This process should be irrespective of bias to ensure appropriate diversity of the board.
Knowledge: The board should be comprised of those with the knowledge, skills and experience to effectively discharge their duties. The board should have sufficient independence to serve as an effective check on company management and ensure the best outcomes for shareholders.
Evaluation: The board should be evaluated for effectiveness on a regular basis. Board member’s contributions should be considered individually.
Independence: The board should present a fair and balanced view of the company’s position and prospects.
Integrity: The board should ensure that all reports produced accurately reflect the financial position, prospects and risks relevant to the company. The board should ensure the independence and effectiveness of internal and external audit functions.
Audit: The board should ensure that clear, uncontentious accounts are produced. These should conform to the relevant best accountancy practices and accurately represent the financial position of the company. Deviations from standard accounting practices should be clearly documented with a corresponding rationale.
Risk: The board should ensure the company has sound risk management and internal control systems. There should be a regular assessment and communication of the company’s emerging and principal risks.
Remuneration: Levels of remuneration should be sufficient to attract, retain and motivate talent of the quality required to run the company successfully.
Goal Based: The board should base remuneration on goal-based, qualitative, discretionary cash incentives. Remuneration should consider underlying industry and macroeconomic conditions and not be structured in a tax oriented manner.
Transparent: Remuneration arrangements should be transparent and should avoid complexity.
Sustainable: Remuneration should not be excessively share based and should be accurately represented and controlled as an operational cost. The remuneration of executives should promote long term focus and respect the interests of existing shareholders.
The relevant factors are used by Insight to develop Voting Guidelines enabling a consistent approach to proxy voting, which are reviewed annually by the Proxy Voting Group (“PVG”) - (see section 6).
B-14

Voting activity is usually performed by the Chair of the PVG, a Senior Stewardship Analyst with no day-to-day investment discretion. This creates an independent governance structure for voting, helping to mitigate actual and potential conflicts of interest (see section 5).
The Chair of the PVG can seek support from portfolio managers, who have active discretion over the securities, to provide additional input into the voting decision such as company background. However the vote will be cast by the Chair of the PVG or their delegate. Insight seeks to vote on all holdings with associated voting rights in one of three ways: in support of, against, or in abstention. If the chair is unable to cast a vote, the decision will be cast by the deputy chair. Insight uses a Voting Agent to assist in the analysis and administration of the vote (see section 4.1). The rationale for voting for, against, or abstaining is retained on a case-by-case basis as appropriate and reviewed by the PVG on a regular basis.
Voting Agent
To assist Insight professionals with implementing its proxy voting strategy, Insight retains the services of an independent proxy voting service, namely Minerva (“Voting Agent”). The Voting Agent’s responsibilities include, but are not limited to, monitoring company meeting agendas and items to be voted on, reviewing each vote against Insight’s Voting Guidelines and providing a voting analysis based upon the Voting Guidelines. The Voting Agent also identifies resolutions that require specific shareholder judgement often relating to corporate transactions or shareholder resolutions. This enables Insight to review situations where the Voting Guidelines require additional consideration or assist in the identification of potential conflicts of interest impacting the proxy vote decision. The Chair of the PVG will review for contentious resolutions and in the event of one will determine if an actual or potential conflict exists in which case the resolution will be escalated to the PVG voting committee (see section 5.1).
Voting decisions are communicated by Insight to the Voting Agent and submitted to shareholder meetings through a specific proxy.
On a monthly basis, the Voting Agent provides reports on voting activity to Insight. Voting data is available to Clients upon request and is posted on its website (see section 7). Insight conducts an annual due diligence to review the Voting Guidelines and the Voting Agent’s related services.
Insight will aim to vote all proxies when eligible. However, there may be instances where operational and logistical considerations may lead to Insight not being able to vote on behalf of client holdings.
5.Conflicts of Interest
Effective stewardship requires protecting our Clients against any potential conflicts of interest and managing them with appropriate governance. To comply with applicable legal and regulatory requirements, Insight believes managing perceived conflicts is as important as managing actual conflicts.
In the course of normal business, Insight and its personnel may encounter situations where it faces a conflict of interest or a conflict of interest could be perceived. A conflict of interest occurs whenever the interests of Insight or its personnel could diverge from those of a Client or when Insight or its personnel could have obligations to more than one party whose interests are different to each other or those of Insight’s Clients.
In identifying a potential conflict situation, as a minimum, consideration will be made as to whether Insight, or a member of staff, is likely to:
make a financial gain or avoid a financial loss at the expense of the Client;
present material differences in the thoughts of two PM’s who own the same security
benefit if it puts the interest of one Client over the interests of another Client;
gain an interest from a service provided to, or transaction carried out on behalf of a Client which may not be in, or which may be different from, the Client’s interest;
obtain a higher than usual benefit from a third party in relation to a service provided to the Client;
B-15

receive an inducement in relation to a service provided to the Client, in the form of monies, goods or services other than standard commission or fee for that service; or
have a personal interest that could be seen to conflict with their duties at Insight;
create a conflict where Insight invests in firms which are Clients or potential Clients of Insight. Insight might give preferential treatment in its research (including external communication of the same) and/or investment management to issuers of publicly traded debt or equities which are also clients or closely related to clients (e.g. sponsors of pension schemes). This includes financial and ESG considerations.
create a conflict between investment teams with fixed income holdings in publicly listed firms or material differences in the thoughts of two PM’s who own the same security.
Escalation of Contentious Voting Issue
When a contentious voting issue is identified, the Chair of the PVG or delegate will review, evaluate and determine whether an actual material conflict of interest exists, and, if so, will escalate the matter to the PVG voting committee. Depending upon the nature of the material conflict of interest, Insight may elect to take one or more of the following measures:
removing certain Insight personnel from the proxy voting process;
walling off personnel with knowledge of the material conflict to ensure that such personnel do not influence the relevant proxy vote;
voting in accordance with the applicable Voting Guidelines, if any, if the application of the Voting Guidelines would objectively result in the casting of a proxy vote in a predetermined manner; and
An unconflicted contentious resolution will be voted by the Chair or their delegate. Where a conflict is deemed to exist the vote, widened to the PVG voting committee, will be determined by majority vote.
The resolution of all contentious voting issues, will be documented in order to demonstrate that Insight acted in the best interests of its Clients. Any voting decision not resolved by the PVG will be escalated to the Insight Chief Investment Officer (“CIO”) or their delegate for additional input.
6.
Proxy Voting Group
The PVG is responsible for overseeing the implementation of voting decisions where Insight has voting authority on behalf of Clients. The PVG meets at least semiannually, or more frequently as required. In ensuring that votes casted are in the best interest of Clients, the PVG will oversee the following proxy voting activities:
Casting votes on behalf of Clients;
Voting Policy: Oversee and set the Proxy Voting Policy;
Voting Guidelines: Oversee and set the Voting Guidelines which are reviewed and approved on an annual basis;
Stewardship Code & Engagement Policy: Review for consistency with Proxy Voting Policy and Voting Guidelines;
Conflicts of interest: Manage conflicts when making voting instructions in line with Insight's Conflict of Interest Policy;
Resolution Assessment: Review upcoming votes that cannot be made using Voting Guidelines and make voting decisions;
Voting Agent: Appoint and monitor third-party proxy agencies, including the services they perform for Insight in implementing its voting strategy; and
Reporting: Ensure voting activity aligns with local regulations and standards.
B-16

The PVG is chaired by a Senior Stewardship Analyst (who has no direct day-to-day investment discretion) and attended by Portfolio Management personnel, a Market Operations Manager (Deputy Chair), Corporate Risk, and Compliance personnel. The PVG is accountable to and provides semi-annual updates to the Investment Management Group (“IMG”).
7.
Disclosure and Recording Keeping
In certain foreign jurisdictions, the voting of proxies can result in additional restrictions that have an economic impact to the security, such as “share-blocking.” If Insight votes on the proxy, share-blocking may prevent Insight from selling the shares of the security for a period of time. In determining whether to vote proxies subject to such restrictions, Insight, in consultation with the PVG, considers whether the vote, either in itself or together with the votes of other shareholders is expected to affect the value of the security that outweighs the cost of voting. If Insight votes on a proxy and during the “share-blocking period,” Insight would like to sell the affected security, Insight in consultation with the PVG, will attempt to recall the shares (as allowable within the market time-frame and practices).
Insight publishes its voting activity in full on its website and annual report. This can be found at www.insightinvestment.com/ri.
8.Proxy Voting Policy Review
Insight will review its Proxy Voting arrangements regularly through the PVG. Insight reviews this Policy at least annually or whenever a material change occurs and will notify Clients of any material change that affects our ability to vote in line with the best interests of its Clients.
A material change shall be a significant event that could impact Insight’s ability to vote proxies such as a change in voting agent.
JANUS HENDERSON INVESTORS US LLC (“Janus Henderson Investors”)
Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote all proxies relating to portfolio securities held in client accounts for which it has been delegated voting authority in accordance with the Policy, including these Guidelines, and the implementation instructions provided to the Proxy Voting Service. Nonetheless, because proxy issues and the circumstances of individual companies are varied, there may be instances when Janus Henderson Investors may not vote in strict adherence to the Guidelines. Portfolio Management is responsible for monitoring significant corporate developments, including proxy proposals submitted to shareholders, and instructing votes contrary to the Guidelines where they reasonably believe that is in the best interest of clients.
Janus Henderson Investors recognizes that corporate governance systems vary a great deal between jurisdictions according to factors such as cultural issues, laws and regulations, the extent of shareholder rights, the level of dispersed ownership and the stage of development more generally. In formulating our approach to corporate governance, we are conscious that a “one size fits all” policy is not appropriate. We will therefore seek to vary our voting activities according to the local market and its standards of best practices.
While Janus Henderson Investors has attempted to address the most common issues through the Guidelines, there will be various proxy voting proposals that are not addressed by the Guidelines or that require case-by-case resolution under the Guidelines. In addition, it may not be appropriate to apply certain Guidelines to investment types such as mutual funds, exchange-traded funds, and closed-end funds, in which case Janus Henderson Investors will generally rely on the recommendation of the Proxy Voting Service unless otherwise specified in the Policy. Moreover, there may be various proxy voting proposals as to which the Proxy Voting Service does not have or provide research, analysis and recommendations. For example, the Proxy Voting Service may not provide research, analysis and recommendations for proxy voting proposals of privately-held companies. In such instances, those proposals will be referred to Portfolio Management for resolution. In exercising discretion, Janus Henderson Investors may take into consideration the information and recommendations of the Proxy Voting Service but will vote all proxies based on its own conclusions regarding the best interests of its clients.
In many cases, a security may be held by client accounts managed by multiple portfolio managers. While Janus Henderson Investors generally casts votes consistently across client accounts it manages, different portfolio managers may vote differently on the same matter in the exercise of their discretion. For example, different portfolio managers may reasonably
B-17

reach different conclusions as to what is in the best interest of their clients based on their independent judgments. In addition, in rare circumstances, an individual portfolio manager may reasonably reach different conclusions as to what is in the best interests of different clients depending on each individual client account’s investment strategy or its objectives.
Directors and Boards
Janus Henderson Investors recognises the diversity of corporate governance models across different markets and does not advocate any one form of board structure. However, it also recognises there are certain key functions which are or should be common across all markets:
Reviewing and guiding corporate strategy, major plans of action, risk policy, annual budgets and business plans; setting performance objectives; monitoring implementation and corporate performance; and overseeing major capital expenditures, acquisitions and divestitures;
Monitoring the effectiveness of the company’s governance practices and making changes as needed;
Selecting, compensating, monitoring and, where necessary, replacing key executives and overseeing succession planning;
Aligning key executive and board compensation with the longer-term interests of the company and its shareholders;
Ensuring a formal and transparent board nomination and election process;
Monitoring and managing potential conflicts of interest of management, board members and shareholders, including misuse of corporate assets and abuse in related party transactions;
Ensuring the integrity of the corporation’s accounting and financial reporting systems, including the independent audit, and that appropriate systems of control are in place, in particular, systems for risk management, financial and operational control, and compliance with the law and relevant standards;
Monitoring the quality of relationships with key stakeholders; and
Overseeing the process of disclosure and communications.
Boards of directors should include the number and types of qualified directors sufficient to ensure effective discharge of these responsibilities, including independent non-executive directors with appropriate skills, experience, and knowledge. The responsibilities of such non-executive directors should include monitoring and contributing effectively to the strategy and performance of management, staffing key committees of the board, and influencing the conduct of the board as a whole. Consistent with this principle of independence, a board of directors should generally have a non-executive chairperson. The board of directors should establish audit, compensation, and nomination/succession committees. These should be com these committees and give an account to shareholders in an annual report or other regulatory filing of how their responsibilities have been discharged. The chairpersons and members of these committees should be appointed by the board as a whole according to a transparent procedure.
Janus Henderson Investors believes the board of directors, or supervisory board, as an entity, and each of its members, as an individual, is a fiduciary for all shareholders, and should be accountable to the shareholder body as a whole. Each director should therefore generally stand for election on an annual basis.
In recognition of these principles, Janus Henderson Investors has adopted the following default policy positions among others:
Board Classification – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote against proposals to classify boards of directors and for proposals to declassify boards of directors.
Board Size – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals to increase the size of a board of directors so long as the board would retain a majority of independent directors. Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote against proposals to decrease the size of a board of directors which are intended as anti-takeover measures.
Director Independence – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals to increase the minimum number of independent directors. Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals to separate the role of the chairman from the role of the CEO.
Director Indemnification – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals regarding director or officer indemnification arrangements provided such provisions are not deemed excessive or inappropriate.
B-18

Uncontested Elections –Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of director candidates that result in the board having a majority of independent directors and oppose director candidates that result in the board not having a majority of independent directors. After taking into consideration country-specific practices, Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of individual director candidates unless:
they attend less than 75% of the board and committee meetings without a valid excuse;
they ignore or otherwise fail to respond appropriately to shareholder proposals receiving majority shareholder support;
they are not responsive to advisory votes on executive compensation matters;
they fail to provide appropriate oversight of company’s risk management practices;
they are non-independent directors and sit on the audit, compensation or nominating committees;
they are non-independent directors and the board does not have an audit, compensation, or nominating committee;
they are audit committee members and the non-audit fees paid to the auditor are excessive;
they are audit committee members and poor accounting practices rise to a level of serious concern, or other serious issues surrounding the audit process or arrangement exist;
they serve as directors on an excessive number of boards;
they are compensation committee members and the company has poor compensation practices;
they adopt a long term poison pill without shareholder approval or make material adverse changes to an existing poison pill;
they are the chair of the nominating committee, or are otherwise responsible for the nomination process, of a board that does not have a minimum level of female directors, and the company has not provided a sufficient explanation for its lack of gender diversity;
they are the chair of the nominating committee, or are otherwise responsible for the nomination process, of a board that does not have any apparent racial/ethnic diversity, and the company has not provided a sufficient explanation for its lack of racial/ethnic diversity;
they are the chair of the responsible committee of a company that is a significant greenhouse gas emitter1 where such company is not taking minimum steps needed to understand, assess, and mitigate risks related to climate change;
they amend the company’s bylaws or charter without shareholder approval in a manner that materially diminishes
shareholders’ rights or that could adversely impact shareholders; and/or
the company employs a capital structure with unequal voting rights.
Contested Elections – Janus Henderson Investors will evaluate proposals relating to contested director candidates on case by- case basis.
Cumulative Voting – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals to adopt cumulative voting unless otherwise recommended by the Proxy Voting Service.
Auditors and Accounting Issues
Janus Henderson Investors believes boards of directors should maintain robust structures and processes to ensure sound internal controls and to oversee all aspects of relationships with auditors. Boards of directors should generally have appropriately constituted audit committees with sufficient levels of financial expertise in accordance with prevailing legislation or best practice. The audit committee should ensure that the company gives a balanced and clear presentation of its financial position and prospects and clearly explains its accounting principles and policies. The audit committee should ensure that the independence of the external auditors is not compromised by conflicts of interest (e.g., financial conflicts arising from the award of non-audit assignments).
In recognition of these principles, Janus Henderson Investors has adopted the following default policy positions among others:
Uncontested Auditors – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals to approve external auditors unless:
the auditor has a financial interest in or association with the company and is therefore not independent;
fees for non-audit services are excessive;
there is reason to believe the auditor has rendered an opinion which may be neither accurate nor indicative of the
company’s financial position;
the auditor is being changed without explanation; or
B-19

the auditor is not identified by name.
Contested Auditors – Janus Henderson Investors will evaluate proposals relating to contested auditors on a case-by-case basis.
Compensation Issues
Janus Henderson Investors believes compensation of executive directors and key executives should be aligned with the interests of shareholders. Performance criteria attached to share-based compensation should be demanding. Requirements for directors and senior executives to acquire and retain company shares that are meaningful in the context of their cash compensation are also appropriate. The design of senior executives’ contracts should not commit companies to ‘payment for failure’. Boards should pay attention to minimising this risk when drawing up contracts and to resist pressure to concede excessively generous severance conditions. Any share-based compensation should be subject to shareholder approval.
Companies should disclose in each annual report or proxy statement the board’s policies on executive compensation (and preferably the compensation of individual board members and top executives), as well as the composition of such compensation so that investors can judge whether corporate pay policies and practices are appropriately designed. Broad-based employee share ownership plans or other profit-sharing programs are effective market mechanisms that promote employee participation. When reviewing whether to support proposed new share schemes, we place particular importance on the following factors:
The overall potential cost of the scheme, including the level of dilution;
The issue price of share options relative to the market price;
The use of performance conditions aligning the interests of participants with shareholders;
The holding period (i.e., the length of time from the award date to the earliest date of exercise); and
The level of disclosure.
In recognition of these principles, Janus Henderson Investors has adopted the following default policy positions among others:
Executive and Director Equity-Based Compensation Plans – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of equity-based compensation plans unless they create an inconsistent relationship between long-term share performance and compensation, do not demonstrate good stewardship of investors’ interests, or contain problematic features. Janus Henderson Investors considers the following, non-exhaustive list of practices to be problematic and generally votes against plans or amendments to plans that:
provide for re-pricing of underwater options;
provide for automatic replenishment (“evergreen”) or reload options;
create an inconsistent relationship between long term share performance and compensation increases; and/or
are proposed by management and do not demonstrate good stewardship of investors’ interests regarding executive compensation or are a vehicle for poor compensation practices.
Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote against proposals permitting material amendments to equity-based compensation plans without shareholder approval.
Long-Term Ownership – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals intended to increase long-term stock ownership by executives, officers, and directors. These may include:
requiring executive officers and directors to hold a minimum amount of stock in the company;
requiring stock acquired through exercised options to be held for a certain period of time; and
using restricted stock grants instead of options.
Director and Officer Loans – Janus Henderson Investors will generally oppose proposals requesting approval of loans to officers, executives, and board members of an issuer.
B-20

Say-on-Pay – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of annual advisory votes on executive compensation (say-on-pay frequency). Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote with management on advisory votes on executive compensation (say-on-pay) unless Janus Henderson Investors determines problematic pay practices are maintained.
Executive Severance Agreements – Janus Henderson Investors will evaluate proposals to approve or cancel executive severance agreements on a case-by-case basis. Janus Henderson Investors will vote in favor of proposals to require executive severance agreements to be submitted for shareholder approval unless the proposal requires shareholder approval prior to entering into employment contracts.
Employee Stock Option Plans (ESOP) and Stock Purchase Plans (ESPP) – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals relating to ESOPs and ESPPs unless the shares purchased through the plans are discounted more than the market norm, the shares allocated to the plans are excessive, and/or the plans contain other problematic features.
Option Expensing and Repricing – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals requiring the expensing of options. Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote against proposals providing for the repricing of options.
Capitalization, Issuances, Transactions, Shareholder Rights, and Other Corporate Matters
Janus Henderson Investors believes all shareholders should be treated equitably. Companies’ ordinary shares should provide one vote for each share, and companies should act to ensure the owners’ rights to vote.
Any major strategic modifications to the core businesses of a company should not be made without prior shareholder approval. Equally, any major corporate changes, which in substance or effect, materially dilute the equity or erode the economic interests or share ownership rights of existing shareholders should not be made without prior shareholder approval of the proposed change. Such changes may include but are not limited to modifications to articles or bylaws and the implementation of shareholder rights plans or so called “poison pills.”
We will not support proposals that have the potential to reduce shareholder rights, such as significant open-ended authorities to issue shares without pre-emption rights or anti-takeover proposals, unless companies provide a compelling rationale for why they are in shareholder interests.
In recognition of these principles, Janus Henderson Investors has adopted the following default policy positions among others:
Capital Stock – Subject to local market standards, Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals seeking to increase the number of shares of common or preferred stock authorized for issue unless the company does not adequately justify the need for the additional shares. Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote against proposals to authorize preferred stock whose voting, conversion, dividend, and other rights are determined at the discretion of the board of directors when the stock is issued (“blank check stock”). Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote against proposals for different classes of stock with different voting rights.
Stock Splits – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals to split shares unless they negatively affect the ability to trade shares or the economic value of a share.
Share Issuances - Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals related to share issuances with and without preemptive rights, provided that voting in favor of such proposals is consistent with local market standards, such proposals are not considered excessive in the context of the issuer and such proposals do not provide for different levels of voting rights.
Debt Issuances – Janus Henderson Investors will evaluate proposals regarding the issuance of debt, including convertible debt, on a case- by-case basis.
Mergers, Acquisitions and Other Significant Corporate Transactions – Janus Henderson Investors will evaluate proposals regarding acquisitions, mergers, tender offers, or changes in control on a case-by-case basis, including any related proposals such as share issuances or advisory votes on golden parachutes.
B-21

Reorganization, Restructuring and Liquidation – Janus Henderson Investors will evaluate plans of reorganization, restructuring and liquidation on a case-by-case basis.
Shareholder Rights Plans and Other Anti-Takeover Mechanisms – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote against shareholder rights plans or other proposals designed to prevent or obstruct corporate takeovers (includes poison pills), unless such measures are proposed in a transparent and independent fashion and designed primarily as a short-term means to protect a tax benefit, or are structured in such a way that they give shareholders the ultimate decision on any proposal or offer. This general policy supersedes any other more specific policy to the contrary.
Change in Jurisdiction of Incorporation or Organization - Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals regarding changes in the jurisdiction of incorporation or organization of an issuer.
Confidential Voting – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals to provide for confidential voting and independent tabulation of voting results.
Supermajority Voting – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote against proposals to provide for supermajority voting (e.g., to approve acquisitions or mergers).
Special Meetings – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of management proposals to allow shareholders to call special meetings. Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of shareholder proposals to allow shareholders to call special meetings, unless such right is already provided at a level consistent with local best practice and the shareholder proposal would further reduce the required threshold. Such proposals will be evaluated on a case-by-case basis.
Written Consents – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of management proposals to allow action by shareholders’ written consent. Janus Henderson Investors will evaluate shareholder proposals to allow action by shareholders’ written consent on a case-by-case basis.
Proxy Access – Janus Henderson Investors will evaluate proposals related to proxy access on a case-by-case basis.
Environmental and Social Issues
Janus Henderson Investors believes that good management of stakeholder relationships contributes to business success and long-term shareholder value. These stakeholders include not only shareholders but also employees, consumers, debtholders, business partners, neighbors, and the wider global community. Janus Henderson Investors also recognises the importance of environmental issues such as climate change and social issues such as diversity & inclusion to all these stakeholder groups.
As a fiduciary for its clients, Janus Henderson Investors is primarily concerned with the impact of proposals on a company’s performance and economic value. Janus Henderson Investors recognizes that environmental and social issues are associated with risks, costs and benefits which can have a significant impact on company performance over the short and long term.
When evaluating the merits of proposals on environmental and social issues, Janus Henderson Investors will weigh the risks, costs, and benefits of supporting the proposals against those presented by alternatives, including potentially seeking similar outcomes through direct engagement activities with management. Janus Henderson Investors will generally support management proposals addressing environmental and social issues unless we identify significant weaknesses relative to market practice or peers. Janus Henderson Investors will generally support shareholder proposals addressing environmental and social issues where we identify significant areas of weakness or deficiency relative to peers and/or industry best practices or feel that management has failed to adequately respond to shareholder concerns.
Miscellaneous, Administrative and Routine Items
Janus Henderson Investors believes that management should generally have discretion to make certain types of decisions, including how to use existing capital. In addition, in certain jurisdictions, shareholder approval of certain routine or administrative matters may be required. On these types of issues, Janus Henderson Investors will generally defer to management unless it believes these decisions are not being made, or these actions are not being taken, in good faith.
B-22

In recognition of these principles, Janus Henderson Investors has adopted the following default policy positions among others:
Dividends – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of management proposals relating to the issuance of dividends. Janus Henderson Investors will evaluate shareholder proposals relating to the issuance of dividends on a case-by-case basis.
Share Repurchase Plans - Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of management proposals regarding share repurchases. Janus Henderson Investors will evaluate shareholder proposals relating to share repurchases on a case-by-case basis.
“Other Business” – Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote against proposals to approve “other business” when it appears as a voting item.
Designation of Exclusive Forum - Janus Henderson Investors will generally vote in favor of proposals designating an exclusive forum in federal court or Delaware state court (for companies organized in Delaware). Janus Henderson Investors will evaluate proposals designating an exclusive forum in other jurisdictions on a case- by-case basis.
Proposals Outside the Guidelines
For proposals outside the scope of the Guidelines or instructions otherwise provided to the Proxy Voting Service, Janus Henderson Investors will generally rely on the recommendation of the Proxy Voting Service.
1Janus Henderson Investors will apply the same definition as used by the Proxy Voting Service.
LOOMIS, SAYLES & COMPANY, L.P. (“LOOMIS SAYLES”)
Loomis Sayles uses the services of third parties (“Proxy Voting Services”) to provide research, analysis and voting recommendations and to administer the process of voting proxies for those accounts and funds for which Loomis Sayles has voting authority. Loomis Sayles will generally follow its express policy with input from the Proxy Voting Service that provides research, analysis and voting recommendations to Loomis Sayles unless Loomis Sayles’ Proxy Committee determines that the client’s best interests are served by voting otherwise. All issues presented for shareholder vote are subject to the oversight of the Proxy Committee. All nonroutine issues will generally be considered directly by the Proxy Committee and, when necessary, the investment professionals responsible for the fund holding the security, and will be voted in the best investment interests of the fund. All routine “for” and “against” issues will be voted according to Loomis Sayles’ policy unless special factors require that they be considered by the Proxy Committee and, when necessary, the investment professionals responsible for the fund holding the security. Loomis Sayles’ Proxy Committee has established these routine policies in what it believes are the best investment interests of Loomis Sayles’ clients.
The specific responsibilities of the Proxy Committee include (1) the development, authorization, implementation and updating of the Loomis Sayles’ Proxy Voting Policies and Procedures (the “Procedures”), including an annual review of the Procedures, existing voting guidelines and the proxy voting process in general, (2) oversight of the proxy voting process including oversight of the vote on proposals according to the predetermined policies in the voting guidelines, directing the vote on proposals where there is reason not to vote according to the predetermined policies in the voting guidelines or where proposals require special consideration, and consultation with the portfolio managers and analysts for the fund holding the security when necessary or appropriate and, periodically sampling or engaging an outside party to sample proxy votes to ensure they comply with the Procedures and are cast in accordance with the clients’ best interests and, (3) engagement and oversight of third-party vendors, including Proxy Voting Services including determining whether a Proxy Voting Service has the capacity and competency to adequately analyze proxy issues, providing ongoing oversight of the Proxy Voting Services to ensure that proxies continue to be voted in the best interests of clients, receiving and reviewing updates from the Proxy Voting Services regarding relevant business changes or changes to the Proxy Voting Services’ conflict policies and procedures, and in the event that the Proxy Committee becomes aware that a Proxy Voting Service’s recommendation was based on a material factual error: investigating the error, considering the nature of the error and the related recommendation, and determining whether the Proxy Voting Service has taken reasonable steps to reduce the likelihood of similar errors in the future.
B-23

Loomis Sayles has established several policies to ensure that proxies are voted in its clients’ best interest and are not affected by any possible conflicts of interest. First, except in certain limited instances, Loomis Sayles votes in accordance with its pre-determined policies set forth in the Procedures. Second, where these Procedures allow for discretion, Loomis Sayles will generally consider the recommendations of the Proxy Voting Services in making its voting decisions. However, if the Proxy Committee determines that the Proxy Voting Services’ recommendation is not in the best interest of its clients, then the Proxy Committee may use its discretion to vote against the Proxy Voting Services’ recommendation, but only after taking the following steps: (1) conducting a review for any material conflict of interest Loomis Sayles may have; and, (2) if any material conflict is found to exist, excluding anyone at Loomis Sayles who is subject to that conflict of interest from participating in the voting decision in any way. However, if deemed necessary or appropriate by the Proxy Committee after full prior disclosure of any conflict, that person may provide information, opinions or recommendations on any proposal to the Proxy Committee. In such event, prior to directing the vote, the Proxy Committee will make reasonable efforts to obtain and consider information, opinions and recommendations from or about the opposing position.
MELLON INVESTMENTS CORPORATION 
Mellon Investments Corporation (“Mellon”) has a fiduciary responsibility to our clients. We seek to make proxy-voting decisions that are in the best long-term economic interest of our clients as shareholders. We understand that we owe each of our clients a duty of care and loyalty with respect to voting proxies. Our approach to proxy voting is with the same analysis and engagement that we apply to all of our investment activities.
In general, we employ proxy voting to:
Align the interests of a company’s management and board of directors with those of the company’s shareholders,
Promote the accountability of a company’s management to its board of directors, as well as the accountability of the board of directors to the company’s shareholders and stakeholders,
Uphold the rights of a company’s shareholders to affect change by voting on those matters submitted to shareholders for approval, and
Promote adequate disclosure about a company’s business operations and financial activity
The Committee reviews all shareholder resolutions related to Environmental and Social considerations on a case-by-case basis. Our belief is that a company’s environmental, social and governance (ESG) practices have a long-term effect on a company’s economic value, and therefore we consider these factors when voting proxies. We have created Proxy Voting Guidelines (“voting guidelines”) and established a Proxy Voting and Governance Committee (the “Committee”) that is comprised primarily of senior investment professionals.
Mellon will carefully review proposals that would limit shareholder control or could affect the value of a client’s investment. It will generally oppose proposals designed to insulate an issuer’s management unnecessarily from the wishes of a majority of shareholders. Mellon pays particular attention to repeat issues where management has failed in its commitment in the intervening period to take action on issues.
Mellon seeks to avoid material conflicts of interest by applying detailed, predetermined proxy voting guidelines in an objective and consistent manner across client accounts, based on internal and external research and recommendations provided by a third-party vendor, and without consideration of any client relationship factors. Further, Mellon engages a third party as an independent fiduciary to vote all proxies for BNY Mellon securities and affiliated mutual fund securities.
Proxy voting proposals are reviewed, categorized, analyzed and voted in accordance with Mellon’s voting guidelines. These guidelines are reviewed periodically and updated as necessary to reflect new topics or proposals and any changes in policies on specific issues. Items that can be categorized under these voting guidelines will be voted in accordance with such guidelines or referred to the Committee, if the applicable guidelines so require. Proposals that cannot be categorized under these voting guidelines will be referred to the Committee for discussion and vote. Additionally, the Committee may review any proposal where it has identified a particular company, industry or issue for special scrutiny. With regard to voting proxies of foreign companies, Mellon may weigh the cost of voting, and potential inability to sell the securities (which may occur during the voting process), against the benefit of voting the proxies to determine whether or not to vote.
In evaluating proposals regarding incentive plans and restricted stock plans, the Committee typically employs a shareholder value transfer model. This model seeks to assess the amount of shareholder equity flowing out of the company to executives
B-24

as options are exercised. After determining the cost of the plan, the Committee evaluates whether the cost is reasonable based on a number of factors, including industry classification and historical performance information. The Committee generally votes against proposals that permit the repricing or replacement of stock options without shareholder approval.
NATIONWIDE ASSET MANAGEMENT, LLC (“NWAM”)
These guidelines describe how NWAM discharges its fiduciary duty to vote on behalf of client’s proxies that are received in connection with underlying portfolio securities held by NWAM’s clients (said proxies hereinafter referred to as “proxies”). NWAM understands its responsibility to process proxies and to maintain proxy records. In addition, NWAM understands its duty to vote proxies.
These Proxy Voting Guidelines reflect the general belief that proxies should be voted in a manner that serves the best economic interests of clients (to the extent, if any, that the economic interests of a client are affected by the proxy), unless otherwise directed by the client.
How Proxies Are Voted
NWAM will:
Vote proxies received in the best interest of the client. The Enterprise Portfolio Manager (EPM) for the account holding the security will be the person that decides how to vote a proxy based on their understanding of the portfolio and applying information/research received from the other professionals within the Nationwide Investments office;
The EPM will maintain appropriate records of proxy voting that are easily accessible by appropriate authorized persons of NWAM; and
The Nationwide Investment’s Operations team will ensure the proxies are signed or instructed via email and filed with, or electronically submitted to, the appropriate parties with desired voting action.
In accordance with these Proxy Voting Guidelines, NWAM, and as otherwise set forth in these guidelines, shall attempt to process every vote for all domestic and foreign proxies that it receives.
Foreign Proxies
There are situations; however, in which NWAM cannot process a proxy in connection with a foreign security (hereinafter, “foreign proxies”). For example, NWAM will not process a foreign proxy:
if the cost of voting a foreign proxy outweighs the benefit of voting the foreign proxy;
when NWAM has not been given enough time to process the vote; or
when a sell order for the foreign security is outstanding and, in the particular foreign country, proxy voting would impede the sale of the foreign security.
Proxy Voting for Securities Involved in Securities Lending
NWAM Clients may participate in securities lending programs. Under most securities lending arrangements, proxies received in connection with the securities on loan may not be voted by the lender (unless the loan is recalled) (i.e., proxy voting rights during the lending period generally are transferred to the borrower). NWAM believes that each Client has the right to determine whether participating in a securities lending program enhances returns. If a Client has determined to participate in a securities lending program, NWAM, therefore, shall cooperate with the Client’s determination that securities lending is beneficial to the Client’s account and shall not attempt to seek recalls for the purpose of voting proxies unless the client has provisions in place to allow for this. Consequently, it is NWAM’s policy that, in the event that NWAM manages an account for a Client that employs a securities lending program, NWAM generally will not seek to vote proxies relating to the securities on loan unless the client has provisions in place to allow for this.
Recordkeeping & Reporting
NWAM shall keep and maintain the following records and other items:
its Proxy Voting Guidelines;
B-25

proxy statements received regarding underlying portfolio securities held by Clients (received through Bank of New York, other custodian arrangements in place and any securities lending or sub-custody contractors);
records of votes cast on behalf of Clients (where possible or applicable);
Client written requests for information as to how NWAM voted proxies for said Client;
any NWAM written responses to an oral or written request from a Client for information as to how NWAM voted proxies for the Client; and
any documents prepared by NWAM that were material to making a decision as to how to vote proxies or that memorialized the basis for the voting decision.
These records and other items shall be maintained for at least five (5) years from the end of the fiscal year during which the last entry was made on this record, the first two (2) years in an appropriate office of NWAM.
NATIONWIDE FUND ADVISORS
GENERAL
The Board of Trustees of Nationwide Mutual Funds and Nationwide Variable Insurance Trust (the “Funds”) has approved the continued delegation of the authority to vote proxies relating to the securities held in the portfolios of the Funds to each Fund’s investment adviser, who in turn may, and typically does, delegate such authority to each Fund’s subadviser(s), as applicable, (unless the investment adviser has entered into specific voting arrangements with the subadviser(s)), some of which advisers and subadvisers use an independent service provider, as described below.
Nationwide Fund Advisors (“NFA” or the “Adviser”), is an investment adviser that is registered with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) pursuant to the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, as amended (the “Advisers Act”). NFA currently provides investment advisory services to registered investment companies (hereinafter referred to collectively as “Clients”).
Voting proxies that are received in connection with underlying portfolio securities held by Clients is an important element of the portfolio management services that NFA performs for Clients. NFA’s goal in performing this service is to make proxy voting decisions: (i) to vote or not to vote proxies in a manner that serves the best economic interests of Clients; and (ii) that avoid the influence of conflicts of interest. To implement this goal, NFA has adopted proxy voting guidelines (the “Proxy Voting Guidelines”) to assist it in making proxy voting decisions and in developing procedures for effecting those decisions. The Proxy Voting Guidelines are designed to ensure that, where NFA has the authority to vote proxies, all legal, fiduciary, and contractual obligations will be met.
The Proxy Voting Guidelines address a wide variety of individual topics, including, among other matters, shareholder voting rights, anti-takeover defenses, board structures and the election of directors, executive and director compensation, reorganizations, mergers, and various shareholder proposals.
The proxy voting records of the Funds are available to shareholders on the Trust’s website, https://www.nationwide.com/personal/investing/mutual-funds/proxy-voting/, and the SEC’s EDGAR database on its website, sec.gov.
HOW PROXIES ARE VOTED
NFA has delegated to Institutional Shareholder Services Inc. (“ISS”), an independent service provider, the administration of proxy voting for Client portfolio securities directly managed by NFA, subject to oversight by NFA’s “Proxy Voting Committee.” ISS, a Delaware corporation, provides proxy-voting services to many asset managers on a global basis. The NFA Proxy Voting Committee has reviewed, and will continue to review annually, the relationship with ISS and the quality and effectiveness of the various services provided by ISS.
Specifically, ISS assists NFA in the proxy voting and corporate governance oversight process by developing and updating the “ISS Proxy Voting Guidelines,” which are incorporated into the Proxy Voting Guidelines, and by providing research and analysis, recommendations regarding votes, operational implementation, and recordkeeping and reporting services. ISS also provides NFA with any additional solicitation materials filed by an issuer in response to any ISS recommendation. NFA’s Proxy Voting Committee evaluates any such additional information provided by ISS and uses its best judgement in voting
B-26

proxies on behalf of Client Accounts. NFA’s decision to retain ISS is based principally on the view that the services that ISS provides, subject to oversight by NFA, generally will result in proxy voting decisions which serve the best economic interests of Clients. NFA has reviewed, analyzed, and determined that the ISS Proxy Voting Guidelines are consistent with the views of NFA on the various types of proxy proposals. When the ISS Proxy Voting Guidelines do not cover a specific proxy issue and ISS does not provide a recommendation: (i) ISS will notify NFA; and (ii) NFA’s Proxy Voting Committee will use its best judgment in voting proxies on behalf of the Clients. A summary of the ISS Proxy Voting Guidelines is set forth below.
CONFLICTS OF INTEREST
NFA does not engage in investment banking, administration or management of corporate retirement plans, or any other activity that is likely to create a potential conflict of interest. In addition, because Client proxies are voted by ISS pursuant to the pre-determined ISS Proxy Voting Guidelines, NFA generally does not make an actual determination of how to vote a particular proxy, and, therefore, proxies voted on behalf of Clients do not reflect any conflict of interest. Nevertheless, the Proxy Voting Guidelines address the possibility of such a conflict of interest arising.
The Proxy Voting Guidelines provide that, if a proxy proposal were to create a conflict of interest between the interests of a Client and those of NFA (or between a Client and those of any of NFA’s affiliates, including Nationwide Fund Distributors LLC and Nationwide), then the proxy should be voted strictly in conformity with the recommendation of ISS. To monitor compliance with this policy, any proposed or actual deviation from a recommendation of ISS must be reported by the NFA Proxy Voting Committee to the chief counsel for NFA. The chief counsel for NFA then will provide guidance concerning the proposed deviation and whether a deviation presents any potential conflict of interest. If NFA then casts a proxy vote that deviates from an ISS recommendation, the affected Client (or other appropriate Client authority) will be given a report of this deviation.
CIRCUMSTANCES UNDER WHICH PROXIES WILL NOT BE VOTED
NFA shall attempt to process every vote for all domestic and foreign proxies that they receive; however, there may be cases in which NFA will not process a proxy because it is impractical or too expensive to do so. For example, NFA will not process a proxy in connection with a foreign security if the cost of voting a foreign proxy outweighs the benefit of voting the foreign proxy, when NFA has not been given enough time to process the vote, or when a sell order for the foreign security is outstanding and proxy voting would impede the sale of the foreign security. Also, NFA generally will not seek to recall the securities on loan for the purpose of voting the securities -- except, in regard to a sub-advised Fund, for those proxy votes that a subadviser (retained to manage the sub-advised Fund and overseen by NFA) has determined could materially affect the security on loan. The Firm will seek to have the appropriate Subadviser(s) vote those proxies relating to securities on loan that are held by a Sub-advised Nationwide Fund that the Subadviser(s) has determined could materially affect the security on loan.
DELEGATION OF PROXY VOTING TO SUBADVISERS TO FUNDS
For any Fund, or portion of a Fund that is directly managed by a subadviser, the Trustees of the Fund and NFA have delegated proxy voting authority to that subadviser. Each subadviser has provided its proxy voting policies to NFA for review and these proxy voting policies are described elsewhere in this Appendix B. Each subadviser is required to represent quarterly to NFA that (1) all proxies of the Fund(s) managed by the subadviser were voted in accordance with the subadviser’s proxy voting policies as provided to NFA, unless NFA has entered into specific voting arrangements with the subadviser; (2) there have been no material changes to the subadviser’s proxy voting policies; and (3) all proxies voted by the subadviser were cast as intended.
ISS’ 2023 U.S. Proxy Voting Concise Guidelines
BOARD OF DIRECTORS
Voting on Director Nominees in Uncontested Elections
General Recommendation: Generally vote for director nominees, except under the following circumstances (with new nominees1 considered on case-by-case basis):
B-27

Independence
Vote against2 or withhold from non-independent directors (Executive Directors and Non-Independent Non-Executive Directors per ISS’ Classification of Directors) when:
Independent directors comprise 50 percent or less of the board;
The non-independent director serves on the audit, compensation, or nominating committee;
The company lacks an audit, compensation, or nominating committee so that the full board functions as that committee; or
The company lacks a formal nominating committee, even if the board attests that the independent directors fulfill the functions of such a committee.
Composition
Attendance at Board and Committee Meetings: Generally vote against or withhold from directors (except nominees who served only part of the fiscal year3) who attend less than 75 percent of the aggregate of their board and committee meetings for the period for which they served, unless an acceptable reason for absences is disclosed in the proxy or another SEC filing. Acceptable reasons for director absences are generally limited to the following:
Medical issues/illness;
Family emergencies; and
Missing only one meeting (when the total of all meetings is three or fewer).
In cases of chronic poor attendance without reasonable justification, in addition to voting against the director(s) with poor attendance, generally vote against or withhold from appropriate members of the nominating/governance committees or the full board.
If the proxy disclosure is unclear and insufficient to determine whether a director attended at least 75 percent of the aggregate of his/her board and committee meetings during his/her period of service, vote against or withhold from the director(s) in question.
Overboarded Directors: Generally vote against or withhold from individual directors who:
Sit on more than five public company boards; or
Are CEOs of public companies who sit on the boards of more than two public companies besides their own— withhold only at their outside boards4.
Gender Diversity:
Generally vote against or withhold from the chair of the nominating committee (or other directors on a case-by-case basis) at companies where there are no women on the company's board. An exception will be made if there was at least one woman on the board at the preceding annual meeting and the board makes a firm commitment to return to a gender-diverse status within a year.
Racial and/or Ethnic Diversity: For companies in the Russell 3000 or S&P 1500 indices, generally vote against or withhold from the chair of the nominating committee (or other directors on a case-by-case basis) where the board has no apparent racially or ethnically diverse members5. An exception will be made if there was racial and/or ethnic diversity on the board at the preceding annual meeting and the board makes a firm commitment to appoint at least one racial and/or ethnic diverse member within a year.
Responsiveness
Vote case-by-case on individual directors, committee members, or the entire board of directors as appropriate if:
The board failed to act on a shareholder proposal that received the support of a majority of the shares cast in the previous year or failed to act on a management proposal seeking to ratify an existing charter/bylaw provision that received opposition of a majority of the shares cast in the previous year. Factors that will be considered are:
Disclosed outreach efforts by the board to shareholders in the wake of the vote;
B-28

Rationale provided in the proxy statement for the level of implementation;
The subject matter of the proposal;
The level of support for and opposition to the resolution in past meetings;
Actions taken by the board in response to the majority vote and its engagement with shareholders;
The continuation of the underlying issue as a voting item on the ballot (as either shareholder or management proposals); and
Other factors as appropriate.
The board failed to act on takeover offers where the majority of shares are tendered;
At the previous board election, any director received more than 50 percent withhold/against votes of the shares cast and the company has failed to address the issue(s) that caused the high withhold/against vote.
Vote case-by-case on Compensation Committee members (or, in exceptional cases, the full board) and the Say on Pay proposal if:
The company’s previous say-on-pay received the support of less than 70 percent of votes cast. Factors that will be considered are:
The company's response, including:
Disclosure of engagement efforts with major institutional investors, including the frequency and timing of engagements and the company participants (including whether independent directors participated);
Disclosure of the specific concerns voiced by dissenting shareholders that led to the say-on-pay opposition;
Disclosure of specific and meaningful actions taken to address shareholders' concerns;
Other recent compensation actions taken by the company;
Whether the issues raised are recurring or isolated;
The company's ownership structure; and
Whether the support level was less than 50 percent, which would warrant the highest degree of responsiveness.
The board implements an advisory vote on executive compensation on a less frequent basis than the frequency that received the plurality of votes cast.
Accountability
Problematic Takeover Defenses, Capital Structure, and Governance Structure
Poison Pills: Generally vote against or withhold from all nominees (except new nominees1, who should be considered case-by-case) if:
The company has a poison pill with a deadhand or slowhand feature6;
The board makes a material adverse modification to an existing pill, including, but not limited to, extension, renewal, or lowering the trigger, without shareholder approval; or
The company has a long-term poison pill (with a term of over one year) that was not approved by the public shareholders7.
Vote case-by-case on nominees if the board adopts an initial short-term pill6 (with a term of one year or less) without shareholder approval, taking into consideration:
The disclosed rationale for the adoption;
The trigger;
The company’s market capitalization (including absolute level and sudden changes);
A commitment to put any renewal to a shareholder vote; and
Other factors as relevant.
Unequal Voting Rights: Generally vote withhold or against directors individually, committee members, or the entire board (except new nominees1, who should be considered case-by-case), if the company employs a common stock structure with unequal voting rights8.
Exceptions to this policy will generally be limited to:
Newly-public companies9 with a sunset provision of no more than seven years from the date of going public;
Limited Partnerships and the Operating Partnership (OP) unit structure of REITs;
B-29

Situations where the super-voting shares represent less than 5% of total voting power and therefore considered to be de minimis; or
The company provides sufficient protections for minority shareholders, such as allowing minority shareholders a regular binding vote on whether the capital structure should be maintained.
Classified Board Structure: The board is classified, and a continuing director responsible for a problematic governance issue at the board/committee level that would warrant a withhold/against vote recommendation is not up for election. All appropriate nominees (except new) may be held accountable.
Removal of Shareholder Discretion on Classified Boards: The company has opted into, or failed to opt out of, state laws requiring a classified board structure.
Problematic Governance Structure: For companies that hold or held their first annual meeting9 of public shareholders after Feb. 1, 2015, generally vote against or withhold from directors individually, committee members, or the entire board (except new nominees1, who should be considered case-by-case) if, prior to or in connection with the company's public offering, the company or its board adopted the following bylaw or charter provisions that are considered to be materially adverse to shareholder rights:
Supermajority vote requirements to amend the bylaws or charter;
A classified board structure; or
Other egregious provisions.
A provision which specifies that the problematic structure(s) will be sunset within seven years of the date of going public will be considered a mitigating factor.
Unless the adverse provision is reversed or removed, vote case-by-case on director nominees in subsequent years.
Unilateral Bylaw/Charter Amendments: Generally vote against or withhold from directors individually, committee members, or the entire board (except new nominees1, who should be considered case-by-case) if the board amends the company's bylaws or charter without shareholder approval in a manner that materially diminishes shareholders' rights or that could adversely impact shareholders, considering the following factors:
The board's rationale for adopting the bylaw/charter amendment without shareholder ratification;
Disclosure by the company of any significant engagement with shareholders regarding the amendment;
The level of impairment of shareholders' rights caused by the board's unilateral amendment to the bylaws/charter;
The board's track record with regard to unilateral board action on bylaw/charter amendments or other entrenchment provisions;
The company's ownership structure;
The company's existing governance provisions;
The timing of the board's amendment to the bylaws/charter in connection with a significant business development; and
Other factors, as deemed appropriate, that may be relevant to determine the impact of the amendment on shareholders.
Unless the adverse amendment is reversed or submitted to a binding shareholder vote, in subsequent years vote case- by-case on director nominees. Generally vote against (except new nominees1, who should be considered case-by-case) if the directors:
Classified the board;
Adopted supermajority vote requirements to amend the bylaws or charter;
Eliminated shareholders' ability to amend bylaws;
Adopted a fee-shifting provision; or
Adopted another provision deemed egregious.
B-30

Restricting Binding Shareholder Proposals: Generally vote against or withhold from the members of the governance committee if:
The company’s governing documents impose undue restrictions on shareholders’ ability to amend the bylaws. Such restrictions include but are not limited to: outright prohibition on the submission of binding shareholder proposals or share ownership requirements, subject matter restrictions, or time holding requirements in excess of SEC Rule 14a-8. Vote against or withhold on an ongoing basis.
Submission of management proposals to approve or ratify requirements in excess of SEC Rule 14a-8 for the submission of binding bylaw amendments will generally be viewed as an insufficient restoration of shareholders' rights. Generally continue to vote against or withhold on an ongoing basis until shareholders are provided with an unfettered ability to amend the bylaws or a proposal providing for such unfettered right is submitted for shareholder approval.
Director Performance Evaluation: The board lacks mechanisms to promote accountability and oversight, coupled with sustained poor performance relative to peers. Sustained poor performance is measured by one-, three-, and five-year total shareholder returns in the bottom half of a company’s four-digit GICS industry group (Russell 3000 companies only). Take into consideration the company’s operational metrics and other factors as warranted. Problematic provisions include but are not limited to:
A classified board structure;
A supermajority vote requirement;
Either a plurality vote standard in uncontested director elections, or a majority vote standard in contested elections;
The inability of shareholders to call special meetings;
The inability of shareholders to act by written consent;
A multi-class capital structure; and/or
A non-shareholder-approved poison pill.
Management Proposals to Ratify Existing Charter or Bylaw Provisions: Vote against/withhold from individual directors, members of the governance committee, or the full board, where boards ask shareholders to ratify existing charter or bylaw provisions considering the following factors:
The presence of a shareholder proposal addressing the same issue on the same ballot;
The board's rationale for seeking ratification;
Disclosure of actions to be taken by the board should the ratification proposal fail;
Disclosure of shareholder engagement regarding the board’s ratification request;
The level of impairment to shareholders' rights caused by the existing provision;
The history of management and shareholder proposals on the provision at the company’s past meetings;
Whether the current provision was adopted in response to the shareholder proposal;
The company's ownership structure; and
Previous use of ratification proposals to exclude shareholder proposals.
Problematic Audit-Related Practices
Generally vote against or withhold from the members of the Audit Committee if:
The non-audit fees paid to the auditor are excessive;
The company receives an adverse opinion on the company’s financial statements from its auditor; or
There is persuasive evidence that the Audit Committee entered into an inappropriate indemnification agreement with its auditor that limits the ability of the company, or its shareholders, to pursue legitimate legal recourse against the audit firm.
Vote case-by-case on members of the Audit Committee and potentially the full board if:
Poor accounting practices are identified that rise to a level of serious concern, such as: fraud; misapplication of GAAP; and material weaknesses identified in Section 404 disclosures. Examine the severity, breadth, chronological sequence, and duration, as well as the company’s efforts at remediation or corrective actions, in determining whether withhold/against votes are warranted.
B-31

Problematic Compensation Practices
In the absence of an Advisory Vote on Executive Compensation (Say on Pay) ballot item or in egregious situations, vote against or withhold from the members of the Compensation Committee and potentially the full board if:
There is an unmitigated misalignment between CEO pay and company performance (pay for performance);
The company maintains significant problematic pay practices; or
The board exhibits a significant level of poor communication and responsiveness to shareholders.
Generally vote against or withhold from the Compensation Committee chair, other committee members, or potentially the full board if:
The company fails to include a Say on Pay ballot item when required under SEC provisions, or under the company’s declared frequency of say on pay; or
The company fails to include a Frequency of Say on Pay ballot item when required under SEC provisions.
Generally vote against members of the board committee responsible for approving/setting non-employee director compensation if there is a pattern (i.e. two or more years) of awarding excessive non-employee director compensation without disclosing a compelling rationale or other mitigating factors.
Problematic Pledging of Company Stock:
Vote against the members of the committee that oversees risks related to pledging, or the full board, where a significant level of pledged company stock by executives or directors raises concerns. The following factors will be considered:
The presence of an anti-pledging policy, disclosed in the proxy statement, that prohibits future pledging activity;
The magnitude of aggregate pledged shares in terms of total common shares outstanding, market value, and trading volume;
Disclosure of progress or lack thereof in reducing the magnitude of aggregate pledged shares over time;
Disclosure in the proxy statement that shares subject to stock ownership and holding requirements do not include pledged company stock; and
Any other relevant factors.
Climate Accountability
For companies that are significant greenhouse gas (GHG) emitters, through their operations or value chain10, generally vote against or withhold from the incumbent chair of the responsible committee (or other directors on a case-by-case basis) in cases where ISS determines that the company is not taking the minimum steps needed to understand, assess, and mitigate risks related to climate change to the company and the larger economy.
Minimum steps to understand and mitigate those risks are considered to be the following. Both minimum criteria will be required to be in alignment with the policy:
Detailed disclosure of climate-related risks, such as according to the framework established by the Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures (TCFD), including:
Board governance measures;
Corporate strategy;
Risk management analyses; and
Metrics and targets.
Appropriate GHG emissions reduction targets.
At this time, “appropriate GHG emissions reductions targets” will be medium-term GHG reduction targets or Net Zero-by-2050 GHG reduction targets for a company's operations (Scope 1) and electricity use (Scope 2). Targets should cover the vast majority of the company’s direct emissions.
B-32

Governance Failures
Under extraordinary circumstances, vote against or withhold from directors individually, committee members, or the entire board, due to:
Material failures of governance, stewardship, risk oversight11, or fiduciary responsibilities at the company;
Failure to replace management as appropriate; or
Egregious actions related to a director’s service on other boards that raise substantial doubt about his or her ability to effectively oversee management and serve the best interests of shareholders at any company.
Voting on Director Nominees in Contested Elections
Vote-No Campaigns
General Recommendation: In cases where companies are targeted in connection with public “vote-no” campaigns, evaluate director nominees under the existing governance policies for voting on director nominees in uncontested elections. Take into consideration the arguments submitted by shareholders and other publicly available information.
Proxy Contests/Proxy Access
General Recommendation: Vote case-by-case on the election of directors in contested elections, considering the following factors:
Long-term financial performance of the company relative to its industry;
Management’s track record;
Background to the contested election;
Nominee qualifications and any compensatory arrangements;
Strategic plan of dissident slate and quality of the critique against management;
Likelihood that the proposed goals and objectives can be achieved (both slates); and
Stock ownership positions.
In the case of candidates nominated pursuant to proxy access, vote case-by-case considering any applicable factors listed above or additional factors which may be relevant, including those that are specific to the company, to the nominee(s) and/or to the nature of the election (such as whether there are more candidates than board seats).
Other Board-Related Proposals
Independent Board Chair
General Recommendation: Generally vote for shareholder proposals requiring that the board chair position be filled by an independent director, taking into consideration the following:
The scope and rationale of the proposal;
The company's current board leadership structure;
The company's governance structure and practices;
Company performance; and
Any other relevant factors that may be applicable.
The following factors will increase the likelihood of a “for” recommendation:
A majority non-independent board and/or the presence of non-independent directors on key board committees;
A weak or poorly-defined lead independent director role that fails to serve as an appropriate counterbalance to a combined CEO/chair role;
The presence of an executive or non-independent chair in addition to the CEO, a recent recombination of the role of CEO and chair, and/or departure from a structure with an independent chair;
Evidence that the board has failed to oversee and address material risks facing the company;
A material governance failure, particularly if the board has failed to adequately respond to shareholder concerns or if the board has materially diminished shareholder rights; or
B-33

Evidence that the board has failed to intervene when management’s interests are contrary to shareholders' interests.
SHAREHOLDER RIGHTS & DEFENSES
Shareholder Ability to Act by Written Consent
General Recommendation: Generally vote against management and shareholder proposals to restrict or prohibit shareholders' ability to act by written consent.
Generally vote for management and shareholder proposals that provide shareholders with the ability to act by written consent, taking into account the following factors:
Shareholders' current right to act by written consent;
The consent threshold;
The inclusion of exclusionary or prohibitive language;
Investor ownership structure; and
Shareholder support of, and management's response to, previous shareholder proposals.
Vote case-by-case on shareholder proposals if, in addition to the considerations above, the company has the following governance and antitakeover provisions:
An unfettered12 right for shareholders to call special meetings at a 10 percent threshold;
A majority vote standard in uncontested director elections;
No non-shareholder-approved pill; and
An annually elected board.
Shareholder Ability to Call Special Meetings
General Recommendation: Vote against management or shareholder proposals to restrict or prohibit shareholders’ ability to call special meetings.
Generally vote for management or shareholder proposals that provide shareholders with the ability to call special meetings taking into account the following factors:
Shareholders’ current right to call special meetings;
Minimum ownership threshold necessary to call special meetings (10 percent preferred);
The inclusion of exclusionary or prohibitive language;
Investor ownership structure; and
Shareholder support of, and management’s response to, previous shareholder proposals.
Virtual Shareholder Meetings
General Recommendation: Generally vote for management proposals allowing for the convening of shareholder meetings by electronic means, so long as they do not preclude in-person meetings. Companies are encouraged to disclose the circumstances under which virtual-only13 meetings would be held, and to allow for comparable rights and opportunities for shareholders to participate electronically as they would have during an in-person meeting.
Vote case-by-case on shareholder proposals concerning virtual-only meetings, considering:
Scope and rationale of the proposal; and
Concerns identified with the company’s prior meeting practices.
B-34

CAPITAL/RESTRUCTURING
Common Stock Authorization
General Authorization Requests
General Recommendation: Vote case-by-case on proposals to increase the number of authorized shares of
common stock that are to be used for general corporate purposes:
If share usage (outstanding plus reserved) is less than 50% of the current authorized shares, vote for an increase of up to 50% of current authorized shares.
If share usage is 50% to 100% of the current authorized, vote for an increase of up to 100% of current authorized shares.
If share usage is greater than current authorized shares, vote for an increase of up to the current share usage.
In the case of a stock split, the allowable increase is calculated (per above) based on the post-split adjusted authorization.
Generally vote against proposed increases, even if within the above ratios, if the proposal or the company’s prior or ongoing use of authorized shares is problematic, including, but not limited to:
The proposal seeks to increase the number of authorized shares of the class of common stock that has superior voting rights to other share classes;
On the same ballot is a proposal for a reverse split for which support is warranted despite the fact that it would result in an excessive increase in the share authorization;
The company has a non-shareholder approved poison pill (including an NOL pill); or
The company has previous sizeable placements (within the past 3 years) of stock with insiders at prices substantially below market value, or with problematic voting rights, without shareholder approval.
However, generally vote for proposed increases beyond the above ratios or problematic situations when there is disclosure of specific and severe risks to shareholders of not approving the request, such as:
In, or subsequent to, the company's most recent 10-K filing, the company discloses that there is substantial doubt about its ability to continue as a going concern;
The company states that there is a risk of imminent bankruptcy or imminent liquidation if shareholders do not approve the increase in authorized capital; or
A government body has in the past year required the company to increase its capital ratios.
For companies incorporated in states that allow increases in authorized capital without shareholder approval, generally vote withhold or against all nominees if a unilateral capital authorization increase does not conform to the above policies.
Specific Authorization Requests
General Recommendation: Generally vote for proposals to increase the number of authorized common shares where the primary purpose of the increase is to issue shares in connection with transaction(s) (such as acquisitions, SPAC transactions, private placements, or similar transactions) on the same ballot, or disclosed in the proxy statement, that warrant support. For such transactions, the allowable increase will be the greater of:
twice the amount needed to support the transactions on the ballot, and
the allowable increase as calculated for general issuances above.
Share Issuance Mandates at U.S. Domestic Issuers Incorporated Outside the U.S.
General Recommendation: For U.S. domestic issuers incorporated outside the U.S. and listed solely on a U.S. exchange, generally vote for resolutions to authorize the issuance of common shares up to 20 percent of currently issued common share capital, where not tied to a specific transaction or financing proposal.
B-35

For pre-revenue or other early-stage companies that are heavily reliant on periodic equity financing, generally vote for resolutions to authorize the issuance of common shares up to 50 percent of currently issued common share capital. The burden of proof will be on the company to establish that it has a need for the higher limit.
Renewal of such mandates should be sought at each year’s annual meeting.
Vote case-by-case on share issuances for a specific transaction or financing proposal.
Mergers and Acquisitions
General Recommendation: Vote case-by-case on mergers and acquisitions. Review and evaluate the merits and drawbacks of the proposed transaction, balancing various and sometimes countervailing factors including:
Valuation - Is the value to be received by the target shareholders (or paid by the acquirer) reasonable? While the fairness opinion may provide an initial starting point for assessing valuation reasonableness, emphasis is placed on the offer premium, market reaction, and strategic rationale.
Market reaction - How has the market responded to the proposed deal? A negative market reaction should cause closer scrutiny of a deal.
Strategic rationale - Does the deal make sense strategically? From where is the value derived? Cost and revenue synergies should not be overly aggressive or optimistic, but reasonably achievable. Management should also have a favorable track record of successful integration of historical acquisitions.
Negotiations and process - Were the terms of the transaction negotiated at arm's-length? Was the process fair and equitable? A fair process helps to ensure the best price for shareholders. Significant negotiation “wins” can also signify the deal makers' competency. The comprehensiveness of the sales process (e.g., full auction, partial auction, no auction) can also affect shareholder value.
Conflicts of interest - Are insiders benefiting from the transaction disproportionately and inappropriately as compared to non-insider shareholders? As the result of potential conflicts, the directors and officers of the company may be more likely to vote to approve a merger than if they did not hold these interests. Consider whether these interests may have influenced these directors and officers to support or recommend the merger. The CIC figure presented in the “ISS Transaction Summary” section of this report is an aggregate figure that can in certain cases be a misleading indicator of the true value transfer from shareholders to insiders. Where such figure appears to be excessive, analyze the underlying assumptions to determine whether a potential conflict exists.
Governance - Will the combined company have a better or worse governance profile than the current governance profiles of the respective parties to the transaction? If the governance profile is to change for the worse, the burden is on the company to prove that other issues (such as valuation) outweigh any deterioration in governance.
COMPENSATION
Executive Pay Evaluation
Underlying all evaluations are five global principles that most investors expect corporations to adhere to in designing and administering executive and director compensation programs:
Maintain appropriate pay-for-performance alignment, with emphasis on long-term shareholder value: This principle encompasses overall executive pay practices, which must be designed to attract, retain, and appropriately motivate the key employees who drive shareholder value creation over the long term. It will take into consideration, among other factors, the link between pay and performance; the mix between fixed and variable pay; performance goals; and equity-based plan costs;
Avoid arrangements that risk “pay for failure”: This principle addresses the appropriateness of long or indefinite contracts, excessive severance packages, and guaranteed compensation;
Maintain an independent and effective compensation committee: This principle promotes oversight of executive pay programs by directors with appropriate skills, knowledge, experience, and a sound process for compensation decision-making (e.g., including access to independent expertise and advice when needed);
Provide shareholders with clear, comprehensive compensation disclosures: This principle underscores the importance of informative and timely disclosures that enable shareholders to evaluate executive pay practices fully and fairly;
B-36

Avoid inappropriate pay to non-executive directors: This principle recognizes the interests of shareholders in ensuring that compensation to outside directors is reasonable and does not compromise their independence and ability to make appropriate judgments in overseeing managers’ pay and performance. At the market level, it may incorporate a variety of generally accepted best practices.
Advisory Votes on Executive Compensation—Management Proposals (Say-on-Pay)
General Recommendation: Vote case-by-case on ballot items related to executive pay and practices, as well as certain aspects of outside director compensation.
Vote against Advisory Votes on Executive Compensation (Say-on-Pay or “SOP”) if:
There is an unmitigated misalignment between CEO pay and company performance (pay for performance);
The company maintains significant problematic pay practices;
The board exhibits a significant level of poor communication and responsiveness to shareholders.
Vote against or withhold from the members of the Compensation Committee and potentially the full board if:
There is no SOP on the ballot, and an against vote on an SOP would otherwise be warranted due to pay-for- performance misalignment, problematic pay practices, or the lack of adequate responsiveness on compensation issues raised previously, or a combination thereof;
The board fails to respond adequately to a previous SOP proposal that received less than 70 percent support of votes cast;
The company has recently practiced or approved problematic pay practices, such as option repricing or option backdating; or
The situation is egregious.
Primary Evaluation Factors for Executive Pay
Pay-for-Performance Evaluation
ISS annually conducts a pay-for-performance analysis to identify strong or satisfactory alignment between pay and performance over a sustained period. With respect to companies in the S&P1500, Russell 3000, or Russell 3000E Indices14, this analysis considers the following:
1. Peer Group15 Alignment:
The degree of alignment between the company's annualized TSR rank and the CEO's annualized total pay rank within a peer group, each measured over a three-year period.
The rankings of CEO total pay and company financial performance within a peer group, each measured over a three-year period.
The multiple of the CEO's total pay relative to the peer group median in the most recent fiscal year.
2. Absolute Alignment16 – the absolute alignment between the trend in CEO pay and company TSR over the prior five fiscal years i.e., the difference between the trend in annual pay changes and the trend in annualized TSR during the period.
If the above analysis demonstrates significant unsatisfactory long-term pay-for-performance alignment or, in the case of companies outside the Russell indices, a misalignment between pay and performance is otherwise suggested, our analysis may include any of the following qualitative factors, as relevant to an evaluation of how various pay elements may work to encourage or to undermine long-term value creation and alignment with shareholder interests:
The ratio of performance- to time-based incentive awards;
The overall ratio of performance-based compensation to fixed or discretionary pay;
The rigor of performance goals;
The complexity and risks around pay program design;
The transparency and clarity of disclosure;
The company's peer group benchmarking practices;
Financial/operational results, both absolute and relative to peers;
B-37

Special circumstances related to, for example, a new CEO in the prior FY or anomalous equity grant practices (e.g., bi-annual awards);
Realizable pay17 compared to grant pay; and
Any other factors deemed relevant.
Problematic Pay Practices
Problematic pay elements are generally evaluated case-by-case considering the context of a company's overall pay program and demonstrated pay-for-performance philosophy. The focus is on executive compensation practices that contravene the global pay principles, including:
Problematic practices related to non-performance-based compensation elements;
Incentives that may motivate excessive risk-taking or present a windfall risk; and
Pay decisions that circumvent pay-for-performance, such as options backdating or waiving performance requirements.
The list of examples below highlights certain problematic practices that carry significant weight in this overall consideration and may result in adverse vote recommendations:
Repricing or replacing of underwater stock options/SARs without prior shareholder approval (including cash buyouts and voluntary surrender of underwater options);
Extraordinary perquisites or tax gross-ups;
New or materially amended agreements that provide for:
Excessive termination or CIC severance payments (generally exceeding 3 times base salary and average/target/most recent bonus);
CIC severance payments without involuntary job loss or substantial diminution of duties (“single” or “modified single” triggers) or in connection with a problematic Good Reason definition;
CIC excise tax gross-up entitlements (including “modified” gross-ups);
Multi-year guaranteed awards that are not at risk due to rigorous performance conditions;
Liberal CIC definition combined with any single-trigger CIC benefits;
Insufficient executive compensation disclosure by externally-managed issuers (EMIs) such that a reasonable assessment of pay programs and practices applicable to the EMI's executives is not possible;
Severance payments made when the termination is not clearly disclosed as involuntary (for example, a termination without cause or resignation for good reason);
Any other provision or practice deemed to be egregious and present a significant risk to investors.
The above examples are not an exhaustive list. Please refer to ISS' U.S. Compensation Policies FAQ document for additional detail on specific pay practices that have been identified as problematic and may lead to negative vote recommendations.
Options Backdating
The following factors should be examined case-by-case to allow for distinctions to be made between “sloppy” plan administration versus deliberate action or fraud:
Reason and motive for the options backdating issue, such as inadvertent vs. deliberate grant date changes;
Duration of options backdating;
Size of restatement due to options backdating;
Corrective actions taken by the board or compensation committee, such as canceling or re-pricing backdated options, the recouping of option gains on backdated grants; and
Adoption of a grant policy that prohibits backdating and creates a fixed grant schedule or window period for equity grants in the future.
Compensation Committee Communications and Responsiveness
Consider the following factors case-by-case when evaluating ballot items related to executive pay on the board’s responsiveness to investor input and engagement on compensation issues:
Failure to respond to majority-supported shareholder proposals on executive pay topics; or
B-38

Failure to adequately respond to the company's previous say-on-pay proposal that received the support of less than 70 percent of votes cast, taking into account:
Disclosure of engagement efforts with major institutional investors, including the frequency and timing of engagements and the company participants (including whether independent directors participated);
Disclosure of the specific concerns voiced by dissenting shareholders that led to the say-on-pay opposition;
Disclosure of specific and meaningful actions taken to address shareholders' concerns;
Other recent compensation actions taken by the company;
Whether the issues raised are recurring or isolated;
The company's ownership structure; and
Whether the support level was less than 50 percent, which would warrant the highest degree of responsiveness.
Equity-Based and Other Incentive Plans
Please refer to ISS' U.S. Equity Compensation Plans FAQ document for additional details on the Equity Plan Scorecard policy.
General Recommendation: Vote case-by-case on certain equity-based compensation plans18 depending on a combination of certain plan features and equity grant practices, where positive factors may counterbalance negative factors, and vice versa, as evaluated using an “Equity Plan Scorecard” (EPSC) approach with three pillars:
Plan Cost: The total estimated cost of the company’s equity plans relative to industry/market cap peers, measured by the company's estimated Shareholder Value Transfer (SVT) in relation to peers and considering both:
SVT based on new shares requested plus shares remaining for future grants, plus outstanding unvested/unexercised grants; and
SVT based only on new shares requested plus shares remaining for future grants.
Plan Features:
Quality of disclosure around vesting upon a change in control (CIC);
Discretionary vesting authority;
Liberal share recycling on various award types;
Lack of minimum vesting period for grants made under the plan;
Dividends payable prior to award vesting.
Grant Practices:
The company’s three-year burn rate relative to its industry/market cap peers;
Vesting requirements in CEO’s recent equity grants (3-year look-back);
The estimated duration of the plan (based on the sum of shares remaining available and the new shares requested, divided by the average annual shares granted in the prior three years);
The proportion of the CEO's most recent equity grants/awards subject to performance conditions;
Whether the company maintains a sufficient claw-back policy;
Whether the company maintains sufficient post-exercise/vesting share-holding requirements.
Generally vote against the plan proposal if the combination of above factors indicates that the plan is not, overall, in shareholders' interests, or if any of the following egregious factors (“overriding factors”) apply:
Awards may vest in connection with a liberal change-of-control definition;
The plan would permit repricing or cash buyout of underwater options without shareholder approval (either by expressly permitting it for NYSE and Nasdaq listed companies or by not prohibiting it when the company has a history of repricing for non-listed companies);
The plan is a vehicle for problematic pay practices or a significant pay-for-performance disconnect under certain circumstances;
The plan is excessively dilutive to shareholders’ holdings;
The plan contains an evergreen (automatic share replenishment) feature; or
Any other plan features are determined to have a significant negative impact on shareholder interests.
B-39

SOCIAL AND ENVIRONMENTAL ISSUES
Global Approach E&S Shareholder Proposals
ISS applies a common approach globally to evaluating social and environmental proposals which cover a wide range of topics, including consumer and product safety, environment and energy, labor standards and human rights, workplace and board diversity, and corporate political issues. While a variety of factors goes into each analysis, the overall principle guiding all vote recommendations focuses on how the proposal may enhance or protect shareholder value in either the short or long term.
General Recommendation: Generally vote case-by-case, examining primarily whether implementation of the proposal is likely to enhance or protect shareholder value. The following factors will be considered:
If the issues presented in the proposal are being appropriately or effectively dealt with through legislation or government regulation;
If the company has already responded in an appropriate and sufficient manner to the issue(s) raised in the proposal;
Whether the proposal's request is unduly burdensome (scope or timeframe) or overly prescriptive;
The company's approach compared with any industry standard practices for addressing the issue(s) raised by the proposal;
Whether there are significant controversies, fines, penalties, or litigation associated with the company's practices related to the issue(s) raised in the proposal;
If the proposal requests increased disclosure or greater transparency, whether reasonable and sufficient information is currently available to shareholders from the company or from other publicly available sources; and
If the proposal requests increased disclosure or greater transparency, whether implementation would reveal proprietary or confidential information that could place the company at a competitive disadvantage.
Climate Change
Say on Climate (SoC) Management Proposals
General Recommendation: Vote case-by-case on management proposals that request shareholders to approve the company’s climate transition action plan19, taking into account the completeness and rigor of the plan. Information that will be considered where available includes the following:
The extent to which the company’s climate related disclosures are in line with TCFD recommendations and meet other market standards;
Disclosure of its operational and supply chain GHG emissions (Scopes 1, 2, and 3);
The completeness and rigor of company’s short-, medium-, and long-term targets for reducing operational and supply chain GHG emissions (Scopes 1, 2, and 3 if relevant);
Whether the company has sought and received third-party approval that its targets are science-based;
Whether the company has made a commitment to be “net zero” for operational and supply chain emissions (Scopes 1, 2, and 3) by 2050;
Whether the company discloses a commitment to report on the implementation of its plan in subsequent years;
Whether the company’s climate data has received third-party assurance;
Disclosure of how the company’s lobbying activities and its capital expenditures align with company strategy;
Whether there are specific industry decarbonization challenges; and
The company’s related commitment, disclosure, and performance compared to its industry peers.
Say on Climate (SoC) Shareholder Proposals
General Recommendation: Vote case-by-case on shareholder proposals that request the company to disclose a report providing its GHG emissions levels and reduction targets and/or its upcoming/approved climate transition action plan and provide shareholders the opportunity to express approval or disapproval of its GHG emissions reduction plan, taking into account information such as the following:
The completeness and rigor of the company’s climate-related disclosure;
The company’s actual GHG emissions performance;
B-40

Whether the company has been the subject of recent, significant violations, fines, litigation, or controversy related to its GHG emissions; and
Whether the proposal’s request is unduly burdensome (scope or timeframe) or overly prescriptive.
Climate Change/Greenhouse Gas (GHG) Emissions
General Recommendation: Generally vote for resolutions requesting that a company disclose information on the financial, physical, or regulatory risks it faces related to climate change on its operations and investments or on how the company identifies, measures, and manages such risks, considering:
Whether the company already provides current, publicly-available information on the impact that climate change may have on the company as well as associated company policies and procedures to address related risks and/or opportunities;
The company's level of disclosure compared to industry peers; and
Whether there are significant controversies, fines, penalties, or litigation associated with the company's climate change-related performance.
Generally vote for proposals requesting a report on greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions from company operations and/or products and operations, unless:
The company already discloses current, publicly-available information on the impacts that GHG emissions may have on the company as well as associated company policies and procedures to address related risks and/or opportunities;
The company's level of disclosure is comparable to that of industry peers; and
There are no significant controversies, fines, penalties, or litigation associated with the company's GHG emissions.
Vote case-by-case on proposals that call for the adoption of GHG reduction goals from products and operations, taking into account:
Whether the company provides disclosure of year-over-year GHG emissions performance data;
Whether company disclosure lags behind industry peers;
The company's actual GHG emissions performance;
The company's current GHG emission policies, oversight mechanisms, and related initiatives; and
Whether the company has been the subject of recent, significant violations, fines, litigation, or controversy related to GHG emissions.
Racial Equity and/or Civil Rights Audit Guidelines
General Recommendation: Vote case-by-case on proposals asking a company to conduct an independent racial equity and/or civil rights audit, taking into account:
The company’s established process or framework for addressing racial inequity and discrimination internally;
Whether the company adequately discloses workforce diversity and inclusion metrics and goals;
Whether the company has issued a public statement related to its racial justice efforts in recent years, or has committed to internal policy review;
Whether the company has engaged with impacted communities, stakeholders, and civil rights experts;
The company’s track record in recent years of racial justice measures and outreach externally; and
Whether the company has been the subject of recent controversy, litigation, or regulatory actions related to racial inequity or discrimination.
ESG Compensation-Related Proposals
General Recommendation: Vote case-by-case on proposals seeking a report or additional disclosure on the company’s approach, policies, and practices on incorporating environmental and social criteria into its executive compensation strategy, considering:
The scope and prescriptive nature of the proposal;
The company's current level of disclosure regarding its environmental and social performance and governance;
B-41

The degree to which the board or compensation committee already discloses information on whether it has considered related E&S criteria; and
Whether the company has significant controversies or regulatory violations regarding social or environmental issues.
FOOTNOTES
1
A “new nominee” is a director who is being presented for election by shareholders for the first time. Recommendations on new nominees who have served for less than one year are made on a case-by-case basis depending on the timing of their appointment and the problematic governance issue in question.
2
In general, companies with a plurality vote standard use “Withhold” as the contrary vote option in director elections; companies with a majority vote standard use “Against”. However, it will vary by company and the proxy must be checked to determine the valid contrary vote option for the particular company.
3
Nominees who served for only part of the fiscal year are generally exempted from the attendance policy.
4
Although all of a CEO’s subsidiary boards with publicly-traded common stock will be counted as separate boards, ISS will not recommend a withhold vote for the CEO of a parent company board or any of the controlled (˃50 percent ownership) subsidiaries of that parent, but may do so at subsidiaries that are less than 50 percent controlled and boards outside the parent/subsidiary relationships.
5
Aggregate diversity statistics provided by the board will only be considered if specific to racial and/or ethnic diversity.
6
If a short-term pill with a deadhand or slowhand feature is enacted but expires before the next shareholder vote, ISS will generally still recommend withhold/against nominees at the next shareholder meeting following its adoption.
7
Approval prior to, or in connection, with a company’s becoming publicly-traded, or in connection with a de-SPAC transaction, is insufficient.
8
This generally includes classes of common stock that have additional votes per share than other shares; classes of shares that are not entitled to vote on all the same ballot items or nominees; or stock with time-phased voting rights (“loyalty shares”).
9
Includes companies that emerge from bankruptcy, SPAC transactions, spin-offs, direct listings, and those who complete a traditional initial public offering.
10
Companies defined as “significant GHG emitters” will be those on the current Climate Action 100+ Focus Group list.
11
Examples of failure of risk oversight include but are not limited to: bribery; large or serial fines or sanctions from regulatory bodies; demonstrably poor risk oversight of environmental and social issues, including climate change; significant adverse legal judgments or settlement; or hedging of company stock.
12
“Unfettered” means no restrictions on agenda items, no restrictions on the number of shareholders who can group together to reach the 10 percent threshold, and only reasonable limits on when a meeting can be called: no greater than 30 days after the last annual meeting and no greater than 90 prior to the next annual meeting.
13
“Virtual-only shareholder meeting” refers to a meeting of shareholders that is held exclusively using technology without a corresponding in-person meeting.
14
The Russell 3000E Index includes approximately 4,000 of the largest U.S. equity securities.
15
The revised peer group is generally comprised of 14-24 companies that are selected using market cap, revenue (or assets for certain financial firms), GICS industry group, and company's selected peers' GICS industry group, with size constraints, via a process designed to select peers that are comparable to the subject company in terms of revenue/assets and industry, and also within a market-cap bucket that is reflective of the company's market cap. For Oil, Gas & Consumable Fuels companies, market cap is the only size determinant.
16
Only Russell 3000 Index companies are subject to the Absolute Alignment analysis.
17
ISS research reports include realizable pay for S&P1500 companies.
18
Proposals evaluated under the EPSC policy generally include those to approve or amend (1) stock option plans for employees and/or employees and directors, (2) restricted stock plans for employees and/or employees and directors, and (3) omnibus stock incentive plans for employees and/or employees and directors; amended plans will be further evaluated case-by-case.
19
Variations of this request also include climate transition related ambitions, or commitment to reporting on the implementation of a climate plan.
NEWTON INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT NORTH AMERICA, LLC (“Newton”)
Newton has established overarching voting guidelines which inform our ultimate voting decision, based on guidance established by internationally recognized governance principles including the OECD Corporate Governance Principles, the ICGN Global Governance Principles, the UK Investment Association’s Principles of Remuneration and the UK Corporate Governance Code, in addition to other local governance codes. 
All voting decisions are based on Newton’s voting guidelines. We have used the services of an independent voting service provider to translate these guidelines into explicit voting actions forming a bespoke voting policy for Newton. This policy will be applied to all our votable holdings, enabling a universal approach to our voting while allowing us to deploy in-depth case-by-case analysis from the stewardship team for those issuers and/or proposals which merit greater focus due to the materiality of our investment or the importance of the issue at hand (e.g., shareholder resolution, corporate action, related-party transactions). In these instances, communication with or input from the wider investment team may be sought, as well as, if relevant, engagement with the company. The stewardship team retains the ultimate discretion to deviate the vote instruction from Newton’s bespoke policy’s recommendation.
Our active approach to voting means that our voting decisions reflect our investment rationale and take into consideration engagement activity and the company’s approach to relevant codes, market practices and regulations. These are applied to the
B-42

company’s unique situation, while also taking into account any explanations offered for why the company has adopted a certain position or policy.
Newton seeks to make proxy voting decisions that are in the best long-term financial interests of its clients and which seek to support investor value creation by supporting proposals that are consistent with our corporate governance views and investment case.
We publish two major reports each year:  (i) our annual stewardship report which provides narrative around our approach to stewardship, how we have evolved, and case studies on engagements related to our priority themes and our voting related to significant holdings or trends; and (ii) a post-season voting report outlining our views and approach on key trends observed, an overview of how we voted on shareholder proposals, and case studies on significant holdings and high profile names.  
We also publish our quarterly vote record which includes voting rationale for decisions not aligned with the recommendations of the underlying company’s management and for decisions on all shareholder proposed resolutions.  Additionally, we publish a quarterly list of all issuers with whom we discussed ESG matters.
Throughout the year we publish blogs featuring case studies of engagements and voting action to continue to provide a regular flow of information.
Published to our website is Newton’s Voting Guidelines, which describes our approach to the exercise of voting rights.
Newton utilizes an independent voting service provider for the purposes of managing upcoming meetings via its electronic platform, providing research and for implementing Newton’s bespoke voting policy and issuing recommendations based on this policy. 
UBS ASSET MANAGEMENT (AMERICAS), INC. (“UBS AM”)
Corporate Governance Policy & Proxy Voting
Acting in clients’ best interests through active ownership
Voting rights hold economic value and should be treated accordingly. Where clients of UBS Asset Management have delegated to us the discretion to exercise the voting rights for shares they beneficially own, we have a fiduciary duty to vote such shares in the clients’ best interest and in a manner which achieves the best economic outcome for their investments. This includes where such investment maybe via UBS investment funds managed by UBS-AM.
Voting enables us to voice our opinion to a company on a broad range of topics and is a way of encouraging boards to listen to and address investor concerns. We consider voting to be an important part of our oversight role and integral to both the investment process and our overall stewardship approach.
Wherever possible we seek to vote all shares held consistently across our range of investments, in order to maximize the outcome of the vote.
As long-term shareholders we will generally seek to support current management initiatives. Where we have concerns with a company arising from our stewardship and engagement activities, or in relation to a particular resolution that we believe is not in the interests of our clients, we may choose not to support a particular proposal. This includes resolutions put forward by both company management and outside parties.
In some circumstances we may determine that the voting of a particular proxy would not deliver sufficient benefit to clients, in which case we may abstain or choose not to vote. This can include when there is documentation we are unable to provide, a requirement for a representative to physically attend a meeting in order to vote, or if the process of voting restricts our ability to manage a portfolio during the voting period.
Key Voting Principles
B-43

Underlying UBS- AM’s voting principles are two fundamental objectives:
To maximize the value of our clients’ investments and
As an investment advisor, we have a strong commercial interest that companies in which we invest on behalf of our clients are successful.
Our core principles are:
Board of Directors
Ideally the Board Chair and CEO roles should be separate and held by two separate individuals.
A majority of the board should be regarded as independent, according to UBS-AM criteria.
The Board should be comprised of high calibre individuals capable of providing good judgment and diligent oversight with appropriate and diverse backgrounds.
Shareholders’ Rights
Voting rights should ideally be granted in line with the “one share-one vote” principle.
Information on the matters to be discussed and voted upon should be disclosed to shareholders clearly and in sufficient time before the shareholder meeting.
Proposals to enhance shareholder rights will normally be supported.
Capital Considerations
The board should allocate capital appropriately and determine a reasonable dividend policy.
Any new share issuance should require shareholder approval and UBS-AM will only support reasonable share issuance authorities
Mergers and Acquisitions will be supported if they are deemed to increase shareholder value in the longer term.
Audit and Risk Oversight
The board should appoint a dedicated Audit/Risk Committee, as well as an independent external auditor.
Companies are required to have a robust internal audit system with clear processes to identify and manage potential risks.
Remuneration Considerations
Compensation should be aligned with the performance and the strategy of the company.
We expect a company to provide a clear explanation of how the structure is in shareholders’ economic interests.
Transparent reporting is expected around senior management and board compensation.
Sustainability and ESG Matters
Boards must implement a robust approach that manages environmental risks impacting the company.
Proposals that seek to promote corporate citizenship and environmental stewardship will be closely reviewed and will be supported if in shareholder interests.
Boards should implement policies and strategies which seek to promote diversity and fairness across the workforce.
B-44

Use of Proxy Voting Advisory Services
In order for us to meet our stewardship responsibilities it is essential that we have access to accurate information regarding the corporate governance structure, ESG practices and shareholder meetings of operating companies in which we invest on behalf of our clients and funds.
Taking into account the number of operating companies invested across our range of capabilities, we use the services of a specialist provider for a number of services, to supplement our own assessments.
We have selected Institutional Shareholder Services (ISS) to provide proxy advisory services. ISS are a leading proxy advisory firm, with the appropriate competency, capacity and systems to provide this service on a global basis.
The proxy voting related research and recommendations provided to us by ISS are based upon the proxy guidelines contained in this policy document. We do not delegate our voting responsibilities to ISS and retain full discretion when determining how to vote shares held for our clients and funds.
We regularly monitor the services provided to us by ISS and other external vendors, including performing an annual due diligence on the compliance policies, controls, procedures and quality of service provided. We further require information regarding how the vendor manages any conflicts of interest that may arise through certain affiliations or business practices.
WCM INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT, LLC (“WCM”)
Proxy Voting Procedures
WCM accepts responsibility for voting proxies whenever requested by a Client or as required by law. Each Client’s investment management agreement should specify whether WCM is to vote proxies relating to securities held for the Client’s account. If the agreement is silent as to the proxy voting and no instructions from the client are on file, WCM will assume responsibility of proxy voting.
In cases in which WCM has proxy voting authority for securities held by its advisory clients, WCM will ensure securities are voted for the exclusive benefit, and in the best economic interest, of those clients and their beneficiaries, subject to any restrictions or directions from a client. Such voting responsibilities will be exercised in a manner that is consistent with the general antifraud provisions of the Advisers Act, the Proxy Voting Rule, Rule 206(4)-6, and for ERISA accounts, the DOL’s Proxy Voting Rule, as well as with WCM’s fiduciary duties under federal and state law to act in the best interests of its clients. Even when WCM has proxy voting authority, a Client may request that WCM vote in a certain manner. Any such instructions shall be provided to WCM, in writing or electronic communication, saved in the Client files and communicated to the Portfolio Associate and Proxy Admin.
Special Rules for ERISA
Unless proxy voting responsibility has been expressly reserved by the plan, trust document, or investment management agreement, and is being exercised by another “named fiduciary” for an ERISA Plan Client, WCM, as the investment manager for the account, has the exclusive authority to vote proxies or exercise other shareholder relating to securities held for the Plan’s account. The interests or desires of plan sponsors should not be considered. In addition, if a “named fiduciary” for the plan has provided WCM with written proxy voting guidelines, those guidelines must be followed, unless the guidelines, or the results of following the guidelines, would be contrary to the economic interests of the plan's participants or beneficiaries, imprudent or otherwise contrary to ERISA.
Investors in WCM Private Funds which are deemed to hold “plan assets” under ERISA accept WCM’s investment policy statement and a proxy voting policy before they are allowed to invest.
Role of the Independent Proxy Adviser
WCM utilizes the proxy voting recommendations of Glass Lewis (our “Proxy Adviser”). The purpose of the Proxy Advisers proxy research and advice is to facilitate shareholder voting in favor of governance structures that will drive performance, create shareholder value and maintain a proper tone at the top. Because the Proxy Adviser is not in the business of providing
B-45

consulting services to public companies, it can focus solely on the best interests of investors. The Proxy Adviser’s approach to corporate governance is to look at each company individually and determine what is in the best interests of the shareholders of each particular company. Research on proxies covers more than just corporate governance the Proxy Adviser analyzes accounting, executive compensation, compliance with regulation and law, risks and risk disclosure, litigation and other matters that reflect on the quality of board oversight and company transparency.
The voting recommendations of the Proxy Adviser are strongly considered; however, the final determination for voting in the best economic interest of the clients is the responsibility of the relevant strategy Investment Strategy Group (“ISG”). When a decision is reached to vote contrary to the recommendation of the Proxy Adviser, the ISG will address any potential conflicts of interest (as described in this policy) and proceed accordingly. They will maintain documentation to support the decision, which will be reviewed by the Compliance Team.
WCM will take reasonable steps under the circumstances to make sure that all proxies are received and for those that WCM has determined should be voted, are voted in a timely manner.
Role of the Portfolio Associate
The Portfolio Associate is responsible for the onboarding and maintenance of Client accounts. For each Client, the Portfolio Associate:
Determines whether WCM is vested with proxy voting responsibility or whether voting is reserved to the Client or delegated to another designee;
Instructs registered owners of record (e.g. the Client, Trustee or Custodian) that receive proxy materials from the issuer or its information agent to send proxies electronically directly to Broadridge/ProxyEdge, a third party service provider, to: (1) provide notification of impending votes; (2) vote proxies based on the Proxy Adviser and/or WCM recommendations; and (3) maintain records of such votes electronically.
Assigns the appropriate proxy voting guidelines based on a Client’s Investment Policy Guidelines;
Reports proxy voting record to Client, as requested.
Role of the Proxy Admin.
The Proxy Admin circulates proxy ballot information and administers the proxy vote execution process. The Proxy Admin:
Monitors the integrity of the data feed between the Client’s registered owner of record and Broadridge/ProxyEdge;
Executes votes based on the recommendation of the Proxy Adviser or ISG;
Ensures all votes are cast in a timely manner.
Role of the ISG and Analysts
With the support of the Analysts, and in consideration of the voting recommendation of the Proxy Adviser, the Investment Strategy Group (ISG) is responsible for review of the Proxy Adviser policy and final vote determination. The ISG:
Annually, reviews the policy of the Proxy Adviser to ensure voting recommendations are based on a Client’s best interest;
Reviews the ballot voting recommendations of the Proxy Adviser;
Investigates ballot voting issues during the normal course of research, company visits, or discussions with company representatives.
If the ISG:
Agrees with the voting recommendation of the Proxy Adviser, no further action is required;
Disagrees with the voting recommendation of the Proxy Adviser, they will:
Deal with conflicts of interest, as described below;
Provide updated voting instructions to the Proxy Admin;
Document the rationale for the decision, which is provided to Compliance.
B-46

Certain Proxy Votes May Not Be Cast
In some cases, WCM may determine that it is in the best interests of our clients to abstain from voting certain proxies. WCM will abstain from voting in the event any of the following conditions are met with regard to a proxy proposal:
Neither the Proxy Adviser’s recommendation nor specific client instructions cover an issue;
In circumstances where, in WCM’s judgment, the costs of voting the proxy exceed the expected benefits to the Client.
In addition, WCM will only seek to vote proxies for securities on loan when such a vote is deemed to have a material impact on the account. In such cases, materiality is determined and documented by the ISG.
Further, in accordance with local law or business practices, many foreign companies prevent the sales of shares that have been voted for a certain period beginning prior to the shareholder meeting and ending on the day following the meeting (“share blocking”). Depending on the country in which a company is domiciled, the blocking period may begin a stated number of days prior to the meeting (e.g., one, three or five days) or on a date established by the company. While practices vary, in many countries the block period can be continued for a longer period if the shareholder meeting is adjourned and postponed to a later date. Similarly, practices vary widely as to the ability of a shareholder to have the “block” restriction lifted early (e.g., in some countries shares generally can be “unblocked” up to two days prior to the meeting whereas in other countries the removal of the block appears to be discretionary with the issuer’s transfer agent). WCM believes that the disadvantage of being unable to sell the stock regardless of changing conditions generally outweighs the advantages of voting at the shareholder meeting for routine items. Accordingly, WCM generally will not vote those proxies subject to “share blocking.”
Identifying and Dealing with Material Conflicts of Interest between WCM and Proxy Issuer
WCM believes the use of the Proxy Adviser’s independent guidelines helps to mitigate proxy voting related conflicts between the firm and its clients. Notwithstanding WCM may choose to vote a proxy against the recommendation of the Proxy Adviser, if WCM believes such vote is in the best economic interest of its clients. Such a decision will be made and documented by the ISG. Because WCM retains this authority, it creates a potential conflict of interest between WCM and the proxy issuer. As a result, WCM may not overrule the Proxy Adviser’s recommendation with respect to a proxy unless the following steps are taken by the CCO:
The CCO must determine whether WCM has a conflict of interest with respect to the issuer that is the subject of the proxy. The CCO will use the following standards to identify issuers with which WCM may have a conflict of interest.
Significant Business Relationships – The CCO will determine whether WCM may have a significant business relationship with the issuer, such as, for example, where WCM manages a pension plan. For this purpose, a “significant business relationship” is one that: (i) represents 1% or $1,000,000 of WCM’s revenues for the fiscal year, whichever is less, or is reasonably expected to represent this amount for the current fiscal year; or (ii) may not directly involve revenue to WCM but is otherwise determined by the CCO to be significant to WCM.
Significant Personal/Family Relationships – the CCO will determine whether any Supervised Persons who are involved in the proxy voting process may have a significant personal/family relationship with the issuer. For this purpose, a “significant personal/family relationship” is one that would be reasonably likely to influence how WCM votes proxies. To identify any such relationships, the CCO shall obtain information about any significant personal/family relationship between any Supervised Person of WCM who is involved in the proxy voting process (e.g., ISG members) and senior Supervised Persons of issuers for which WCM may vote proxies.
If the CCO determines that WCM has a conflict of interest with respect to the issuer, the CCO shall determine whether the conflict is “material” to any specific proposal included within the proxy. The CCO shall determine whether a proposal is material as follows:
Routine Proxy Proposals – Proxy proposals that are “routine” shall be presumed not to involve a material conflict of interest for WCM, unless the ISG has actual knowledge that a routine proposal should be treated as material. For this purpose, “routine” proposals would typically include matters such as the selection of an accountant, uncontested election of directors, meeting formalities, and approval of an annual report/financial statements.
B-47

Non-Routine Proxy Proposals – Proxy proposals that are “non-routine” shall be presumed to involve a material conflict of interest for WCM, unless the CCO determines that WCM’s conflict is unrelated to the proposal in question (see 3. below). For this purpose, “non-routine” proposals would typically include any contested matter, including a contested election of directors, a merger or sale of substantial assets, a change in the articles of incorporation that materially affects the rights of shareholders, and compensation matters for management (e.g., stock option plans, retirement plans, profit sharing or other special remuneration plans).
Determining that a Non-Routine Proposal is Not Material – As discussed above, although non-routine proposals are presumed to involve a material conflict of interest, the CCO may determine on a case-by-case basis that particular non-routine proposals do not involve a material conflict of interest. To make this determination, the CCO must conclude that a proposal is not directly related to WCM’s conflict with the issuer or that it otherwise would not be considered important by a reasonable investor. The CCO shall record in writing the basis for any such determination.
For any proposal where the CCO determines that WCM has a material conflict of interest, WCM may vote a proxy regarding that proposal in any of the following manners:
Obtain Client Consent or Direction – If the CCO approves the proposal to overrule the recommendation of the Proxy Adviser, WCM shall fully disclose to each client holding the security at issue the nature of the conflict, and obtain the client’s consent to how WCM will vote on the proposal (or otherwise obtain instructions from the client as to how the proxy on the proposal should be voted).
Use the Proxy Adviser’s Recommendation – Vote in accordance with the Proxy Adviser’s recommendation.
For any proposal where the CCO determines that WCM does not have a material conflict of interest, the ISG may overrule the Proxy Adviser’s recommendation if the ISG reasonably determines that doing so is in the best interests of WCM’s clients. If the ISG decides to overrule the Proxy Adviser’s recommendation, the ISG will maintain documentation to support their decision.
Dealing with Material Conflicts of Interest between a Client and the Proxy Adviser or Proxy Issuer
If WCM is notified by a client regarding a conflict of interest between them and the Proxy Adviser or the proxy issuer, The CCO will evaluate the circumstances and either
elevate the decision to the ISG who will make a determination as to what would be in the Client’s best interest;
if practical, seek a waiver from the Client of the conflict; or
if agreed upon in writing with the Clients, forward the proxies to affected Clients allowing them to vote their own proxies.
Maintenance of Proxy Voting Records
As required by Rule 204-2 under the Advisers Act, and for ERISA accounts, the DOL’s Proxy Voting Rule, WCM will maintain or procure the maintenance of the following records relating to proxy voting for a period of at least five years:
a copy of these Proxy Policies, as they may be amended from time to time;
copies of proxy statements received regarding Client securities;
a record of each proxy vote cast on behalf of its Clients;
a copy of any internal documents created by WCM that were material to making the decision how to vote proxies on behalf of its Clients; and
each written Client request for information on how WCM voted proxies on behalf of the Client and each written response by WCM to oral or written Client requests for this information.
As permitted by Rule 204-2(c), electronic proxy statements and the record of each vote cast on behalf of each Client account will be maintained by ProxyEdge. WCM shall obtain and maintain an undertaking from ProxyEdge to provide it with copies of proxy voting records and other documents relating to its Clients’ votes promptly upon request. WCM and ProxyEdge may rely on the SEC’s EDGAR system to keep records of certain proxy statements if the proxy statements are maintained by issuers on that system (e.g., large U.S.-based issuers).
B-48

Disclosure
WCM will provide all Clients a summary of these Proxy Policies, either directly or by delivery to the Client of a copy of its Form ADV, Part 2A containing such a summary, and information on how to obtain a copy of the full text of these Proxy Policies and a record of how WCM has voted the Client’s proxies. Upon receipt of a Client’s request for more information, WCM will provide to the Client a copy of these Proxy Policies and/or in accordance with the Client’s stated requirements, how the Client’s proxies were voted during the period requested. Such periodic reports will not be made available to third parties absent the express written request of the Client. However, to the extent that WCM serves as a sub-adviser to another adviser to a Client, WCM will be deemed to be authorized to provide proxy voting records on such Client accounts to such other adviser.
Oversight of the Proxy Adviser
Prior to adopting the proxy guidelines and recommendations of a Proxy adviser, WCM will exercise prudence and diligence to determine that the guidelines for proxy recommendations are consistent with WCM’s fiduciary obligations. Each year, Compliance, in conjunction with input from the Proxy Admin, the ISG and others as determined by the CCO, will review WCM’s relationship with, and services provided by the Proxy Adviser. To facilitate this review, WCM will request information from the Proxy Adviser in consideration of the Proxy Adviser processes, policies and procedures to:
Analyze and formulate voting recommendations on the matters for which WCM is responsible for voting and to disclose its information sources and methods used to develop such voting recommendations;
Ensure that it has complete and accurate information about issuers when making recommendations and to provide its clients and issuers timely opportunities to provide input on certain matters;
Resolve any identified material deficiencies in the completeness or accuracy of information about issuers for whom voting recommendations are made; and
Identify, resolve, and disclose actual and potential conflicts of interest associated with its recommendations;
Additionally, WCM will review the Proxy Adviser’s proposed changes to its proxy voting guidelines to ensure alignment with the ISG’s expectations. The Proxy Adviser typically distributes proposed changes to its guidelines annually; therefore, WCM’s review of these proposed changes will typically coincide with the Proxy Adviser’ schedule.
WELLINGTON MANAGEMENT COMPANY LLP (“WELLINGTON MANAGEMENT”)
Introduction
Wellington Management has adopted and implemented policies and procedures it believes are reasonably designed to ensure that proxies are voted in the best interests of clients for which it exercises proxy-voting discretion.
The purpose of this document is to outline Wellington Management’s approach to executing proxy voting. Wellington Management’s Proxy Voting Guidelines (the “Guidelines”), which are contained in a separate document, set forth broad guidelines and positions on common issues that Wellington Management uses for voting proxies. The Guidelines set out our general expectations on how we vote rather than rigid rules that we apply without consideration of the particular facts and circumstances.
Statement of Policy
Wellington Management:
Votes client proxies for clients that have affirmatively delegated proxy voting authority, in writing, unless we have arranged in advance with a particular client to limit the circumstances in which the client would exercise voting authority, or we determine that it is in the best interest of one or more clients to refrain from voting a given proxy.
Seeks to vote proxies in the best financial interests of the clients for which we are voting.
Identifies and resolves all material proxy-related conflicts of interest between the firm and our clients in the best interests of the client.
B-49

Responsibility and Oversight
The Proxy Voting Team monitors regulatory requirements with respect to proxy voting and works with the firm’s Legal and Compliance Group and the Investment Stewardship Committee to develop practices that implement those requirements. The Proxy Voting Team also acts as a resource for portfolio managers and investment research analysts on proxy matters as needed. Day-to-day administration of the proxy voting process is the responsibility of the Proxy Voting Team. The Investment Stewardship Committee, a senior, cross-functional group of experienced professionals, is responsible for oversight of the implementation of the Global Proxy Policy and Procedures, review and approval of the Guidelines, and identification and resolution of conflicts of interest. The Investment Stewardship Committee reviews the Guidelines as well as the Global Proxy Policy and Procedures annually.
Procedures
Use of Third-Party Voting Agent
Wellington Management uses the services of a third-party voting agent for research and to manage the administrative aspects of proxy voting. We view third-party research as an input to our process. Wellington Management complements the research provided by its primary voting agent with research from other firms.
Our primary voting agent processes proxies for client accounts and maintains records of proxies voted. For certain routine issues, as detailed below, votes may be instructed according to standing instructions given to our primary voting agent, which are based on the Guidelines.
We manually review instances where our primary voting agent discloses a material conflict of interest of its own, potentially impacting its research outputs. We perform oversight of our primary voting agent, which involves regular service calls and an annual due diligence exercise, as well as regular touchpoints in the normal course of business.
Receipt of Proxy
If a client requests that Wellington Management vote proxies on its behalf, the client must instruct its custodian bank to deliver all relevant voting materials to Wellington Management or its designated voting agent in a timely manner.
Reconciliation
Proxies for public equity securities received by electronic means are matched to the securities eligible to be voted, and a reminder is sent to custodians/trustees that have not forwarded the proxies due. This reconciliation is performed at the ballot level. Although proxies received for private equity securities, as well as those received in non-electronic format for any securities, are voted as received, Wellington Management is not able to reconcile these ballots, and does not notify custodians of non-receipt; Wellington Management is only able to reconcile ballots where clients have consented to providing holdings information with its provider for this purpose.
Proxy Voting Process
Our approach to voting is investment-led and serves as an influential component of our engagement and escalation strategy. The Investment Stewardship Committee, a cross-functional group of experienced professionals, oversees Wellington Management’s activities with regards to proxy voting practices.
Routine issues that can be addressed by the proxy voting guidance below are voted by means of standing instructions communicated to our primary voting agent. Some votes warrant analysis of specific facts and circumstances and therefore are reviewed individually. We examine such vote sources including internal research notes, third-party voting research and company engagement. While manual votes are often resolved by investment research teams, each portfolio manager is empowered to make a final decision for their relevant client portfolio(s), absent a material conflict of interest. Proactive portfolio manager input is sought under certain circumstances, which may include consideration of position size and proposal subject matter and nature. Where portfolio manager input is proactively sought, deliberation across the firm may occur. This collaboration does not prioritize consensus across the firm above all other interests but rather seeks to inform portfolio managers’ decisions by allowing them to consider multiple perspectives. Portfolio managers may occasionally
B-50

arrive at different voting conclusions for their clients, resulting in decisions for the same vote. Voting procedures and the deliberation that occurs before a vote decision are aligned with our role as active owners and fiduciaries for our clients.
Material Conflict of Interest Identification and Resolution Processes
Further detail on our management of conflicts of interest can be found in our Stewardship Conflicts of Interest Policy, available on our website.
Other Considerations
In certain instances, Wellington Management may be unable to vote or may determine not to vote a proxy on behalf of one or more clients. While not exhaustive, the following are potential instances in which a proxy vote might not be entered.
Securities Lending
Clients may elect to participate in securities lending Such lending may impact their ability to have their shares voted. Under certain circumstances, and where practical considerations allow, Wellington Management may determine that the anticipated value of voting could outweigh the benefit to the client resulting from use of securities for lending and recommend that a client attempt to have its custodian recall the security to permit voting of related proxies. We do not borrow shares for the sole purpose of exercising voting rights.
Share Blocking and Re-Registration
Certain countries impose trading restrictions or requirements regarding re-registration of securities held in omnibus accounts in order for shareholders to vote a proxy. The potential impact of such requirements is evaluated when determining whether to vote such proxies.
Lack of Adequate Information, Untimely Receipt of Proxy Materials, or Excessive Costs
Wellington Management may abstain from voting a proxy when the proxy statement or other available information is inadequate to allow for an informed vote; the proxy materials are not delivered in a timely fashion; or, in Wellington Management’s judgment, the costs of voting exceed the expected benefits to clients (included but not limited to instances such as when powers of attorney or consularization or the disclosure of client confidential information are required).
Additional Information
Wellington Management maintains records related to proxies pursuant to Rule 204-2 of the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 (the “Advisers Act”), the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (“ERISA”), and other applicable laws. In addition, Wellington Management discloses voting decisions through its website, including the rationale for votes against management.
Wellington Management provides clients with a copy of its Global Proxy Policy and Procedures, as well as the Voting Guidelines, upon written request. In addition, Wellington Management will provide specific client information relating to proxy voting to a client upon written request.
B-51

Appendix C
Portfolio Managers
INVESTMENTS IN EACH FUND
Name of Portfolio
Manager
Fund
Dollar Range of
Investments in
Each Fund as of
October 31, 2023
Amundi Asset Management US, Inc.
Kenneth J. Monaghan
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
None
Jonathan M. Duensing, CFA
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
None
Jeffrey C. Galloway, CFA
Nationwide Amundi Strategic Income Fund
None
Bailard, Inc.
Eric P. Leve, CFA
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
$100,001-$500,000
Daniel McKellar, CFA
Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund
$100,001-$500,000
Thomas J. Mudge III, CFA
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
Over $1,000,000
Blaine Townsend, CIMC, CIMA
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
$50,001-$100,000
Osman Akgun, PhD, CFA
Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund
$100,001-$500,000
Sonya Thadhani Mughal, CFA
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
$100,001-$500,000
David H. Smith, CFA
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
$100,001-$500,000
Christopher Moshy
Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund
$50,001-$100,000
BlackRock Investment Management, LLC
Jennifer Hsui, CFA
Nationwide International Index Fund
None
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
None
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
None
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
None
Peter Sietsema
Nationwide International Index Fund
None
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
None
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
None
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
None
Paul Whitehead
Nationwide International Index Fund
None
Nationwide Mid Cap Market Index Fund
None
Nationwide S&P 500 Index Fund
None
Nationwide Small Cap Index Fund
None
Karen Uyehara
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
None
James Mauro
Nationwide Bond Index Fund
None
Brown Capital Management, LLC
Keith A. Lee
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
None
Chaitanya Yaramada, CFA
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
None
Kempton M. Ingersol
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
None
Damien L. Davis, CFA
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
None
Daman C. Blakeney
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
None
Fujun Wu, CFA
Nationwide Small Company Growth Fund
None
Geneva Capital Management LLC
William A. Priebe, CFA
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
Over $1,000,000
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
Over $1,000,000
William S. Priebe
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
Over $1,000,000
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
Over $1,000,000
José Muñoz, CFA
Nationwide Geneva Mid Cap Growth Fund
$50,001-$100,000
Nationwide Geneva Small Cap Growth Fund
$50,001-$100,000
GQG Partners LLC
Rajiv Jain
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund
None
C-1

Name of Portfolio
Manager
Fund
Dollar Range of
Investments in
Each Fund as of
October 31, 2023
Brian Kersmanc
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund
None
Sudarshan Murthy, CFA
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund
None
Siddharth Jain
Nationwide GQG US Quality Equity Fund
None
Insight North America LLC
Brendan Murphy, CFA
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
None
Scott Zaleski, CFA
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
None
James DiChiaro
Nationwide BNY Mellon Core Plus Bond ESG Fund
None
Janus Henderson Investors US LLC
Julian McManus
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
None
Christopher O’Malley, CFA
Nationwide Janus Henderson Overseas Fund
None
Loomis, Sayles & Company, L.P.
Aziz V. Hamzaogullari, CFA
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
None
Christopher T. Harms
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
None
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
None
Clifton V. Rowe, CFA
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
None
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
None
Daniel Conklin, CFA
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
None
Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
None
Ian Anderson
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
None
Barath W. Sankaran, CFA
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund
None
Mellon Investments Corporation
Marlene Walker Smith
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
None
David France, CFA
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
None
Todd Frysinger, CFA
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
None
Vlasta Sheremeta, CFA
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
None
Michael Stoll
Nationwide NYSE Arca Tech 100 Index Fund
None
Nationwide Asset Management, LLC
Gary S. Davis, CFA
Nationwide Bond Fund
$1-$10,000
Corsan Maley
Nationwide Bond Fund
None
Chad W. Finefrock, CFA
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
None
Nicholas J. Kern, CFA
Nationwide Inflation-Protected Securities Fund
None
Newton Investment Management North America, LLC
John C. Bailer, CFA
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income
Fund
$50,001-$100,000
Brian C. Ferguson
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income
Fund
None
Keith Howell, Jr., CFA
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income
Fund
None
James H. Stavena
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
None
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income
Fund
None
Dimitri Curtil
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
None
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income
Fund
None
Torrey K. Zaches, CFA
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Core Fund
None
Nationwide BNY Mellon Dynamic U.S. Equity Income
Fund
None
C-2

Name of Portfolio
Manager
Fund
Dollar Range of
Investments in
Each Fund as of
October 31, 2023
UBS Asset Management (Americas) Inc.
Joseph Elegante, CFA
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
None
Adam Jokich, CFA
Nationwide Global Sustainable Equity Fund
None
WCM Investment Management, LLC
Jonathon Detter, CFA
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
None
Anthony B. Glickhouse, CFA
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
None
Patrick McGee, CFA
Nationwide WCM Focused Small Cap Fund
None
Wellington Management Company LLP
Jonathan G. White, CFA
Nationwide Fund
None
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
None
Mary L. Pryshlak, CFA
Nationwide Fund
None
Nationwide International Small Cap Fund
None
DESCRIPTION OF COMPENSATION STRUCTURE
Amundi Asset Management US, Inc. (“Amundi US”)
Amundi US’s compensation philosophy emphasizes medium and long-term incentive compensation programs and awards and is a key driver of employee attraction and motivation.
We reward short- and medium-term investment performance through bonus and performance based incentives; and long term strategic performance with long-term incentive awards.
We drive competitiveness with external market compensation rates and structures.
We have developed a system of compensation for portfolio managers and analysts that seeks to align the financial interests of the investment professional with both those of clients (through incentive payments based in part on relative investment performance) and also the firm (through incentive payments based in part on Amundi US’s financial performance).
The compensation program is based on four primary elements including (1) base salary (based on the experience and level of responsibility of the investment professional), (2) an annual bonus program, (3) the ability to participate in Long Term Incentive Programs (for some senior investment professionals), and (4) a suite of benefits that are generally offered to all full-time employees.
Base Salary
Base salary is fixed and normally reviewed on an annual basis. Each year, we participate in compensation surveys specifically targeted at investment management companies, to monitor and maintain our competitiveness in the marketplace. Amundi US seeks to set base compensation at competitive market rates, taking into account the experience and responsibilities of the individual.
Bonus Plan
The bonuses for portfolio managers and analysts are decided by a combination of the following factors:
Portfolio Managers
The bonus plan is intended to provide a competitive level of annual bonus compensation that is tied to the individual achieving competitive investment performance. 40% of the bonus may be deferred over a three year period, vesting 1/3 each year. The deferral is to underpin long-term retention of key investment employees. This portion is also eligible for further investment and managed by the participant over the course of the three-year term.
C-3

Quantitative Investment Performance (70% overall weighting): The quantitative investment performance calculation is based on pre-tax performance of all of the accounts managed by the portfolio manager, which includes the fund and any other accounts managed by the portfolio manager. Performance is measured over one, three and five calendar year periods.
Fund performance is ranked against its peer group universe (60%) and a broad-based securities market index (40%), while institutional or separate accounts are measured specifically against the assigned broad-based market index (100%).
Qualitative Performance (30% overall weighting): The qualitative performance component includes specific objectives that are mutually established and evaluated by each portfolio manager and management.
Company Results: Company results affect a portfolio manager's actual bonus by a leverage factor of plus or minus a predetermined percentage.
For purposes of calculation, Amundi US’s Portfolio Management Team applies a 70% weighting to Quantitative factors, and a 30% weighting to Qualitative factors.
Fixed Income Analysts
Amundi US’s fixed income research analysts are compensated through base salary, incentive compensation and other longer-term awards, utilizing a similar structure to the fixed income portfolio management team.  70% of incentive compensation for analysts is tied to the performance of the portfolios to which they contribute. 
30% of the bonus calculation is based on qualitative criteria defined by a set of objectives for each analyst that may include company knowledge, investment decision skill, adherence to the investment process and policies, integration of ESG concepts where applicable, and factors such as quality of communication and other activities to support the performance of the team.
Company results affect an analysts’ actual bonus by a leverage factor of plus or minus a predetermined percentage.
Additionally, 40% of the annual performance bonus may be deferred over a three year period, vesting 1/3 each year. This portion is also eligible for further investment and managed by the participant over the course of the three-year term.
Long Term Incentive Plan
The Amundi Group Long-Term Incentive:
Share-based Plan aligns the interests of its key people with those of the company and its shareholders, supporting the achievement of the Business Plan. Number of Shares vested will depend on the performance of the Group for the performance period, calculated as the weighted average achievement rate on three objectives: Net Income, Cost-to-Income ratio and achievement of net income flows. Vesting schedule is 3-Year Cliff vesting share based plan.
Amundi Intermediate Deferred Cash Award Plan “AIDCAP”:
Award plan to provide supplemental compensation to reward performance and encourage retention of key contributors to the Company. Vesting schedule is 3-Year Cliff vesting cash Incentive Plan.
Special Award Plan:
Award plan to provide supplemental compensation to reward performance and encourage retention of key contributors to the Company. Vesting schedule is 25% Year 1, 25% Year 2, and remaining balance after Year 3.
Bailard, Inc. (“Bailard”)
Dr. Akgun, Mr. McKellar, Mr. Mudge, Mr. Smith and Mr. Moshy are each paid a base salary, an “investment performance” bonus relating to the Fund and strategy each manages and, potentially, an additional discretionary bonus. The investment performance bonus is designed to be significant but not so significant that it would encourage extreme risk taking. For the
C-4

Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund, the Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund and the Nationwide Bailard Technology and Science Fund, it is based on the relevant Fund’s return ranking on a rolling 12-month basis relative to that Fund’s peer group: Morningstar Small Cap Value Category (for the Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund), Morningstar Foreign Large Blend Category (for the Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund) and Morningstar Technology Category (for the Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund). Additionally, a portion of Mr. McKellar’s investment performance bonus is based on the performance of Bailard’s EAFE Composite (0% Emerging Markets) on a rolling 12-month basis. In addition to the investment performance bonus related to the Fund, Dr. Akgun also receives an investment performance bonus for Bailard’s Tactical Asset Allocation strategy. The discretionary bonus, if any, reflects the pre-tax profitability of Bailard and the portfolio manager’s contribution to meeting Bailard’s general corporate goals. On occasion, the portfolio managers named above may receive stock grants based on individual performance.
Mr. Leve, Ms. Mughal and Mr. Townsend are members of Bailard’s Senior Management Team and as such, their compensation consists primarily of a base salary and a significant discretionary cash bonus. The cash bonus reflects Bailard’s profitability and Mr. Leve, Ms. Mughal and Mr. Townsend’s contribution to Bailard’s corporate goals. On occasion, portfolio managers on the Senior Management Team may receive stock grants based on individual performance. None of Mr. Leve’s compensation is based directly on the performance of the Nationwide Bailard International Equities Fund. None of Ms. Mughal’s compensation is based directly on the performance of the Nationwide Bailard Technology & Science Fund. None of Mr. Townsend’s compensation is based directly on the performance of the Nationwide Bailard Cognitive Value Fund.
BlackRock Investment Management, LLC (“BlackRock”)
The discussion below describes the portfolio managers’ compensation as of October 31, 2023.
BlackRock’s financial arrangements with its portfolio managers, its competitive compensation and its career path emphasis at all levels reflect the value senior management places on key resources. Compensation may include a variety of components and may vary from year to year based on a number of factors. The principal components of compensation include a base salary, a performance-based discretionary bonus, participation in various benefits programs and one or more of the incentive compensation programs established by BlackRock.
Base Compensation. Generally, portfolio managers receive base compensation based on their position with the firm.
Discretionary Incentive Compensation Ms. Hsui and Messrs. Sietsema and Whitehead
Discretionary incentive compensation is a function of several components: the performance of BlackRock, Inc., the performance of the portfolio manager’s group within BlackRock, the investment performance, including risk-adjusted returns, of the firm’s assets under management or supervision by that portfolio manager relative to predetermined benchmarks, and the individual’s performance and contribution to the overall performance of these portfolios and BlackRock.  In most cases, these benchmarks are the same as the benchmark or benchmarks against which the performance of the Funds or other accounts managed by the portfolio managers are measured.  Among other things, BlackRock’s Chief Investment Officers make a subjective determination with respect to each portfolio manager’s compensation based on the performance of the Funds and other accounts managed by each portfolio manager relative to the various benchmarks.  Performance of fixed income and multi-asset class funds is measured on a pre-tax and/or after-tax basis over various time periods including 1-, 3- and 5- year periods, as applicable.  Performance of index funds is based on the performance of such funds relative to pre-determined tolerance bands around a benchmark, as applicable. The performance of Ms. Hsui and Messrs. Sietsema and Whitehead is not measured against a specific benchmark.
Discretionary Incentive Compensation Ms. Uyehara and Mr. Mauro
Discretionary incentive compensation is a function of several components: the performance of BlackRock, Inc., the performance of the portfolio manager’s group within BlackRock, the investment performance, including risk-adjusted returns, of the firm’s assets under management or supervision by that portfolio manager relative to predetermined benchmarks, and the individual’s performance and contribution to the overall performance of these portfolios and BlackRock.  In most cases, these benchmarks are the same as the benchmark or benchmarks against which the performance of the Funds or other accounts managed by the portfolio managers are measured.  Among other things, BlackRock’s Chief Investment Officers make a subjective determination with respect to each portfolio manager’s compensation based on the performance of the Funds and other accounts managed by each portfolio manager relative to the various benchmarks. 
C-5

Performance of fixed income funds is measured on a pre-tax and/or after-tax basis over various time periods including 1-, 3- and 5- year periods, as applicable. With respect to these portfolio managers, such benchmarks for the Fund and other accounts are:
Portfolio Manager
Benchmarks
James Mauro
A combination of market-based indices (e.g., Bloomberg MBS Index and the
Bloomberg U.S. TIPS 0-5 Years Index).
Karen Uyehara
A combination of market-based indices (e.g., Bloomberg U.S. Aggregate Bond
Index), certain customized indices and certain fund industry peer groups.
Distribution of Discretionary Incentive Compensation. Discretionary incentive compensation is distributed to portfolio managers in a combination of cash, deferred BlackRock, Inc. stock awards, and/or deferred cash awards that notionally track the return of certain BlackRock investment products.
Portfolio managers receive their annual discretionary incentive compensation in the form of cash. Portfolio managers whose total compensation is above a specified threshold also receive deferred BlackRock, Inc. stock awards annually as part of their discretionary incentive compensation. Paying a portion of discretionary incentive compensation in the form of deferred BlackRock, Inc. stock puts compensation earned by a portfolio manager for a given year “at risk” based on BlackRock’s ability to sustain and improve its performance over future periods. In some cases, additional deferred BlackRock, Inc. stock may be granted to certain key employees as part of a long-term incentive award to aid in retention, align interests with long-term shareholders and motivate performance. Deferred BlackRock, Inc. stock awards are generally granted in the form of BlackRock, Inc. restricted stock units that vest pursuant to the terms of the applicable plan and, once vested, settle in BlackRock, Inc. common stock. The portfolio managers of these Funds have deferred BlackRock, Inc. stock awards.
For certain portfolio managers, a portion of the discretionary incentive compensation is also distributed in the form of deferred cash awards that notionally track the returns of select BlackRock investment products they manage, which provides direct alignment of portfolio manager discretionary incentive compensation with investment product results. Deferred cash awards vest ratably over a number of years and, once vested, settle in the form of cash. Only portfolio managers who manage specified products and whose total compensation is above a specified threshold are eligible to participate in the deferred cash award program.
Other Compensation Benefits. In addition to base salary and discretionary incentive compensation, portfolio managers may be eligible to receive or participate in one or more of the following:
Incentive Savings Plans BlackRock, Inc. has created a variety of incentive savings plans in which BlackRock employees are eligible to participate, including a 401(k) plan, the BlackRock Retirement Savings Plan (RSP), and the BlackRock Employee Stock Purchase Plan (ESPP). The employer contribution components of the RSP include a company match equal to 50% of the first 8% of eligible pay contributed to the plan capped at $5,000 per year, and a company retirement contribution equal to 3-5% of eligible compensation up to the Internal Revenue Service limit ($330,000 for 2023). The RSP offers a range of investment options, including registered investment companies and collective investment funds managed by the firm. BlackRock contributions follow the investment direction set by participants for their own contributions or, absent participant investment direction, are invested into a target date fund that corresponds to, or is closest to, the year in which the participant attains age 65. The ESPP allows for investment in BlackRock common stock at a 5% discount on the fair market value of the stock on the purchase date. Annual participation in the ESPP is limited to the purchase of 1,000 shares of common stock or a dollar value of $25,000 based on its fair market value on the purchase date. All of the eligible portfolio managers are eligible to participate in these plans.
Brown Capital Management, LLC (“Brown Capital Management”)
Brown Capital’s compensation structure seeks to retain superior talent by rewarding exceptional performance over time. Investment team members are paid a competitive base salary. Bonuses are paid once every three years based on metrics focused on performance relative to the benchmarks and peer groups of the strategies they manage, annual team evaluations, and contributions to the firm’s overall performance. Together with the ESOP incentives, the firm believes this total compensation rewards our investment professionals in a manner that reflects the value of their skills, experience, and ability to deliver results.
C-6

Geneva Capital Management LLC (“Geneva”)
Geneva investment professionals receive a competitive market-based salary and discretionary bonus. The size of the bonus pool is a function of firm revenues. Bonuses at the individual level will be based on a number of factors including analyst productivity, performance of coverage universe and a discretionary component. This discretionary component is meant to encourage teamwork and collaboration and reward individuals who make a positive long-term impact on the business. In addition to bonus and salary most members of the investment team are shareholders of the Firm and receive profit distributions based on their ownership stake in the company. Additionally, Geneva continually evaluates ways to incent investment professionals who make a positive long-term impact. This may include an opportunity to purchase equity in the Firm, which is offered on an invitation only basis. Geneva believes this compensation plan encourages investment professionals to focus on the long-term success of the business.
GQG Partners LLC (“GQG”)
Each portfolio manager receives a fixed salary, retirement benefits, investment management services from GQG and, in the case of Messrs. Kersmanc, Murthy and S. Jain, variable compensation, which includes a discretionary annual bonus that is based on both a qualitative and quantitative evaluation of the portfolio manager’s performance and GQG’s overall performance and profitability.  A portion of the discretionary annual bonus is typically paid in cash each year, and the remainder of the bonus is normally allocated to a deferred compensation plan, subject to a vesting schedule and paid out over time (e.g., 3 years).  Amounts deferred under the plan earn the rate of return earned by the institutional shares class of a proprietary mutual fund advised by GQG, calculated gross of management fees but net of other operating expenses. No portfolio manager’s compensation is directly based on the value of assets in a fund’s portfolio.  In addition, from time-to-time, employees of GQG, including Messrs. Kersmanc, Murthy and S. Jain, may receive an award of restricted stock units in GQG’s parent company, GQG Partners Inc.  The grant of any such award is subject to the discretion of the Board of Directors of GQG Partners Inc. 
Insight North America LLC (“Insight”)
The strategic goal of Insight is to provide a high-quality investment service to our clients over the long term. The route to achieving this strategy is through the performance and commitment of our people. Our reward philosophy has a key role to play in the motivation and retention of our people and is therefore an important contributing factor in the achievement of our business strategy. Our approach to compensation and how this incentivizes behaviors within Insight is captured within five key parameters:
Shared ownership for all employees: Our people are highly engaged with our business and our culture of collective ownership reinforces collaboration across teams and strengthens the alignment with our clients. All of our people are awarded an annual grant of our long-term incentive plan (LTIP). LTIP awards typically vest after three years and their value is based on an independent external assessment of Insight’s market value. Share-based LTIP is awarded as non-voting, non-dividend paying equity in Insight. The LTIP is a powerful tool for staff retention and ensures employees share directly in the success of the business. For our senior management, investment desk heads and material risk-takers, we operate a deferral policy where at least 40% of variable pay is deferred through LTIP. In the UK, our employees also have an opportunity to acquire Insight shares from their pre-taxed salary.
Designed to support a culture of high performance: Our approach to compensation is designed to support the culture of the business and to ensure that top performance is recognized with top quartile industry pay. This has successfully enabled us to attract and retain, what we believe to be, the best available talent in the industry. The structure of our compensation plans actively promote team working and collaboration across teams. The main components of compensation are base salary and variable pay. Variable pay is made up of two elements; discretionary annual cash amount and a deferral into our LTIP, awarded under a consistent set of principles, globally. We also offer competitive benefits and well-being programs, where the health and welfare of our people is paramount.
Simple and transparent: We recognize the importance of applying a clear and consistent compensation process as aligned with our philosophy of payment for performance. For our senior staff, total compensation is heavily weighted towards variable pay and the overall value of variable pay is directly linked to the profitability and performance of the business. Therefore, if Insight performs and our people deliver strong performance their total compensation will be competitive.
C-7

Aligned with performance management: Insight believes firmly in setting performance-related objectives that are structured to promote sound and effective risk management within the company’s risk management appetite. Performance is assessed and evaluated in light of an individual's contribution to the overall client mandate, team and business performance, and culture. We aim to reward most highly those individuals who help the team to perform strongly. A team culture is an essential part of the way we conduct our business and our compensation policy is designed to encourage this.
Regulatory compliant with robust governance: The general principles of our compensation arrangements are agreed with our parent company, BNY Mellon, and are reviewed at least twice a year by the Insight Remuneration Committee. We ensure our compensation processes and policy are compliant with all relevant regulation, including the requirements of the FCA Remuneration Code and corresponding local Directives.
Both analysts and portfolio managers will receive short-term incentives (STIP) and LTIP compensation. The level of variable compensation is determined across the organization taking into account performance of the company, department and individual. The individual’s performance is assessed against objectives set at the beginning of the year and will be different across business areas, seniority and specialization. Therefore, although we do not offer different compensation packages between analysts and portfolio managers, the objectives that they are assessed against will be different and individual performance will be a variable that could impact on the level and mix of STIP and LTIP that they receive.
For US employees, there are no employment contracts in place and employment is at will; however, it is important to note that for all employees, retention and compensation strategies are structured with the aim of aligning individual interests with the success and profitability of the firm. Our LTIP provides all employees with a share in the business and has proved a successful retention tool, alongside broader talent management and succession planning frameworks.
Janus Henderson Investors US LLC (“Janus Henderson”)
Portfolio management is compensated for managing a Fund and any other funds, portfolios, or accounts for which they have exclusive or shared responsibilities through two components: fixed compensation and variable compensation. Compensation (both fixed and variable) is determined on a pre-tax basis.
Fixed Compensation: Fixed compensation is paid in cash and is comprised of an annual base salary. The base salary is based on factors such as performance, scope of responsibility, skills, knowledge, experience, ability, and market competitiveness.
Variable Compensation: Portfolio management’s variable compensation is discretionary and is determined by investment team management. The overall investment team variable compensation pool is funded by an amount equal to a percentage of Janus Henderson’s pre-incentive operating income. In determining individual awards, both quantitative and qualitative factors are considered. Such factors include, among other things, consistent short-term and long-term fund performance (i.e., one-, three-, and five-year performance), client support and investment team support through the sharing of ideas, leadership, development, mentoring, and teamwork.
Performance fees: The firm receives performance fees in relation to certain funds depending on outperformance of the fund against pre-determined benchmarks. Performance fees are shared directly with the investment professional in two instances; on a discretionary basis, if the fees were generated by certain products, and on a formulaic basis, if there is a contractual agreement in place.
The discretionary performance fee sharing incentives are funded from within the profit pools and subject to the same risk adjustment, review, and standard deferral arrangements that apply to the discretionary funding frameworks.
Deferrals/Firm Ownership: All employees are subject to Janus Henderson’s standard deferral arrangements which apply to variable incentive awards. Deferral rates apply to awards that exceed a minimum threshold, rates of deferral increase for larger incentive awards. Deferred awards vest in three equal installments over a 3-year period and are delivered into JHG restricted stock and/or funds.
Portfolio management may be eligible to defer payment of a designated percentage of their fixed compensation and/or up to all of their variable compensation in accordance with JHG’s Executive Income Deferral Program.
C-8

Loomis, Sayles & Company, L.P. (“Loomis Sayles”)
Nationwide Loomis All Cap Growth Fund
Loomis Sayles believes that Portfolio Manager compensation should be driven primarily by the delivery of consistent and superior long-term performance for its clients. Mr. Hamzaogullari’s compensation has four components: a competitive base salary, an annual incentive bonus driven by investment performance, participation in a long-term incentive plan (with an annual and a post-retirement payout), and a revenue sharing bonus if certain revenue thresholds and performance hurdles are met.
Maximum variable compensation potential is a multiple of base salary and reflects performance achievements relative to peers with similar disciplines. The performance review considers the asset class, manager experience, and maturity of the product. The incentive compensation is based on trailing strategy performance and is weighted at one third for the three-year period, one third for the five-year period and one third for the ten-year period. He also receives performance based compensation as Portfolio Manager for a private investment fund. The Firm’s senior management reviews the components annually.
In addition, Mr. Hamzaogullari participates in the Loomis Sayles profit sharing plan, in which Loomis Sayles makes a contribution to the retirement plan of each employee based on a percentage of base salary (up to a maximum amount). He may also participate in the Loomis Sayles deferred compensation plan which requires all employees to defer 50% of their annual bonus if in excess of a certain dollar amount, except for those employees who will be age 61 or older on the date the bonus is awarded. These amounts are deferred over a two year period with 50% being paid out one year from the bonus anniversary date and the second 50% being paid out two years from the bonus anniversary date. These deferrals are deposited into an investment account on the employee's behalf, but the employee must be with Loomis Sayles on the vesting dates in order to receive the deferred bonus.
Nationwide Loomis Core Bond Fund and Nationwide Loomis Short Term Bond Fund
Loomis Sayles believes that Portfolio Manager compensation should be driven primarily by the delivery of consistent and superior long-term performance for its clients. Although Portfolio Manager compensation is not directly tied to assets under management, a Portfolio Manager’s base salary and/or bonus potential may reflect the amount of assets for which the manager is responsible relative to other Portfolio Managers. The annual bonus is incentive-based and generally represents a significant multiple of base salary. The bonus is based on three factors: investment performance, profit growth of the Firm, and personal conduct. Investment performance is the primary component of the annual bonus and generally represents at least 60% of the total for fixed-income managers. The other factors are used to determine the remainder of the annual incentive bonus, subject to the discretion of the Firm’s Chief Investment Officer (“CIO”) and senior management. The Firm’s CIO and senior management evaluate these other factors annually.
The investment performance component of the annual incentive bonus depends primarily on investment performance against benchmark and/or against peers within similar disciplines. The score is based upon the product’s institutional composite performance; however, adjustments may be made if there is significant dispersion among the returns of the composite and accounts not included in the composite. For most products, the product investment score compares the product’s rolling three year performance over the past nine quarters (a five year view) against both a benchmark and a peer group established by the CIO. The scoring rewards both the aggregate excess performance of the product against a benchmark and the product’s relative rank within a peer group. In addition, for fixed income products, the performance score rewards for the consistency of that outperformance and is enhanced if over the past five years it has kept its rolling three-year performance ahead of its benchmark. Portfolio Managers working on several product teams receive a final score based on the relative revenue weight of each product.
Portfolio Managers may also participate in the three segments of the long-term incentive program. The amount of the awards for each segment are dependent upon role, industry experience, team and Firm profitability, and/or investment performance.
C-9

General
The core elements of the Loomis Sayles compensation plan include a base salary, an annual incentive bonus, and, for senior investor and leadership roles, a long-term incentive bonus. The base salary is a fixed amount based on a combination of factors, including industry experience, Firm experience, job performance and market considerations. The annual incentive bonus and long term incentive bonus is driven by a variety of factors depending upon the specific role. Factors include investment performance, individual performance, team and Firm profitability, role, and industry experience. Both the annual and long term bonus have a deferral component. Loomis Sayles has developed and implemented three long-term incentive plan segments to attract and retain investment talent.
For the senior-most investment roles, a Long Term Incentive Plan provides annual grants relative to the role, and includes a post retirement payment feature to incentivize effective succession management. Participation is contingent upon signing an award agreement, which includes a non-compete covenant. The second and third Long Term Incentive Plans are constructed to create mid- term alignment for key positions, including a two year deferral feature. The second plan is role based, and the third is team based which is more specifically dependent upon team profitability and/or investment performance.
In addition, Loomis Sayles also offers a profit sharing plan for all employees and a defined benefit plan for employees who joined the Firm prior to May 3, 2003. The profit sharing contribution to the retirement plan of each employee is based on a percentage of base salary (up to a maximum amount). The defined benefit plan is based on years of service and base compensation (up to a maximum amount).
Mellon Investments Corporation (“Mellon”) 
The firm’s rewards program is designed to be market-competitive and align our compensation with the goals of our clients. This alignment is achieved through an emphasis on deferred awards, which incentivizes our investment personnel to focus on long-term performance.
Our incentive model is designed to compensate for quantitative and qualitative objectives achieved during the performance year. An individual’s final annual incentive award is tied to the firm’s overall performance, the team’s performance and the individual’s performance.
Awards are paid in cash on an annual basis. However, some portfolio managers may receive a portion of their annual incentive award in deferred vehicles. Annual incentive as a percentage of fixed pay varies with the profitability of the firm and the product team.
The following factors encompass our investment professional rewards program.
Base salary
Annual cash incentive
Long-Term Incentive Plan
BNY Mellon restricted stock units
Nationwide Asset Management, LLC (“NWAM”)
NWAM’s compensation program consists of base salary, annual incentives and long-term incentives; hereby known as “Compensation Structure.” Annually, the “Compensation Structure” is reviewed for competitiveness by using the McLagan Compensation surveys.
The “Compensation Structure” is designed to motivate and reward individual and team actions and behaviors that drive a high-performance organization and deliver risk-adjusted investment returns that are aligned with the strategy of Nationwide and our business partners.
Align interests of NWAM and business partners and foster collaboration
Base a substantial portion of NWAM compensation directly on NWAM
Recognize qualitative as well as quantitative performance
Encourage a higher level of intelligent investment risk taking and entrepreneurial attitudes and behaviors
Provide a high degree of “line of sight” for NWAM participants and other business partners
C-10

Attract and retain individuals with skills critical to the NWAM strategy
Target median total compensation for the industry
Utilize variable compensation (annual and long term) to close compensation market gaps.
Newton Investment Management North America LLC (“NIMNA”)
NIMNA employees are remunerated using a combination of base salary and discretionary annual incentive which is delivered in a mix of cash and deferred incentive depending on the level of incentive and appropriateness for the role.
Discretionary deferred incentive arrangements can include a mix of a long-term incentive plan (LTIP), which has Newton real equity, and awards made under a deferred cash plan linked to the performance of a basket of Newton-managed portfolios (pooled vehicles). This approach aligns us closely with clients and provides employees with an appropriately balance discretionary incentive arrangement. Most discretionary incentive-eligible employees now receive 100% of their deferred awards in the deferred cash plan linked to the performance of a basket of Newton-managed portfolios (pooled vehicles), with members of the executive team receiving a portion of their incentive award in the Newton real equity plan and a portion in the deferred cash plan linked to the performance of a basket of Newton-managed portfolios (pooled vehicles).
For portfolio managers, a portion of the deferred cash award is linked to the performance of a portfolio (pooled vehicle) where they form part of the portfolio management team, and the remaining portion is linked to the performance of the Newton-wide basket of portfolios, providing and tangible and direct link between compensation and the performance of the fund they are responsible for.
For awards made under the Newton equity plan the value of Newton equity is calculated twice a year. The valuation is based on current and future forecasted financial performance of the Newton business. The class of shares, which the participants hold, is non-voting and non-dividend-bearing and the parent company (holding dividend-bearing NIM shares with voting rights) retains 100% control of Newton.
It is intended that discretionary incentive awards will be made annually with deferred elements having a three-year vesting period. For the Newton equity awards, the vesting period will be followed by a minimum further six-month and one-day holding period.
NB: The approach described to reward structures above is applied consistently to Newton’s go forward business in both the UK and US, albeit the fund baskets used in each jurisdiction differ slightly (in part to ensure appropriate alignment with clients). We regularly review our compensation approach, including mixture and features of the deferred compensation schemes and will make changes that we consider appropriate to ensure that we remain aligned with regulatory requirements, client outcomes and market practices.
UBS Asset Management (Americas) Inc. (“UBS AM”)
UBS AM’s compensation philosophy is to align the interests of our employees with those of our clients and investors. The Total Reward Principles establish the framework for determining our performance award pool and guide the allocation and delivery mechanisms of compensation to employees, including deferred compensation programs. These Principles underpin our compensation framework that balances performance and prudent risk-taking with a focus on conduct and sound risk management practices. Our compensation structure is aligned with our strategic priorities. It encourages employees to develop a strong client franchise, create sustainable value and achieve the highest standards of performance. Moreover, we reward behavior that helps build and protect the firm’s reputation—specifically accountability with integrity, collaboration and challenge. We strive for excellence and sustainable performance in everything we do. Compensation for each employee is based on individual, team, business division and Group performance, within the context of the markets in which we operate.
In general, the total compensation received by the portfolio managers and analysts at UBS AM consists of two elements: a fixed component (base salary and benefits) and an annual discretionary performance award that is correlated with investment performance.
C-11

Fixed component (base salary and benefits):
Set with the aim of being competitive in the industry and monitored and adjusted periodically with reference to the relevant local labor market in order to remain so.
The fixed component is used to recognize the experience, skills and knowledge that each portfolio manager or analyst brings to their role.
Performance award:
Determined annually on a discretionary basis.
Based on the individual’s financial and non-financial contribution—as assessed through a rigorous performance assessment process—as well as on the performance of their respective function, of UBS AM and of UBS as a whole.
Delivered in cash and, when total compensation is over a defined threshold, partly in deferral vehicles.
For awards subject to deferral, the deferred amount is calculated using graduated marginal deferral rates, which increase as the value of the performance award increases.
Deferred amounts are then typically delivered via two deferral vehicles—75% in the UBS Asset Management Equity Ownership Plan (AM EOP) and 25% in the Deferred Contingent Capital Plan (DCCP):
AM EOP awards generally vest over five years with 40% of the award vesting in year two, 40% in year three and 20% in year five, provided the vesting conditions, including continued service, are met and the awards have not been forfeited on or before the vesting dates. Deferred awards under the AM EOP are granted in the form of Notional Funds. The Notional Funds are aligned to selected UBS AM funds. They provide for a high level of transparency and correlation between an employee’s compensation and the investment performance of UBS AM. This enhances the alignment of investment professionals’ and other employees’ interests with those of our clients.
The DCCP is a mandatory deferral plan. Awards under the DCCP vest 100% in year five, subject to vesting conditions, including continued employment, and subject to forfeiture. The terms of the DCCP are similar to those of a loss-absorbing bond instrument offered to external investors with regard to notional interest entitlement and the impact of trigger and viability events.
The DCCP aligns the interests of our key employees with the interests of external investors and, alongside the AM EOP, attempts to ensure an appropriate balance between client and other stakeholder alignment.
For UBS Asset Management’s Equities, Fixed Income, Investment Solutions and Passive investment areas:
From January 1, 2015, UBS AM introduced a new Key Performance Indicator (KPI)-led model for each business area, aligning our business steering logic with our strategic priorities. For our investment areas, sustainable investment performance is a major component of the KPI model.
Portfolio managers’ performance awards are subject to detailed KPIs, mainly focused on investment performance of relevant client portfolios and funds, and also including some other factors such as risk management and client focus. Equities, Fixed Income, Solutions and Passive are assessed annually based on the investment performance during each of prior three years versus benchmark, performance target and peers. This helps to ensure that the interests of portfolio managers are aligned with those of our clients. In addition, we evaluate our passive strategies in terms of how closely the performance of the strategies tracks their respective benchmarks over time.
For analysts, performance awards are, in general, based on the performance of some combination of model and/or client portfolios, generally evaluated over one and three years. This is coupled with a qualitative assessment of their contribution considering factors such as the quality of their research, stock recommendations and their communication within and between teams and with portfolio managers.
For awards subject to deferral (e.g. above a certain compensation level), UBS AM employees receive at least 75% of their deferred performance awards in notional funds under the AM EOP and up to 25% under the DCCP. This aligns UBS AM employee compensation more closely with industry standards. The average deferral period for deferred performance awards for employees below Group Executive Board (GEB) level is 3.5 years.
C-12

WCM Investment Management, LLC (“WCM”)
Compensation for WCM portfolio management personnel is determined by research team leaders in conjunction with WCM’s Leadership Team, and consists of 1) a salary with 2) a possible bonus, 3) a possible revenue-share, and 4) a possible equity component.
1.
Base Salary. Salary levels are based on the individual’s degree of industry tenure, experience, and responsibilities at the firm.
2.
Discretionary bonus. The bonus component is discretionary, and is based on qualitative employee performance measures, such as our “return on time” evaluation, contribution to the portfolio team, management of their portfolios, and other responsibilities (e.g., personnel management) at the firm. Furthermore, the overall performance of WCM (e.g., total assets under management, company profitability) will also impact this compensation component.
3.
Revenue share. Portfolio managers may share in the revenue generated by the investment strategy for which they are responsible.
4.
Equity ownership. Finally, portfolio managers may also receive compensation in the form of offers of equity ownership and the consequent distributions therefrom.
Portfolio managers are also eligible to participate in the company’s “401(k)” Employee Savings Plan, which includes an annual company contribution based on the profitability of the firm.
Upon termination or retirement, an equity shareholder's stake in the firm is repurchased by WCM at book value, unless otherwise negotiated.
Wellington Management Company LLP (“Wellington Management”)
Wellington Management receives a fee based on the assets under management of the Nationwide Fund and the Nationwide International Small Cap Fund (the “Funds”) as set forth in the Subadvisory Agreements between Wellington Management, Nationwide Mutual Funds and Nationwide Fund Advisors on behalf of each Fund. Wellington Management pays its investment professionals out of its total revenues, including the advisory fees earned with respect to the Funds. The following information is as of October 31, 2023.
Wellington Management’s compensation structure is designed to attract and retain high-caliber investment professionals necessary to deliver high quality investment management services to its clients. Wellington Management’s compensation of each Fund’s managers listed in the prospectus who are primarily responsible for the day-to-day management of the Funds (“Portfolio Managers”) includes a base salary. The base salary for each Portfolio Manager who is a partner (a “Partner”) of Wellington Management Group LLP, the ultimate holding company of Wellington Management, is generally a fixed amount that is determined by the managing partners of Wellington Management Group LLP. The base salary for the other Portfolio Manager is determined by the Portfolio Manager’s experience and performance in his role as a Portfolio Manager. Base salaries for Wellington Management's employees are reviewed annually and may be adjusted based on the recommendation of a Portfolio Manager’s manager, using guidelines established by Wellington Management's Compensation Committee, which has final oversight responsibility for base salaries of employees of the firm.
The Investment Professionals may also be eligible for bonus payments based on their overall contribution to Wellington Management’s business operations. Senior management at Wellington Management may reward individuals as it deems appropriate based on other factors. Each Partner is eligible to participate in a Partner-funded tax qualified retirement plan, the contributions to which are made pursuant to an actuarial formula. Ms. Pryshlak is a Partner.
Fund
Benchmark Index
Nationwide Fund
S&P 500 Index
Nationwide International Small
Cap Fund
MSCI EAFE® Small Cap Index
C-13

OTHER MANAGED ACCOUNTS
The following chart summarizes information regarding accounts, including the Fund(s), for which each portfolio manager has day-to-day management responsibilities. Accounts are grouped into the following three categories: (1) mutual funds; (2) other pooled investment vehicles; and (3) other accounts. To the extent that any of these accounts pay advisory fees that are based on account performance (“performance-based fees”), information on those accounts is provided separately.
Name of Portfolio Manager
Number of Accounts Managed by Each Portfolio Manager and Total Assets by Category as of
October 31, 2023
Amundi Asset Management US, Inc.
Kenneth J. Monaghan
Mutual Funds: 8 accounts, $1.45 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 31 accounts, $3.96 billion total assets (13
accounts, $2.22 billion total assets for which the advisory fee is based on
performance)
Other Accounts: 4 accounts, $449.03 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Jonathan M. Duensing, CFA
Mutual Funds: 4 accounts, $519.14 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 14 accounts, $1.81 billion total assets (7
accounts, $561.17 million total assets for which the advisory fee is based on
performance)
Other Accounts: 11 accounts, $4.31 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Jeffrey C. Galloway, CFA
Mutual Funds: 2 accounts, $456.19 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for which the
advisory fee is based on performance)
Bailard, Inc.
Eric P. Leve, CFA
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $163.1 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 1 account, $334.1 million total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 11 accounts, $605.8 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Christopher Moshy
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $135 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for which the
advisory fee is based on performance)
Daniel McKellar, CFA
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $163.1 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 11 accounts, $605.8 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
C-14

Name of Portfolio Manager
Number of Accounts Managed by Each Portfolio Manager and Total Assets by Category as of
October 31, 2023
Thomas J. Mudge III, CFA
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $84.1 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 2 accounts, $57.5 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Blaine Townsend, CIMC, CIMA
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $84.1 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 52 accounts, $332.7 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
David H. Smith, CFA
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $135 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 1 account, $14.6 million total assets (1 accounts,
$14.6 million total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 4 accounts, $45 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Sonya Thadhani Mughal, CFA
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $135 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 1 account, $334.1 million total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for which the
advisory fee is based on performance)
Osman Akgun, PhD, CFA
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $84.1 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 1 account, $334.1 million total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 15 accounts, $115.2 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
BlackRock Investment Management, LLC
Jennifer Hsui, CFA
Mutual Funds: 338 accounts, $1.84 trillion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for which the
advisory fee is based on performance)
Peter Sietsema
Mutual Funds: 61 accounts, $104.3 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 5 accounts, $1.96 billion total assets (1 account, $1.85 billion total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Paul Whitehead
Mutual Funds: 345 accounts, $1.85 trillion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 342 accounts, $908.4 billion total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 135 accounts, $561.5 billion total assets (1 account, $2.35 billion
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
C-15

Name of Portfolio Manager
Number of Accounts Managed by Each Portfolio Manager and Total Assets by Category as of
October 31, 2023
Karen Uyehara
Mutual Funds: 115 accounts, $557 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 15 accounts, $ 244.4 million total assets (2
accounts, $121.1 million total assets for which the advisory fee is based on
performance)
Other Accounts: 2 accounts, $2.34 billion total assets (1 account, $587.7 million
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
James Mauro
Mutual Funds: 130 accounts, $591.6 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 30 accounts, $36.31 billion total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 5 accounts, $3.75 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Brown Capital Management, LLC
Keith A. Lee
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $3.10 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 28 accounts, $2.27 billion total assets (2 accounts, $99.65 million
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Chaitanya Yaramada, CFA
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $3.10 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 28 accounts, $2.27 billion total assets (2 accounts, $99.65 million
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Kempton M. Ingersol
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $3.10 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 28 accounts, $2.27 billion total assets (2 accounts, $99.65 million
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Damien L. Davis, CFA
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $3.10 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 28 accounts, $2.27 billion total assets (2 accounts, $99.65 million
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Daman C. Blakeney
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $3.10 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 28 accounts, $2.27 billion total assets (2 accounts, $99.65 million
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Fujun Wu, CFA
Mutual Funds: 1 account, $3.10 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 28 accounts, $2.27 billion total assets (2 accounts, $99.65 million
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
C-16

Name of Portfolio Manager
Number of Accounts Managed by Each Portfolio Manager and Total Assets by Category as of
October 31, 2023
Geneva Capital Management LLC
William A. Priebe, CFA
Mutual Funds: 4 accounts, $1.75 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 2 accounts, $84.8 million total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 201 accounts, $2.97 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
William S. Priebe
Mutual Funds: 5 accounts, $1.75 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 2 accounts, $84.8 million total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 241 accounts, $3.12 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
José Muñoz, CFA
Mutual Funds: 5 accounts, $1.75 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 2 accounts, $84.8 million total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 213 accounts, $3.03 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
GQG Partners LLC
Rajiv Jain
Mutual Funds: 11 accounts, $47.97 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 42 accounts, $32.96 billion total assets (3
accounts, $286 million total assets for which the advisory fee is based on
performance)
Other Accounts: 44 accounts, $21.8 billion total assets (7 accounts, $5 billion total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Brian Kersmanc
Mutual Funds: 11 accounts, $47.97 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 42 accounts, $32.96 billion total assets (3
accounts, $286 million total assets for which the advisory fee is based on
performance)
Other Accounts: 44 accounts, $21.8 billion total assets (7 accounts, $5 billion total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Sudarshan Murthy, CFA
Mutual Funds: 11 accounts, $47.97 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 42 accounts, $32.96 billion total assets (3
accounts, $286 million total assets for which the advisory fee is based on
performance)
Other Accounts: 44 accounts, $21.8 billion total assets (7 accounts, $5 billion total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Siddharth Jain
Mutual Funds: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for which the
advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for which the
advisory fee is based on performance)
C-17

Name of Portfolio Manager
Number of Accounts Managed by Each Portfolio Manager and Total Assets by Category as of
October 31, 2023
Insight North America LLC
Scott Zaleski, CFA
Mutual Funds: 4 accounts, $4.023 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 1 account, $194 million total assets (0 accounts,
$0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 17 accounts, $3.043 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Brendan Murphy, CFA
Mutual Funds: 3 accounts, $2.699 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 4 accounts, $213 million total assets (0 accounts,
$0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 7 accounts, $2.608 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
James DiChiaro
Mutual Funds: 6 accounts, $4.06 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 account, $ total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 24 accounts, $3.17 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Janus Henderson Investors US LLC
Julian McManus
Mutual Funds: 3 accounts, $5.59 billion total assets (2 accounts, $3.37 billion total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 3 accounts, $1.04 billion total assets (0 accounts,
$0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 2 account, $34.41 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Christopher O’Malley, CFA
Mutual Funds: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for which the
advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 0 account, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for which the
advisory fee is based on performance)
Loomis, Sayles & Company, L.P.
Aziz V. Hamzaogullari, CFA
Mutual Funds: 30 accounts, $22 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 20 accounts, $11.93 billion total assets (3
accounts, $563.13 million total assets for which the advisory fee is based on
performance)
Other Accounts: 132 accounts, $25.80 billion total assets (1 account,
$318.21 million total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Christopher T. Harms
Mutual Funds: 20 accounts, $5.34 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 11 accounts, $8.77 billion total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 299 accounts, $21.45 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
C-18

Name of Portfolio Manager
Number of Accounts Managed by Each Portfolio Manager and Total Assets by Category as of
October 31, 2023
Clifton V. Rowe, CFA
Mutual Funds: 9 accounts, $5.33 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 11 accounts, $8.77 billion total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 220 accounts, $20.63 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Daniel Conklin, CFA
Mutual Funds: 9 accounts, $5.33 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 11 accounts, $8.77 billion total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 221 accounts, $20.62 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Ian Anderson
Mutual Funds: 3 accounts, $2.81 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 1 account, $2.91 billion total assets (0 accounts,
$0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 38 accounts, $6.61 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Barath W. Sankaran, CFA
Mutual Funds: 3 accounts, $2.81 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 1 account, $2.91 billion total assets (0 accounts,
$0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 38 accounts, $6.61 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Mellon Investments Corporation
Marlene Walker Smith
Mutual Funds: 123 accounts, $117.91 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 118 accounts, $113.93 billion total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 64 accounts, $118.30 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
David France, CFA
Mutual Funds: 123 accounts, $117.91 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 118 accounts, $113.93 billion total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 64 accounts, $118.30 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Todd Frysinger, CFA
Mutual Funds: 123 accounts, $117.91 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 118 accounts, $113.93 billion total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 64 accounts, $118.30 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Vlasta Sheremeta, CFA
Mutual Funds: 123 accounts, $117.91 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 118 accounts, $113.93 billion total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 64 accounts, $118.30 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
C-19

Name of Portfolio Manager
Number of Accounts Managed by Each Portfolio Manager and Total Assets by Category as of
October 31, 2023
Michael Stoll
Mutual Funds: 123 accounts, $117.91 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 118 accounts, $113.93 billion total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 64 accounts, $118.30 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Nationwide Asset Management, LLC
Gary S. Davis, CFA
Mutual Funds: 2 accounts, $1.81 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for which the
advisory fee is based on performance)
Chad W. Finefrock, CFA
Mutual Funds: 2 accounts, $530 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 1 account, $2.996 billion total assets (0 accounts,
$0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for which the
advisory fee is based on performance)
Nicholas J. Kern, CFA
Mutual Funds: 2 accounts, $530 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for which the
advisory fee is based on performance)
Corsan Maley
Mutual Funds: 2 accounts, $1.81 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 6 accounts, $5.99 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Newton Investment Management North America, LLC
James H. Stavena
Mutual Funds: 15 accounts, $3.96 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 143 accounts, $7.74 billion total assets (2
accounts, $278.24 million total assets for which the advisory fee is based on
performance)
Other Accounts: 27 accounts, $3.30 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Dimitri Curtil
Mutual Funds: 14 accounts, $3.96 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 140 accounts, $7.63 billion total assets (2
accounts, $278.24 million total assets for which the advisory fee is based on
performance)
Other Accounts: 22 accounts, $2.38 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
C-20

Name of Portfolio Manager
Number of Accounts Managed by Each Portfolio Manager and Total Assets by Category as of
October 31, 2023
Torrey K. Zaches, CFA
Mutual Funds: 14 accounts, $3.96 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 138 accounts, $6.35 billion total assets (2
accounts, $278.24 million total assets for which the advisory fee is based on
performance)
Other Accounts: 24 accounts, $3.19 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
John C. Bailer, CFA
Mutual Funds: 7 accounts, $7.05 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 8 accounts, $843.79 billon total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 36 accounts, $5.79 billion total assets (4 accounts, $98.41 million
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Brian C. Ferguson
Mutual Funds: 7 accounts, $8.80 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 8 accounts, $843.79 million total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 35 accounts, $5.03 billion total assets (4 accounts, $98.41 million
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Keith Howell Jr., CFA
Mutual Funds: 7 accounts, $7.05 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets for
which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 8 accounts, $843.79 million total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 36 accounts, $4.96 billion total assets (4 accounts, $98.41 million
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
UBS Asset Management (Americas) Inc.
Joseph Elegante, CFA
Mutual Funds: 4 accounts, $512.04 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 17 accounts, $8.52 billion total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 6,694 accounts, $12.14 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Adam Jokich, CFA
Mutual Funds: 4 accounts, $512.04 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 15 accounts, $7.53 billion total assets (0
accounts, $0 total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 6,693 accounts, $11.13 billion total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
WCM Investment Management, LLC
Jonathon Detter, CFA
Mutual Funds: 5 accounts, $693.32 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 23 accounts, $375.25 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Anthony B. Glickhouse, CFA
Mutual Funds: 5 accounts, $693.32 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 23 accounts, $375.25 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
C-21

Name of Portfolio Manager
Number of Accounts Managed by Each Portfolio Manager and Total Assets by Category as of
October 31, 2023
Patrick McGee, CFA
Mutual Funds: 5 accounts, $693.32 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total assets
for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 0 accounts, $0 total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Accounts: 23 accounts, $375.25 million total assets (0 accounts, $0 total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Wellington Management Company LLP
Jonathan G. White, CFA
Mutual Funds: 15 accounts, $11.4 billion total assets (3 accounts, $4.4 billion total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 54 accounts, $14.7 billion total assets (7
accounts, $3.3 billion total assets for which the advisory fee is based on
performance)
Other Accounts: 90 accounts, $24.4 billion total assets (11 accounts, $5.4 billion
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Mary L. Pryshlak, CFA
Mutual Funds: 15 accounts, $11.4 billion total assets (3 accounts, $4.4 billion total
assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
Other Pooled Investment Vehicles: 51 accounts, $14.4 billion total assets (7
accounts, $3.3 billion total assets for which the advisory fee is based on
performance)
Other Accounts: 87 accounts, $24.3 billion total assets (11 accounts, $5.4 billion
total assets for which the advisory fee is based on performance)
POTENTIAL CONFLICTS OF INTEREST
Amundi Asset Management US, Inc. (“Amundi”)
Amundi has established an Investment and Trade Allocation Policy to ensure that there is fair and equitable allocation and aggregation of trades among the funds and clients for which Amundi acts as an Investment Manager.
Trades for accounts will be aggregated only if the following conditions are met:
Account trades are treated equally with other account trades;
Each participant in the trade will receive average execution and average commissions;
Securities purchased or sold are allocated pro rata; and or other equitable method; and
The practice of aggregating client trades is fully disclosed in the Form ADV of Amundi and each client's investment advisory contract.
Once a portfolio manager has decided to buy or sell an equity security for an account, he or she places the order with Amundi’s trading desk using Amundi’s trade order management system. Orders are time-stamped and then routed to the trading desk for execution. Once a portfolio manager places an order into the system, he or she cannot modify the order. Corrections to orders placed with Amundi’s trading desk must be cancelled and re-submitted.
Contemporaneous orders for the same security can be aggregated into a single trade. This function is performed automatically by the MCE/ALTO trade order management system if the orders are from the same portfolio manager and manually by the trading desk where the orders are from different portfolio managers.
Subsequent orders for a security are aggregated with existing orders for the same security, if the terms of the subsequent order are the same and the existing orders have not been executed. If the existing orders were executed before the subsequent orders are placed, subsequent orders for a security are not aggregated with existing orders. If an order for a security is partially filled when the trading desk receives a subsequent order for the same security with the same terms, the existing execution will be booked and the residual will be aggregated with the subsequent order. Price does not affect trade aggregation at Amundi.
C-22

Bailard, Inc. (“Bailard”)
Bailard’s services are provided to a broad range of client types. Conflicts of interest can arise with Bailard managing the Funds’ assets as well as the assets of its other clients. Some of these conflicts include:
Bailard and/or its affiliate are eligible to receive a performance-based fee or allocation from a pooled vehicle, i.e., Bailard Emerging Opportunities Fund I, LP (the “EOF”), when certain criteria are met1. For all other clients, Bailard charges fees that are based on a fixed percent of the assets under our management. The performance fee applicable to the pooled vehicle creates a potential conflict of interest in that it provides an incentive for Bailard to make investments that are riskier or more speculative than would be the case if such arrangements were not in effect. In addition, the performance fee creates a potential incentive for Bailard to favor the pooled vehicle over other client accounts in the allocation of investment opportunities. To mitigate these potential conflicts, Bailard has adopted side-by-side management and trade allocation policies and procedures designed to monitor that client accounts are treated fairly and equitably regardless of the types of fees that they pay.
From time to time, Bailard buys, sells, or sells short the same securities in different client accounts and in our own proprietary accounts (including those of certain affiliates). These trades may occur in the same direction (that is buying the same security in all affected accounts, selling the same security in all affected accounts or selling short the same securities in all affected accounts). These trades may also occur in opposite directions (that is buying the same security in one account (or accounts) while selling it or selling it short in other account(s) or vice versa). We can buy, sell or sell short the same security in different client accounts and in our proprietary accounts as long as the trades: (i) are consistent with the investment strategy for each account; and (ii) do not systematically favor or disadvantage one account or class of accounts over another.
Where more than one broker is believed to be capable of providing the best execution with respect to a particular portfolio transaction, Bailard periodically selects brokers that provide research or brokerage services to Bailard. Bailard also engages in commission sharing arrangements (“CSAs”) in which commissions for trades executed by one broker are shared with another broker that provides research or brokerage services to Bailard. These arrangements sometimes include agreement(s) with CSA aggregation firm(s) that transfer soft dollar credits from commissions generated from a non-CSA broker to a CSA broker which in turn will use those credits to pay for qualifying research services. All of these practices can cause a client’s account to pay an amount of commission to a broker greater than the amount another broker would have charged. In selecting such broker, Bailard will make a good faith determination that the amount of commission is reasonable in relation to the value of the research and brokerage services received, viewed in terms of either the specific transaction or Bailard’s overall responsibility to the accounts for which it exercises investment discretion. The receipt of research or brokerage services from any broker executing transactions for Bailard’s clients does not result in a reduction of Bailard’s customary and normal research activities. While the commissions for trades executed for Bailard Asset Management accounts generally generate soft dollar credits, those for Bailard Wealth Management accounts do not.The research and brokerage services received from brokers are used by Bailard to service accounts other than those that pay commissions to the broker-dealer providing the products or services. For example, it is expected that commissions attributable to clients of Bailard Asset Management will generate substantially more commission dollars than those attributable to accounts of clients of Bailard Wealth Management. Certain broker-dealers receiving commissions from Bailard clients provide Bailard with research and brokerage products or services which are used by Bailard to service other accounts regardless of whether such accounts generated any of the brokerage commissions. Nevertheless, to the extent Wealth Management clients invest in affiliated pooled vehicles and mutual funds managed by Bailard Asset Management, these clients indirectly generate commission dollars and in turn indirectly benefit from the research and brokerage services purchased with these commissions.
Portfolio transactions of numerous accounts may be aggregated based on concurrent authorizations to purchase or sell the same security for numerous accounts served by Bailard. Although such aggregations potentially could be either advantageous or disadvantageous to any one or more particular accounts for any given transaction, Bailard only aggregates trades to the extent it believes that such aggregation is in the best interests of the affected accounts and consistent with its duty to seek the best execution for client trades. Bailard has adopted trade aggregation and allocation policies and procedures designed to allocate trades in a manner that is fair and equitable allocation when trades are aggregated.
The same Bailard employee can serve as the portfolio manager of accounts with different investment strategies (including competing investment strategies) as long as all such accounts are treated fairly and equitably.
C-23

Bailard can give advice to, and take action on behalf of, any of our clients that differs from that of other clients so long as it is consistent with the client’s investment policy, and it is our policy, to the extent practicable, to allocate investment opportunities among our clients fairly and equitably over time. Bailard has adopted Bailard has adopted side-by-side management, trade allocation, IPO investment and allocation, and real estate deal allocation/portfolio rotation policies and procedures to help address conflicts of interests.
Certain of Bailard’s investment advisory clients serve on the Board of Directors of BB&K Holdings, Inc. (Bailard’s parent company). These clients are compensated for this service. A small number of clients also own shares of BB&K Holdings, Inc. stock. Certain Bailard clients (some of whom are also investors in the Real Estate Fund and/or the EOF) are currently loaning money to BB&K Holdings, Inc. and have access to certain of Bailard’s financial records that are not generally available to other clients. This arrangement creates a potential incentive for Bailard to give these clients preferential treatment. To address this conflict of interest, Bailard reviews the relative performance of these clients’ investment management account(s) as part of quarterly asset allocation/ performance reviews of Bailard Wealth Management accounts and as part of its compliance testing.
1Bailard is in the process of launching a new pooled vehicle, the Bailard Multifamily Fund, L.P. When certain conditions are met, Bailard would be eligible to receive an incentive allocation from this pooled vehicle.
BlackRock Investment Management, LLC (“BlackRock”)
BlackRock has built a professional working environment, firm-wide compliance culture and compliance procedures and systems designed to protect against potential incentives that may favor one account over another. BlackRock has adopted policies and procedures that address the allocation of investment opportunities, execution of portfolio transactions, personal trading by employees and other potential conflicts of interest that are designed to ensure that all client accounts are treated equitably over time. Nevertheless, BlackRock furnishes investment management and advisory services to numerous clients in addition to the Fund, and BlackRock may, consistent with applicable law, make investment recommendations to other clients or accounts (including accounts which are hedge funds or have performance or higher fees paid to BlackRock, or in which portfolio managers have a personal interest in the receipt of such fees), which may be the same as or different from those made to the Fund. In addition, BlackRock, its affiliates and significant shareholders and any officer, director, shareholder or employee may or may not have an interest in the securities whose purchase and sale BlackRock recommends to the Fund. BlackRock, or any of its affiliates or significant shareholders, or any officer, director, shareholder, employee or any member of their families may take different actions than those recommended to the Fund by BlackRock with respect to the same securities. Moreover, BlackRock may refrain from rendering any advice or services concerning securities of companies of which any of BlackRock’s (or its affiliates’ or significant shareholders’) officers, directors or employees are directors or officers, or companies as to which BlackRock or any of its affiliates or significant shareholders or the officers, directors and employees of any of them has any substantial economic interest or possesses material non-public information. Certain portfolio managers also may manage accounts whose investment strategies may at times be opposed to the strategy utilized for a fund. It should also be noted that Mr. Mauro and Ms. Uyehara may be managing hedge fund and/or long only accounts, or may be part of a team managing hedge fund and/or long only accounts, subject to incentive fees. Mr. Mauro and Ms. Uyehara may therefore be entitled to receive a portion of any incentive fees earned on such accounts.
As a fiduciary, BlackRock owes a duty of loyalty to its clients and must treat each client fairly. When BlackRock purchases or sells securities for more than one account, the trades must be allocated in a manner consistent with its fiduciary duties. BlackRock attempts to allocate investments in a fair and equitable manner among client accounts, with no account receiving preferential treatment. To this end, BlackRock has adopted policies that are intended to ensure reasonable efficiency in client transactions and provide BlackRock with sufficient flexibility to allocate investments in a manner that is consistent with the particular investment discipline and client base, as appropriate.
Brown Capital Management, LLC (“Brown Capital”)
Brown Capital does not maintain a separate policy titled conflicts of interests. However, it discloses conflicts of interests in its ADV part 2A and manages those conflicts with policies and procedures found in the Compliance Manual.
Brown Capital manages portfolios for multiple institutional, individual, and mutual fund clients. Each portfolio has its own set of investment objectives and investment policies that may differ from those of the Fund. The portfolio managers make investment decisions for each portfolio based on the investment objectives and policies and other relevant investment considerations applicable to that portfolio. Accordingly, a particular portfolio may contain different securities than the Fund, and investment decisions may be made in other accounts that are different than the decisions made for the Fund. As an
C-24

example, the portfolio manager may decide to buy a security in one or more portfolios, while selling the same security in other portfolios based on the different objectives, restrictions, and cash flows in the portfolios.
Brown Capital’s objective is to meet its fiduciary obligation to treat all clients fairly. To help accomplish this objective and to address potential conflicts of interest, Brown Capital has adopted and implemented policies and procedures reasonably designed to allocate investment opportunities on a fair and equitable basis over time. Brown Capital’s compliance procedures include actively monitoring compliance with investment policies, trade allocation, and Code of Ethics requirements. In addition, Brown Capital’s senior management team reviews the performance of portfolio managers and analysts.
Geneva Capital Management LLC (“Geneva”)
Geneva’s portfolio managers manage multiple accounts for a diverse client base, including mutual funds, collective investment trusts (CITs), separate accounts (assets managed on behalf of institutions such as pension funds, public entities and foundations) and wrap fee programs (“Other Accounts”). Certain of these Other Accounts may pay higher advisory fees than a Fund creating an incentive to favor the higher paying account. Therefore, conflicts of interest may arise in connection with the portfolio managers’ management of a Fund’s investments on the one hand and the investments of such Other Accounts on the other hand. However, Geneva has adopted policies and procedures designed to address such conflicts, including, among others, policies and procedures relating to allocation of investment opportunities, soft dollars, and aggregation of trades. It also developed procedures to compare performance among client accounts managed under similar investment styles to detect favoritism or unusual investment results.
Although Geneva’s investment decisions on behalf of a Fund may differ from and/or conflict with advice given to its other clients, some Other Accounts may make investments in the same type of instruments or securities as a Fund at the same time as a Fund. These Other Accounts may have investment strategies similar to a Fund. In addition, Geneva’s personnel may stand to benefit more personally from good investment performance by these Other Accounts than by equivalent performance of a Fund. In those instances, where a Fund and another client of Geneva’s trade in the same type of instrument at the same time, Geneva has established trading models and aggregation and allocation procedures to allocate such trades equitably among its various clients and a Fund. In some cases, these procedures may affect adversely the size or price of the position obtainable for a Fund.
In purchasing and selling portfolio securities for a Fund, Geneva seeks to obtain best execution on behalf of its clients. Geneva has adopted procedures to monitor its best execution responsibilities. Geneva does engage broker-dealers on behalf of a Fund who provide research services to Geneva at a commission rate that is higher than another broker might have charged. However, Geneva will only do so if it is determined that the commission is reasonable in relation to the value of the brokerage and research services that are provided, viewed in terms of either the particular transaction or Geneva’s other advisory accounts. Research services provided to Geneva from brokers in connection with a Fund’s brokerage transactions and Geneva’s Other Accounts may disproportionately benefit Geneva’s other clients based on the relative amounts of brokerage services provided to a Fund and such other clients.
Some Geneva employees or their family members have made investments in mutual funds that Geneva manages. Geneva also recommends mutual funds that they manage to certain clients. This presents a possible conflict of interest that could create an incentive for Geneva to favor those mutual funds over other clients. Geneva maintains investment and trade allocation policies and procedures designed to manage such conflicts of interest.
GQG Partners LLC (“GQG”)
GQG’s portfolio managers are also responsible for managing other account portfolios in addition to the Fund, including account portfolios in which they and/or other employees of GQG have an ownership interest.
The portfolio managers’ management of other accounts may give rise to potential conflicts of interest in connection with the management of the Fund’s investments on the one hand and the investments of the other accounts, on the other. The side-by-side management of the Fund and other accounts presents a variety of potential conflicts of interests. For example, a portfolio manager may purchase or sell securities for one portfolio and not another. The performance of securities within one portfolio may differ from the performance of securities in another portfolio.
C-25

In some cases, another account managed by a portfolio manager may compensate GQG based on performance of the portfolio held by that account. Performance-based fee arrangements may create an incentive for GQG to favor higher fee paying accounts over other accounts, including accounts that are charged no performance-based fees, in the allocation of investment opportunities. GQG has adopted policies and procedures that seek to mitigate such conflicts and to ensure that all clients are treated fairly and equitably.
Another potential conflict could arise in instances in which securities considered as investments for the Fund are also appropriate investments for other investment accounts managed by GQG. When a decision is made to buy or sell a security for the Fund and one or more of the other accounts, GQG may aggregate the purchase or sale of the securities and will allocate the securities transactions in a manner it believes to be equitable under the circumstances. However, a variety of factors can determine whether a particular account may participate in a particular aggregated transaction. Because of such differences, there may be differences in invested positions and securities held in accounts managed according to similar strategies. When aggregating orders, GQG employs procedures designed to ensure accounts will be treated in a fair and equitable manner and no account will be favored over any other. GQG has implemented specific policies and procedures to address any potential conflicts.
GQG may invest in securities of companies issued by broker-dealers (or their affiliates) used by GQG to effect transactions for client accounts, including the Fund.  In addition, from time to time, GQG directs trades to broker-dealers that are clients of GQG (or are affiliated with clients of GQG) that provide investment banking or other financial services to GQG (or are affiliated with companies that provide such services) and/or that sponsor pooled vehicles to which GQG provides investment advisory services (or are affiliated with such sponsors).  These various business relationships with other companies give rise to rise to conflicts of interest and incentives to favor the interests of these companies when GQG provides services to the Fund and its other clients.  GQG has adopted policies and procedures that are designed to address such conflicts of interest to help ensure that it acts in a manner that is consistent with its fiduciary obligations to all clients.
Subject to its duty to seek best execution, GQG may select broker-dealers that furnish GQG with proprietary and/or third-party research and brokerage services (collectively, “Services”) that provide, in GQG’s view, appropriate assistance in the investment decision-making process. These Services may be bundled with the trade execution, clearing, or settlement services provided by a particular broker-dealer and/or, subject to applicable law, GQG may pay for such Services with client commissions (or “soft dollars”). Services received by GQG may include, for example, proprietary and third-party research reports on markets, companies, industries and securities, access to broker-dealer analysts and issuer representatives, and trading software to route orders to market centers. As result, the Fund may pay a commission that is higher than the commission another qualified broker-dealer might charge to effect the same transaction. Use of soft dollars may create a conflict of interest in executing trades for client accounts. Services may be used in servicing any or all of GQG’s clients, and may benefit certain accounts more than others. GQG receives such Services in a manner consistent with the “safe harbor” requirements of Section 28(e) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”) and has adopted policies and procedures to mitigate conflicts.
Insight North America LLC (“Insight”)
Insight ensures it manages conflicts of interest fairly and in accordance with the Securities and Exchange Commission and does not place its own interests unfairly above those of its customers. Where potential conflicts arise, Insight will not enter into a transaction until it has ensured the fair treatment for all customers. In order to preserve its reputation and comply with applicable legal and regulatory requirements, Insight believes managing perceived conflicts is as important as managing actual conflicts.
Janus Henderson Investors US LLC (“Janus Henderson”)
Portfolio management generally manages other accounts, including accounts that may hold the same securities as or pursue investment strategies similar to the Funds. Those other accounts may include separately managed accounts, model or emulation accounts, Janus Henderson mutual funds and ETFs, private-label funds for which the Adviser or an affiliate serves as subadviser, or other Janus Henderson pooled investment vehicles, such as hedge funds, which may have different fee structures or rates than a Fund or may have a performance-based management fee. The Adviser or an affiliate may also proprietarily invest in or provide seed capital to some but not all of these accounts. In addition, portfolio management may personally invest in or provide seed capital to some but not all of these accounts, and certain of these accounts may have a greater impact on their compensation than others. Further, portfolio management (or their family members) may beneficially
C-26

own or transact in the same securities as those held in a Fund’s portfolio. Moreover, portfolio management may also have other roles at Janus Henderson (e.g., research analyst) and receive compensation attributable to the other roles. Portfolio management may also have roles with an affiliate of the Adviser, and provide advice on behalf of the Adviser through participating affiliate agreements, and receive compensation attributable to other roles. These factors could create conflicts of interest between portfolio management and the Funds because portfolio management may have incentives to favor one or more accounts over others or one role over another in the allocation of time, resources, or investment opportunities and the sequencing of trades, resulting in the potential for the Fund to be disadvantaged relative to one or more other accounts.
A conflict of interest between the Funds and other clients, including one or more Funds, may arise if portfolio management identifies a limited investment opportunity that may be appropriate for a Fund, but the Fund is not able to take full advantage of that opportunity due to the need to allocate that opportunity among other accounts also managed by such portfolio management. A conflict may also arise if a portfolio manager executes transactions in one or more accounts that adversely impact the value of securities held by a Fund.
The Adviser believes that these and other conflicts are mitigated by policies, procedures, and practices in place, including those governing personal trading, proprietary trading and seed capital deployment, aggregation and allocation of trades, allocation of limited offerings, cross trades, and best execution. In addition, the Adviser generally requires portfolio management to manage accounts with similar investment strategies in a similar fashion, subject to a variety of exceptions, including, but not limited to, investment restrictions or policies applicable only to certain accounts, certain portfolio holdings that may be transferred in-kind when an account is opened, differences in cash flows and account sizes, and similar factors.
The Adviser monitors accounts with similar strategies for any holdings, risk, or performance dispersion or unfair treatment. The Adviser and its affiliates generate trades throughout the day, depending on the volume of orders received from portfolio management, for all of its clients using trade system software. Trades are pre-allocated to individual clients and submitted to selected brokers via electronic files, in alignment with the Adviser’s best execution policy. If an order is not completely filled, executed shares are allocated to client accounts in proportion to the order. In addition, the Adviser has adopted trade allocation procedures that govern allocation of securities among various Janus Henderson accounts. Trade allocation and personal trading are described in further detail under “Additional Information About the Adviser.”
The Adviser manages the Funds and the Janus Henderson “funds of funds,” which are funds that invest primarily in other Janus Henderson funds. Because the Adviser manages the Janus Henderson “funds of funds” and the Funds, it is subject to certain potential conflicts of interest when allocating the assets of a Janus Henderson “fund of funds” among such Funds. For example, the Adviser has a conflict of interest in selecting investments for a Fund because the underlying funds, unlike unaffiliated investment companies, pay fees to the Adviser, and the fees paid to it by some underlying funds are higher than the fees paid by other underlying funds. Further, the Janus Henderson “funds of funds” investments have been and may continue to be a significant portion of the investments in other Janus Henderson funds, allowing the Adviser the opportunity to recoup expenses it previously waived or reimbursed for a Fund, or to reduce the amount of seed capital investment needed by Janus for the Janus Henderson funds. Purchases and redemptions of Fund shares by a Janus Henderson “funds of funds” due to reallocations or rebalancing may result in a Fund having to sell securities or invest cash when it otherwise would not do so, which could accelerate the realization of taxable income or cause actual expenses to increase. In addition, redemptions by a Janus Henderson “funds of funds” could cause actual expenses to increase, or could result in a Fund’s current expense being allocated over a smaller asset base, which may lead to an increase in the Fund’s expense ratio.
The impact of these transactions is likely to be greater when a Janus Henderson “funds of funds” purchases, redeems, or owns a substantial portion of a Fund’s shares.
Loomis, Sayles & Company, L.P. (“Loomis Sayles”)
Conflicts of interest may arise in the allocation of investment opportunities and the allocation of aggregated orders among the Funds and other accounts managed by the Portfolio Managers. A Portfolio Manager potentially could give favorable treatment to some accounts for a variety of reasons, including favoring larger accounts, accounts that pay higher fees, accounts that pay performance-based fees, accounts of affiliated companies and accounts in which the Portfolio Manager has an interest. In addition, due to differences in the investment strategies or restrictions among the Fund(s) and a Portfolio Manager’s other accounts, the Portfolio Manager may take action with respect to another account that differs from the action taken with respect to the Fund(s). Although such favorable treatment could lead to more favorable investment opportunities or allocations for some accounts and may appear to create additional conflicts of interest for the Portfolio Manager in the
C-27

allocation of management time and resources, Loomis Sayles strives to ensure that Portfolio Managers endeavor to exercise their discretion in a manner that is equitable to all interested persons. Furthermore, Loomis Sayles makes investment decisions for all accounts (including institutional accounts, mutual funds, hedge funds and affiliated accounts) based on each account’s investment objective, investment guidelines and restrictions, the availability of other comparable investment opportunities and Loomis Sayles’ desire to treat all accounts fairly and equitably over time. Loomis Sayles maintains Trade Aggregation and Allocation Policies and Procedures to mitigate the effects of these potential conflicts as well as other types of conflicts of interest. However, there is no guarantee that such procedures will detect each and every situation where a conflict arises or that Loomis Sayles will treat all accounts identically. Conflicts of interest also arise to the extent a Portfolio Manager short sells a stock or otherwise takes a short position in one client account but holds that stock long in other accounts, including the Fund(s), or sells a stock for some accounts while buying the stock for others, and through the use of “soft dollar arrangements,” which are discussed in Loomis Sayles’ Brokerage Allocation Policies and Procedures and Loomis Sayles’ Trade Aggregation and Allocation Policies and Procedures.
Mellon Investments Corporation (“Mellon”)
It is the policy of Mellon Investments Corporation (the “Firm”) to make business decisions free from conflicting outside influences. The Firm’s objective is to recognize potential conflicts of interest and work to eliminate or control and disclose such conflicts as they are identified. The Firm’s business decisions are based on its duty to its clients, and not driven by any personal interest or gain. As an asset manager operating in a number of different jurisdictions with a diverse client base in a variety of strategies, conflicts of interest are inherent. Furthermore, as an indirect subsidiary of The Bank of New York Mellon Corporation (“BNYM”), potential conflicts may also arise between the Firm and other BNYM companies.
The Firm will take steps to provide reasonable assurance that no client or group of clients is advantaged at the expense of any other client. As such, the Firm has adopted a Code of Ethics (the “Code”) and compliance policy manual to address such conflicts. These potential and inherent conflicts include but are not limited to: the allocation of investment opportunities, side by side management, execution of portfolio transactions, brokerage conflicts, compensation conflicts, related party arrangements, personal interests, and other investment and operational conflicts of interest. Our compliance policies are designed to ensure that all client accounts are treated equitably over time. Additionally, the Firm has structured compensation of investment personnel to reasonably safeguard client accounts from being adversely impacted by any potential or related conflicts.
All material conflicts of interest are presented in greater detail within Part 2A of our Form ADV.
Nationwide Asset Management, LLC (“Nationwide Asset Management”)
Nationwide Asset Management is a separate, wholly owned subsidiary of Nationwide Mutual Insurance Company. Certain employees of the firm may also provide advisory services to affiliated portfolios outside of the Registered Investment Adviser, including Nationwide Life Insurance and Nationwide Mutual Insurance, side by side to its clients.
Nationwide Fund Distributors, LLC is an affiliated broker dealer that distributes funds for which Nationwide Asset Management performs sub-advisory services on behalf of Nationwide Funds Advisors to Nationwide Mutual Funds and the Nationwide Variable Insurance Trust.
Investment adviser representatives of Nationwide Asset Management may also be representatives of our affiliated broker-dealers Nationwide Investment Services Corporation and Nationwide Securities. Nationwide Asset Management does not place trades through affiliated broker-dealers.
Nationwide Asset Management has adopted a Code of Ethics and Gifts and Entertainment Policy for all supervised persons of the firm describing its high standard of business conduct, and fiduciary duty to its clients. The Code of Ethics includes provisions relating to the confidentiality of client information, a prohibition on insider trading, restrictions on the acceptance of significant gifts and the reporting of certain gifts and business entertainment items, and personal securities trading procedures, among other things. All supervised persons at Nationwide Asset Management must acknowledge the terms of the Code of Ethics annually, or as amended.
Nationwide Asset Management anticipates that, in appropriate circumstances, consistent with clients’ investment objectives, it will cause accounts over which it has management authority to effect, and will recommend to investment advisory clients
C-28

or prospective clients, the purchase or sale of securities in which its access persons, its affiliates and/or clients, directly or indirectly, have a position of interest. Nationwide Asset Management’s personnel are required to follow its Code of Ethics. Subject to satisfying this policy and applicable laws, officers, directors and employees of Nationwide Asset Management and its affiliates may trade for their own accounts in securities which are recommended to and/or purchased for its clients. The Code of Ethics is designed to assure that the personal securities transactions, activities and interests of the employees of Nationwide Asset Management will not interfere with (i) making decisions in the best interest of advisory clients and (ii) implementing such decisions while, at the same time, allowing employees to invest for their own accounts. Under the Code certain classes of securities have been designated as exempt transactions, based upon a determination that these would materially not interfere with the best interest of Nationwide Asset Management’s clients. In addition, the Code requires pre-clearance of certain transactions against a restricted list. Nonetheless, because the Code of Ethics in some circumstances would permit employees to invest in the same securities as clients, there is a possibility that employees might benefit from market activity by a client in a security held by an employee. Employee trading is continually monitored under the Code of Ethics to reasonably prevent conflicts of interest between Nationwide Asset Management and its clients.
Nationwide Asset Management may use the products or services provided by brokers to service all accounts managed by it and not just the accounts whose transactions were associated with the broker providing the product or service. However, Nationwide Asset Management expects that each client will benefit overall by this practice because each is receiving the benefit of research services that it might not otherwise receive. To the extent brokers supply research to the firm, it is relieved of expenses that it might otherwise bear.
There are situations where Nationwide Asset Management would deem it advisable to purchase or sell the same securities for two or more clients at the same time, or approximately the same time. In this case, Nationwide Asset Management may execute the orders to purchase or sell on an aggregated basis. When possible, client trades in the same security will be aggregated into a Single Executable Order when the firm determines that it is consistent with best execution and in the best interests of its clients.
Aggregated trades may be used to facilitate best execution by negotiating more favorable prices, obtaining more timely execution or reducing overall transaction costs.
When a decision is made to aggregate transactions on behalf of more than one account, such transactions will be allocated to all participating client accounts in a fair and equitable manner. Affiliated accounts may be included in aggregated trade orders.
Nationwide Asset Management does not engage in cross trades between client portfolios.
The firm does not have soft dollar arrangements with broker-dealers however it does receive research materials.
Newton Investment Management North America, LLC (“NIMNA”)
It is the policy of the Firm to make business decisions free from conflict. The Firm’s objective is to recognize potential conflicts of interest and work to eliminate or control and disclose such conflicts as they are identified. The Firm’s business decisions are based on its duty to its clients, and not driven by any personal interest or gain.
As an asset manager with a diverse client base in a variety of strategies, conflicts of interest are inherent. Furthermore, as an indirect subsidiary of The Bank of New York Mellon Corporation (“BNY Mellon”), potential conflicts may also arise between NIMNA and other BNY Mellon companies. NIMNA will take steps to provide reasonable assurance that no client or group of clients is advantaged at the expense of any other client.
UBS Asset Management (Americas) Inc. (“UBS AM”)
The portfolio management team’s management of the Fund and other accounts could result in potential conflicts of interest if the Fund and other accounts have different objectives, benchmarks and fees because the portfolio management team must allocate its time and investment expertise across multiple accounts, including the Fund. A portfolio manager and his or her team manage the Fund and other accounts utilizing a model portfolio approach that groups similar accounts within a model portfolio. UBS AM manages accounts according to the appropriate model portfolio, including where possible, those accounts
C-29

that have specific investment restrictions. Accordingly, portfolio holdings, position sizes and industry and sector exposures tend to be similar across accounts, which may minimize the potential for conflicts of interest.
If a portfolio manager identifies a limited investment opportunity that may be suitable for more than one account or model portfolio, the Fund may not be able to take full advantage of that opportunity due to an allocation of filled purchase or sale orders across all eligible model portfolios and accounts. To deal with these situations, UBS AM has adopted procedures for allocating portfolio trades across multiple accounts to provide fair treatment to all accounts.
The management of personal accounts by a portfolio manager may also give rise to potential conflicts of interest. UBS AM has adopted a Code of Ethics that governs such personal trading but there is no assurance that the Code will adequately address all such conflicts.
UBS Group AG (“UBS”) is a worldwide full-service investment banking, broker-dealer, asset management and financial services organization. As a result, UBS AM and UBS (including, for these purposes, their directors, partners, officers and employees) worldwide, including the entities and personnel who may be involved in the investment activities and business operations of the Fund are engaged in businesses and have interests other than that of managing the Fund. These activities and interests include potential multiple advisory, transactional, financial, consultative, and other interests in transactions, companies, securities and other instruments that may be engaged in, purchased or sold by the Fund.
UBS AM may purchase or sell, or recommend for purchase or sale, for the Fund or its other accounts securities of companies: (i) with respect to which its affiliates act as an investment banker or financial adviser; (ii) with which its affiliates have other confidential relationships; (iii) in which its affiliates maintain a position or (iv) for which its affiliates make a market; or in which it or its officers, directors or employees or those of its affiliates own securities or otherwise have an interest. Except to the extent prohibited by law or regulation or by client instruction, UBS AM may recommend to the Fund or its other clients, or purchase for the Fund or its other clients, securities of issuers in which UBS has an interest as described in this paragraph.
UBS AM manages accounts of certain clients by means of separate accounts (“Separate Accounts”). With respect to the Fund, UBS AM may follow a strategy that is expected to be similar over time to that delivered by the Separate Accounts. The Fund and the Separate Account Clients are subject to independent management and, given the independence in the implementation of advice to these accounts, there can be no assurance that such investment advice will be implemented simultaneously. While each will use reasonable endeavors to procure timely execution, it is possible that prior execution for or on behalf of the Separate Accounts could adversely affect the prices and availability of the securities, currencies and instruments in which the Fund invests.
From time to time and subject to client approval, UBS AM may rely on certain affiliates to execute trades for the Fund or its other accounts. For each security transaction effected by UBS, UBS AM may compensate and UBS may retain such compensation for effecting the transaction, and UBS AM may receive affiliated group credit for generating such business.
Transactions undertaken by UBS or client accounts managed by UBS (“Client Accounts”) may adversely impact the Fund. UBS and one or more Client Accounts may buy or sell positions while the Fund is undertaking the same or a differing, including potentially opposite, strategy, which could disadvantage the Fund.
UBS AM manages both accounts that are charged a performance-based fee and accounts that are charged a flat fee or an asset-based fee. Conflicts of interests may arise when managing these accounts side-by-side, as there may be an incentive to favor accounts for which UBS AM receives a performance-based fee. UBS AM seeks to mitigate these potential conflicts by implementing a number of compliance policies and business processes. Specifically, prior to implementing performance-based fee arrangements, these arrangements are reviewed by UBS AM to assess whether the proposed fee arrangement would unfairly disadvantage any of UBS AM’s clients. In addition, many of UBS AM’s strategies are managed on a model basis, meaning the portfolio managers manage a model for the strategy and translation of the models into individual client portfolios is handled by multiple other functions within UBS AM. This division of labor imparts checks and balances into the portfolio management process that minimizes the potential for one account to be favored over another. UBS AM’s performance measurement team and compliance personnel monitor for dispersion of investment performance among similarly managed accounts to confirm that no accounts are being favored. UBS AM has established a trade allocation policy designed to ensure fair and equitable allocation of investments among client accounts. Additionally, portfolio holdings, position sizes and industry and sector exposures tend to be similar across accounts, which may minimize the potential for conflicts of interests.
C-30

UBS AM and its advisory affiliates utilize a common portfolio and trading platform for its clients. Certain investment professionals and other employees of UBS AM are officers of advisory affiliates and related persons and may provide investment advisory services to clients of such affiliated entities. UBS AM’s personnel also provide research and trading support to personnel of certain advisory affiliates.
While it selects brokers primarily on the basis of the execution capabilities, UBS AM, in its discretion, may cause a client to pay a commission to brokers or dealers for effecting a transaction for that client in excess of the amount another broker or dealer would have charged for effecting that transaction. This may be done when UBS AM has determined in good faith that the commission is reasonable in relation to the value of the execution, brokerage and/or research services provided by the broker. UBS AM’s arrangements for the receipt of research services from brokers may create conflicts of interest, in that it has an incentive to choose a broker or dealer that provides research services, instead of one that charges a lower commission rate but does not provide any research. Brokers may provide third party research services through client commission arrangements (CCAs) or commission sharing arrangements (CSAs). Research-related costs may be shared by advisory affiliates and related persons and may benefit the clients of such advisory affiliates. Since research services are shared between UBS AM and its advisory affiliates, UBS AM and its advisory affiliates maintain an aggregated CCA/CSA research budget. Therefore, research services that benefit UBS AM’s clients may be paid for with commissions generated by clients of its advisory affiliates. Similarly, research services paid for by commissions generated by UBS AM’s clients may benefit advisory affiliates and their clients. UBS AM does not allocate the relative costs or benefits of research received from brokers or dealers among its clients because UBS AM believes that the research received is, in the aggregate, of assistance in fulfilling UBS AM’s overall responsibilities to its clients. The research may be used in connection with the management of accounts other than those for which trades are executed by the brokers or dealers providing the research.
WCM Investment Management, LLC (“WCM”)
The management of multiple funds and accounts may give rise to potential conflicts of interest if the funds and other accounts have different objectives, benchmarks, time horizons, and fees as the portfolio manager must allocate his time and investment ideas across multiple funds and accounts. The firm seeks to manage such competing interests for the time and attention of portfolio managers by having portfolio managers focus on a particular investment discipline. Most other accounts managed by a portfolio manager are managed using the same investment strategies that are used in connection with the management of the Fund. Accordingly, portfolio holdings, position sizes, and industry and sector exposures tend to be similar across similar portfolios, which may minimize the potential for conflicts of interest. The separate management of the trade execution and valuation functions from the portfolio management process also helps to reduce potential conflicts of interest. However, securities selected for funds or accounts other than the Fund may outperform the securities selected for the Fund. Moreover, if a portfolio manager identifies a limited investment opportunity that may be suitable for more than one fund or other account, the Fund may not be able to take full advantage of that opportunity due to an allocation of that opportunity across all eligible funds and other accounts. The firm seeks to manage such potential conflicts by using procedures intended to provide a fair allocation of buy and sell opportunities among funds and other accounts.
The management of personal accounts by a portfolio manager may give rise to potential conflicts of interest. While WCM has adopted a code of ethics which we believe contains provisions reasonably necessary to prevent a wide range of prohibited activities by portfolio managers and others with respect to their personal trading activities, there can be no assurance that the code of ethics addresses all individual conduct that could result in conflicts of interest.
In addition, WCM has adopted certain compliance procedures that are designed to address these, and other, types of conflicts. However, there is no guarantee that such procedures will detect each and every situation where a conflict arises.
Wellington Management Company LLP (“Wellington Management”)
Individual investment professionals at Wellington Management manage multiple accounts for multiple clients. These accounts may include mutual funds, separate accounts (assets managed on behalf of institutions, such as pension funds, insurance companies, foundations, or separately managed account programs sponsored by financial intermediaries), bank common trust accounts, and hedge funds. Each Fund’s manager listed in the prospectus who are primarily responsible for the day-to-day management of the Funds (“Portfolio Manager”) generally manage accounts in several different investment styles. These accounts may have investment objectives, strategies, time horizons, tax considerations and risk profiles that differ from those of the Funds. The Portfolio Managers make investment decisions for each account, including the Fund, based on the investment objectives, policies, practices, benchmarks, cash flows, tax and other relevant investment
C-31

considerations applicable to that account. Consequently, the Portfolio Managers may purchase or sell securities, including IPOs, for one account and not another account, and the performance of securities purchased for one account may vary from the performance of securities purchased for other accounts. Alternatively, these accounts may be managed in a similar fashion to the Fund and thus the accounts may have similar, and in some cases nearly identical, objectives, strategies and/or holdings to that of the Fund.
The Portfolio Managers or other investment professionals at Wellington Management may place transactions on behalf of other accounts that are directly or indirectly contrary to investment decisions made on behalf of the Fund, or make investment decisions that are similar to those made for the Fund, both of which have the potential to adversely impact the Fund depending on market conditions. For example, an investment professional may purchase a security in one account while appropriately selling that same security in another account. Similarly, the Portfolio Managers may purchase the same security for the Fund and one or more other accounts at or about the same time. In those instances, the other accounts will have access to their respective holdings prior to the public disclosure of the Fund’s holdings. In addition, some of these accounts have fee structures, including performance fees, which are or have the potential to be higher, in some cases significantly higher, than the fees Wellington Management receives for managing the Fund. The Portfolio Manager also manage accounts which pay performance allocations to Wellington Management or its affiliates. Because incentive payments paid by Wellington Management to the Portfolio Managers are tied to revenues earned by Wellington Management and, where noted, to the performance achieved by the manager in each account, the incentives associated with any given account may be significantly higher or lower than those associated with other accounts managed by Portfolio Managers. Finally, the Portfolio Managers may hold shares or investments in the other pooled investment vehicles and/or other accounts identified above.
Wellington Management’s goal is to meet its fiduciary obligation to treat all clients fairly and provide high quality investment services to all its clients. Wellington Management has adopted and implemented policies and procedures, including brokerage and trade allocation policies and procedures, which it believes address the conflicts associated with managing multiple accounts for multiple clients. In addition, Wellington Management monitors a variety of areas, including compliance with primary account guidelines, the allocation of IPOs, and compliance with the firm’s Code of Ethics, and places additional investment restrictions on investment professionals who manage hedge funds and certain other accounts. Furthermore, senior investment and business personnel at Wellington Management periodically review the performance of Wellington Management’s investment professionals. Although Wellington Management does not track the time an investment professional spends on a single account, Wellington Management does periodically assess whether an investment professional has adequate time and resources to effectively manage the investment professional’s various client mandates.
C-32

Appendix D
5% Shareholders
Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-1

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-2

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-3

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-4

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-5

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-6

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-7

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-8

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-9

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-10

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-11

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-12

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-13

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-14

Fund Name/Class
Shareholder Name
City
State
Zip
Number of Shares
% of Ownership
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
D-15